Add selftests run filtering
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662 place:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668 @end smallexample
1669
1670 @noindent
1671 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680 @cindex completion of structure field names
1681 @cindex structure field name completion
1682 @cindex completion of union field names
1683 @cindex union field name completion
1684 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689 left-hand-side:
1690
1691 @smallexample
1692 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694 to_data to_isatty to_write
1695 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696 to_flush to_read
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 @noindent
1700 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702 follows:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 struct ui_file
1706 @{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718 @}
1719 @end smallexample
1720
1721
1722 @node Help
1723 @section Getting Help
1724 @cindex online documentation
1725 @kindex help
1726
1727 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728 using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730 @table @code
1731 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732 @item help
1733 @itemx h
1734 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 (@value{GDBP}) help
1739 List of classes of commands:
1740
1741 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743 data -- Examining data
1744 files -- Specifying and examining files
1745 internals -- Maintenance commands
1746 obscure -- Obscure features
1747 running -- Running the program
1748 stack -- Examining the stack
1749 status -- Status inquiries
1750 support -- Support facilities
1751 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756 commands in that class.
1757 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758 documentation.
1759 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760 (@value{GDBP})
1761 @end smallexample
1762 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764 @item help @var{class}
1765 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767 help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1771 Status inquiries.
1772
1773 List of commands:
1774
1775 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777 info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779 show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783 documentation.
1784 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785 (@value{GDBP})
1786 @end smallexample
1787
1788 @item help @var{command}
1789 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792 @kindex apropos
1793 @item apropos @var{args}
1794 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798 @smallexample
1799 apropos alias
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent
1803 results in:
1804
1805 @smallexample
1806 @c @group
1807 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 @c @end group
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @kindex complete
1816 @item complete @var{args}
1817 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819 command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 complete i
1823 @end smallexample
1824
1825 @noindent results in:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 @group
1829 if
1830 ignore
1831 info
1832 inspect
1833 @end group
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837 @end table
1838
1839 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845 Index}.
1846
1847 @c @group
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex info
1850 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851 @item info
1852 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857 @w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859 @kindex set
1860 @item set
1861 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863 @code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865 @kindex show
1866 @item show
1867 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868 @value{GDBN} itself.
1869 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874 @kindex info set
1875 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881 @end table
1882 @c @end group
1883
1884 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @kindex show version
1889 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890 @item show version
1891 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899 @value{GDBN}.
1900
1901 @kindex show copying
1902 @kindex info copying
1903 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904 @item show copying
1905 @itemx info copying
1906 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908 @kindex show warranty
1909 @kindex info warranty
1910 @item show warranty
1911 @itemx info warranty
1912 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915 @kindex show configuration
1916 @item show configuration
1917 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922 your report.
1923
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Running
1927 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930 debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935 kill a child process.
1936
1937 @menu
1938 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939 * Starting:: Starting your program
1940 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1951 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952 @end menu
1953
1954 @node Compilation
1955 @section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961 and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964 the compiler.
1965
1966 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970 executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996 format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998 @need 2000
1999 @node Starting
2000 @section Starting your Program
2001 @cindex starting
2002 @cindex running
2003
2004 @table @code
2005 @kindex run
2006 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007 @item run
2008 @itemx r
2009 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015 @end table
2016
2017 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022 message like this one:
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026 Try "help target" or "continue".
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031 first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038 divided into four categories:
2039
2040 @table @asis
2041 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2042 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046 the arguments.
2047 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051 below for details).
2052
2053 @item The @emph{environment.}
2054 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2060 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2061 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2062 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2063
2064 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2065 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2066 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2067 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2068 set a different device for your program.
2069 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2070
2071 @cindex pipes
2072 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2073 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2074 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2075 wrong program.
2076 @end table
2077
2078 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2079 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2080 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2081 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2082 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2083
2084 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2085 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2086 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2087 your current breakpoints.
2088
2089 @table @code
2090 @kindex start
2091 @item start
2092 @cindex run to main procedure
2093 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2094 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2095 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2096 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2097 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2098 procedure, depending on the language used.
2099
2100 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2101 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2102 the @samp{run} command.
2103
2104 @cindex elaboration phase
2105 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2106 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2107 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2108 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2109 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2110 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2111 will remain to halt execution.
2112
2113 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2114 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2115 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2116 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2117 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2118
2119 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2120 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2121 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2122 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2123 elaboration code before running your program.
2124
2125 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2126 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2127 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2128 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2129 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2130 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2131 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2132 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2133 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2134 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2135 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2136 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2137
2138 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2139 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2140 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2141 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2142
2143 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2144 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2145 environment:
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2149 (@value{GDBP}) run
2150 @end smallexample
2151
2152 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2153 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2154
2155 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2156 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2157 @item set startup-with-shell
2158 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2159 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2160 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2161 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2162 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2163 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2164 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2165 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2166 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2167 startup failures such as:
2168
2169 @smallexample
2170 (@value{GDBP}) run
2171 Starting program: ./a.out
2172 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2173 @end smallexample
2174
2175 @noindent
2176 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2177 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2178 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2179 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2180 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2181 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2182
2183 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2184 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2185 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2186 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2187 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2188 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2189
2190 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2191 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2192 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2193 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2194 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2195 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2196
2197 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2198 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2199 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2200
2201 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2202 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 (@value{GDBP}) run
2206 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2207 @end smallexample
2208
2209 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2210 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2211
2212 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2213 @code{target native} command. For example,
2214
2215 @smallexample
2216 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2217 (@value{GDBP}) run
2218 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2219 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2220 (@value{GDBP}) run
2221 Starting program: ./a.out
2222 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2223 @end smallexample
2224
2225 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2226 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2227 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2228 disconnect.
2229
2230 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2231 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2232 proc}, @code{info os}.
2233
2234 @kindex set disable-randomization
2235 @item set disable-randomization
2236 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2237 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2238 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2239 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2240 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2241
2242 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2243 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2247 @end smallexample
2248
2249 @item set disable-randomization off
2250 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2251 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2252 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2253 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2254 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2255 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2256
2257 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2258 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2259 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2260 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2261 a code at its expected addresses.
2262
2263 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2264 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2265 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2266 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2267 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2268 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2269 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2270 a randomly chosen address.
2271
2272 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2273 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2274 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2275 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2276 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2277
2278 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2279 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2280
2281 @item show disable-randomization
2282 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2283 the virtual address space of the started program.
2284
2285 @end table
2286
2287 @node Arguments
2288 @section Your Program's Arguments
2289
2290 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2291 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2292 @code{run} command.
2293 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2294 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2295 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2296 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2297 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2298
2299 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2300 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2301 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2302 the program, not by the shell.
2303
2304 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2305 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2306
2307 @table @code
2308 @kindex set args
2309 @item set args
2310 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2311 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2312 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2313 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2314 it again without arguments.
2315
2316 @kindex show args
2317 @item show args
2318 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2319 @end table
2320
2321 @node Environment
2322 @section Your Program's Environment
2323
2324 @cindex environment (of your program)
2325 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2326 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2327 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2328 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2329 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2330 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2331 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2332
2333 @table @code
2334 @kindex path
2335 @item path @var{directory}
2336 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2337 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2338 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2339 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2340 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2341 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2342 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2343
2344 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2345 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2346 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2347 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2348 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2349 @var{directory} to the search path.
2350 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2351 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2352
2353 @kindex show paths
2354 @item show paths
2355 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2356 environment variable).
2357
2358 @kindex show environment
2359 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2360 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2361 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2362 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2363 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2364
2365 @kindex set environment
2366 @anchor{set environment}
2367 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2368 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2369 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2370 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2371 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2372 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2373 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2374 null value.
2375 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2376 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2377
2378 For example, this command:
2379
2380 @smallexample
2381 set env USER = foo
2382 @end smallexample
2383
2384 @noindent
2385 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2386 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2387 are not actually required.)
2388
2389 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2390 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2391 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2392 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2393 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2394
2395 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2396 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2397 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2398
2399 @kindex unset environment
2400 @anchor{unset environment}
2401 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2402 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2403 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2404 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2405 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2406
2407 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2408 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2409 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2410 @end table
2411
2412 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2413 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2414 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2415 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2416 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2417 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2418 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2419 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2420 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2421 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2422
2423 @node Working Directory
2424 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2425
2426 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2427 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2428 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2429 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2430 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2431 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2432
2433 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2434 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2435 Specify Files}.
2436
2437 @table @code
2438 @kindex cd
2439 @cindex change working directory
2440 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2441 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2442 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2443
2444 @kindex pwd
2445 @item pwd
2446 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2447 @end table
2448
2449 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2450 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2451 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2452 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2453 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2454 current working directory of the debuggee.
2455
2456 @node Input/Output
2457 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2458
2459 @cindex redirection
2460 @cindex i/o
2461 @cindex terminal
2462 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2463 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2464 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2465 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2466 running your program.
2467
2468 @table @code
2469 @kindex info terminal
2470 @item info terminal
2471 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2472 program is using.
2473 @end table
2474
2475 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2476 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2477
2478 @smallexample
2479 run > outfile
2480 @end smallexample
2481
2482 @noindent
2483 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2484
2485 @kindex tty
2486 @cindex controlling terminal
2487 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2488 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2489 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2490 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2491 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2492
2493 @smallexample
2494 tty /dev/ttyb
2495 @end smallexample
2496
2497 @noindent
2498 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2499 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2500 that as their controlling terminal.
2501
2502 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2503 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2504 terminal.
2505
2506 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2507 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2508 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2509 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2510
2511 @cindex inferior tty
2512 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2513 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2514 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2515 program.
2516
2517 @table @code
2518 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2519 @kindex set inferior-tty
2520 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2521 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2522 @value{GDBN}.
2523
2524 @item show inferior-tty
2525 @kindex show inferior-tty
2526 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2527 @end table
2528
2529 @node Attach
2530 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2531 @kindex attach
2532 @cindex attach
2533
2534 @table @code
2535 @item attach @var{process-id}
2536 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2537 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2538 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2539 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2540 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2541
2542 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2543 executing the command.
2544 @end table
2545
2546 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2547 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2548 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2549 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2550
2551 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2552 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2553 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2554 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2555 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2556 Specify Files}.
2557
2558 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2559 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2560 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2561 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2562 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2563 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2564 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2565
2566 @table @code
2567 @kindex detach
2568 @item detach
2569 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2570 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2571 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2572 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2573 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2574 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2575 executing the command.
2576 @end table
2577
2578 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2579 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2580 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2581 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2582 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2583 Messages}).
2584
2585 @node Kill Process
2586 @section Killing the Child Process
2587
2588 @table @code
2589 @kindex kill
2590 @item kill
2591 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2592 @end table
2593
2594 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2595 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2596 is running.
2597
2598 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2599 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2600 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2601 outside the debugger.
2602
2603 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2604 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2605 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2606 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2607 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2608 breakpoint settings).
2609
2610 @node Inferiors and Programs
2611 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2612
2613 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2614 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2615 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2616 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2617 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2618 from multiple executables.
2619
2620 @cindex inferior
2621 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2622 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2623 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2624 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2625 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2626 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2627 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2628 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2629 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2630 threads running in it.
2631
2632 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2633 inferiors}}:
2634
2635 @table @code
2636 @kindex info inferiors
2637 @item info inferiors
2638 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2639
2640 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2641
2642 @enumerate
2643 @item
2644 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2645
2646 @item
2647 the target system's inferior identifier
2648
2649 @item
2650 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2651
2652 @end enumerate
2653
2654 @noindent
2655 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2656 indicates the current inferior.
2657
2658 For example,
2659 @end table
2660 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2661
2662 @smallexample
2663 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2664 Num Description Executable
2665 2 process 2307 hello
2666 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2667 @end smallexample
2668
2669 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2670
2671 @table @code
2672 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2673 @item inferior @var{infno}
2674 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2675 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2676 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2677 @end table
2678
2679 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2680 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2681 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2682 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2683 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2684 information on convenience variables.
2685
2686 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2687 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2688 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2689 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2690 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2691 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2692
2693 @table @code
2694 @kindex add-inferior
2695 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2696 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2697 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2698 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2699 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2700 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2701
2702 @kindex clone-inferior
2703 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2704 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2705 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2706 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2707 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2708
2709 @smallexample
2710 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2711 Num Description Executable
2712 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2713 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2714 Added inferior 2.
2715 1 inferiors added.
2716 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2717 Num Description Executable
2718 2 <null> helloworld
2719 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2720 @end smallexample
2721
2722 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2723
2724 @kindex remove-inferiors
2725 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2726 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2727 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2728 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2729
2730 @end table
2731
2732 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2733 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2734 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2735 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2736
2737 @table @code
2738 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2739 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2740 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2741 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2742 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2743 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2744
2745 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2746 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2747 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2748 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2749 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2750 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2751 @end table
2752
2753 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2754 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2755 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2756 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2757
2758
2759 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2760 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2761
2762 @table @code
2763 @kindex set print inferior-events
2764 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2765 @item set print inferior-events
2766 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2767 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2768 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2769 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2770 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2771 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2772
2773 @kindex show print inferior-events
2774 @item show print inferior-events
2775 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2776 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2777 @end table
2778
2779 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2780 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2781 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2782
2783
2784 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2785 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2786 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2787 info program-spaces}} command.
2788
2789 @table @code
2790 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2791 @item maint info program-spaces
2792 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2793 @value{GDBN}.
2794
2795 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2796
2797 @enumerate
2798 @item
2799 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2800
2801 @item
2802 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2803 the @code{file} command.
2804
2805 @end enumerate
2806
2807 @noindent
2808 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2809 indicates the current program space.
2810
2811 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2812 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2813 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2814
2815 @smallexample
2816 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2817 Id Executable
2818 * 1 hello
2819 2 goodbye
2820 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2821 @end smallexample
2822
2823 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2824 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2825 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2826 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2827 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2828
2829 @smallexample
2830 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2831 Id Executable
2832 * 1 vfork-test
2833 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2834 @end smallexample
2835
2836 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2837 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2838 @end table
2839
2840 @node Threads
2841 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2842
2843 @cindex threads of execution
2844 @cindex multiple threads
2845 @cindex switching threads
2846 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2847 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2848 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2849 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2850 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2851 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2852 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2853
2854 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2855 programs:
2856
2857 @itemize @bullet
2858 @item automatic notification of new threads
2859 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2860 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2861 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2862 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2863 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2864 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2865 messages on thread start and exit.
2866 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2867 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2868 isn't compatible with the program.
2869 @end itemize
2870
2871 @cindex focus of debugging
2872 @cindex current thread
2873 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2874 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2875 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2876 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2877 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2878
2879 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2880 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2881 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2882 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2883 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2884 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2885 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2886 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2887 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2888 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2889
2890 @smallexample
2891 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2892 @end smallexample
2893
2894 @noindent
2895 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2896 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2897 further qualifier.
2898
2899 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2900 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2901 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2902 @c program?
2903 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2904 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2905 @c threads ab initio?
2906
2907 @anchor{thread numbers}
2908 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2909 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2910 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2911 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2912 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2913 between threads of different inferiors.
2914
2915 @cindex qualified thread ID
2916 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2917 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2918 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2919 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2920 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2921 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2922 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2923 inferior.
2924
2925 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2926 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2927 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2928 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2929
2930 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2931 @cindex thread ID lists
2932 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2933 argument. A list element can be:
2934
2935 @enumerate
2936 @item
2937 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2938 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2939 @samp{1}.
2940
2941 @item
2942 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2943 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2944 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2945
2946 @item
2947 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2948 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2949 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2950 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2951 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2952
2953 @end enumerate
2954
2955 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2956 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2957 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2958 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2959 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2960 7.1}.
2961
2962
2963 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2964 @cindex global thread number
2965 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2966 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2967 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2968 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2969 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2970 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2971
2972 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2973 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2974 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2975
2976 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2977 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2978 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2979 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2980 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2981 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2982 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2983 general information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2986 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2987 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2988
2989 @smallexample
2990 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2991 @end smallexample
2992
2993 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2994
2995 @smallexample
2996 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2997 @end smallexample
2998
2999 @table @code
3000 @kindex info threads
3001 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3002
3003 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3004 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3005 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3006 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3007
3008 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3009
3010 @enumerate
3011 @item
3012 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3013
3014 @item
3015 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3016 option was specified
3017
3018 @item
3019 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3020
3021 @item
3022 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3023 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3024 program itself.
3025
3026 @item
3027 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3028 @end enumerate
3029
3030 @noindent
3031 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3032 indicates the current thread.
3033
3034 For example,
3035 @end table
3036 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3037
3038 @smallexample
3039 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3040 Id Target Id Frame
3041 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3042 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3043 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3044 at threadtest.c:68
3045 @end smallexample
3046
3047 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3048 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3049 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3050
3051 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3052 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3053
3054 @smallexample
3055 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3056 Id GId Target Id Frame
3057 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3058 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3059 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3060 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3061 @end smallexample
3062
3063 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3064 Solaris-specific command:
3065
3066 @table @code
3067 @item maint info sol-threads
3068 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3069 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3070 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3071 @end table
3072
3073 @table @code
3074 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3075 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3076 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3077 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3078 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3079 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3080
3081 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3082 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3083
3084 @smallexample
3085 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3086 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3087 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3088 8 printf ("hello\n");
3089 @end smallexample
3090
3091 @noindent
3092 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3093 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3094 threads.
3095
3096 @kindex thread apply
3097 @cindex apply command to several threads
3098 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3099 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3100 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3101 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3102 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3103 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3104 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3105 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3106
3107
3108 @kindex thread name
3109 @cindex name a thread
3110 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3111 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3112 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3113 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3114
3115 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3116 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3117 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3118 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3119 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3120
3121 @kindex thread find
3122 @cindex search for a thread
3123 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3124 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3125 matches the supplied regular expression.
3126
3127 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3128 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3129 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3130 is the LWP id.
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3134 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3135 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3136 Id Target Id Frame
3137 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3138 @end smallexample
3139
3140 @kindex set print thread-events
3141 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3142 @item set print thread-events
3143 @itemx set print thread-events on
3144 @itemx set print thread-events off
3145 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3146 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3147 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3148 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3149 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3150
3151 @kindex show print thread-events
3152 @item show print thread-events
3153 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3154 have started and exited.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3158 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3159 programs with multiple threads.
3160
3161 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3162 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3163
3164 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3165 @table @code
3166 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3167 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3168 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3169 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3170 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3171 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3172 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3173 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3174 macro.
3175
3176 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3177 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3178 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3179 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3180 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3181 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3182
3183 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3184 refers to the default system directories that are
3185 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3186 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3187 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3188
3189 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3190 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3191 was loaded in the inferior process.
3192
3193 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3194 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3195 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3196 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3197 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3198 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3199 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3200
3201 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3202 only on some platforms.
3203
3204 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3205 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3206 Display current libthread_db search path.
3207
3208 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3209 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3210 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3211 @item set debug libthread-db
3212 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3213 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3214 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 @node Forks
3218 @section Debugging Forks
3219
3220 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3221 @cindex multiple processes
3222 @cindex processes, multiple
3223 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3224 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3225 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3226 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3227 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3228 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3229 will cause it to terminate.
3230
3231 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3232 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3233 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3234 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3235 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3236 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3237 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3238 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3239 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3240 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3241
3242 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3243 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3244 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3245 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3246
3247 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3248 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3249 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3250
3251 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3252 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3253
3254 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3255 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3256
3257 @table @code
3258 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3259 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3260 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3261 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3262 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3263
3264 @table @code
3265 @item parent
3266 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3267 unimpeded. This is the default.
3268
3269 @item child
3270 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3271 unimpeded.
3272
3273 @end table
3274
3275 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3276 @item show follow-fork-mode
3277 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3278 @end table
3279
3280 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3281 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3282 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3283
3284 @table @code
3285 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3286 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3287 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3288 retain debugger control over them both.
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @item on
3292 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3293 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3294 independently. This is the default.
3295
3296 @item off
3297 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3298 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3299 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3300 is held suspended.
3301
3302 @end table
3303
3304 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3305 @item show detach-on-fork
3306 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3307 @end table
3308
3309 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3310 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3311 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3312 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3313 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3314 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3315
3316 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3317 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3318 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3319 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3320 and Programs}.
3321
3322 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3323 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3324 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3325 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3326 the child process's @code{main}.
3327
3328 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3329 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3330
3331 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3332 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3333 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3334 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3335 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3336 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3337 command.
3338
3339 @table @code
3340 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3341 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3342
3343 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3344 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3345
3346 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3347
3348 @table @code
3349 @item new
3350 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3351 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3352 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3353 original inferior.
3354
3355 For example:
3356
3357 @smallexample
3358 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3359 (gdb) info inferior
3360 Id Description Executable
3361 * 1 <null> prog1
3362 (@value{GDBP}) run
3363 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3364 Program exited normally.
3365 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3366 Id Description Executable
3367 1 <null> prog1
3368 * 2 <null> prog2
3369 @end smallexample
3370
3371 @item same
3372 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3373 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3374 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3375 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3376 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3377
3378 For example:
3379
3380 @smallexample
3381 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3382 Id Description Executable
3383 * 1 <null> prog1
3384 (@value{GDBP}) run
3385 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3386 Program exited normally.
3387 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3388 Id Description Executable
3389 * 1 <null> prog2
3390 @end smallexample
3391
3392 @end table
3393 @end table
3394
3395 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3396 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3397
3398 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3399 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3400 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3401
3402 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3403 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3404
3405 @cindex checkpoint
3406 @cindex restart
3407 @cindex bookmark
3408 @cindex snapshot of a process
3409 @cindex rewind program state
3410
3411 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3412 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3413 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3414 later.
3415
3416 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3417 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3418 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3419 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3420 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3421
3422 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3423 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3424 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3425 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3426 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3427 start again from there.
3428
3429 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3430 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3431
3432 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3433
3434 @table @code
3435 @kindex checkpoint
3436 @item checkpoint
3437 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3438 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3439 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3440
3441 @kindex info checkpoints
3442 @item info checkpoints
3443 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3444 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3445 listed:
3446
3447 @table @code
3448 @item Checkpoint ID
3449 @item Process ID
3450 @item Code Address
3451 @item Source line, or label
3452 @end table
3453
3454 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3455 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3456 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3457 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3458 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3459 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3460 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3461
3462 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3463 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3464 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3465 the debugger.
3466
3467 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3468 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3469 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3470
3471 @end table
3472
3473 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3474 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3475 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3476 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3477 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3478 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3479 previously read data can be read again.
3480
3481 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3482 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3483 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3484 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3485 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3486 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3487
3488 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3489 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3490 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3491 different execution path this time.
3492
3493 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3494 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3495 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3496 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3497 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3498 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3499 potentially pose a problem.
3500
3501 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3502
3503 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3504 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3505 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3506 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3507 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3508 next.
3509
3510 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3511 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3512 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3513 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3514 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3515
3516 @node Stopping
3517 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3518
3519 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3520 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3521 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3522
3523 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3524 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3525 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3526 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3527 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3528 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3529 explicitly request this information at any time.
3530
3531 @table @code
3532 @kindex info program
3533 @item info program
3534 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3535 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3536 @end table
3537
3538 @menu
3539 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3540 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3541 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3542 Skipping over functions and files
3543 * Signals:: Signals
3544 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3545 @end menu
3546
3547 @node Breakpoints
3548 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3549
3550 @cindex breakpoints
3551 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3552 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3553 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3554 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3555 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3556 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3557 program.
3558
3559 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3560 the executable is run.
3561
3562 @cindex watchpoints
3563 @cindex data breakpoints
3564 @cindex memory tracing
3565 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3566 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3567 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3568 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3569 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3570 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3571 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3572 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3573 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3574 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3575 same commands.
3576
3577 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3578 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3579 Automatic Display}.
3580
3581 @cindex catchpoints
3582 @cindex breakpoint on events
3583 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3584 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3585 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3586 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3587 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3588 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3589 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3590
3591 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3592 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3593 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3594 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3595 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3596 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3597 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3598 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3599 enable it again.
3600
3601 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3602 @cindex breakpoint lists
3603 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3604 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3605 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3606 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3607 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3608 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3609 are operated on.
3610
3611 @menu
3612 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3613 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3614 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3615 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3616 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3617 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3618 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3619 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3620 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3621 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3622 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3623 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3624 @end menu
3625
3626 @node Set Breaks
3627 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3628
3629 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3630 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3631 @c
3632 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3633
3634 @kindex break
3635 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3636 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3637 @cindex latest breakpoint
3638 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3639 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3640 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3641 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3642 convenience variables.
3643
3644 @table @code
3645 @item break @var{location}
3646 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3647 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3648 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3649 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3650 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3651
3652 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3653 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3654 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3655 that situation.
3656
3657 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3658 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3659 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3660
3661 @item break
3662 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3663 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3664 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3665 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3666 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3667 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3668 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3669 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3670 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3671 inside loops.
3672
3673 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3674 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3675 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3676 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3677 existed when your program stopped.
3678
3679 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3680 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3681 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3682 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3683 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3684 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3685 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3686
3687 @kindex tbreak
3688 @item tbreak @var{args}
3689 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3690 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3691 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3692 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3693
3694 @kindex hbreak
3695 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3696 @item hbreak @var{args}
3697 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3698 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3699 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3700 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3701 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3702 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3703 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3704 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3705 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3706 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3707 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3708 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3709 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3710 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3711 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3712 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3713 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3714 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3715
3716 @kindex thbreak
3717 @item thbreak @var{args}
3718 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3719 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3720 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3721 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3722 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3723 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3724 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3725 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3726
3727 @kindex rbreak
3728 @cindex regular expression
3729 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3730 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3731 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3732 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3733 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3734 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3735 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3736 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3737 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3738
3739 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3740 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3741 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3742 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3743 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3744 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3745
3746 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3747 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3748 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3749 classes.
3750
3751 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3752 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3753 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3757 @end smallexample
3758
3759 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3760 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3761 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3762 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3763 every function in a given file:
3764
3765 @smallexample
3766 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3770 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3771
3772 @kindex info breakpoints
3773 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3774 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3775 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3776 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3777 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3778 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3779 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3780
3781 @table @emph
3782 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3783 @item Type
3784 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3785 @item Disposition
3786 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3787 @item Enabled or Disabled
3788 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3789 that are not enabled.
3790 @item Address
3791 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3792 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3793 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3794 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3795 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3796 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3797 @item What
3798 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3799 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3800 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3801 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3802 @end table
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3806 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3807 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3808 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3809 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3810 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3811
3812 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3813 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3814 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3815 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3816
3817 @noindent
3818 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3819 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3820 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3821 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3822 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3823
3824 @noindent
3825 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3826 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3827 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3828 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3829 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3830 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3831
3832 @noindent
3833 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3834 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3835
3836 @end table
3837
3838 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3839 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3840 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3841 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3842
3843 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3844 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3845 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3846 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3847
3848 @itemize @bullet
3849 @item
3850 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3851
3852 @item
3853 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3854 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3855
3856 @item
3857 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3858 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3859
3860 @item
3861 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3862 several places where that function is inlined.
3863 @end itemize
3864
3865 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3866 the relevant locations.
3867
3868 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3869 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3870 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3871 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3872 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3873 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3874 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3875
3876 For example:
3877
3878 @smallexample
3879 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3880 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3881 stop only if i==1
3882 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3883 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3884 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3885 @end smallexample
3886
3887 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3888 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3889 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3890 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3891 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3892 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3893 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3894 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3895 that belong to that breakpoint.
3896
3897 @cindex pending breakpoints
3898 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3899 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3900 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3901 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3902 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3903 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3904 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3905 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3906 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3907 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3908 is not yet resolved.
3909
3910 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3911 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3912 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3913 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3914 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3915 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3916
3917 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3918 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3919 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3920 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3921
3922 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3923 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3924 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3925
3926 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3927 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3928 address specification to an address:
3929
3930 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3931 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3932 @table @code
3933 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3934 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3935 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3936
3937 @item set breakpoint pending on
3938 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3939 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3940
3941 @item set breakpoint pending off
3942 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3943 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3944 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3945
3946 @item show breakpoint pending
3947 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3948 @end table
3949
3950 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3951 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3952 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3953
3954 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3955 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3956 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3957 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3958 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3959 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3960 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3961 breakpoints.
3962
3963 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
3964
3965 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3966 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3967 @table @code
3968 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3969 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3970 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3971 breakpoint must be used.
3972
3973 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3974 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3975 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3976 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3977 @end table
3978
3979 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3980 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3981 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3982 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3983 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3984 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3985 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3986 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3987 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3988
3989 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3990 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3991 @table @code
3992 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3993 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3994 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3995 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3996
3997 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3998 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3999 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4000 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4001 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4002 @end table
4003
4004 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4005 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4006 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4007
4008 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4009 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4010
4011 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4012
4013 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4014 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4015 @table @code
4016 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4017 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4018 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4019 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4020 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4021
4022 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4023 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4024 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4025 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4026 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4027 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4028 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4029 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4030 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4031 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4032 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4033 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4034 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4035
4036 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4037 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4038 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4039 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4040 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4041 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4042 @end table
4043
4044
4045 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4046 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4047 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4048 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4049 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4050 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4051 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4052 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4053
4054
4055 @node Set Watchpoints
4056 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4057
4058 @cindex setting watchpoints
4059 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4060 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4061 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4062 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4063 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4064
4065 @itemize @bullet
4066 @item
4067 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4068
4069 @item
4070 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4071 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4072 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4073
4074 @item
4075 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4076 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4077 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4078 @end itemize
4079
4080 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4081 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4082 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4083 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4084 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4085 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4086 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4087 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4088 the expression changes.
4089
4090 @cindex software watchpoints
4091 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4092 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4093 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4094 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4095 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4096 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4097 culprit.)
4098
4099 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4100 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4101 slow down the running of your program.
4102
4103 @table @code
4104 @kindex watch
4105 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4106 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4107 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4108 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4109 to watch the value of a single variable:
4110
4111 @smallexample
4112 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4113 @end smallexample
4114
4115 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4116 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4117 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4118 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4119 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4120 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4121
4122 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4123 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4124 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4125 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4126 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4127 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4128 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4129 error.
4130
4131 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4132 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4133 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4134 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4135 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4136 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4137 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4138 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4139 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4140 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4141 Examples:
4142
4143 @smallexample
4144 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4145 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4146 @end smallexample
4147
4148 @kindex rwatch
4149 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4150 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4151 by the program.
4152
4153 @kindex awatch
4154 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4155 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4156 or written into by the program.
4157
4158 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4159 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4160 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4161 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4162 @end table
4163
4164 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4165 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4166 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4167 a never-changing value:
4168
4169 @smallexample
4170 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4171 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4172 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4173 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4174 @end smallexample
4175
4176 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4177 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4178 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4179 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4180 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4181 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4182
4183 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4184 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4185 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4186 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4187 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4188 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4189 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4190 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4194 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4195 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4196
4197 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4198 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4199 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4200 @end table
4201
4202 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4203 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4204 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4205
4206 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4207
4208 @smallexample
4209 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4210 @end smallexample
4211
4212 @noindent
4213 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4214
4215 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4216 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4217 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4218 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4219 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4220 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4221 will print a message like this:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4228 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4229 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4230 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4231 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4232 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4233 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4234 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4235
4236 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4237 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4238 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4239 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4240 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4241 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4242
4243 @smallexample
4244 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4245 @end smallexample
4246
4247 @noindent
4248 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4249
4250 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4251 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4252 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4253 expression with separately allocated resources.
4254
4255 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4256 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4257 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4258
4259 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4260 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4261 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4262 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4263 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4264 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4265 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4266 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4267 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4268
4269 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4270 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4271 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4272 watched expression from every thread.
4273
4274 @quotation
4275 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4276 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4277 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4278 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4279 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4280 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4281 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4282 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4283 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4284 @end quotation
4285
4286 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4287
4288 @node Set Catchpoints
4289 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4290 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4291 @cindex exception handlers
4292 @cindex event handling
4293
4294 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4295 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4296 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4297
4298 @table @code
4299 @kindex catch
4300 @item catch @var{event}
4301 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4302
4303 @table @code
4304 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4305 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4306 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4307 @kindex catch throw
4308 @kindex catch rethrow
4309 @kindex catch catch
4310 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4311 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4312
4313 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4314 regular expression will be caught.
4315
4316 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4317 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4318 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4319 exception being thrown.
4320
4321 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4322 @value{GDBN}:
4323
4324 @itemize @bullet
4325 @item
4326 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4327 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4328 supported.
4329
4330 @item
4331 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4332 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4333 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4334 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4335 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4336 built.
4337
4338 @item
4339 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4340 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4341
4342 @item
4343 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4344 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4345 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4346 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4347
4348 @item
4349 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4350 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4351 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4352 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4353 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4354 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4355 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4356 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4357 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4358
4359 @item
4360 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4361
4362 @item
4363 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4364 @end itemize
4365
4366 @item exception
4367 @kindex catch exception
4368 @cindex Ada exception catching
4369 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4370 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4371 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4372 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4373 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4374
4375 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4376 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4377 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4378 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4379 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4380 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4381 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4382 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4383
4384 @item exception unhandled
4385 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4386 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4387
4388 @item assert
4389 @kindex catch assert
4390 A failed Ada assertion.
4391
4392 @item exec
4393 @kindex catch exec
4394 @cindex break on fork/exec
4395 A call to @code{exec}.
4396
4397 @item syscall
4398 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4399 @kindex catch syscall
4400 @cindex break on a system call.
4401 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4402 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4403 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4404 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4405 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4406 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4407 will be caught.
4408
4409 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4410 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4411 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4412 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4413
4414 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4415 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4416 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4417 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4418
4419 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4420 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4421 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4422 available choices.
4423
4424 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4425 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4426 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4427 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4428 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4429 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4430 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4431 behind the OS upgrades).
4432
4433 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4434 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4435 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4436 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4437 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4438 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4439 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4440 syscall groups available on your environment.
4441
4442 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4443 arguments to it:
4444
4445 @smallexample
4446 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4447 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4448 (@value{GDBP}) r
4449 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4450
4451 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4452 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4453 (@value{GDBP}) c
4454 Continuing.
4455
4456 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4457 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4458 (@value{GDBP})
4459 @end smallexample
4460
4461 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4462
4463 @smallexample
4464 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4465 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4466 (@value{GDBP}) r
4467 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4468
4469 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4470 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4471 (@value{GDBP}) c
4472 Continuing.
4473
4474 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4475 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4476 (@value{GDBP})
4477 @end smallexample
4478
4479 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4480 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4481 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4482
4483 @smallexample
4484 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4485 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4486 (@value{GDBP}) r
4487 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4488
4489 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4490 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4491 (@value{GDBP}) c
4492 Continuing.
4493
4494 Program exited normally.
4495 (@value{GDBP})
4496 @end smallexample
4497
4498 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4499
4500 @smallexample
4501 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4502 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4503 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4504 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4505 (@value{GDBP}) r
4506 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4507
4508 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4509 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4510
4511 (@value{GDBP}) c
4512 Continuing.
4513 @end smallexample
4514
4515 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4516 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4517 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4518 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4519
4520 @smallexample
4521 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4522 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4523 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4524 (@value{GDBP})
4525 @end smallexample
4526
4527 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4528 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4529 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4530 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4531 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4532 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4533
4534 @smallexample
4535 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4536 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4537 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4538 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4539 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4540 (@value{GDBP})
4541 @end smallexample
4542
4543 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4544
4545 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4546 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4547
4548 @smallexample
4549 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4550 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4551 @end smallexample
4552
4553 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4554
4555 @item fork
4556 @kindex catch fork
4557 A call to @code{fork}.
4558
4559 @item vfork
4560 @kindex catch vfork
4561 A call to @code{vfork}.
4562
4563 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4564 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4565 @kindex catch load
4566 @kindex catch unload
4567 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4568 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4569 matches one of the affected libraries.
4570
4571 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4572 @kindex catch signal
4573 The delivery of a signal.
4574
4575 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4576 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4577 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4578
4579 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4580 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4581 signal names.
4582
4583 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4584 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4585 will be caught.
4586
4587 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4588 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4589 catchpoint.
4590
4591 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4592 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4593 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4594 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4595 commands.
4596
4597 @end table
4598
4599 @item tcatch @var{event}
4600 @kindex tcatch
4601 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4602 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4603
4604 @end table
4605
4606 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4607
4608
4609 @node Delete Breaks
4610 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4611
4612 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4613 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4614 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4615 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4616 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4617 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4618
4619 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4620 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4621 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4622 their breakpoint numbers.
4623
4624 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4625 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4626 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4627
4628 @table @code
4629 @kindex clear
4630 @item clear
4631 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4632 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4633 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4634 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4635
4636 @item clear @var{location}
4637 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4638 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4639 most useful ones are listed below:
4640
4641 @table @code
4642 @item clear @var{function}
4643 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4644 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4645
4646 @item clear @var{linenum}
4647 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4648 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4649 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4650 @end table
4651
4652 @cindex delete breakpoints
4653 @kindex delete
4654 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4655 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4656 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4657 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4658 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4659 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4660 @end table
4661
4662 @node Disabling
4663 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4664
4665 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4666 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4667 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4668 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4669 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4670
4671 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4672 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4673 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4674 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4675 do not know which numbers to use.
4676
4677 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4678 affects all of its locations.
4679
4680 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4681 different states of enablement:
4682
4683 @itemize @bullet
4684 @item
4685 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4686 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4687 @item
4688 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4689 @item
4690 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4691 disabled.
4692 @item
4693 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4694 N times, then becomes disabled.
4695 @item
4696 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4697 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4698 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4699 @end itemize
4700
4701 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4702 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4703
4704 @table @code
4705 @kindex disable
4706 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4707 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4708 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4709 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4710 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4711 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4712 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4713
4714 @kindex enable
4715 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4716 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4717 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4718
4719 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4720 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4721 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4722
4723 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4724 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4725 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4726 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4727 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4728 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4729 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4730
4731 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4732 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4733 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4734 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4735 @end table
4736
4737 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4738 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4739 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4740 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4741 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4742 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4743 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4744 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4745 Stepping}.)
4746
4747 @node Conditions
4748 @subsection Break Conditions
4749 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4750 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4751
4752 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4753 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4754 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4755 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4756 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4757 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4758 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4759 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4760
4761 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4762 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4763 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4764 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4765 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4766
4767 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4768 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4769 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4770 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4771 one.
4772
4773 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4774 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4775 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4776 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4777 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4778 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4779 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4780 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4781 conditions for the
4782 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4783 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4784
4785 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4786 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4787 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4788 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4789 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4790 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4791
4792 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4793 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4794 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4795 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4796 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4797
4798 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4799 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4800 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4801 with the @code{condition} command.
4802
4803 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4804 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4805 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4806 catchpoint.
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @kindex condition
4810 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4811 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4812 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4813 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4814 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4815 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4816 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4817 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4818 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4819 prints an error message:
4820
4821 @smallexample
4822 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4823 @end smallexample
4824
4825 @noindent
4826 @value{GDBN} does
4827 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4828 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4829 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4830
4831 @item condition @var{bnum}
4832 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4833 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4834 @end table
4835
4836 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4837 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4838 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4839 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4840 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4841 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4842 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4843 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4844 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4845 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4846 your program reaches it.
4847
4848 @table @code
4849 @kindex ignore
4850 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4851 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4852 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4853 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4854 takes no action.
4855
4856 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4857 a count of zero.
4858
4859 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4860 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4861 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4862 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4863
4864 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4865 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4866 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4867
4868 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4869 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4870 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4871 Variables}.
4872 @end table
4873
4874 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4875
4876
4877 @node Break Commands
4878 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4879
4880 @cindex breakpoint commands
4881 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4882 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4883 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4884 enable other breakpoints.
4885
4886 @table @code
4887 @kindex commands
4888 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4889 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4890 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4891 @itemx end
4892 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4893 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4894 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4895
4896 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4897 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4898
4899 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4900 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4901 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4902 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4903 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4904 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4905 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4906 Expressions}).
4907 @end table
4908
4909 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4910 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4911
4912 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4913 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4914 that resumes execution.
4915
4916 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4917 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4918 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4919 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4920 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4921
4922 @kindex silent
4923 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4924 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4925 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4926 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4927 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4928 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4929
4930 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4931 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4932 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4933
4934 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4935 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4936
4937 @smallexample
4938 break foo if x>0
4939 commands
4940 silent
4941 printf "x is %d\n",x
4942 cont
4943 end
4944 @end smallexample
4945
4946 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4947 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4948 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4949 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4950 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4951 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4952 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4953
4954 @smallexample
4955 break 403
4956 commands
4957 silent
4958 set x = y + 4
4959 cont
4960 end
4961 @end smallexample
4962
4963 @node Dynamic Printf
4964 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4965
4966 @cindex dynamic printf
4967 @cindex dprintf
4968 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4969 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4970 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4971 having to recompile it.
4972
4973 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4974 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4975 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4976 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4977 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4978 redirects to files and so forth.
4979
4980 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4981 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4982 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4983 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4984 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4985 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4986 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4987
4988 @table @code
4989 @kindex dprintf
4990 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4991 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4992 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4993 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4994
4995 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4996 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4997 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4998 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4999 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5000 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5001
5002 @table @code
5003 @item gdb
5004 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5005 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5006
5007 @item call
5008 @kindex dprintf-style call
5009 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5010 @code{printf}).
5011
5012 @item agent
5013 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5014 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5015 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5016 support running commands on the target.
5017 @end table
5018
5019 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5020 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5021 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5022 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5023 command.
5024
5025 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5026 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5027 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5028 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5029 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5030 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5031
5032 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5033 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5034 you could do the following:
5035
5036 @example
5037 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5038 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5039 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5040 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5041 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5042 (gdb) info break
5043 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5044 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5045 continue
5046 (gdb)
5047 @end example
5048
5049 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5050 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5051 the variable settings.
5052
5053 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5054 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5055 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5056 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5057 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5058 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5059
5060 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5061 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5062 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5063
5064 @end table
5065
5066 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5067 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5068 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5069 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5070 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5071 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5072
5073 @node Save Breakpoints
5074 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5075
5076 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5077 breakpoints}} command.
5078
5079 @table @code
5080 @kindex save breakpoints
5081 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5082 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5083 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5084 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5085 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5086 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5087 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5088 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5089 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5090 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5091 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5092 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5093 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5094 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5095 that can no longer be recreated.
5096 @end table
5097
5098 @node Static Probe Points
5099 @subsection Static Probe Points
5100
5101 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5102 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5103 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5104 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5105 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5106
5107 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5108 ELF-compatible systems:
5109
5110 @itemize @bullet
5111
5112 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5113 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5114 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5115 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5116 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5117 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5118 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5119 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5120
5121 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5122 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5123 C@t{++} languages.
5124 @end itemize
5125
5126 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5127 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5128 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5129 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5130 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5131 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5132 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5133 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5134 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5135
5136 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5137 probes}, with optional arguments:
5138
5139 @table @code
5140 @kindex info probes
5141 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5142 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5143 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5144 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5145
5146 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5147 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5148 probes from all providers are listed.
5149
5150 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5151 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5152 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5153
5154 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5155 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5156 given, all object files are considered.
5157
5158 @item info probes all
5159 List the available static probes, from all types.
5160 @end table
5161
5162 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5163 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5164 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5165 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5166 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5167
5168 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5169 commands, with optional arguments:
5170
5171 @table @code
5172 @kindex enable probes
5173 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5174 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5175 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5176 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5177
5178 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5179 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5180 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5181
5182 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5183 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5184 given, all object files are considered.
5185
5186 @kindex disable probes
5187 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5188 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5189 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5190 @end table
5191
5192 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5193 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5194 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5195 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5196 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5197 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5198 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5199 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5200 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5201 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5202 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5203 at the current probe point.
5204
5205 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5206 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5207 an error message.
5208
5209
5210 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5211 @node Error in Breakpoints
5212 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5213
5214 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5215 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5216
5217 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5218 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5219 @smallexample
5220 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5221 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5222 @end smallexample
5223
5224 @noindent
5225 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5226 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5227 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5228
5229 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5230 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5231
5232 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5233 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5234 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5235
5236 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5237 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5238 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5239 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5240
5241 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5242 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5243 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5244 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5245 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5246 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5247 first in the bundle.
5248
5249 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5250 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5251 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5252 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5253 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5254 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5255 is hit.
5256
5257 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5258 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5259
5260 @smallexample
5261 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5262 @end smallexample
5263
5264 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5265 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5266 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5267 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5268 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5269 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5270 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5271 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5272
5273 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5274 adjusted breakpoints:
5275
5276 @smallexample
5277 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5278 to 0x00010410.
5279 @end smallexample
5280
5281 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5282 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5283 frequently than expected.
5284
5285 @node Continuing and Stepping
5286 @section Continuing and Stepping
5287
5288 @cindex stepping
5289 @cindex continuing
5290 @cindex resuming execution
5291 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5292 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5293 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5294 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5295 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5296 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5297 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5298 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5299 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5300 handlers}).)
5301
5302 @table @code
5303 @kindex continue
5304 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5305 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5306 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5307 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5308 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5309 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5310 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5311 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5312 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5313 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5314
5315 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5316 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5317 @code{continue} is ignored.
5318
5319 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5320 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5321 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5322 @code{continue}.
5323 @end table
5324
5325 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5326 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5327 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5328 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5329
5330 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5331 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5332 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5333 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5334 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5335 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5336
5337 @table @code
5338 @kindex step
5339 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5340 @item step
5341 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5342 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5343 abbreviated @code{s}.
5344
5345 @quotation
5346 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5347 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5348 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5349 @c distinction here.
5350 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5351 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5352 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5353 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5354 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5355 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5356 below.
5357 @end quotation
5358
5359 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5360 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5361 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5362 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5363 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5364 called within the line.
5365
5366 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5367 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5368 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5369 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5370 was any debugging information about the routine.
5371
5372 @item step @var{count}
5373 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5374 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5375 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5376
5377 @kindex next
5378 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5379 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5380 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5381 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5382 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5383 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5384 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5385 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5386
5387 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5388
5389
5390 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5391 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5392 @c
5393 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5394 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5395 @c function are executed without stopping.
5396
5397 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5398 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5399 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5400
5401 @kindex set step-mode
5402 @item set step-mode
5403 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5404 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5405 @itemx set step-mode on
5406 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5407 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5408 information rather than stepping over it.
5409
5410 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5411 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5412 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5413
5414 @item set step-mode off
5415 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5416 debug information. This is the default.
5417
5418 @item show step-mode
5419 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5420 source line debug information.
5421
5422 @kindex finish
5423 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5424 @item finish
5425 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5426 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5427 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5428
5429 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5430 ,Returning from a Function}).
5431
5432 @kindex until
5433 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5434 @cindex run until specified location
5435 @item until
5436 @itemx u
5437 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5438 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5439 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5440 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5441 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5442 than the address of the jump.
5443
5444 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5445 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5446 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5447 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5448 through the next iteration.
5449
5450 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5451 stack frame.
5452
5453 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5454 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5455 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5456 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5457 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5458
5459 @smallexample
5460 (@value{GDBP}) f
5461 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5462 206 expand_input();
5463 (@value{GDBP}) until
5464 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5465 @end smallexample
5466
5467 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5468 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5469 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5470 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5471 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5472 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5473 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5474
5475 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5476 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5477 argument.
5478
5479 @item until @var{location}
5480 @itemx u @var{location}
5481 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5482 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5483 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5484 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5485 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5486 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5487 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5488 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5489 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5490 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5491 invocations have returned.
5492
5493 @smallexample
5494 94 int factorial (int value)
5495 95 @{
5496 96 if (value > 1) @{
5497 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5498 98 @}
5499 99 return (value);
5500 100 @}
5501 @end smallexample
5502
5503
5504 @kindex advance @var{location}
5505 @item advance @var{location}
5506 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5507 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5508 @ref{Specify Location}.
5509 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5510 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5511 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5512 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5513
5514
5515 @kindex stepi
5516 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5517 @item stepi
5518 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5519 @itemx si
5520 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5521
5522 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5523 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5524 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5525 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5526
5527 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5528
5529 @need 750
5530 @kindex nexti
5531 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5532 @item nexti
5533 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5534 @itemx ni
5535 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5536 proceed until the function returns.
5537
5538 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5539
5540 @end table
5541
5542 @anchor{range stepping}
5543 @cindex range stepping
5544 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5545 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5546 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5547 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5548 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5549 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5550 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5551 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5552 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5553 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5554 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5555 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5556 if necessary:
5557
5558 @table @code
5559 @kindex set range-stepping
5560 @kindex show range-stepping
5561 @item set range-stepping
5562 @itemx show range-stepping
5563 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5564
5565 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5566 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5567 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5568 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5569 default is @code{on}.
5570
5571 @end table
5572
5573 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5574 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5575 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5576
5577 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5578 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5579 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5580 a particular file when stepping.
5581
5582 For example, consider the following C function:
5583
5584 @smallexample
5585 101 int func()
5586 102 @{
5587 103 foo(boring());
5588 104 bar(boring());
5589 105 @}
5590 @end smallexample
5591
5592 @noindent
5593 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5594 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5595 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5596 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5597
5598 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5599 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5600 is called from many places.
5601
5602 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5603 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5604 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5605 @code{foo}.
5606
5607 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5608 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5609 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5610
5611 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5612 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5613 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5614 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5615 the underlying system.
5616 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5617 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5618
5619 @table @code
5620 @kindex skip
5621 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5622 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5623 that specify what to skip.
5624 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5625
5626 @table @code
5627 @item -file @var{file}
5628 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5629 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5630
5631 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5632 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5633 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5634 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5635 over when stepping.
5636
5637 @smallexample
5638 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5639 @end smallexample
5640
5641 @item -function @var{linespec}
5642 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5643 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5644 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5645 @xref{Specify Location}.
5646
5647 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5648 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5649 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5650 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5651
5652 This form is useful for complex function names.
5653 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5654 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5655 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5656 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5657 regular expression makes this easier.
5658
5659 @smallexample
5660 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5661 @end smallexample
5662
5663 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5664 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5665
5666 @smallexample
5667 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5668 @end smallexample
5669 @end table
5670
5671 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5672 will be skipped.
5673
5674 @kindex skip function
5675 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5676 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5677 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5678 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5679
5680 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5681 will be skipped.
5682
5683 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5684 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5685
5686 @kindex skip file
5687 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5688 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5689 will be skipped over when stepping.
5690
5691 @smallexample
5692 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5693 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5694 @end smallexample
5695
5696 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5697 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5698 @end table
5699
5700 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5701 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5702
5703 @table @code
5704 @kindex info skip
5705 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5706 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5707 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5708 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5709
5710 @table @emph
5711 @item Identifier
5712 A number identifying this skip.
5713 @item Enabled or Disabled
5714 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5715 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5716 @item Glob
5717 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5718 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5719 @item File
5720 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5721 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5722 @item RE
5723 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5724 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5725 @item Function
5726 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5727 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5728 @end table
5729
5730 @kindex skip delete
5731 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5732 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5733 skips.
5734
5735 @kindex skip enable
5736 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5737 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5738 skips.
5739
5740 @kindex skip disable
5741 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5742 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5743 skips.
5744
5745 @end table
5746
5747 @node Signals
5748 @section Signals
5749 @cindex signals
5750
5751 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5752 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5753 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5754 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5755 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5756 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5757 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5758 requested an alarm).
5759
5760 @cindex fatal signals
5761 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5762 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5763 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5764 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5765 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5766 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5767
5768 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5769 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5770 signal.
5771
5772 @cindex handling signals
5773 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5774 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5775 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5776 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5777 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5778
5779 @table @code
5780 @kindex info signals
5781 @kindex info handle
5782 @item info signals
5783 @itemx info handle
5784 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5785 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5786 the defined types of signals.
5787
5788 @item info signals @var{sig}
5789 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5790
5791 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5792
5793 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5794 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5795 for details about this command.
5796
5797 @kindex handle
5798 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5799 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5800 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5801 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5802 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5803 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5804 say what change to make.
5805 @end table
5806
5807 @c @group
5808 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5809 Their full names are:
5810
5811 @table @code
5812 @item nostop
5813 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5814 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5815
5816 @item stop
5817 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5818 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5819
5820 @item print
5821 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5822
5823 @item noprint
5824 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5825 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5826
5827 @item pass
5828 @itemx noignore
5829 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5830 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5831 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5832
5833 @item nopass
5834 @itemx ignore
5835 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5836 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5837 @end table
5838 @c @end group
5839
5840 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5841 program until you
5842 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5843 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5844 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5845 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5846 program sees that signal when you continue.
5847
5848 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5849 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5850 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5851 erroneous signals.
5852
5853 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5854 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5855 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5856 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5857 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5858 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5859 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5860 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5861 Program a Signal}.
5862
5863 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5864 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5865
5866 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5867 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5868 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5869 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5870 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5871 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5872 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5873 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5874 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5875 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5876 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5877 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5878 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5879
5880 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5881
5882 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5883 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5884 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5885 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5886
5887 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5888 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5889 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5890 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5891
5892 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5893 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5894
5895 @smallexample
5896 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5897 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5898 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5899 (@value{GDBP}) c
5900 Continuing.
5901
5902 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5903 main () sigusr1.c:28
5904 28 p = 0;
5905 (@value{GDBP}) si
5906 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5907 9 @{
5908 @end smallexample
5909
5910 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5911 program to receive the signal first:
5912
5913 @smallexample
5914 (@value{GDBP}) n
5915 28 p = 0;
5916 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5917 (@value{GDBP}) si
5918 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5919 9 @{
5920 (@value{GDBP})
5921 @end smallexample
5922
5923 @cindex extra signal information
5924 @anchor{extra signal information}
5925
5926 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5927 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5928 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5929 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5930 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5931 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5932 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5933 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5934 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5935 system header.
5936
5937 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5938 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5939
5940 @smallexample
5941 @group
5942 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5943 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5944 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5945 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5946 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5947 type = struct @{
5948 int si_signo;
5949 int si_errno;
5950 int si_code;
5951 union @{
5952 int _pad[28];
5953 struct @{...@} _kill;
5954 struct @{...@} _timer;
5955 struct @{...@} _rt;
5956 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5957 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5958 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5959 @} _sifields;
5960 @}
5961 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5962 type = struct @{
5963 void *si_addr;
5964 @}
5965 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5966 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5967 @end group
5968 @end smallexample
5969
5970 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5971
5972 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5973 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5974 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5975 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5976 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5977 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5978 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5979 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5980 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5981 information is displayed.
5982
5983 The usual output of a segfault is:
5984 @smallexample
5985 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5986 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5987 68 value = *(p + len);
5988 @end smallexample
5989
5990 While a bound violation is presented as:
5991 @smallexample
5992 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5993 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5994 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5995 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5996 68 value = *(p + len);
5997 @end smallexample
5998
5999 @node Thread Stops
6000 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6001
6002 @cindex stopped threads
6003 @cindex threads, stopped
6004
6005 @cindex continuing threads
6006 @cindex threads, continuing
6007
6008 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6009 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6010 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6011 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6012 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6013 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6014 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6015 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6016 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6017
6018 @menu
6019 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6020 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6021 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6022 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6023 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6024 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6025 @end menu
6026
6027 @node All-Stop Mode
6028 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6029
6030 @cindex all-stop mode
6031
6032 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6033 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6034 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6035 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6036 underfoot.
6037
6038 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6039 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6040 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6041
6042 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6043 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6044 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6045 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6046 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6047 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6048 stops.
6049
6050 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6051 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6052 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6053 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6054
6055 @cindex automatic thread selection
6056 @cindex switching threads automatically
6057 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6058 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6059 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6060 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6061 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6062 thread.
6063
6064 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6065 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6066
6067 @table @code
6068 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6069 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6070 @cindex lock scheduler
6071 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6072 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6073 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6074 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6075 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6076 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6077 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6078 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6079 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6080 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6081 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6082 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6083 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6084 @code{on} in replay mode.
6085
6086 @item show scheduler-locking
6087 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6088 @end table
6089
6090 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6091 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6092 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6093 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6094 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6095 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6096 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6097 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6098 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6099 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6100 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6101 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6102 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6103 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6104
6105 @table @code
6106 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6107 @item set schedule-multiple
6108 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6109 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6110 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6111 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6112 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6113 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6114
6115 @item show schedule-multiple
6116 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6117 multiple processes.
6118 @end table
6119
6120 @node Non-Stop Mode
6121 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6122
6123 @cindex non-stop mode
6124
6125 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6126 @c with more details.
6127
6128 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6129 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6130 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6131 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6132 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6133 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6134
6135 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6136 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6137 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6138 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6139 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6140 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6141 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6142 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6143 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6144 independently and simultaneously.
6145
6146 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6147 or attach to your program:
6148
6149 @smallexample
6150 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6151 set pagination off
6152
6153 # Finally, turn it on!
6154 set non-stop on
6155 @end smallexample
6156
6157 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @kindex set non-stop
6161 @item set non-stop on
6162 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6163 @item set non-stop off
6164 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6165 @kindex show non-stop
6166 @item show non-stop
6167 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6168 @end table
6169
6170 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6171 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6172 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6173 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6174 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6175 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6176 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6177 default.
6178
6179 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6180 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6181 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6182
6183 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6184 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6185 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6186 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6187 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6188
6189 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6190 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6191 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6192 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6193 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6194
6195 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6196
6197 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6198 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6199 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6200 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6201 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6202 previously current thread.
6203
6204 @node Background Execution
6205 @subsection Background Execution
6206
6207 @cindex foreground execution
6208 @cindex background execution
6209 @cindex asynchronous execution
6210 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6211
6212 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6213 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6214 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6215 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6216 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6217 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6218
6219 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6220 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6221
6222 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6223 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6224 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6225 are:
6226
6227 @table @code
6228 @kindex run&
6229 @item run
6230 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6231
6232 @item attach
6233 @kindex attach&
6234 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6235
6236 @item step
6237 @kindex step&
6238 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6239
6240 @item stepi
6241 @kindex stepi&
6242 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6243
6244 @item next
6245 @kindex next&
6246 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6247
6248 @item nexti
6249 @kindex nexti&
6250 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6251
6252 @item continue
6253 @kindex continue&
6254 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6255
6256 @item finish
6257 @kindex finish&
6258 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6259
6260 @item until
6261 @kindex until&
6262 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6263
6264 @end table
6265
6266 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6267 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6268 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6269 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6270 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6271 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6272
6273 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6274 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6275
6276 @table @code
6277 @kindex interrupt
6278 @item interrupt
6279 @itemx interrupt -a
6280
6281 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6282 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6283 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6284 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6285 @end table
6286
6287 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6288 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6289
6290 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6291 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6292 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6293
6294 @table @code
6295 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6296 @cindex thread breakpoints
6297 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6298 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6299 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6300 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6301 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6302 specify some source line.
6303
6304 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6305 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6306 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6307 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6308 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6309
6310 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6311 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6312 program.
6313
6314 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6315 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6316 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6317
6318 @smallexample
6319 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 @end table
6323
6324 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6325 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6326 thread list. For example:
6327
6328 @smallexample
6329 (@value{GDBP}) c
6330 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6331 @end smallexample
6332
6333 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6334 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6335 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6336 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6337 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6338 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6339 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6340 command.
6341
6342 @node Interrupted System Calls
6343 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6344
6345 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6346 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6347 @cindex premature return from system calls
6348 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6349 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6350 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6351 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6352 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6353 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6354 stop execution.
6355
6356 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6357 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6358 style anyways.
6359
6360 For example, do not write code like this:
6361
6362 @smallexample
6363 sleep (10);
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6367 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6368
6369 Instead, write this:
6370
6371 @smallexample
6372 int unslept = 10;
6373 while (unslept > 0)
6374 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6375 @end smallexample
6376
6377 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6378 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6379 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6380 @value{GDBN}.
6381
6382 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6383 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6384 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6385 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6386
6387 @node Observer Mode
6388 @subsection Observer Mode
6389
6390 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6391 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6392 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6393 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6394 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6395
6396 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6397 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6398 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6399 mode.
6400
6401 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6402 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6403 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6404 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6405 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6406
6407 @table @code
6408
6409 @kindex observer
6410 @item set observer on
6411 @itemx set observer off
6412 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6413 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6414 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6415 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6416
6417 @item show observer
6418 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6419
6420 @kindex may-write-registers
6421 @item set may-write-registers on
6422 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6423 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6424 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6425 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6426
6427 @item show may-write-registers
6428 Show the current permission to write registers.
6429
6430 @kindex may-write-memory
6431 @item set may-write-memory on
6432 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6433 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6434 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6435 defaults to @code{on}.
6436
6437 @item show may-write-memory
6438 Show the current permission to write memory.
6439
6440 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6441 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6442 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6443 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6444 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6445 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6446
6447 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6448 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6449
6450 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6451 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6452 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6453 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6454 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6455 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6456 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6457
6458 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6459 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6460
6461 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6462 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6463 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6464 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6465 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6466 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6467 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6468
6469 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6470 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6471
6472 @kindex may-interrupt
6473 @item set may-interrupt on
6474 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6475 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6476 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6477 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6478 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6479
6480 @item show may-interrupt
6481 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6482
6483 @end table
6484
6485 @node Reverse Execution
6486 @chapter Running programs backward
6487 @cindex reverse execution
6488 @cindex running programs backward
6489
6490 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6491 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6492 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6493 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6494
6495 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6496 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6497 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6498 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6499 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6500 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6501
6502 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6503 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6504 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6505 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6506 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6507 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6508 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6509 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6510 prior values@footnote{
6511 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6512 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6513 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6514
6515 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6516 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6517 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6518 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6519 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6520 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6521 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6522 }.
6523
6524 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6525 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6526
6527 @table @code
6528 @kindex reverse-continue
6529 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6530 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6531 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6532 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6533 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6534 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6535 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6536
6537 @kindex reverse-step
6538 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6539 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6540 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6541 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6542
6543 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6544 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6545 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6546 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6547 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6548 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6549
6550 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6551 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6552
6553 @kindex reverse-stepi
6554 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6555 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6556 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6557 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6558 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6559 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6560 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6561
6562 @kindex reverse-next
6563 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6564 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6565 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6566 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6567 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6568 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6569 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6570 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6571 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6572 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6573
6574 @kindex reverse-nexti
6575 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6576 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6577 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6578 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6579 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6580 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6581 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6582 frame) is reached.
6583
6584 @kindex reverse-finish
6585 @item reverse-finish
6586 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6587 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6588 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6589 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6590
6591 @kindex set exec-direction
6592 @item set exec-direction
6593 Set the direction of target execution.
6594 @item set exec-direction reverse
6595 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6596 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6597 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6598 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6599 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6600 @item set exec-direction forward
6601 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6602 This is the default.
6603 @end table
6604
6605
6606 @node Process Record and Replay
6607 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6608 @cindex process record and replay
6609 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6610
6611 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6612 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6613 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6614
6615 @cindex replay mode
6616 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6617 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6618 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6619 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6620 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6621 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6622 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6623 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6624 execution log.
6625
6626 @cindex record mode
6627 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6628 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6629 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6630 for future replay.
6631
6632 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6633 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6634 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6635 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6636 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6637 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6638
6639 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6640 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6641 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6642 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6643
6644 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6645 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6646
6647 @table @code
6648 @kindex target record
6649 @kindex target record-full
6650 @kindex target record-btrace
6651 @kindex record
6652 @kindex record full
6653 @kindex record btrace
6654 @kindex record btrace bts
6655 @kindex record btrace pt
6656 @kindex record bts
6657 @kindex record pt
6658 @kindex rec
6659 @kindex rec full
6660 @kindex rec btrace
6661 @kindex rec btrace bts
6662 @kindex rec btrace pt
6663 @kindex rec bts
6664 @kindex rec pt
6665 @item record @var{method}
6666 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6667 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6668 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6669 recording methods are available:
6670
6671 @table @code
6672 @item full
6673 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6674 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6675 execution.
6676
6677 @item btrace @var{format}
6678 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6679 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6680 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6681 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6682 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6683 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6684 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6685
6686 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6687 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6688 formats are available:
6689
6690 @table @code
6691 @item bts
6692 @cindex branch trace store
6693 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6694 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6695 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6696
6697 @item pt
6698 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6699 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6700 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6701 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6702
6703 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6704 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6705 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6706
6707 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6708 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6709 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6710 buffer-size with care.
6711 @end table
6712
6713 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6714 @end table
6715
6716 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6717 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6718 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6719 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6720
6721 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6722 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6723 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6724 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6725 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6726
6727 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6728 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6729 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6730 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6731 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6732 does not support these two modes.
6733
6734 @kindex record stop
6735 @kindex rec s
6736 @item record stop
6737 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6738 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6739 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6740
6741 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6742 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6743 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6744 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6745 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6746
6747 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6748 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6749 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6750 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6751 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6752
6753 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6754 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6755
6756 @kindex record goto
6757 @item record goto
6758 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6759 ways to specify the location to go to:
6760
6761 @table @code
6762 @item record goto begin
6763 @itemx record goto start
6764 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6765
6766 @item record goto end
6767 Go to the end of the execution log.
6768
6769 @item record goto @var{n}
6770 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6771 @end table
6772
6773 @kindex record save
6774 @item record save @var{filename}
6775 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6776 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6777 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6778
6779 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6780
6781 @kindex record restore
6782 @item record restore @var{filename}
6783 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6784 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6785
6786 @kindex set record full
6787 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6788 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6789 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6790 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6791
6792 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6793 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6794 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6795 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6796 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6797 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6798 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6799 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6800
6801 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6802 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6803 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6804
6805 @kindex show record full
6806 @item show record full insn-number-max
6807 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6808 recording method.
6809
6810 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6811 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6812 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6813 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6814 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6815 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6816 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6817 oldest one to be deleted.
6818
6819 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6820 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6821
6822 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6823 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6824
6825 @item set record full memory-query
6826 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6827 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6828 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6829 case.
6830
6831 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6832 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6833 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6834 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6835 results.
6836
6837 @item show record full memory-query
6838 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6839
6840 @kindex set record btrace
6841 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6842 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6843 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6844 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6845 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6846 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6847 You can use the following command for that:
6848
6849 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6850 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6851 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6852 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6853 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6854 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6855 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6856 position.
6857
6858 @kindex show record btrace
6859 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6860 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6861
6862 @kindex set record btrace bts
6863 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6864 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6865 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6866 format. Default is 64KB.
6867
6868 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6869 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6870 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6871 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6872 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6873 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6874 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6875
6876 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6877 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6878
6879 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6880 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6881
6882 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6883 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6884 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6885
6886 @kindex set record btrace pt
6887 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6888 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6889 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6890 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6891
6892 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6893 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6894 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6895 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6896 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6897 actual buffer size for each thread.
6898
6899 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6900 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6901
6902 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6903 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6904
6905 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6906 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6907 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6908
6909 @kindex info record
6910 @item info record
6911 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6912 method:
6913
6914 @table @code
6915 @item full
6916 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6917 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6918
6919 @itemize @bullet
6920 @item
6921 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6922 @item
6923 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6924 @item
6925 Highest recorded instruction number.
6926 @item
6927 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6928 @item
6929 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6930 @item
6931 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6932 @end itemize
6933
6934 @item btrace
6935 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6936
6937 @itemize @bullet
6938 @item
6939 Recording format.
6940 @item
6941 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6942 @item
6943 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6944 instructions.
6945 @item
6946 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6947 @end itemize
6948
6949 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6950 @itemize @bullet
6951 @item
6952 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6953 @end itemize
6954
6955 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6956 @itemize @bullet
6957 @item
6958 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6959 @end itemize
6960 @end table
6961
6962 @kindex record delete
6963 @kindex rec del
6964 @item record delete
6965 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6966 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6967 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6968 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6969
6970 @kindex record instruction-history
6971 @kindex rec instruction-history
6972 @item record instruction-history
6973 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6974 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6975 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6976 are printed in execution order.
6977
6978 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6979 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6980 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6981
6982 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6983 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6984 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6985 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6986 @code{/p} modifier.
6987
6988 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6989 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6990 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6991
6992 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6993 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6994
6995 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6996 disassemble:
6997
6998 @table @code
6999 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7000 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7001 @var{insn}.
7002
7003 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7004 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7005 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7006 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7007 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7008 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7009
7010 @item record instruction-history
7011 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7012
7013 @item record instruction-history -
7014 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7015
7016 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7017 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7018 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7019 number @var{end} is included.
7020 @end table
7021
7022 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7023
7024 @kindex set record
7025 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7026 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7027 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7028 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7029 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7030
7031 @kindex show record
7032 @item show record instruction-history-size
7033 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7034 instruction-history} command.
7035
7036 @kindex record function-call-history
7037 @kindex rec function-call-history
7038 @item record function-call-history
7039 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7040 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7041 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7042 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7043 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7044 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7045 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7046 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7047 given together.
7048
7049 @smallexample
7050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7051 1 void foo (void)
7052 2 @{
7053 3 @}
7054 4
7055 5 void bar (void)
7056 6 @{
7057 7 ...
7058 8 foo ();
7059 9 ...
7060 10 @}
7061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7062 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7063 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7064 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7065 @end smallexample
7066
7067 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7068 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7069 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7070 to print:
7071
7072 @table @code
7073 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7074 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7075
7076 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7077 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7078 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7079 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7080 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7081
7082 @item record function-call-history
7083 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7084
7085 @item record function-call-history -
7086 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7087
7088 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7089 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7090 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7091 @end table
7092
7093 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7094
7095 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7096 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7097 Define how many lines to print in the
7098 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7099 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7100
7101 @item show record function-call-history-size
7102 Show how many lines to print in the
7103 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7104 @end table
7105
7106
7107 @node Stack
7108 @chapter Examining the Stack
7109
7110 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7111 stopped and how it got there.
7112
7113 @cindex call stack
7114 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7115 is generated.
7116 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7117 the arguments of the call,
7118 and the local variables of the function being called.
7119 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7120 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7121 stack}.
7122
7123 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7124 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7125
7126 @cindex selected frame
7127 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7128 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7129 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7130 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7131 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7132 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7133
7134 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7135 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7136 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7137
7138 @menu
7139 * Frames:: Stack frames
7140 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7141 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7142 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7143 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7144
7145 @end menu
7146
7147 @node Frames
7148 @section Stack Frames
7149
7150 @cindex frame, definition
7151 @cindex stack frame
7152 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7153 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7154 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7155 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7156 which the function is executing.
7157
7158 @cindex initial frame
7159 @cindex outermost frame
7160 @cindex innermost frame
7161 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7162 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7163 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7164 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7165 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7166 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7167 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7168 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7169
7170 @cindex frame pointer
7171 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7172 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7173 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7174 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7175 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7176 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7177
7178 @cindex frame number
7179 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7180 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7181 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7182 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7183 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7184
7185 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7186 @c underflow problems.
7187 @cindex frameless execution
7188 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7189 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7190 @smallexample
7191 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7192 @end smallexample
7193 generates functions without a frame.)
7194 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7195 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7196 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7197 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7198 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7199 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7200 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7201
7202 @node Backtrace
7203 @section Backtraces
7204
7205 @cindex traceback
7206 @cindex call stack traces
7207 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7208 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7209 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7210 stack.
7211
7212 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7213 @table @code
7214 @kindex backtrace
7215 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7216 @item backtrace
7217 @itemx bt
7218 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7219 frames in the stack.
7220
7221 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7222 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7223
7224 @item backtrace @var{n}
7225 @itemx bt @var{n}
7226 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7227
7228 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7229 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7230 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7231
7232 @item backtrace full
7233 @itemx bt full
7234 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7235 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7236 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7237 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7238
7239 @item backtrace no-filters
7240 @itemx bt no-filters
7241 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7242 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7243 @itemx bt no-filters full
7244 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7245 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7246 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7247 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7248 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7249 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7250 support.
7251 @end table
7252
7253 @kindex where
7254 @kindex info stack
7255 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7256 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7257
7258 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7259 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7260 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7261 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7262 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7263 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7264 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7265 multi-threaded program.
7266
7267 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7268 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7269 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7270 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7271 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7272 line number.
7273
7274 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7275 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7276
7277 @smallexample
7278 @group
7279 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7280 at builtin.c:993
7281 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7282 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7283 at macro.c:71
7284 (More stack frames follow...)
7285 @end group
7286 @end smallexample
7287
7288 @noindent
7289 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7290 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7291 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7292
7293 @noindent
7294 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7295 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7296 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7297 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7298 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7299
7300 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7301 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7302 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7303 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7304 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7305 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7306 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7307 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7308 such a backtrace might look like:
7309
7310 @smallexample
7311 @group
7312 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7313 at builtin.c:993
7314 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7315 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7316 at macro.c:71
7317 (More stack frames follow...)
7318 @end group
7319 @end smallexample
7320
7321 @noindent
7322 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7323 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7324
7325 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7326 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7327 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7328
7329 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7330 @cindex program entry point
7331 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7332 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7333 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7334 @code{main}@footnote{
7335 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7336 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7337 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7338 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7339 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7340 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7341
7342 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7343 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7344
7345 @table @code
7346 @item set backtrace past-main
7347 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7348 @kindex set backtrace
7349 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7350
7351 @item set backtrace past-main off
7352 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7353 default.
7354
7355 @item show backtrace past-main
7356 @kindex show backtrace
7357 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7358
7359 @item set backtrace past-entry
7360 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7361 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7362 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7363 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7364
7365 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7366 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7367 application. This is the default.
7368
7369 @item show backtrace past-entry
7370 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7371
7372 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7373 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7374 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7375 @cindex backtrace limit
7376 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7377 or zero means unlimited levels.
7378
7379 @item show backtrace limit
7380 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7381 @end table
7382
7383 You can control how file names are displayed.
7384
7385 @table @code
7386 @item set filename-display
7387 @itemx set filename-display relative
7388 @cindex filename-display
7389 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7390
7391 @item set filename-display basename
7392 Display only basename of a filename.
7393
7394 @item set filename-display absolute
7395 Display an absolute filename.
7396
7397 @item show filename-display
7398 Show the current way to display filenames.
7399 @end table
7400
7401 @node Selection
7402 @section Selecting a Frame
7403
7404 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7405 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7406 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7407 of the stack frame just selected.
7408
7409 @table @code
7410 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7411 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7412 @item frame @var{n}
7413 @itemx f @var{n}
7414 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7415 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7416 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7417 @code{main}.
7418
7419 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7420 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7421 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7422 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7423 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7424 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7425 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7426 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7427
7428 @kindex up
7429 @item up @var{n}
7430 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7431 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7432 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7433
7434 @kindex down
7435 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7436 @item down @var{n}
7437 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7438 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7439 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7440 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7441 @end table
7442
7443 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7444 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7445 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7446 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7447
7448 @need 1000
7449 For example:
7450
7451 @smallexample
7452 @group
7453 (@value{GDBP}) up
7454 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7455 at env.c:10
7456 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7457 @end group
7458 @end smallexample
7459
7460 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7461 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7462 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7463 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7464 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7465 for details.
7466
7467 @table @code
7468 @kindex select-frame
7469 @item select-frame
7470 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7471 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7472 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7473 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7474
7475 @kindex down-silently
7476 @kindex up-silently
7477 @item up-silently @var{n}
7478 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7479 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7480 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7481 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7482 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7483 distracting.
7484 @end table
7485
7486 @node Frame Info
7487 @section Information About a Frame
7488
7489 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7490 stack frame.
7491
7492 @table @code
7493 @item frame
7494 @itemx f
7495 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7496 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7497 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7498 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7499 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7500
7501 @kindex info frame
7502 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7503 @item info frame
7504 @itemx info f
7505 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7506 including:
7507
7508 @itemize @bullet
7509 @item
7510 the address of the frame
7511 @item
7512 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7513 @item
7514 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7515 @item
7516 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7517 @item
7518 the address of the frame's arguments
7519 @item
7520 the address of the frame's local variables
7521 @item
7522 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7523 @item
7524 which registers were saved in the frame
7525 @end itemize
7526
7527 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7528 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7529 the usual conventions.
7530
7531 @item info frame @var{addr}
7532 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7533 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7534 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7535 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7536 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7537 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7538
7539 @kindex info args
7540 @item info args
7541 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7542
7543 @item info locals
7544 @kindex info locals
7545 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7546 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7547 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7548
7549 @end table
7550
7551 @node Frame Filter Management
7552 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7553 @cindex managing frame filters
7554
7555 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7556 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7557
7558 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7559 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7560
7561 @table @code
7562 @kindex info frame-filter
7563 @item info frame-filter
7564 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7565 their name, priority and enabled status.
7566
7567 @kindex disable frame-filter
7568 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7569 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7570 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7571 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7572 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7573 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7574 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7575 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7576 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7577 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7578 may be enabled again later.
7579
7580 @kindex enable frame-filter
7581 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7582 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7583 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7584 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7585 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7586 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7587 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7588 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7589 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7590
7591 Example:
7592
7593 @smallexample
7594 (gdb) info frame-filter
7595
7596 global frame-filters:
7597 Priority Enabled Name
7598 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7599 100 Yes Reverse
7600
7601 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7602 Priority Enabled Name
7603 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7604
7605 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7606 Priority Enabled Name
7607 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7608
7609 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7610 (gdb) info frame-filter
7611
7612 global frame-filters:
7613 Priority Enabled Name
7614 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7615 100 Yes Reverse
7616
7617 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7618 Priority Enabled Name
7619 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7620
7621 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7622 Priority Enabled Name
7623 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7624
7625 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7626 (gdb) info frame-filter
7627
7628 global frame-filters:
7629 Priority Enabled Name
7630 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7631 100 Yes Reverse
7632
7633 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7634 Priority Enabled Name
7635 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7636
7637 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7638 Priority Enabled Name
7639 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7640 @end smallexample
7641
7642 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7643 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7644 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7645 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7646 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7647 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7648 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7649
7650 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7651 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7652 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7653 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7654 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7655 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7656 dictionary resides.
7657
7658 Example:
7659
7660 @smallexample
7661 (gdb) info frame-filter
7662
7663 global frame-filters:
7664 Priority Enabled Name
7665 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7666 100 Yes Reverse
7667
7668 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7669 Priority Enabled Name
7670 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7671
7672 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7673 Priority Enabled Name
7674 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7675
7676 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7677 (gdb) info frame-filter
7678
7679 global frame-filters:
7680 Priority Enabled Name
7681 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7682 50 Yes Reverse
7683
7684 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7685 Priority Enabled Name
7686 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7687
7688 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7689 Priority Enabled Name
7690 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7691 @end smallexample
7692 @end table
7693
7694 @node Source
7695 @chapter Examining Source Files
7696
7697 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7698 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7699 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7700 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7701 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7702 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7703 source files by explicit command.
7704
7705 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7706 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7707 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7708
7709 @menu
7710 * List:: Printing source lines
7711 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7712 * Edit:: Editing source files
7713 * Search:: Searching source files
7714 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7715 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7716 @end menu
7717
7718 @node List
7719 @section Printing Source Lines
7720
7721 @kindex list
7722 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7723 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7724 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7725 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7726 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7727
7728 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7729
7730 @table @code
7731 @item list @var{linenum}
7732 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7733 current source file.
7734
7735 @item list @var{function}
7736 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7737 @var{function}.
7738
7739 @item list
7740 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7741 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7742 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7743 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7744 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7745
7746 @item list -
7747 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7748 @end table
7749
7750 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7751 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7752 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7753
7754 @table @code
7755 @kindex set listsize
7756 @item set listsize @var{count}
7757 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7758 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7759 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7760 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7761
7762 @kindex show listsize
7763 @item show listsize
7764 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7765 @end table
7766
7767 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7768 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7769 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7770 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7771 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7772
7773 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7774 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7775 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7776 to specify some source line.
7777
7778 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7779
7780 @table @code
7781 @item list @var{location}
7782 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7783
7784 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7785 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7786 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7787 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7788 the same source file as the first location.
7789
7790 @item list ,@var{last}
7791 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7792
7793 @item list @var{first},
7794 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7795
7796 @item list +
7797 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7798
7799 @item list -
7800 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7801
7802 @item list
7803 As described in the preceding table.
7804 @end table
7805
7806 @node Specify Location
7807 @section Specifying a Location
7808 @cindex specifying location
7809 @cindex location
7810 @cindex source location
7811
7812 @menu
7813 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7814 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7815 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7816 @end menu
7817
7818 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7819 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7820 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7821 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7822 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7823
7824 @node Linespec Locations
7825 @subsection Linespec Locations
7826 @cindex linespec locations
7827
7828 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7829 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7830 specifying a linespec:
7831
7832 @table @code
7833 @item @var{linenum}
7834 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7835
7836 @item -@var{offset}
7837 @itemx +@var{offset}
7838 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7839 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7840 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7841 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7842 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7843 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7844 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7845 linespec.
7846
7847 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7848 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7849 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7850 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7851 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7852 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7853 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7854
7855 @item @var{function}
7856 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7857 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7858
7859 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7860 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7861
7862 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7863 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7864 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7865 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7866 functions in different source files.
7867
7868 @item @var{label}
7869 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7870 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7871 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7872 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7873
7874 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7875 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7876 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7877 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7878 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7879 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7880
7881 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7882 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7883 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7884 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7885 each one of those probes.
7886 @end table
7887
7888 @node Explicit Locations
7889 @subsection Explicit Locations
7890 @cindex explicit locations
7891
7892 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7893 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7894
7895 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7896 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7897 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7898 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7899 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7900
7901 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7902 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7903 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7904 the symbol table to know.
7905
7906 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7907 following table:
7908
7909 @table @code
7910 @item -source @var{filename}
7911 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7912 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7913 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7914 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7915 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7916
7917 @item -function @var{function}
7918 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7919 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7920 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7921 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7922
7923 @item -label @var{label}
7924 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7925 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7926 selected stack frame.
7927
7928 @item -line @var{number}
7929 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7930 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7931 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7932 relative to the current line.
7933 @end table
7934
7935 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7936 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7937
7938 @node Address Locations
7939 @subsection Address Locations
7940 @cindex address locations
7941
7942 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7943 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7944
7945 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7946 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7947 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7948 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7949 source files.
7950
7951 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7952 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7953 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7954 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7955 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7956 of @var{address}:
7957
7958 @table @code
7959 @item @var{expression}
7960 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7961
7962 @item @var{funcaddr}
7963 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7964 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7965 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7966 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7967 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7968 (although the Pascal form also works).
7969
7970 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7971 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7972
7973 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7974 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7975 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7976 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7977 functions with identical names in different source files.
7978 @end table
7979
7980 @node Edit
7981 @section Editing Source Files
7982 @cindex editing source files
7983
7984 @kindex edit
7985 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7986 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7987 The editing program of your choice
7988 is invoked with the current line set to
7989 the active line in the program.
7990 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7991 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7992
7993 @table @code
7994 @item edit @var{location}
7995 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7996 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7997 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7998 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7999 command most commonly used:
8000
8001 @table @code
8002 @item edit @var{number}
8003 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8004
8005 @item edit @var{function}
8006 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8007 @end table
8008
8009 @end table
8010
8011 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8012 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8013 @footnote{
8014 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8015 following command-line syntax:
8016 @smallexample
8017 ex +@var{number} file
8018 @end smallexample
8019 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8020 the file where to start editing.}.
8021 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8022 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8023 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8024 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8025 @smallexample
8026 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8027 export EDITOR
8028 gdb @dots{}
8029 @end smallexample
8030 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8031 @smallexample
8032 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8033 gdb @dots{}
8034 @end smallexample
8035
8036 @node Search
8037 @section Searching Source Files
8038 @cindex searching source files
8039
8040 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8041 regular expression.
8042
8043 @table @code
8044 @kindex search
8045 @kindex forward-search
8046 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8047 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8048 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8049 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8050 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8051 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8052 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8053 @code{fo}.
8054
8055 @kindex reverse-search
8056 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8057 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8058 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8059 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8060 this command as @code{rev}.
8061 @end table
8062
8063 @node Source Path
8064 @section Specifying Source Directories
8065
8066 @cindex source path
8067 @cindex directories for source files
8068 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8069 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8070 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8071 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8072 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8073 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8074 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8075
8076 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8077 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8078 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8079 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8080 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8081 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8082 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8083 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8084 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8085 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8086 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8087
8088 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8089 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8090 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8091 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8092 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8093 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8094
8095 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8096 source files.
8097
8098 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8099 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8100 each line is in the file.
8101
8102 @kindex directory
8103 @kindex dir
8104 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8105 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8106 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8107
8108 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8109 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8110
8111 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8112 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8113 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8114 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8115 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8116 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8117 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8118 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8119 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8120 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8121 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8122 name to look up the sources.
8123
8124 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8125 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8126 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8127 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8128 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8129 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8130 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8131 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8132
8133 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8134 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8135 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8136 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8137 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8138 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8139 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8140
8141 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8142 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8143 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8144 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8145 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8146 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8147 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8148 command.
8149
8150 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8151 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8152 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8153 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8154 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8155 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8156 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8157
8158 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8159 @cindex default source path substitution
8160 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8161 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8162 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8163 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8164 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8165 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8166 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8167 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8168 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8169 together.
8170
8171 @table @code
8172 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8173 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8174 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8175 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8176 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8177 part of absolute file names) or
8178 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8179 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8180
8181 @kindex cdir
8182 @kindex cwd
8183 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8184 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8185 @cindex compilation directory
8186 @cindex current directory
8187 @cindex working directory
8188 @cindex directory, current
8189 @cindex directory, compilation
8190 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8191 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8192 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8193 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8194 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8195 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8196
8197 @item directory
8198 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8199
8200 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8201 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8202
8203 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8204 @kindex set directories
8205 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8206 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8207
8208 @item show directories
8209 @kindex show directories
8210 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8211
8212 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8213 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8214 @kindex set substitute-path
8215 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8216 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8217 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8218
8219 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8220 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8221
8222 @smallexample
8223 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8224 @end smallexample
8225
8226 @noindent
8227 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8228 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8229 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8230
8231 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8232 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8233 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8234 the substitution.
8235
8236 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8237
8238 @smallexample
8239 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8240 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8241 @end smallexample
8242
8243 @noindent
8244 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8245 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8246 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8247 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8248
8249
8250 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8251 @kindex unset substitute-path
8252 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8253 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8254 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8255
8256 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8257
8258 @item show substitute-path [path]
8259 @kindex show substitute-path
8260 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8261 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8262
8263 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8264 rules.
8265
8266 @end table
8267
8268 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8269 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8270 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8271
8272 @enumerate
8273 @item
8274 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8275
8276 @item
8277 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8278 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8279 directories in one command.
8280 @end enumerate
8281
8282 @node Machine Code
8283 @section Source and Machine Code
8284 @cindex source line and its code address
8285
8286 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8287 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8288 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8289 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8290 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8291 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8292 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8293 well as hex.
8294
8295 @table @code
8296 @kindex info line
8297 @item info line @var{location}
8298 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8299 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8300 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8301 @end table
8302
8303 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8304 the object code for the first line of function
8305 @code{m4_changequote}:
8306
8307 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8308 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8309 @smallexample
8310 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8311 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8312 @end smallexample
8313
8314 @noindent
8315 @cindex code address and its source line
8316 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8317 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8318 @smallexample
8319 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8320 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8321 @end smallexample
8322
8323 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8324 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8325 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8326 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8327 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8328 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8329 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8330 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8331 Variables}).
8332
8333 @table @code
8334 @kindex disassemble
8335 @cindex assembly instructions
8336 @cindex instructions, assembly
8337 @cindex machine instructions
8338 @cindex listing machine instructions
8339 @item disassemble
8340 @itemx disassemble /m
8341 @itemx disassemble /s
8342 @itemx disassemble /r
8343 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8344 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8345 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8346 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8347 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8348 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8349 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8350 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8351 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8352 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8353
8354 @table @code
8355 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8356 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8357 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8358 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8359 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8360 @end table
8361
8362 @noindent
8363 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8364 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8365
8366 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8367 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8368
8369 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8370 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8371 @end table
8372
8373 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8374 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8375
8376 @smallexample
8377 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8378 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8379 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8380 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8381 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8382 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8383 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8384 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8385 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8386 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8387 End of assembler dump.
8388 @end smallexample
8389
8390 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8391 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8392 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8396 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8397 5 @{
8398 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8399 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8400 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8401 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8402 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8403
8404 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8405 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8406 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8407
8408 7 return 0;
8409 8 @}
8410 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8411 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8412 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8413
8414 End of assembler dump.
8415 @end smallexample
8416
8417 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8418 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8419 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8420 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8421 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8422 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8423 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8424 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8425 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8426
8427 @file{foo.h}:
8428
8429 @smallexample
8430 int
8431 foo (int a)
8432 @{
8433 if (a < 0)
8434 return a * 2;
8435 if (a == 0)
8436 return 1;
8437 return a + 10;
8438 @}
8439 @end smallexample
8440
8441 @file{foo.c}:
8442
8443 @smallexample
8444 #include "foo.h"
8445 volatile int x, y;
8446 int
8447 main ()
8448 @{
8449 x = foo (y);
8450 return 0;
8451 @}
8452 @end smallexample
8453
8454 @smallexample
8455 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8456 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8457 5 @{
8458
8459 6 x = foo (y);
8460 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8461 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8462
8463 7 return 0;
8464 8 @}
8465 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8466 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8467 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8468 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8469
8470 End of assembler dump.
8471 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8472 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8473 foo.c:
8474 5 @{
8475 6 x = foo (y);
8476 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8477
8478 foo.h:
8479 4 if (a < 0)
8480 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8481 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8482
8483 6 if (a == 0)
8484 7 return 1;
8485 8 return a + 10;
8486 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8487 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8488 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8489 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8490
8491 foo.c:
8492 6 x = foo (y);
8493 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8494
8495 7 return 0;
8496 8 @}
8497 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8498 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8499
8500 foo.h:
8501 5 return a * 2;
8502 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8503 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8504 End of assembler dump.
8505 @end smallexample
8506
8507 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8508
8509 @smallexample
8510 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8511 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8512 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8513 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8514 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8515 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8516 End of assembler dump.
8517 @end smallexample
8518
8519 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8520 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8521 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8522 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8523
8524 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8525 mnemonics or other syntax.
8526
8527 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8528 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8529 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8530 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8531 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8532
8533 @table @code
8534 @kindex set disassembler-options
8535 @cindex disassembler options
8536 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8537 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8538 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8539 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8540 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8541 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8542 The default value is the empty string.
8543
8544 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8545 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8546 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8547 and S/390.
8548
8549 @kindex show disassembler-options
8550 @item show disassembler-options
8551 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8552 @end table
8553
8554 @table @code
8555 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8556 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8557 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8558 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8559 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8560 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8561
8562 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8563 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8564 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8565 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8566
8567 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8568 @item show disassembly-flavor
8569 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8570 @end table
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8574 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8575 @item set disassemble-next-line
8576 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8577 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8578 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8579 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8580 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8581 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8582 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8583 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8584 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8585 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8586 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8587 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8588 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8589 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8590 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8591 instruction.
8592 @end table
8593
8594
8595 @node Data
8596 @chapter Examining Data
8597
8598 @cindex printing data
8599 @cindex examining data
8600 @kindex print
8601 @kindex inspect
8602 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8603 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8604 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8605 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8606 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8607 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8608
8609 @table @code
8610 @item print @var{expr}
8611 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8612 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8613 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8614 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8615 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8616 Formats}.
8617
8618 @item print
8619 @itemx print /@var{f}
8620 @cindex reprint the last value
8621 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8622 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8623 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8624 @end table
8625
8626 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8627 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8628 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8629
8630 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8631 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8632 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8633 Table}.
8634
8635 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8636 @kindex explore
8637 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8638 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8639 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8640 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8641 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8642 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8643 embedded in the higher level data types.
8644
8645 @table @code
8646 @item explore @var{arg}
8647 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8648 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8649 @end table
8650
8651 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8652 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8653 C program as
8654
8655 @smallexample
8656 struct SimpleStruct
8657 @{
8658 int i;
8659 double d;
8660 @};
8661
8662 struct ComplexStruct
8663 @{
8664 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8665 int arr[10];
8666 @};
8667 @end smallexample
8668
8669 @noindent
8670 followed by variable declarations as
8671
8672 @smallexample
8673 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8674 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @noindent
8678 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8679 @code{explore} command as follows.
8680
8681 @smallexample
8682 (gdb) explore cs
8683 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8684 the following fields:
8685
8686 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8687 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8688
8689 Enter the field number of choice:
8690 @end smallexample
8691
8692 @noindent
8693 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8694 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8695 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8696 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8697 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8698 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8699 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8700 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8701
8702 @smallexample
8703 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8704 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8705 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8706 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8707
8708 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8709 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8710
8711 Press enter to return to parent value:
8712 @end smallexample
8713
8714 @noindent
8715 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8716 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8717 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8718 to explore.
8719
8720 @smallexample
8721 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8722 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8723
8724 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8725
8726 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8727
8728 Press enter to return to parent value:
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8732 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8733 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8734 level data structure).
8735
8736 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8737 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8738 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8739 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8740 same example as above, your can explore the type
8741 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8742 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8743
8744 @smallexample
8745 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8746 @end smallexample
8747
8748 @noindent
8749 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8750 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8751 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8752 example.
8753
8754 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8755 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8756 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8757 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8758 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8759
8760 @table @code
8761 @item explore value @var{expr}
8762 @cindex explore value
8763 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8764 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8765 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8766 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8767 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8768
8769 @item explore type @var{arg}
8770 @cindex explore type
8771 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8772 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8773 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8774 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8775 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8776 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8777 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8778 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8779 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8780 @end table
8781
8782 @menu
8783 * Expressions:: Expressions
8784 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8785 * Variables:: Program variables
8786 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8787 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8788 * Memory:: Examining memory
8789 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8790 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8791 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8792 * Value History:: Value history
8793 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8794 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8795 * Registers:: Registers
8796 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8797 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8798 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8799 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8800 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8801 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8802 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8803 character set than GDB does
8804 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8805 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8806 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8807 @end menu
8808
8809 @node Expressions
8810 @section Expressions
8811
8812 @cindex expressions
8813 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8814 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8815 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8816 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8817 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8818 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8819 @ref{Compilation}.
8820
8821 @cindex arrays in expressions
8822 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8823 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8824 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8825 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8826 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8827 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8828
8829 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8830 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8831 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8832 languages.
8833
8834 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8835 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8836
8837 @cindex casts, in expressions
8838 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8839 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8840 at that address in memory.
8841 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8842
8843 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8844 to programming languages:
8845
8846 @table @code
8847 @item @@
8848 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8849 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8850
8851 @item ::
8852 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8853 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8854
8855 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8856 @cindex type casting memory
8857 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8858 @cindex casts, to view memory
8859 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8860 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8861 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8862 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8863 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8864 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8865 @end table
8866
8867 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8868 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8869 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8870
8871 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8872 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8873 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8874 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8875 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8876 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8877 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8878
8879 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8880 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8881 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8882 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8883 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8884 as well.
8885
8886 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8887 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8888 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8889 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8890 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8891 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8892 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8893 choices.
8894
8895 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8896 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8897 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8898
8899 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8900 @smallexample
8901 @group
8902 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8903 [0] cancel
8904 [1] all
8905 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8906 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8907 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8908 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8909 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8910 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8911 > 2 4 6
8912 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8913 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8914 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8915 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8916 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8917 breakpoints.
8918 (@value{GDBP})
8919 @end group
8920 @end smallexample
8921
8922 @table @code
8923 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8924 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8925 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8926
8927 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8928 is ambiguous.
8929
8930 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8931 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8932 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8933 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8934 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8935 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8936 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8937 in the use of the menu.
8938
8939 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8940 when an ambiguity is detected.
8941
8942 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8943 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8944
8945 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8946 @item show multiple-symbols
8947 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8948 @end table
8949
8950 @node Variables
8951 @section Program Variables
8952
8953 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8954 in your program.
8955
8956 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8957 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8958
8959 @itemize @bullet
8960 @item
8961 global (or file-static)
8962 @end itemize
8963
8964 @noindent or
8965
8966 @itemize @bullet
8967 @item
8968 visible according to the scope rules of the
8969 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8970 @end itemize
8971
8972 @noindent This means that in the function
8973
8974 @smallexample
8975 foo (a)
8976 int a;
8977 @{
8978 bar (a);
8979 @{
8980 int b = test ();
8981 bar (b);
8982 @}
8983 @}
8984 @end smallexample
8985
8986 @noindent
8987 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8988 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8989 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8990 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8991
8992 @cindex variable name conflict
8993 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8994 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8995 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8996 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8997 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8998 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8999 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9000
9001 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9002 @ifnotinfo
9003 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9004 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9005 @end ifnotinfo
9006 @smallexample
9007 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9008 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9009 @end smallexample
9010
9011 @noindent
9012 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9013 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9014 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9015 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9016
9017 @smallexample
9018 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9019 @end smallexample
9020
9021 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9022 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9023 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9024 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9025 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9026
9027 @smallexample
9028 void
9029 foo (int a)
9030 @{
9031 if (a < 10)
9032 bar (a);
9033 else
9034 process (a); /* Stop here */
9035 @}
9036
9037 int
9038 bar (int a)
9039 @{
9040 foo (a + 5);
9041 @}
9042 @end smallexample
9043
9044 @noindent
9045 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9046 here is what you might see
9047 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9048
9049 @smallexample
9050 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9051 $1 = 10
9052 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9053 $2 = 5
9054 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9055 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9056 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9057 $3 = 5
9058 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9059 $4 = 0
9060 @end smallexample
9061
9062 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9063 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9064 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9065 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9066 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9067
9068 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9069 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9070 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9071 @code{some_global}.
9072
9073 @smallexample
9074 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9075 $1 = 23
9076 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9077 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9078 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9079 $2 = 27
9080 @end smallexample
9081
9082 @cindex wrong values
9083 @cindex variable values, wrong
9084 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9085 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9086 @quotation
9087 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9088 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9089 scope, and just before exit.
9090 @end quotation
9091 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9092 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9093 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9094 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9095 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9096 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9097 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9098 variable definitions may be gone.
9099
9100 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9101 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9102 when compiling.
9103
9104 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9105 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9106 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9107 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9108 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9109 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9110 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9111
9112 @smallexample
9113 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9114 @end smallexample
9115
9116 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9117 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9118 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9119 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9120 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9121
9122 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9123 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9124 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9125 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9126
9127 @cindex no debug info variables
9128 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9129 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9130 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9131 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9132 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9133 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9134 example, in a C program:
9135
9136 @smallexample
9137 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9138 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9139 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9140 $1 = 3.14
9141 @end smallexample
9142
9143 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9144 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9145 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9146 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9147 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9148
9149 @smallexample
9150 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9151 29 i++;
9152 (gdb) next
9153 30 e (i);
9154 (gdb) print i
9155 $1 = 31
9156 (gdb) print i@@entry
9157 $2 = 30
9158 @end smallexample
9159
9160 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9161 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9162 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9163 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9164 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9165 For program code
9166
9167 @smallexample
9168 char var0[] = "A";
9169 signed char var1[] = "A";
9170 @end smallexample
9171
9172 You get during debugging
9173 @smallexample
9174 (gdb) print var0
9175 $1 = "A"
9176 (gdb) print var1
9177 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9178 @end smallexample
9179
9180 @node Arrays
9181 @section Artificial Arrays
9182
9183 @cindex artificial array
9184 @cindex arrays
9185 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9186 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9187 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9188 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9189 program.
9190
9191 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9192 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9193 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9194 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9195 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9196 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9197 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9198 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9199 example. If a program says
9200
9201 @smallexample
9202 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9203 @end smallexample
9204
9205 @noindent
9206 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9207
9208 @smallexample
9209 p *array@@len
9210 @end smallexample
9211
9212 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9213 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9214 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9215 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9216 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9217
9218 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9219 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9220 The value need not be in memory:
9221 @smallexample
9222 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9223 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9224 @end smallexample
9225
9226 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9227 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9228 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9229 @smallexample
9230 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9231 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9232 @end smallexample
9233
9234 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9235 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9236 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9237 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9238 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9239 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9240 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9241 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9242 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9243 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9244
9245 @smallexample
9246 set $i = 0
9247 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9248 @key{RET}
9249 @key{RET}
9250 @dots{}
9251 @end smallexample
9252
9253 @node Output Formats
9254 @section Output Formats
9255
9256 @cindex formatted output
9257 @cindex output formats
9258 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9259 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9260 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9261 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9262 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9263
9264 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9265 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9266 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9267 letters supported are:
9268
9269 @table @code
9270 @item x
9271 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9272 hexadecimal.
9273
9274 @item d
9275 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9276
9277 @item u
9278 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9279
9280 @item o
9281 Print as integer in octal.
9282
9283 @item t
9284 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9285 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9286 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9287 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9288
9289 @item a
9290 @cindex unknown address, locating
9291 @cindex locate address
9292 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9293 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9294 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9295
9296 @smallexample
9297 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9298 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9299 @end smallexample
9300
9301 @noindent
9302 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9303 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9304
9305 @item c
9306 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9307 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9308 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9309 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9310
9311 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9312 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9313 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9314 data.
9315
9316 @item f
9317 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9318 using typical floating point syntax.
9319
9320 @item s
9321 @cindex printing strings
9322 @cindex printing byte arrays
9323 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9324 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9325 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9326 natural types.
9327
9328 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9329 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9330 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9331 array.
9332
9333 @item z
9334 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9335 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9336 to the size of the integer type.
9337
9338 @item r
9339 @cindex raw printing
9340 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9341 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9342 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9343 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9344 pretty-printer which might exist.
9345 @end table
9346
9347 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9348
9349 @smallexample
9350 p/x $pc
9351 @end smallexample
9352
9353 @noindent
9354 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9355 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9356
9357 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9358 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9359 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9360
9361 @node Memory
9362 @section Examining Memory
9363
9364 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9365 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9366
9367 @cindex examining memory
9368 @table @code
9369 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9370 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9371 @itemx x @var{addr}
9372 @itemx x
9373 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9374 @end table
9375
9376 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9377 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9378 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9379 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9380 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9381
9382 @table @r
9383 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9384 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9385 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9386 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9387 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9388 @c 4.1.2.
9389
9390 @item @var{f}, the display format
9391 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9392 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9393 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9394 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9395 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9396
9397 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9398 The unit size is any of
9399
9400 @table @code
9401 @item b
9402 Bytes.
9403 @item h
9404 Halfwords (two bytes).
9405 @item w
9406 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9407 @item g
9408 Giant words (eight bytes).
9409 @end table
9410
9411 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9412 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9413 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9414 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9415 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9416 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9417 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9418 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9419 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9420 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9421 be altered.
9422
9423 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9424 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9425 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9426 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9427 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9428 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9429 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9430 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9431 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9432 a value from memory).
9433 @end table
9434
9435 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9436 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9437 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9438 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9439 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9440
9441 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9442 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9443 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9444
9445 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9446 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9447 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9448 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9449 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9450
9451 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9452 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9453 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9454 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9455 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9456 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9457 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9458 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9459 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9460
9461 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9462 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9463 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9464 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9465 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9466 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9467
9468 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9469 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9470 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9471 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9472 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9473 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9474 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9475
9476 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9477 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9478
9479 @smallexample
9480 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9481 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9482 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9483 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9484 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9485 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9486 @end smallexample
9487
9488 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9489 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9490 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9491 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9492 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9493 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9494 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9495 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9496 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9497
9498 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9499 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9500 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9501
9502 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9503 @cindex addressable memory unit
9504 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9505 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9506 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9507 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9508 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9509 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9510 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9511 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9512 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9513
9514 @cindex remote memory comparison
9515 @cindex target memory comparison
9516 @cindex verify remote memory image
9517 @cindex verify target memory image
9518 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9519 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9520 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9521 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9522 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9523 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9524
9525 @table @code
9526 @kindex compare-sections
9527 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9528 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9529 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9530 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9531 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9532 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9533
9534 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9535 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9536 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9537 @end table
9538
9539 @node Auto Display
9540 @section Automatic Display
9541 @cindex automatic display
9542 @cindex display of expressions
9543
9544 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9545 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9546 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9547 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9548 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9549 The automatic display looks like this:
9550
9551 @smallexample
9552 2: foo = 38
9553 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9554 @end smallexample
9555
9556 @noindent
9557 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9558 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9559 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9560 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9561 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9562 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9563
9564 @table @code
9565 @kindex display
9566 @item display @var{expr}
9567 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9568 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9569
9570 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9571
9572 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9573 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9574 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9575 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9576 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9577
9578 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9579 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9580 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9581 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9582 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9583 @end table
9584
9585 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9586 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9587 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9588
9589 @table @code
9590 @kindex delete display
9591 @kindex undisplay
9592 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9593 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9594 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9595 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9596 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9597 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9598 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9599
9600 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9601 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9602
9603 @kindex disable display
9604 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9605 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9606 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9607 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9608 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9609 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9610 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9611 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9612
9613 @kindex enable display
9614 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9615 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9616 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9617 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9618 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9619 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9620 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9621
9622 @item display
9623 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9624 done when your program stops.
9625
9626 @kindex info display
9627 @item info display
9628 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9629 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9630 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9631 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9632 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9633 @end table
9634
9635 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9636 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9637 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9638 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9639 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9640 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9641 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9642 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9643 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9644 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9645 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9646
9647 @node Print Settings
9648 @section Print Settings
9649
9650 @cindex format options
9651 @cindex print settings
9652 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9653 and symbols are printed.
9654
9655 @noindent
9656 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9657
9658 @table @code
9659 @kindex set print
9660 @item set print address
9661 @itemx set print address on
9662 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9663 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9664 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9665 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9666 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9667 @code{set print address on}:
9668
9669 @smallexample
9670 @group
9671 (@value{GDBP}) f
9672 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9673 at input.c:530
9674 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9675 @end group
9676 @end smallexample
9677
9678 @item set print address off
9679 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9680 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9681
9682 @smallexample
9683 @group
9684 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9685 (@value{GDBP}) f
9686 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9687 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9688 @end group
9689 @end smallexample
9690
9691 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9692 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9693 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9694 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9695
9696 @kindex show print
9697 @item show print address
9698 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9699 @end table
9700
9701 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9702 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9703 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9704 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9705 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9706 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9707 it prints a symbolic address:
9708
9709 @table @code
9710 @item set print symbol-filename on
9711 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9712 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9713 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9714 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9715
9716 @item set print symbol-filename off
9717 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9718 default.
9719
9720 @item show print symbol-filename
9721 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9722 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9723 @end table
9724
9725 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9726 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9727 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9728
9729 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9730 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9731
9732 @table @code
9733 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9734 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9735 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9736 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9737 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9738 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9739 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9740 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9741
9742 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9743 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9744 symbolic address.
9745 @end table
9746
9747 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9748 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9749 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9750 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9751 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9752 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9753 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9754 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9755
9756 @smallexample
9757 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9758 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9759 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9760 @end smallexample
9761
9762 @quotation
9763 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9764 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9765 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9766 @end quotation
9767
9768 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9769 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9770
9771 @table @code
9772 @item set print symbol on
9773 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9774 one exists.
9775
9776 @item set print symbol off
9777 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9778 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9779 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9780
9781 @item show print symbol
9782 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9783 address.
9784 @end table
9785
9786 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9787
9788 @table @code
9789 @item set print array
9790 @itemx set print array on
9791 @cindex pretty print arrays
9792 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9793 but uses more space. The default is off.
9794
9795 @item set print array off
9796 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9797
9798 @item show print array
9799 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9800 arrays.
9801
9802 @cindex print array indexes
9803 @item set print array-indexes
9804 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9805 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9806 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9807 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9808
9809 @item set print array-indexes off
9810 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9811
9812 @item show print array-indexes
9813 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9814 arrays.
9815
9816 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9817 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9818 @cindex number of array elements to print
9819 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9820 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9821 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9822 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9823 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9824 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9825 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9826 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9827
9828 @item show print elements
9829 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9830 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9831
9832 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9833 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9834 @cindex printing frame argument values
9835 @cindex print all frame argument values
9836 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9837 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9838 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9839 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9840 values are:
9841
9842 @table @code
9843 @item all
9844 The values of all arguments are printed.
9845
9846 @item scalars
9847 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9848 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9849 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9850 only scalar arguments are shown:
9851
9852 @smallexample
9853 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9854 at frame-args.c:23
9855 @end smallexample
9856
9857 @item none
9858 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9859 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9860
9861 @smallexample
9862 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9863 at frame-args.c:23
9864 @end smallexample
9865 @end table
9866
9867 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9868 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9869 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9870 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9871 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9872 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9873 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9874 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9875 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9876 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9877
9878 @item show print frame-arguments
9879 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9880
9881 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9882 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9883
9884 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9885 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9886 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9887 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9888 This is the default.
9889
9890 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9891 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9892
9893 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9894 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9895 @kindex set print entry-values
9896 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9897 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9898 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9899 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9900 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9901
9902 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9903 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9904 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9905 @code{no} setting.
9906
9907 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9908 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9909 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9910 this information.
9911
9912 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9913
9914 @table @code
9915 @item no
9916 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9917 point.
9918 @smallexample
9919 #0 equal (val=5)
9920 #0 different (val=6)
9921 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9922 #0 born (val=10)
9923 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9924 @end smallexample
9925
9926 @item only
9927 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9928 values are never printed.
9929 @smallexample
9930 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9931 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9932 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9933 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9934 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9935 @end smallexample
9936
9937 @item preferred
9938 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9939 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9940 value for such parameter.
9941 @smallexample
9942 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9943 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9944 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9945 #0 born (val=10)
9946 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9947 @end smallexample
9948
9949 @item if-needed
9950 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9951 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9952 parameter.
9953 @smallexample
9954 #0 equal (val=5)
9955 #0 different (val=6)
9956 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9957 #0 born (val=10)
9958 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9959 @end smallexample
9960
9961 @item both
9962 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9963 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9964 optimizations.
9965 @smallexample
9966 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9967 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9968 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9969 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9970 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9971 @end smallexample
9972
9973 @item compact
9974 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9975 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9976 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9977 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9978 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9979 @smallexample
9980 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9981 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9982 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9983 #0 born (val=10)
9984 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9985 @end smallexample
9986
9987 @item default
9988 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9989 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9990 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9991 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9992 @smallexample
9993 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9994 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9995 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9996 #0 born (val=10)
9997 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9998 @end smallexample
9999 @end table
10000
10001 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10002 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10003
10004 @item show print entry-values
10005 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10006 entry.
10007
10008 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10009 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10010 @cindex repeated array elements
10011 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10012 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10013 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10014 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10015 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10016 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10017 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10018 is 10.
10019
10020 @item show print repeats
10021 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10022 elements.
10023
10024 @item set print null-stop
10025 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10026 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10027 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10028 contain only short strings.
10029 The default is off.
10030
10031 @item show print null-stop
10032 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10033 @sc{null} character.
10034
10035 @item set print pretty on
10036 @cindex print structures in indented form
10037 @cindex indentation in structure display
10038 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10039 per line, like this:
10040
10041 @smallexample
10042 @group
10043 $1 = @{
10044 next = 0x0,
10045 flags = @{
10046 sweet = 1,
10047 sour = 1
10048 @},
10049 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10050 @}
10051 @end group
10052 @end smallexample
10053
10054 @item set print pretty off
10055 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10056
10057 @smallexample
10058 @group
10059 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10060 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10061 @end group
10062 @end smallexample
10063
10064 @noindent
10065 This is the default format.
10066
10067 @item show print pretty
10068 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10069
10070 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10071 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10072 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10073 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10074 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10075 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10076 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10077 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10078
10079 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10080 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10081 international character sets, and is the default.
10082
10083 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10084 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10085
10086 @item set print union on
10087 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10088 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10089 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10090
10091 @item set print union off
10092 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10093 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10094 instead.
10095
10096 @item show print union
10097 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10098 structures and other unions.
10099
10100 For example, given the declarations
10101
10102 @smallexample
10103 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10104 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10105 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10106 Bug_forms;
10107
10108 struct thing @{
10109 Species it;
10110 union @{
10111 Tree_forms tree;
10112 Bug_forms bug;
10113 @} form;
10114 @};
10115
10116 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 @noindent
10120 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10121
10122 @smallexample
10123 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10124 @end smallexample
10125
10126 @noindent
10127 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10128
10129 @smallexample
10130 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10131 @end smallexample
10132
10133 @noindent
10134 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10135 and in Pascal.
10136 @end table
10137
10138 @need 1000
10139 @noindent
10140 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10141
10142 @table @code
10143 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10144 @item set print demangle
10145 @itemx set print demangle on
10146 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10147 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10148 linkage. The default is on.
10149
10150 @item show print demangle
10151 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10152
10153 @item set print asm-demangle
10154 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10155 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10156 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10157 The default is off.
10158
10159 @item show print asm-demangle
10160 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10161 or demangled form.
10162
10163 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10164 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10165 @kindex set demangle-style
10166 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10167 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10168 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10169
10170 @table @code
10171 @item auto
10172 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10173 This is the default.
10174
10175 @item gnu
10176 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10177
10178 @item hp
10179 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10180
10181 @item lucid
10182 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10183
10184 @item arm
10185 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10186 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10187 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10188 require further enhancement to permit that.
10189
10190 @end table
10191 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10192
10193 @item show demangle-style
10194 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10195
10196 @item set print object
10197 @itemx set print object on
10198 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10199 @cindex display derived types
10200 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10201 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10202 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10203 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10204 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10205 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10206 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10207
10208 @item set print object off
10209 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10210 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10211
10212 @item show print object
10213 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10214
10215 @item set print static-members
10216 @itemx set print static-members on
10217 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10218 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10219
10220 @item set print static-members off
10221 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10222
10223 @item show print static-members
10224 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10225
10226 @item set print pascal_static-members
10227 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10228 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10229 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10230 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10231
10232 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10233 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10234
10235 @item show print pascal_static-members
10236 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10237
10238 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10239 @item set print vtbl
10240 @itemx set print vtbl on
10241 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10242 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10243 @cindex VTBL display
10244 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10245 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10246 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10247
10248 @item set print vtbl off
10249 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10250
10251 @item show print vtbl
10252 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10253 @end table
10254
10255 @node Pretty Printing
10256 @section Pretty Printing
10257
10258 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10259 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10260 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10261
10262 @menu
10263 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10264 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10265 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10266 @end menu
10267
10268 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10269 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10270
10271 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10272 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10273 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10274
10275 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10276 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10277 pretty-printers with their names.
10278 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10279 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10280 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10281 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10282
10283 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10284 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10285 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10286 do anything special.
10287
10288 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10289
10290 @itemize @bullet
10291 @item
10292 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10293 all inferiors.
10294
10295 @item
10296 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10297 when debugging that program.
10298 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10299
10300 @item
10301 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10302 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10303 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10304 @end itemize
10305
10306 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10307 pretty-printers are selected,
10308
10309 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10310 for new types.
10311
10312 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10313 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10314
10315 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10316
10317 @smallexample
10318 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10319 $1 = @{
10320 static npos = 4294967295,
10321 _M_dataplus = @{
10322 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10323 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10324 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10325 @},
10326 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10327 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10328 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10329 @}
10330 @}
10331 @end smallexample
10332
10333 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10334
10335 @smallexample
10336 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10337 $2 = "abcd"
10338 @end smallexample
10339
10340 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10341 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10342 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10343
10344 @table @code
10345 @kindex info pretty-printer
10346 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10347 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10348 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10349
10350 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10351 whose pretty-printers to list.
10352 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10353 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10354 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10355 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10356 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10357
10358 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10359 to list.
10360
10361 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10362 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10363 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10364 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10365
10366 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10367 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10368 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10369 @end table
10370
10371 Example:
10372
10373 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10374 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10375 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10376 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10377
10378 @smallexample
10379 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10380 library1.so:
10381 foo
10382 library2.so:
10383 bar
10384 bar1
10385 bar2
10386 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10387 library2.so:
10388 bar
10389 bar1
10390 bar2
10391 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10392 1 printer disabled
10393 2 of 3 printers enabled
10394 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10395 library1.so:
10396 foo [disabled]
10397 library2.so:
10398 bar
10399 bar1
10400 bar2
10401 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10402 1 printer disabled
10403 1 of 3 printers enabled
10404 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10405 library1.so:
10406 foo [disabled]
10407 library2.so:
10408 bar
10409 bar1 [disabled]
10410 bar2
10411 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10412 1 printer disabled
10413 0 of 3 printers enabled
10414 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10415 library1.so:
10416 foo [disabled]
10417 library2.so:
10418 bar [disabled]
10419 bar1 [disabled]
10420 bar2
10421 @end smallexample
10422
10423 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10424 as can each individual subprinter.
10425
10426 @node Value History
10427 @section Value History
10428
10429 @cindex value history
10430 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10431 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10432 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10433 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10434 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10435 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10436 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10437 symbol table.
10438
10439 @cindex @code{$}
10440 @cindex @code{$$}
10441 @cindex history number
10442 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10443 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10444 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10445 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10446 history number.
10447
10448 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10449 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10450 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10451 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10452 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10453 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10454 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10455
10456 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10457 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10458
10459 @smallexample
10460 p *$
10461 @end smallexample
10462
10463 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10464 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10465
10466 @smallexample
10467 p *$.next
10468 @end smallexample
10469
10470 @noindent
10471 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10472 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10473
10474 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10475 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10476
10477 @smallexample
10478 print x
10479 set x=5
10480 @end smallexample
10481
10482 @noindent
10483 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10484 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10485
10486 @table @code
10487 @kindex show values
10488 @item show values
10489 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10490 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10491 values} does not change the history.
10492
10493 @item show values @var{n}
10494 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10495
10496 @item show values +
10497 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10498 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10499 @end table
10500
10501 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10502 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10503
10504 @node Convenience Vars
10505 @section Convenience Variables
10506
10507 @cindex convenience variables
10508 @cindex user-defined variables
10509 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10510 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10511 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10512 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10513 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10514
10515 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10516 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10517 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10518 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10519 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10520
10521 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10522 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10523 For example:
10524
10525 @smallexample
10526 set $foo = *object_ptr
10527 @end smallexample
10528
10529 @noindent
10530 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10531 @code{object_ptr}.
10532
10533 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10534 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10535 value with another assignment at any time.
10536
10537 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10538 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10539 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10540 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10541
10542 @table @code
10543 @kindex show convenience
10544 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10545 @item show convenience
10546 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10547 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10548 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10549
10550 @kindex init-if-undefined
10551 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10552 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10553 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10554 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10555 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10556 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10557 override default values used in a command script.
10558
10559 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10560 any side-effects do not occur.
10561 @end table
10562
10563 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10564 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10565 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10566
10567 @smallexample
10568 set $i = 0
10569 print bar[$i++]->contents
10570 @end smallexample
10571
10572 @noindent
10573 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10574
10575 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10576 values likely to be useful.
10577
10578 @table @code
10579 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10580 @item $_
10581 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10582 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10583 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10584 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10585 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10586 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10587 to the type of @code{$__}.
10588
10589 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10590 @item $__
10591 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10592 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10593 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10594
10595 @item $_exitcode
10596 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10597 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10598 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10599 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10600
10601 @item $_exitsignal
10602 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10603 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10604 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10605 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10606
10607 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10608 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10609 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10610 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10611 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10612
10613 @smallexample
10614 #include <signal.h>
10615
10616 int
10617 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10618 @{
10619 raise (SIGALRM);
10620 return 0;
10621 @}
10622 @end smallexample
10623
10624 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10625 or signalled would be:
10626
10627 @smallexample
10628 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10629 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10630 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10631 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10632 >echo The program has exited\n
10633 >else
10634 >echo The program has signalled\n
10635 >end
10636 >end
10637 (@value{GDBP}) run
10638 Starting program:
10639
10640 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10641 The program no longer exists.
10642 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10643 The program has signalled
10644 @end smallexample
10645
10646 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10647 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10648 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10649 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10650
10651 @smallexample
10652 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10653 The program has exited
10654 @end smallexample
10655
10656 @item $_exception
10657 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10658 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10659
10660 @item $_probe_argc
10661 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10662 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10663
10664 @item $_sdata
10665 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10666 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10667 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10668 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10669 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10670
10671 @item $_siginfo
10672 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10673 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10674 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10675 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10676 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10677
10678 @item $_tlb
10679 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10680 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10681 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10682 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10683 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10684 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10685
10686 @item $_inferior
10687 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10688 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10689
10690 @item $_thread
10691 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10692
10693 @item $_gthread
10694 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10695
10696 @end table
10697
10698 @node Convenience Funs
10699 @section Convenience Functions
10700
10701 @cindex convenience functions
10702 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10703 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10704 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10705 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10706 @value{GDBN}.
10707
10708 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10709 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10710
10711 @table @code
10712
10713 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10714 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10715 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10716 returns zero.
10717
10718 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10719 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10720 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10721 it is @code{void}:
10722
10723 @smallexample
10724 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10725 $1 = void
10726 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10727 $2 = 1
10728 (@value{GDBP}) run
10729 Starting program: ./a.out
10730 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10731 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10732 $3 = 0
10733 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10734 $4 = 0
10735 @end smallexample
10736
10737 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10738 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10739 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10740 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10741 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10742 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10743 anymore.
10744
10745 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10746 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10747
10748 @smallexample
10749 void
10750 foo (void)
10751 @{
10752 @}
10753 @end smallexample
10754
10755 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10756
10757 @smallexample
10758 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10759 $1 = void
10760 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10761 $2 = 1
10762 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10763 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10764 $3 = void
10765 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10766 $4 = 1
10767 @end smallexample
10768
10769 @end table
10770
10771 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10772 @code{Python} support.
10773
10774 @table @code
10775
10776 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10777 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10778 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10779 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10780 Otherwise it returns zero.
10781
10782 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10783 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10784 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10785 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10786 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10787 regular expression support.
10788
10789 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10790 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10791 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10792 Otherwise it returns zero.
10793
10794 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10795 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10796 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10797
10798 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10799 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10800 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10801 Otherwise it returns zero.
10802
10803 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10804 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10805 The default is 1.
10806
10807 Example:
10808
10809 @smallexample
10810 (gdb) backtrace
10811 #0 bottom_func ()
10812 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10813 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10814 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10815 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10816 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10817 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10818 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10819 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10820 $1 = 1
10821 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10822 $1 = 1
10823 @end smallexample
10824
10825 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10826 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10827 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10828 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10829
10830 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10831 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10832 The default is 1.
10833
10834 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10835 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10836 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10837 Otherwise it returns zero.
10838
10839 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10840 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10841 The default is 1.
10842
10843 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10844 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10845 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10846 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10847
10848 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10849 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10850 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10851 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10852
10853 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10854 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10855 The default is 1.
10856
10857 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10858 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10859 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10860 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10861
10862 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10863 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10864 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10865
10866 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10867 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10868 an enumerated type:
10869
10870 @smallexample
10871 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10872 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10873 @end smallexample
10874
10875 @end table
10876
10877 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10878 convenience functions.
10879
10880 @table @code
10881 @item help function
10882 @kindex help function
10883 @cindex show all convenience functions
10884 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10885 @end table
10886
10887 @node Registers
10888 @section Registers
10889
10890 @cindex registers
10891 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10892 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10893 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10894 your machine.
10895
10896 @table @code
10897 @kindex info registers
10898 @item info registers
10899 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10900 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10901
10902 @kindex info all-registers
10903 @cindex floating point registers
10904 @item info all-registers
10905 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10906 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10907
10908 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10909 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10910 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10911 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10912 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10913 @end table
10914
10915 @anchor{standard registers}
10916 @cindex stack pointer register
10917 @cindex program counter register
10918 @cindex process status register
10919 @cindex frame pointer register
10920 @cindex standard registers
10921 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10922 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10923 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10924 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10925 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10926 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10927 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10928 you could print the program counter in hex with
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 p/x $pc
10932 @end smallexample
10933
10934 @noindent
10935 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10936
10937 @smallexample
10938 x/i $pc
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 @noindent
10942 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10943 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10944 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10945 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10946 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10947 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10948 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10949
10950 @smallexample
10951 set $sp += 4
10952 @end smallexample
10953
10954 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10955 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10956 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10957 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10958 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10959 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10960 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10961
10962 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10963 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10964 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10965 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10966 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10967 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10968 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10969
10970 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10971 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10972 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10973 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10974 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10975 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10976 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10977 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10978 prints the data in both formats.
10979
10980 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10981 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10982 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10983 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10984 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10985 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10986 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10987
10988 @smallexample
10989 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10990 $1 = @{
10991 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10992 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10993 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10994 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10995 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10996 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10997 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10998 @}
10999 @end smallexample
11000
11001 @noindent
11002 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11003 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11004 value to a @code{struct} member:
11005
11006 @smallexample
11007 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11008 @end smallexample
11009
11010 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11011 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11012 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11013 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11014 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11015 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11016
11017 @cindex caller-saved registers
11018 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11019 @cindex volatile registers
11020 @cindex <not saved> values
11021 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11022 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11023 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11024 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11025 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11026 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11027 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11028 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11029 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11030 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11031 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11032 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11033 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11034 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11035 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11036 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11037 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11038 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11039 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11040 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11041 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11042 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11043 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11044
11045 @node Floating Point Hardware
11046 @section Floating Point Hardware
11047 @cindex floating point
11048
11049 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11050 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11051
11052 @table @code
11053 @kindex info float
11054 @item info float
11055 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11056 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11057 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11058 the ARM and x86 machines.
11059 @end table
11060
11061 @node Vector Unit
11062 @section Vector Unit
11063 @cindex vector unit
11064
11065 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11066 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11067
11068 @table @code
11069 @kindex info vector
11070 @item info vector
11071 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11072 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11073 @end table
11074
11075 @node OS Information
11076 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11077 @cindex OS information
11078
11079 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11080 you debug your program.
11081
11082 @cindex auxiliary vector
11083 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11084 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11085 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11086 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11087 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11088 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11089 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11090 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11091 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11092 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11093 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11094 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097 @kindex info auxv
11098 @item info auxv
11099 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11100 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11101 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11102 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11103 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11104 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11105 an unrecognized tag.
11106 @end table
11107
11108 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11109 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11110 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11111 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11112 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11113 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11114 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11115
11116 @table @code
11117 @kindex info os
11118 @item info os @var{infotype}
11119
11120 Display OS information of the requested type.
11121
11122 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11123
11124 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11125 @table @code
11126 @kindex info os cpus
11127 @item cpus
11128 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11129 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11130 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11131 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11132 kernel initialization.
11133
11134 @kindex info os files
11135 @item files
11136 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11137 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11138 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11139 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11140
11141 @kindex info os modules
11142 @item modules
11143 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11144 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11145 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11146 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11147 in memory.
11148
11149 @kindex info os msg
11150 @item msg
11151 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11152 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11153 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11154 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11155 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11156 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11157 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11158 the message queue was last changed.
11159
11160 @kindex info os processes
11161 @item processes
11162 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11163 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11164 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11165 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11166 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11167 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11168
11169 @kindex info os procgroups
11170 @item procgroups
11171 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11172 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11173 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11174 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11175 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11176 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11177 and the process group leader is listed first.
11178
11179 @kindex info os semaphores
11180 @item semaphores
11181 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11182 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11183 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11184 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11185 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11186
11187 @kindex info os shm
11188 @item shm
11189 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11190 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11191 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11192 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11193 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11194 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11195 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11196
11197 @kindex info os sockets
11198 @item sockets
11199 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11200 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11201 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11202 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11203 connection.
11204
11205 @kindex info os threads
11206 @item threads
11207 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11208 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11209 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11210 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11211 process is not listed.
11212 @end table
11213
11214 @item info os
11215 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11216 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11217 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11218 types, this command will report an error.
11219 @end table
11220
11221 @node Memory Region Attributes
11222 @section Memory Region Attributes
11223 @cindex memory region attributes
11224
11225 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11226 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11227 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11228 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11229 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11230 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11231 user can override the fetched regions.
11232
11233 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11234 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11235 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11236 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11237 all memory.
11238
11239 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11240 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11241
11242 @table @code
11243 @kindex mem
11244 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11245 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11246 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11247 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11248 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11249 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11250
11251 @item mem auto
11252 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11253 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11254
11255 @kindex delete mem
11256 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11257 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11258 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11259
11260 @kindex disable mem
11261 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11262 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11263 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11264 It may be enabled again later.
11265
11266 @kindex enable mem
11267 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11268 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11269
11270 @kindex info mem
11271 @item info mem
11272 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11273 for each region:
11274
11275 @table @emph
11276 @item Memory Region Number
11277 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11278 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11279 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11280
11281 @item Lo Address
11282 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11283
11284 @item Hi Address
11285 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11286
11287 @item Attributes
11288 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11289 @end table
11290 @end table
11291
11292
11293 @subsection Attributes
11294
11295 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11296 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11297 write accesses to a memory region.
11298
11299 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11300 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11301 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11302
11303 @table @code
11304 @item ro
11305 Memory is read only.
11306 @item wo
11307 Memory is write only.
11308 @item rw
11309 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11310 @end table
11311
11312 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11313 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11314 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11315 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11316 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11317
11318 @table @code
11319 @item 8
11320 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11321 @item 16
11322 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11323 @item 32
11324 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11325 @item 64
11326 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11327 @end table
11328
11329 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11330 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11331 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11332 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11333 @c
11334 @c @table @code
11335 @c @item hwbreak
11336 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11337 @c @item swbreak (default)
11338 @c @end table
11339
11340 @subsubsection Data Cache
11341 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11342 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11343 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11344 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11345 registers.
11346
11347 @table @code
11348 @item cache
11349 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11350 @item nocache
11351 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11352 @end table
11353
11354 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11355 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11356 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11357 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11358 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11359
11360 @table @code
11361 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11362 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11363 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11364 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11365 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11366 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11367 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11368 The default value is @code{on}.
11369 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11370 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11371 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11372 @end table
11373
11374
11375 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11376 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11377 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11378 @c
11379 @c @table @code
11380 @c @item verify
11381 @c @item noverify (default)
11382 @c @end table
11383
11384 @node Dump/Restore Files
11385 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11386 @cindex dump/restore files
11387 @cindex append data to a file
11388 @cindex dump data to a file
11389 @cindex restore data from a file
11390
11391 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11392 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11393 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11394 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11395 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11396 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11397 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11398
11399 @table @code
11400
11401 @kindex dump
11402 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11403 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11404 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11405 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11406
11407 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11408 @table @code
11409 @item binary
11410 Raw binary form.
11411 @item ihex
11412 Intel hex format.
11413 @item srec
11414 Motorola S-record format.
11415 @item tekhex
11416 Tektronix Hex format.
11417 @item verilog
11418 Verilog Hex format.
11419 @end table
11420
11421 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11422 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11423 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11424 form.
11425
11426 @kindex append
11427 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11428 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11429 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11430 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11431 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11432
11433 @kindex restore
11434 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11435 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11436 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11437 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11438 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11439
11440 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11441 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11442 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11443 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11444 from that location.
11445
11446 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11447 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11448 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11449 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11450
11451 @end table
11452
11453 @node Core File Generation
11454 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11455 @cindex dump core from inferior
11456
11457 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11458 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11459 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11460 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11461 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11462 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11463 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11464
11465 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11466 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11467 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11468
11469 @table @code
11470 @kindex gcore
11471 @kindex generate-core-file
11472 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11473 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11474 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11475 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11476 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11477 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11478
11479 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11480 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11481
11482 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11483 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11484 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11485
11486 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11487 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11488 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11489 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11490 Enable or disable the use of the file
11491 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11492 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11493 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11494 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11495
11496 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11497 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11498 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11499 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11500 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11501 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11502 about the bits that can be set in the
11503 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11504 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11505
11506 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11507 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11508 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11509 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11510 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11511 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11512 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11513 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11514 @end table
11515
11516 @node Character Sets
11517 @section Character Sets
11518 @cindex character sets
11519 @cindex charset
11520 @cindex translating between character sets
11521 @cindex host character set
11522 @cindex target character set
11523
11524 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11525 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11526 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11527 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11528 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11529 @dfn{target character set}.
11530
11531 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11532 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11533 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11534 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11535 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11536 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11537 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11538 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11539 character and string literals in expressions.
11540
11541 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11542 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11543 target-charset} command, described below.
11544
11545 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11546 support:
11547
11548 @table @code
11549 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11550 @kindex set target-charset
11551 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11552 list of supported target character sets, type
11553 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11554
11555 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11556 @kindex set host-charset
11557 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11558
11559 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11560 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11561 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11562 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11563 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11564
11565 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11566 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11567 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11568
11569 @item set charset @var{charset}
11570 @kindex set charset
11571 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11572 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11573 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11574 for both host and target.
11575
11576 @item show charset
11577 @kindex show charset
11578 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11579
11580 @item show host-charset
11581 @kindex show host-charset
11582 Show the name of the current host character set.
11583
11584 @item show target-charset
11585 @kindex show target-charset
11586 Show the name of the current target character set.
11587
11588 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11589 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11590 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11591 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11592 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11593 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11594
11595 @item show target-wide-charset
11596 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11597 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11598 @end table
11599
11600 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11601 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11602 @file{charset-test.c}:
11603
11604 @smallexample
11605 #include <stdio.h>
11606
11607 char ascii_hello[]
11608 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11609 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11610 char ibm1047_hello[]
11611 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11612 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11613
11614 main ()
11615 @{
11616 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11617 @}
11618 @end smallexample
11619
11620 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11621 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11622 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11623
11624 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11625
11626 @smallexample
11627 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11628 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11629 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11630 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11631 @dots{}
11632 (@value{GDBP})
11633 @end smallexample
11634
11635 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11636 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11637 strings:
11638
11639 @smallexample
11640 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11641 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11642 (@value{GDBP})
11643 @end smallexample
11644
11645 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11646 initial character set:
11647 @smallexample
11648 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11649 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11650 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11651 (@value{GDBP})
11652 @end smallexample
11653
11654 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11655 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11656 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11657 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11658 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11659
11660 @smallexample
11661 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11662 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11663 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11664 $2 = 72 'H'
11665 (@value{GDBP})
11666 @end smallexample
11667
11668 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11669 literals you use in expressions:
11670
11671 @smallexample
11672 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11673 $3 = 43 '+'
11674 (@value{GDBP})
11675 @end smallexample
11676
11677 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11678 character.
11679
11680 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11681 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11682 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11683
11684 @smallexample
11685 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11686 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11687 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11688 $5 = 200 '\310'
11689 (@value{GDBP})
11690 @end smallexample
11691
11692 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11693 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11694
11695 @smallexample
11696 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11697 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11698 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11699 @end smallexample
11700
11701 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11702 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11703 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11704 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11705 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11706
11707 @smallexample
11708 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11709 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11710 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11711 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11712 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11713 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11714 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11715 $7 = 72 '\110'
11716 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11717 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11718 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11719 $9 = 200 'H'
11720 (@value{GDBP})
11721 @end smallexample
11722
11723 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11724 string literals you use in expressions:
11725
11726 @smallexample
11727 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11728 $10 = 78 '+'
11729 (@value{GDBP})
11730 @end smallexample
11731
11732 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11733 character.
11734
11735 @node Caching Target Data
11736 @section Caching Data of Targets
11737 @cindex caching data of targets
11738
11739 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11740 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11741 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11742 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11743 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11744 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11745 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11746 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11747 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11748 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11749 is executing.
11750 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11751 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11752 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11753 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11754 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11755 in the code segment.
11756 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11757 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11758
11759 @table @code
11760 @kindex set remotecache
11761 @item set remotecache on
11762 @itemx set remotecache off
11763 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11764 with old scripts.
11765
11766 @kindex show remotecache
11767 @item show remotecache
11768 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11769
11770 @kindex set stack-cache
11771 @item set stack-cache on
11772 @itemx set stack-cache off
11773 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11774 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11775
11776 @kindex show stack-cache
11777 @item show stack-cache
11778 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11779
11780 @kindex set code-cache
11781 @item set code-cache on
11782 @itemx set code-cache off
11783 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11784 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11785 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11786
11787 @kindex show code-cache
11788 @item show code-cache
11789 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11790 accesses.
11791
11792 @kindex info dcache
11793 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11794 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11795 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11796 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11797 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11798 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11799
11800 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11801 printed in hex.
11802
11803 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11804 @cindex dcache size
11805 @kindex set dcache size
11806 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11807
11808 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11809 @cindex dcache line-size
11810 @kindex set dcache line-size
11811 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11812 Must be a power of 2.
11813
11814 @item show dcache size
11815 @kindex show dcache size
11816 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11817
11818 @item show dcache line-size
11819 @kindex show dcache line-size
11820 Show default size of dcache lines.
11821
11822 @end table
11823
11824 @node Searching Memory
11825 @section Search Memory
11826 @cindex searching memory
11827
11828 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11829 @code{find} command.
11830
11831 @table @code
11832 @kindex find
11833 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11834 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11835 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11836 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11837 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11838 @end table
11839
11840 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11841 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11842
11843 @table @r
11844 @item @var{s}, search query size
11845 The size of each search query value.
11846
11847 @table @code
11848 @item b
11849 bytes
11850 @item h
11851 halfwords (two bytes)
11852 @item w
11853 words (four bytes)
11854 @item g
11855 giant words (eight bytes)
11856 @end table
11857
11858 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11859 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11860 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11861
11862 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11863 value's type in the current language.
11864 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11865 pattern as a mixture of types.
11866 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11867 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11868 which is typically four bytes.
11869
11870 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11871 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11872 @end table
11873
11874 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11875 (@code{"}).
11876 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11877 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11878
11879 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11880 number of matches found.
11881
11882 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11883 @samp{$_}.
11884 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11885
11886 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11887
11888 @smallexample
11889 void
11890 hello ()
11891 @{
11892 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11893 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11894 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11895 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11896 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11897 @}
11898 @end smallexample
11899
11900 @noindent
11901 you get during debugging:
11902
11903 @smallexample
11904 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11905 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11906 1 pattern found
11907 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11908 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11909 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11910 2 patterns found
11911 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11912 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11913 1 pattern found
11914 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11915 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11916 1 pattern found
11917 (gdb) print $numfound
11918 $1 = 1
11919 (gdb) print $_
11920 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11921 @end smallexample
11922
11923 @node Value Sizes
11924 @section Value Sizes
11925
11926 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11927 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11928 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11929 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11930 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11931
11932 @table @code
11933 @kindex set max-value-size
11934 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11935 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11936 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11937 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11938 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11939
11940 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11941 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11942
11943 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11944 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11945 currently 16 bytes.
11946
11947 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11948 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11949 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11950 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11951 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11952 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11953 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11954 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11955
11956 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11957
11958 @kindex show max-value-size
11959 @item show max-value-size
11960 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11961 allocate for the contents of a value.
11962 @end table
11963
11964 @node Optimized Code
11965 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11966 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11967 @cindex debugging optimized code
11968
11969 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11970 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11971 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11972 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11973 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11974 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11975 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11976
11977 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11978 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11979 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11980 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11981
11982 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11983 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11984 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11985 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11986 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11987 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11988
11989 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11990 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11991 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11992 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11993 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11994
11995 @menu
11996 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11997 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11998 @end menu
11999
12000 @node Inline Functions
12001 @section Inline Functions
12002 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12003
12004 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12005 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12006 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12007 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12008 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12009 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12010 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12011 @code{info frame} command.
12012
12013 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12014 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12015 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12016 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12017 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12018 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12019 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12020 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12021 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12022 local variables in the caller.
12023
12024 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12025 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12026 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12027 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12028 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12029 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12030 instructions are executed.
12031
12032 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12033 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12034 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12035 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12036
12037 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12038 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12039
12040 @itemize @bullet
12041 @item
12042 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12043 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12044 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12045 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12046 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12047 or inside the inlined function instead.
12048
12049 @item
12050 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12051 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12052 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12053 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12054
12055 @end itemize
12056
12057 @node Tail Call Frames
12058 @section Tail Call Frames
12059 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12060
12061 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12062 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12063 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12064 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12065 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12066
12067 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12068 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12069 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12070 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12071 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12072 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12073 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12074
12075 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12076 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12077 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12078 this information.
12079
12080 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12081 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12082
12083 @smallexample
12084 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12085 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12086 (gdb) info frame
12087 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12088 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12089 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12090 source language c++.
12091 Arglist at unknown address.
12092 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12093 @end smallexample
12094
12095 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12096 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12097 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12098 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12099 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12100 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12101
12102 @table @code
12103 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12104 @item set debug entry-values
12105 @kindex set debug entry-values
12106 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12107 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12108 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12109 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12110 result.
12111
12112 @item show debug entry-values
12113 @kindex show debug entry-values
12114 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12115 values at function entry and tail calls.
12116 @end table
12117
12118 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12119 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12120 reference by variable @code{x}):
12121
12122 @smallexample
12123 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12124 void (*x) (void) = c;
12125 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12126 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12127 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12128
12129 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12130 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12131 a () at t.c:3
12132 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12133 (gdb) bt
12134 #0 a () at t.c:3
12135 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12136 @end smallexample
12137
12138 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12139
12140 @smallexample
12141 int i;
12142 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12143 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12144 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12145 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12146 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12147 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12148 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12149 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12150
12151 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12152 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12153 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12154 (gdb) bt
12155 #0 f () at t.c:2
12156 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12157 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12158 @end smallexample
12159
12160 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12161 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12162
12163 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12164 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12165 @set ARROW @click{}
12166 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12167 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12168 @end ifset
12169 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12170 @set ARROW ->
12171 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12172 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12173 @end ifclear
12174
12175 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12176 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12177 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12178
12179 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12180 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12181 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12182 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12183 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12184 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12185
12186 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12187 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12188 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12189 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12190 omitted.
12191
12192 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12193 entry may fail:
12194
12195 @smallexample
12196 int v;
12197 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12198 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12199 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12200 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12201 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12202 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12203
12204 (gdb) bt
12205 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12206 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12207 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12208 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12209 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12210 @end smallexample
12211
12212 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12213 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12214 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12215 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12216 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12217
12218 @node Macros
12219 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12220
12221 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12222 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12223 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12224 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12225 where it was defined.
12226
12227 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12228 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12229 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12230 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12231
12232 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12233 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12234 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12235 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12236 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12237 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12238 see @ref{List}.
12239
12240 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12241 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12242 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12243
12244 @table @code
12245
12246 @kindex macro expand
12247 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12248 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12249 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12250 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12251 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12252 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12253 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12254 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12255 it can be any string of tokens.
12256
12257 @kindex macro exp1
12258 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12259 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12260 @cindex expand macro once
12261 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12262 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12263 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12264 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12265 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12266 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12267 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12268 can be any string of tokens.
12269
12270 @kindex info macro
12271 @cindex macro definition, showing
12272 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12273 @cindex macros, from debug info
12274 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12275 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12276 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12277 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12278 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12279 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12280
12281 @kindex info macros
12282 @item info macros @var{location}
12283 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12284 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12285 command-line where those definitions were established.
12286
12287 @kindex macro define
12288 @cindex user-defined macros
12289 @cindex defining macros interactively
12290 @cindex macros, user-defined
12291 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12292 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12293 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12294 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12295 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12296 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12297 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12298 @var{arglist}.
12299
12300 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12301 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12302 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12303 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12304 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12305
12306 @kindex macro undef
12307 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12308 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12309 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12310 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12311 in the program being debugged.
12312
12313 @kindex macro list
12314 @item macro list
12315 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12316 @end table
12317
12318 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12319 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12320 show our source files:
12321
12322 @smallexample
12323 $ cat sample.c
12324 #include <stdio.h>
12325 #include "sample.h"
12326
12327 #define M 42
12328 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12329
12330 main ()
12331 @{
12332 #define N 28
12333 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12334 #undef N
12335 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12336 #define N 1729
12337 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12338 @}
12339 $ cat sample.h
12340 #define Q <
12341 $
12342 @end smallexample
12343
12344 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12345 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12346 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12347 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12348 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12349 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12350 information.
12351
12352 @smallexample
12353 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12354 $
12355 @end smallexample
12356
12357 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12358
12359 @smallexample
12360 $ gdb -nw sample
12361 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12362 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12363 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12364 (@value{GDBP})
12365 @end smallexample
12366
12367 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12368 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12369 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12370
12371 @smallexample
12372 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12373 3
12374 4 #define M 42
12375 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12376 6
12377 7 main ()
12378 8 @{
12379 9 #define N 28
12380 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12381 11 #undef N
12382 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12383 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12384 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12385 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12386 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12387 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12388 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12389 #define Q <
12390 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12391 expands to: (42 + 1)
12392 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12393 expands to: once (M + 1)
12394 (@value{GDBP})
12395 @end smallexample
12396
12397 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12398 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12399 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12400 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12401
12402 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12403 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12404
12405 @smallexample
12406 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12407 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12408 (@value{GDBP}) run
12409 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12410
12411 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12412 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12413 (@value{GDBP})
12414 @end smallexample
12415
12416 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12417
12418 @smallexample
12419 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12420 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12421 #define N 28
12422 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12423 expands to: 28 < 42
12424 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12425 $1 = 1
12426 (@value{GDBP})
12427 @end smallexample
12428
12429 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12430 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12431 thereof) in force at each point:
12432
12433 @smallexample
12434 (@value{GDBP}) next
12435 Hello, world!
12436 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12437 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12438 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12439 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12440 (@value{GDBP}) next
12441 We're so creative.
12442 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12443 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12444 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12445 #define N 1729
12446 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12447 expands to: 1729 < 42
12448 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12449 $2 = 0
12450 (@value{GDBP})
12451 @end smallexample
12452
12453 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12454 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12455 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12456 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12457
12458 @smallexample
12459 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12460 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12461 -D__STDC__=1
12462 (@value{GDBP})
12463 @end smallexample
12464
12465
12466 @node Tracepoints
12467 @chapter Tracepoints
12468 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12469 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12470
12471 @cindex tracepoints
12472 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12473 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12474 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12475 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12476 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12477 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12478 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12479
12480 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12481 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12482 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12483 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12484 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12485 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12486 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12487 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12488 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12489 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12490 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12491
12492 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12493 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12494 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12495 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12496 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12497 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12498 Packets}.
12499
12500 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12501 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12502 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12503
12504 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12505
12506 @menu
12507 * Set Tracepoints::
12508 * Analyze Collected Data::
12509 * Tracepoint Variables::
12510 * Trace Files::
12511 @end menu
12512
12513 @node Set Tracepoints
12514 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12515
12516 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12517 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12518 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12519 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12520 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12521 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12522 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12523
12524 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12525 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12526 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12527 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12528 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12529 tracepoint was hit.
12530
12531 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12532 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12533 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12534 either.
12535
12536 @cindex fast tracepoints
12537 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12538 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12539 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12540
12541 @cindex static tracepoints
12542 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12543 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12544 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12545 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12546 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12547 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12548 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12549 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12550 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12551 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12552 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12553 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12554 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12555 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12556 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12557 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12558 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12559 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12560 static tracepoint marker.
12561
12562 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12563 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12564
12565 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12566 conditions and actions.
12567
12568 @menu
12569 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12570 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12571 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12572 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12573 * Trace State Variables::
12574 * Tracepoint Actions::
12575 * Listing Tracepoints::
12576 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12577 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12578 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12579 @end menu
12580
12581 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12582 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12583
12584 @table @code
12585 @cindex set tracepoint
12586 @kindex trace
12587 @item trace @var{location}
12588 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12589 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12590 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12591 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12592 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12593 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12594 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12595 in tracing}).
12596 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12597 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12598 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12599 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12600 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12601 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12602 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12603 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12604 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12605 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12606 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12607 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12608
12609 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12610
12611 @smallexample
12612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12613
12614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12615
12616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12617
12618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12619
12620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12621 @end smallexample
12622
12623 @noindent
12624 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12625
12626 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12627 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12628 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12629 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12630 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12631 information on tracepoint conditions.
12632
12633 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12634 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12635 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12636 @kindex ftrace
12637 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12638 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12639 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12640 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12641 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12642 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12643 message.
12644
12645 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12646 @code{trace}.
12647
12648 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12649 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12650 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12651 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12652 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12653 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12654 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12655 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12656
12657 @example
12658 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12659 @end example
12660
12661 @noindent
12662 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12663 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12664
12665 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12666 @cindex set static tracepoint
12667 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12668 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12669 @kindex strace
12670 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12671 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12672 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12673 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12674 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12675
12676 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12677 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12678 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12679 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12680 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12681 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12682 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12683 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12684 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12685 tracing engine:
12686
12687 @smallexample
12688 main ()
12689 @{
12690 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12691 @}
12692 @end smallexample
12693
12694 @noindent
12695 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12696 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12697
12698 @smallexample
12699 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12700 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12701 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12702 Data: "str %s"
12703 [etc...]
12704 @end smallexample
12705
12706 @noindent
12707 so you may probe the marker above with:
12708
12709 @smallexample
12710 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12711 @end smallexample
12712
12713 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12714 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12715 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12716 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12717 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12718 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12719 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12720 the @samp{Data:} field.
12721
12722 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12723 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12724 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12725
12726 @vindex $tpnum
12727 @cindex last tracepoint number
12728 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12729 @cindex tracepoint number
12730 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12731 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12732
12733 @kindex delete tracepoint
12734 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12735 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12736 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12737 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12738 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12739
12740 Examples:
12741
12742 @smallexample
12743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12744
12745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12746 @end smallexample
12747
12748 @noindent
12749 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12750 @end table
12751
12752 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12753 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12754
12755 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12756
12757 @table @code
12758 @kindex disable tracepoint
12759 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12760 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12761 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12762 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12763 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12764 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12765 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12766 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12767 next trace experiment.
12768
12769 @kindex enable tracepoint
12770 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12771 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12772 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12773 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12774 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12775 next time a trace experiment is run.
12776 @end table
12777
12778 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12779 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12780
12781 @table @code
12782 @kindex passcount
12783 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12784 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12785 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12786 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12787 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12788 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12789 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12790 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12791 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12792 user.
12793
12794 Examples:
12795
12796 @smallexample
12797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12798 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12799
12800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12801 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12803 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12804 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12805 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12806 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12807 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12808 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12809 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12810 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12811 @end smallexample
12812 @end table
12813
12814 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12815 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12816 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12817 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12818
12819 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12820 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12821 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12822 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12823 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12824 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12825 is true.
12826
12827 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12828 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12829 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12830 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12831 just as with breakpoints.
12832
12833 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12834 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12835 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12836 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12837 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12838 accesses, and so forth.
12839
12840 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12841 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12842 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12843 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12844 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12845 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12846 search through.
12847
12848 @smallexample
12849 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12850 @end smallexample
12851
12852 @node Trace State Variables
12853 @subsection Trace State Variables
12854 @cindex trace state variables
12855
12856 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12857 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12858 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12859 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12860 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12861 integers.
12862
12863 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12864 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12865 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12866 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12867
12868 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12869 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12870 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12871 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12872 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12873 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12874 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12875 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12876 variable with the same name.
12877
12878 @table @code
12879
12880 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12881 @kindex tvariable
12882 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12883 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12884 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12885 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12886 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12887 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12888 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12889 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12890 value. The default initial value is 0.
12891
12892 @item info tvariables
12893 @kindex info tvariables
12894 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12895 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12896 currently running.
12897
12898 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12899 @kindex delete tvariable
12900 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12901 are specified.
12902
12903 @end table
12904
12905 @node Tracepoint Actions
12906 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12907
12908 @table @code
12909 @kindex actions
12910 @cindex tracepoint actions
12911 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12912 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12913 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12914 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12915 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12916 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12917 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12918 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12919 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12920 @code{while-stepping}.
12921
12922 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12923 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12924 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12925
12926 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12927 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12928 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12929
12930 @smallexample
12931 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12932
12933 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12934
12935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12936 @end smallexample
12937
12938 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12939 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12940 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12941 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12942 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12943 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12944 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12945 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12946
12947 @smallexample
12948 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12950 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12951 > collect bar,baz
12952 > collect $regs
12953 > while-stepping 12
12954 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12955 > end
12956 end
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12960 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12961 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12962 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12963 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12964 special arguments are supported:
12965
12966 @table @code
12967 @item $regs
12968 Collect all registers.
12969
12970 @item $args
12971 Collect all function arguments.
12972
12973 @item $locals
12974 Collect all local variables.
12975
12976 @item $_ret
12977 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12978 of a backtrace.
12979
12980 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12981 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12982 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12983 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12984 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12985 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12986
12987 @item $_probe_argc
12988 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12989 tracepoint is located.
12990 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12991
12992 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12993 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12994 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12995 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12996
12997 @item $_sdata
12998 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12999 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13000 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13001 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13002 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13003 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13004 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13005 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13006 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13007
13008 @smallexample
13009 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13010 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13011 @end smallexample
13012
13013 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13014 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13015 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13016 @value{GDBN}.
13017 @end table
13018
13019 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13020 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13021 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13022
13023 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13024 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13025 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13026 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13027 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13028 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13029 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13030 @samp{mystr}.
13031
13032 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13033 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13034
13035 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13036 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13037 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13038 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13039 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13040 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13041 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13042 action were used.
13043
13044 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13045 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13046 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13047 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13048 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13049 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13050
13051 @smallexample
13052 > while-stepping 12
13053 > collect $regs, myglobal
13054 > end
13055 >
13056 @end smallexample
13057
13058 @noindent
13059 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13060 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13061 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13062 @code{stepping}.
13063
13064 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13065 @kindex set default-collect
13066 @cindex default collection action
13067 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13068 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13069 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13070 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13071 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13072 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13073
13074 @item show default-collect
13075 @kindex show default-collect
13076 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13077 tracepoint hit.
13078
13079 @end table
13080
13081 @node Listing Tracepoints
13082 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13083
13084 @table @code
13085 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13086 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13087 @cindex information about tracepoints
13088 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13089 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13090 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13091 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13092 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13093 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13094
13095 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13096 tracing:
13097
13098 @itemize @bullet
13099 @item
13100 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13101
13102 @item
13103 the state about installed on target of each location
13104 @end itemize
13105
13106 @smallexample
13107 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13108 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13109 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13110 while-stepping 20
13111 collect globfoo, $regs
13112 end
13113 collect globfoo2
13114 end
13115 pass count 1200
13116 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13117 collect $eip
13118 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13119 installed on target
13120 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13121 installed on target
13122 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13123 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13124 not installed on target
13125 (@value{GDBP})
13126 @end smallexample
13127
13128 @noindent
13129 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13130 @end table
13131
13132 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13133 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13134
13135 @table @code
13136 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13137 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13138 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13139 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13140 program.
13141
13142 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13143
13144 @table @emph
13145 @item Count
13146 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13147 stable identifier.
13148 @item ID
13149 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13150 @item Enabled or Disabled
13151 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13152 that are not enabled.
13153 @item Address
13154 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13155 @item What
13156 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13157 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13158 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13159 will be left blank.
13160 @end table
13161
13162 @noindent
13163 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13164
13165 @table @emph
13166 @item Data
13167 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13168 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13169 marker call.
13170 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13171 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13172 @end table
13173
13174 @smallexample
13175 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13176 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13177 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13178 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13179 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13180 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13181 Data: str %s
13182 (@value{GDBP})
13183 @end smallexample
13184 @end table
13185
13186 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13187 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13188
13189 @table @code
13190 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13191 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13192 @cindex collected data discarded
13193 @item tstart
13194 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13195 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13196 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13197 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13198 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13199 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13200 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13201 information, and so forth.
13202
13203 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13204 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13205 @item tstop
13206 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13207 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13208 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13209 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13210 needs to be stopped quickly.
13211
13212 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13213 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13214 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13215
13216 @kindex tstatus
13217 @cindex status of trace data collection
13218 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13219 @item tstatus
13220 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13221 collection.
13222 @end table
13223
13224 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13225
13226 @smallexample
13227 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13229 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13230 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13231 > while-stepping 11
13232 > collect $regs
13233 > end
13234 > end
13235 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13236 [time passes @dots{}]
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13238 @end smallexample
13239
13240 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13241 @cindex disconnected tracing
13242 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13243 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13244 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13245 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13246 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13247 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13248 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13249 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13250
13251 @table @code
13252 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13253 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13254 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13255 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13256 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13257 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13258 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13259 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13260
13261 @item show disconnected-tracing
13262 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13263 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13264
13265 @end table
13266
13267 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13268 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13269 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13270 it will continue after reconnection.
13271
13272 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13273 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13274 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13275 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13276 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13277 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13278 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13279 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13280 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13281 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13282
13283 @cindex circular trace buffer
13284 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13285 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13286 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13287 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13288 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13289 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13290 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13291 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13292 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13293 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13294 the next run.
13295
13296 @table @code
13297 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13298 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13299 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13300 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13301 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13302 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13303 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13304
13305 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13306 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13307 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13308 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13309 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13310 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13311
13312 @end table
13313
13314 @table @code
13315 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13316 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13317 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13318 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13319 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13320 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13321 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13322 likes. This is also the default.
13323
13324 @item show trace-buffer-size
13325 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13326 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13327 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13328 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13329 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13330 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13331 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13332 @end table
13333
13334 @table @code
13335 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13336 @kindex set trace-user
13337
13338 @item show trace-user
13339 @kindex show trace-user
13340
13341 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13342 @kindex set trace-notes
13343 Set the trace run's notes.
13344
13345 @item show trace-notes
13346 @kindex show trace-notes
13347 Show the trace run's notes.
13348
13349 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13350 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13351 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13352 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13353 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13354
13355 @item show trace-stop-notes
13356 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13357 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13358
13359 @end table
13360
13361 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13362 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13363
13364 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13365 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13366 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13367 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13368 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13369 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13370 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13371 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13372 mentioned here.
13373
13374 @itemize @bullet
13375
13376 @item
13377 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13378 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13379 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13380 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13381 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13382 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13383 cannot be collected either.
13384
13385 @item
13386 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13387 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13388 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13389 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13390 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13391 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13392 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13393 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13394 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13395 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13396
13397 @item
13398 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13399 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13400 in a misleading way.
13401
13402 @item
13403 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13404 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13405 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13406 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13407 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13408 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13409 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13410 by @code{ptr}.
13411
13412 @item
13413 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13414 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13415 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13416 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13417 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13418 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13419 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13420 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13421 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13422 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13423 invalid address.
13424
13425 @item
13426 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13427 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13428 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13429 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13430 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13431 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13432 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13433 it to zero.
13434
13435 @end itemize
13436
13437 @node Analyze Collected Data
13438 @section Using the Collected Data
13439
13440 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13441 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13442 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13443 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13444 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13445 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13446 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13447 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13448 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13449 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13450 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13451 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13452 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13453 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13454 the buffer will fail.
13455
13456 @menu
13457 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13458 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13459 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13460 @end menu
13461
13462 @node tfind
13463 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13464
13465 @kindex tfind
13466 @cindex select trace snapshot
13467 @cindex find trace snapshot
13468 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13469 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13470 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13471 snapshot is selected.
13472
13473 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13474
13475 @table @code
13476 @item tfind start
13477 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13478 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13479
13480 @item tfind none
13481 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13482
13483 @item tfind end
13484 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13485
13486 @item tfind
13487 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13488 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13489
13490 @item tfind -
13491 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13492 retracing earlier steps.
13493
13494 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13495 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13496 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13497 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13498 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13499
13500 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13501 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13502 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13503 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13504 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13505
13506 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13507 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13508 addresses (exclusive).
13509
13510 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13511 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13512 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13513
13514 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13515 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13516 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13517 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13518 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13519 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13520 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13521 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13522 @end table
13523
13524 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13525 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13526 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13527 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13528 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13529 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13530 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13531 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13532 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13533 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13534 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13535 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13536 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13537 tracepoint as the current one.
13538
13539 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13540 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13541 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13542 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13543 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13544
13545 @smallexample
13546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13547 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13548 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13549 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13550 > tfind
13551 > end
13552
13553 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13554 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13555 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13556 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13557 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13558 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13559 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13560 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13561 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13562 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13563 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13564 @end smallexample
13565
13566 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13567 the buffer:
13568
13569 @smallexample
13570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13571 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13572 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13573 > tfind line
13574 > end
13575
13576 Frame 0, X = 1
13577 Frame 7, X = 2
13578 Frame 13, X = 255
13579 @end smallexample
13580
13581 @node tdump
13582 @subsection @code{tdump}
13583 @kindex tdump
13584 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13585 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13586
13587 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13588 the current trace snapshot.
13589
13590 @smallexample
13591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13592 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13593 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13594 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13595 > end
13596
13597 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13598
13599 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13600 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13601 at gdb_test.c:444
13602 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13603
13604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13605 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13606 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13607 d1 0x18 24
13608 d2 0x80 128
13609 d3 0x33 51
13610 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13611 d5 0x22 34
13612 d6 0xe0 224
13613 d7 0x380035 3670069
13614 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13615 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13616 a2 0x100 256
13617 a3 0x322000 3284992
13618 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13619 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13620 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13621 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13622 ps 0x0 0
13623 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13624 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13625 fpstatus 0x0 0
13626 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13627 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13628 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13629 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13630 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13631 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13632 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13633 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13634 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13635
13636 (@value{GDBP})
13637 @end smallexample
13638
13639 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13640 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13641 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13642 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13643
13644 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13645 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13646 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13647 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13648 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13649 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13650 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13651 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13652 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13653 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13654
13655 @node save tracepoints
13656 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13657 @kindex save tracepoints
13658 @kindex save-tracepoints
13659 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13660
13661 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13662 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13663 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13664 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13665 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13666 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13667
13668 @node Tracepoint Variables
13669 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13670 @cindex tracepoint variables
13671 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13672
13673 @table @code
13674 @vindex $trace_frame
13675 @item (int) $trace_frame
13676 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13677 snapshot is selected.
13678
13679 @vindex $tracepoint
13680 @item (int) $tracepoint
13681 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13682
13683 @vindex $trace_line
13684 @item (int) $trace_line
13685 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13686
13687 @vindex $trace_file
13688 @item (char []) $trace_file
13689 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13690
13691 @vindex $trace_func
13692 @item (char []) $trace_func
13693 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13694 @end table
13695
13696 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13697 use @code{output} instead.
13698
13699 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13700 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13701 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13702 which are managed by the target.
13703
13704 @smallexample
13705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13706
13707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13708 > output $trace_file
13709 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13710 > tfind
13711 > end
13712 @end smallexample
13713
13714 @node Trace Files
13715 @section Using Trace Files
13716 @cindex trace files
13717
13718 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13719 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13720 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13721 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13722 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13723
13724 @table @code
13725
13726 @kindex tsave
13727 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13728 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13729 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13730 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13731 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13732 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13733 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13734 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13735 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13736 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13737 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13738 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13739 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13740 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13741 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13742
13743 @kindex target tfile
13744 @kindex tfile
13745 @kindex target ctf
13746 @kindex ctf
13747 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13748 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13749 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13750 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13751 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13752 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13753 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13754 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13755 the host.
13756
13757 @smallexample
13758 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13759 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13760 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13761 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13762 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13763 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13764 i = 0
13765 a = 0
13766 b = 1 '\001'
13767 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13768 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13769 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13770 $1 = 1
13771 @end smallexample
13772
13773 @end table
13774
13775 @node Overlays
13776 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13777 @cindex overlays
13778
13779 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13780 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13781 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13782 use overlays.
13783
13784 @menu
13785 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13786 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13787 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13788 mapped by asking the inferior.
13789 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13790 @end menu
13791
13792 @node How Overlays Work
13793 @section How Overlays Work
13794 @cindex mapped overlays
13795 @cindex unmapped overlays
13796 @cindex load address, overlay's
13797 @cindex mapped address
13798 @cindex overlay area
13799
13800 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13801 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13802 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13803 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13804 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13805
13806 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13807 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13808 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13809 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13810 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13811 largest overlay as well.
13812
13813 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13814 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13815 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13816 there.
13817
13818 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13819 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13820 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13821
13822 @smallexample
13823 @group
13824 Data Instruction Larger
13825 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13826 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13827 | | | | | |
13828 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13829 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13830 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13831 | and heap | | | | | |
13832 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13833 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13834 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13835 | | | | | |
13836 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13837 address | | | | | |
13838 | overlay | <-' | | |
13839 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13840 | | <---. | | load address
13841 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13842 | | | |
13843 +-----------+ | |
13844 +-----------+
13845 | |
13846 +-----------+
13847
13848 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13849 @end group
13850 @end smallexample
13851
13852 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13853 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13854 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13855 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13856 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13857 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13858 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13859 program and the overlay area.
13860
13861 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13862 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13863 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13864 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13865 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13866 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13867 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13868
13869 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13870 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13871 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13872
13873 @itemize @bullet
13874
13875 @item
13876 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13877 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13878 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13879 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13880
13881 @item
13882 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13883 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13884 your program's performance.
13885
13886 @item
13887 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13888 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13889 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13890 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13891 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13892 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13893 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13894
13895 @item
13896 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13897 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13898 instruction and data spaces.
13899
13900 @end itemize
13901
13902 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13903 improved in many ways:
13904
13905 @itemize @bullet
13906
13907 @item
13908 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13909 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13910 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13911 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13912 area in the usual way.
13913
13914 @item
13915 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13916 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13917
13918 @item
13919 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13920 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13921 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13922 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13923 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13924 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13925 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13926
13927 @end itemize
13928
13929
13930 @node Overlay Commands
13931 @section Overlay Commands
13932
13933 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13934 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13935 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13936 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13937 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13938 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13939
13940 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13941 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13942
13943 @table @code
13944 @item overlay off
13945 @kindex overlay
13946 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13947 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13948 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13949 overlay support is disabled.
13950
13951 @item overlay manual
13952 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13953 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13954 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13955 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13956 commands described below.
13957
13958 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13959 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13960 @cindex map an overlay
13961 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13962 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13963 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13964 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13965 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13966 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13967
13968 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13969 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13970 @cindex unmap an overlay
13971 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13972 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13973 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13974 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13975
13976 @item overlay auto
13977 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13978 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13979 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13980 Overlay Debugging}.
13981
13982 @item overlay load-target
13983 @itemx overlay load
13984 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13985 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13986 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13987 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13988 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13989 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13990
13991 @item overlay list-overlays
13992 @itemx overlay list
13993 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13994 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13995 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13996
13997 @end table
13998
13999 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14000 of the function the address falls in:
14001
14002 @smallexample
14003 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14004 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14005 @end smallexample
14006 @noindent
14007 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14008 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14009 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14010 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14011
14012 @smallexample
14013 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14014 No sections are mapped.
14015 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14016 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14017 @end smallexample
14018 @noindent
14019 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14020 name normally:
14021
14022 @smallexample
14023 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14024 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14025 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14026 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14027 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14028 @end smallexample
14029
14030 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14031 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14032 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14033 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14034 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14035
14036 @itemize @bullet
14037 @item
14038 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14039 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14040 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14041 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14042 @item
14043 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14044 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14045 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14046 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14047 breakpoints properly.
14048 @end itemize
14049
14050
14051 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14052 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14053 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14054
14055 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14056 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14057 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14058 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14059 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14060 current state of the overlays.
14061
14062 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14063 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14064
14065 @table @asis
14066
14067 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14068 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14069
14070 @smallexample
14071 struct
14072 @{
14073 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14074 unsigned long vma;
14075
14076 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14077 unsigned long size;
14078
14079 /* The overlay's load address. */
14080 unsigned long lma;
14081
14082 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14083 zero otherwise. */
14084 unsigned long mapped;
14085 @}
14086 @end smallexample
14087
14088 @item @code{_novlys}:
14089 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14090 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14091
14092 @end table
14093
14094 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14095 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14096 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14097 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14098 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14099 currently mapped.
14100
14101 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14102 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14103 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14104 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14105 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14106 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14107 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14108 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14109 are not being executed.
14110
14111 @node Overlay Sample Program
14112 @section Overlay Sample Program
14113 @cindex overlay example program
14114
14115 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14116 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14117 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14118 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14119 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14120 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14121 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14122
14123 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14124 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14125 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14126 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14127
14128 @table @file
14129 @item overlays.c
14130 The main program file.
14131 @item ovlymgr.c
14132 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14133 @item foo.c
14134 @itemx bar.c
14135 @itemx baz.c
14136 @itemx grbx.c
14137 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14138 @item d10v.ld
14139 @itemx m32r.ld
14140 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14141 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14142 @end table
14143
14144 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14145 cross-compiler like this:
14146
14147 @smallexample
14148 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14149 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14150 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14151 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14152 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14153 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14154 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14155 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14156 @end smallexample
14157
14158 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14159 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14160 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14161
14162
14163 @node Languages
14164 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14165 @cindex languages
14166
14167 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14168 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14169 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14170 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14171 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14172 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14173
14174 @cindex working language
14175 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14176 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14177 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14178 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14179 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14180 language}.
14181
14182 @menu
14183 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14184 * Show:: Displaying the language
14185 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14186 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14187 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14188 @end menu
14189
14190 @node Setting
14191 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14192
14193 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14194 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14195 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14196 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14197 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14198 are printed, etc.
14199
14200 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14201 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14202 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14203 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14204 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14205 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14206 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14207 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14208 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14209 Displaying the Language}.
14210
14211 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14212 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14213 another language. In that case, make the
14214 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14215 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14216 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14217
14218 @menu
14219 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14220 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14221 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14222 @end menu
14223
14224 @node Filenames
14225 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14226
14227 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14228 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14229
14230 @table @file
14231 @item .ada
14232 @itemx .ads
14233 @itemx .adb
14234 @itemx .a
14235 Ada source file.
14236
14237 @item .c
14238 C source file
14239
14240 @item .C
14241 @itemx .cc
14242 @itemx .cp
14243 @itemx .cpp
14244 @itemx .cxx
14245 @itemx .c++
14246 C@t{++} source file
14247
14248 @item .d
14249 D source file
14250
14251 @item .m
14252 Objective-C source file
14253
14254 @item .f
14255 @itemx .F
14256 Fortran source file
14257
14258 @item .mod
14259 Modula-2 source file
14260
14261 @item .s
14262 @itemx .S
14263 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14264 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14265 @end table
14266
14267 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14268 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14269
14270 @node Manually
14271 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14272
14273 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14274 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14275 your program.
14276
14277 @kindex set language
14278 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14279 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14280 a language, such as
14281 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14282 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14283
14284 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14285 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14286 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14287 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14288 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14289 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14290 command such as:
14291
14292 @smallexample
14293 print a = b + c
14294 @end smallexample
14295
14296 @noindent
14297 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14298 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14299 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14300 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14301
14302 @node Automatically
14303 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14304
14305 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14306 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14307 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14308 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14309 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14310 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14311 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14312 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14313 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14314
14315 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14316 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14317 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14318 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14319 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14320
14321 @node Show
14322 @section Displaying the Language
14323
14324 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14325 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14326
14327 @table @code
14328 @item show language
14329 @anchor{show language}
14330 @kindex show language
14331 Display the current working language. This is the
14332 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14333 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14334
14335 @item info frame
14336 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14337 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14338 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14339 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14340 information listed here.
14341
14342 @item info source
14343 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14344 Display the source language of this source file.
14345 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14346 information listed here.
14347 @end table
14348
14349 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14350 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14351 with a language explicitly:
14352
14353 @table @code
14354 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14355 @kindex set extension-language
14356 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14357 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14358
14359 @item info extensions
14360 @kindex info extensions
14361 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14362 @end table
14363
14364 @node Checks
14365 @section Type and Range Checking
14366
14367 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14368 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14369 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14370 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14371 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14372 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14373 errors when your program is running.
14374
14375 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14376 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14377 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14378 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14379
14380 @menu
14381 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14382 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14383 @end menu
14384
14385 @cindex type checking
14386 @cindex checks, type
14387 @node Type Checking
14388 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14389
14390 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14391 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14392 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14393 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14394
14395 @smallexample
14396 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14397
14398 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14399 $1 = 2
14400 @exdent but
14401 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14402 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14403 @end smallexample
14404
14405 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14406 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14407
14408 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14409 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14410 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14411 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14412 expressions like the second example above.
14413
14414 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14415 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14416 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14417 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14418 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14419 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14420
14421 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14422
14423 @kindex set check type
14424 @kindex show check type
14425 @table @code
14426 @item set check type on
14427 @itemx set check type off
14428 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14429 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14430 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14431
14432 @item show check type
14433 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14434 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14435 @end table
14436
14437 @cindex range checking
14438 @cindex checks, range
14439 @node Range Checking
14440 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14441
14442 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14443 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14444 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14445 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14446 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14447
14448 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14449 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14450 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14451 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14452
14453 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14454 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14455 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14456 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14457 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14458 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14459
14460 @smallexample
14461 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14462 @end smallexample
14463
14464 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14465 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14466 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14467
14468 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14469
14470 @kindex set check range
14471 @kindex show check range
14472 @table @code
14473 @item set check range auto
14474 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14475 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14476 each language.
14477
14478 @item set check range on
14479 @itemx set check range off
14480 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14481 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14482 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14483 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14484
14485 @item set check range warn
14486 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14487 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14488 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14489 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14490 systems).
14491
14492 @item show range
14493 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14494 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14495 @end table
14496
14497 @node Supported Languages
14498 @section Supported Languages
14499
14500 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14501 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14502 @c This is false ...
14503 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14504 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14505 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14506 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14507 language.
14508
14509 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14510 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14511 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14512 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14513 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14514 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14515 language reference or tutorial.
14516
14517 @menu
14518 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14519 * D:: D
14520 * Go:: Go
14521 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14522 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14523 * Fortran:: Fortran
14524 * Pascal:: Pascal
14525 * Rust:: Rust
14526 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14527 * Ada:: Ada
14528 @end menu
14529
14530 @node C
14531 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14532
14533 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14534 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14535
14536 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14537 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14538 together.
14539
14540 @cindex C@t{++}
14541 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14542 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14543 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14544 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14545 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14546 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14547 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14548
14549 @menu
14550 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14551 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14552 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14553 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14554 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14555 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14556 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14557 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14558 @end menu
14559
14560 @node C Operators
14561 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14562
14563 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14564
14565 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14566 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14567 often defined on groups of types.
14568
14569 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14570
14571 @itemize @bullet
14572
14573 @item
14574 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14575 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14576
14577 @item
14578 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14579 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14580
14581 @item
14582 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14583
14584 @item
14585 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14586
14587 @end itemize
14588
14589 @noindent
14590 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14591 in order of increasing precedence:
14592
14593 @table @code
14594 @item ,
14595 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14596 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14597 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14598
14599 @item =
14600 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14601 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14602
14603 @item @var{op}=
14604 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14605 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14606 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14607 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14608 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14609
14610 @item ?:
14611 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14612 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14613 should be of an integral type.
14614
14615 @item ||
14616 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14617
14618 @item &&
14619 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14620
14621 @item |
14622 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14623
14624 @item ^
14625 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14626
14627 @item &
14628 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14629
14630 @item ==@r{, }!=
14631 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14632 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14633
14634 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14635 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14636 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14637 and non-zero for true.
14638
14639 @item <<@r{, }>>
14640 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14641
14642 @item @@
14643 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14644
14645 @item +@r{, }-
14646 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14647 pointer types.
14648
14649 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14650 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14651 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14652 integral types.
14653
14654 @item ++@r{, }--
14655 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14656 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14657 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14658 operation takes place.
14659
14660 @item *
14661 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14662 @code{++}.
14663
14664 @item &
14665 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14666
14667 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14668 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14669 to examine the address
14670 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14671 stored.
14672
14673 @item -
14674 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14675 precedence as @code{++}.
14676
14677 @item !
14678 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14679 @code{++}.
14680
14681 @item ~
14682 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14683 @code{++}.
14684
14685
14686 @item .@r{, }->
14687 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14688 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14689 pointer based on the stored type information.
14690 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14691
14692 @item .*@r{, }->*
14693 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14694
14695 @item []
14696 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14697 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14698
14699 @item ()
14700 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14701
14702 @item ::
14703 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14704 and @code{class} types.
14705
14706 @item ::
14707 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14708 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14709 above.
14710 @end table
14711
14712 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14713 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14714 predefined meaning.
14715
14716 @node C Constants
14717 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14718
14719 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14720
14721 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14722 following ways:
14723
14724 @itemize @bullet
14725 @item
14726 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14727 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14728 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14729 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14730 @code{long} value.
14731
14732 @item
14733 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14734 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14735 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14736 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14737 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14738 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14739 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14740 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14741 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14742 constant.
14743
14744 @item
14745 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14746 integral equivalents.
14747
14748 @item
14749 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14750 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14751 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14752 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14753 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14754 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14755 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14756 @samp{\n} for newline.
14757
14758 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14759 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14760 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14761 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14762
14763 @item
14764 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14765 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14766 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14767 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14768 characters.
14769
14770 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14771 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14772 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14773
14774 @item
14775 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14776 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14777
14778 @item
14779 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14780 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14781 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14782 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14783 @end itemize
14784
14785 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14786 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14787
14788 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14789 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14790
14791 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14792 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14793 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14794 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14795 @quotation
14796 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14797 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14798 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14799 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14800 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14801 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14802 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14803 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14804 @end quotation
14805
14806 @enumerate
14807
14808 @cindex member functions
14809 @item
14810 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14811
14812 @smallexample
14813 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14814 @end smallexample
14815
14816 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14817 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14818 @item
14819 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14820 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14821 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14822 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14823 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14824
14825 @cindex call overloaded functions
14826 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14827 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14828 @item
14829 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14830 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14831 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14832 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14833 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14834 default arguments.
14835
14836 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14837 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14838 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14839 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14840 number of function arguments.
14841
14842 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14843 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14844 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14845
14846 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14847 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14848 @smallexample
14849 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14850 @end smallexample
14851
14852 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14853 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14854
14855 @cindex reference declarations
14856 @item
14857 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14858 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14859 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14860
14861 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14862 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14863 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14864 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14865 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14866
14867 @item
14868 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14869 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14870 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14871 necessary, for example in an expression like
14872 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14873 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14874 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14875
14876 @item
14877 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14878 specification.
14879 @end enumerate
14880
14881 @node C Defaults
14882 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14883
14884 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14885
14886 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14887 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14888 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14889 selects the working language.
14890
14891 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14892 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14893 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14894 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14895 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14896 for further details.
14897
14898 @node C Checks
14899 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14900
14901 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14902
14903 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14904 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14905 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14906 constants to pointers.
14907
14908 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14909 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14910 that is not itself an array.
14911
14912 @node Debugging C
14913 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14914
14915 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14916 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14917 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14918 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14919
14920 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14921 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14922 ,Expressions}.
14923
14924 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14925 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14926
14927 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14928
14929 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14930 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14931
14932 @table @code
14933 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14934 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14935 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14936 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14937 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14938 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14939
14940 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14941 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14942 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14943 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14944 classes.
14945 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14946
14947 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14948 @item catch throw
14949 @itemx catch rethrow
14950 @itemx catch catch
14951 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14952 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14953
14954 @cindex inheritance
14955 @item ptype @var{typename}
14956 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14957 @var{typename}.
14958 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14959
14960 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14961 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14962 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14963 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14964 multiple inheritance is in use.
14965
14966 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14967 @item demangle @var{name}
14968 Demangle @var{name}.
14969 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14970
14971 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14972 @item set print demangle
14973 @itemx show print demangle
14974 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14975 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14976 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14977 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14978 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14979
14980 @item set print object
14981 @itemx show print object
14982 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14983 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14984
14985 @item set print vtbl
14986 @itemx show print vtbl
14987 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14988 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14989 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14990 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14991
14992 @kindex set overload-resolution
14993 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14994 @item set overload-resolution on
14995 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14996 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14997 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14998 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14999 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15000 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15001
15002 @item set overload-resolution off
15003 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15004 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15005 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15006 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15007 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15008 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15009 argument types.
15010
15011 @kindex show overload-resolution
15012 @item show overload-resolution
15013 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15014
15015 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15016 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15017 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15018 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15019 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15020 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15021 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15022 @end table
15023
15024 @node Decimal Floating Point
15025 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15026 @cindex decimal floating point format
15027
15028 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15029 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15030 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15031 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15032
15033 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15034 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15035 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15036 configured target.
15037
15038 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15039 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15040 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15041
15042 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15043 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15044 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15045
15046 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15047 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15048 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15049
15050 @node D
15051 @subsection D
15052
15053 @cindex D
15054 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15055 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15056 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15057
15058 @node Go
15059 @subsection Go
15060
15061 @cindex Go (programming language)
15062 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15063 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15064
15065 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15066
15067 @table @code
15068 @cindex current Go package
15069 @item The current Go package
15070 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15071 specifying global variables and functions.
15072
15073 For example, given the program:
15074
15075 @example
15076 package main
15077 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15078 func main () @{
15079 // ...
15080 @}
15081 @end example
15082
15083 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15084
15085 @example
15086 (gdb) p myglob
15087 (gdb) p main.myglob
15088 @end example
15089
15090 @cindex builtin Go types
15091 @item Builtin Go types
15092 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15093 as a string.
15094
15095 @cindex builtin Go functions
15096 @item Builtin Go functions
15097 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15098 function and handles it internally.
15099
15100 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15101 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15102 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15103 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15104 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15105 @end table
15106
15107 @node Objective-C
15108 @subsection Objective-C
15109
15110 @cindex Objective-C
15111 This section provides information about some commands and command
15112 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15113 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15114 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15115
15116 @menu
15117 * Method Names in Commands::
15118 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15119 @end menu
15120
15121 @node Method Names in Commands
15122 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15123
15124 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15125 names as line specifications:
15126
15127 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15128 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15129 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15130 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15131 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15132 @itemize
15133 @item @code{clear}
15134 @item @code{break}
15135 @item @code{info line}
15136 @item @code{jump}
15137 @item @code{list}
15138 @end itemize
15139
15140 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15141
15142 @smallexample
15143 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15144 @end smallexample
15145
15146 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15147 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15148 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15149 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15150 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15151 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15152 debugged, enter:
15153
15154 @smallexample
15155 break -[Fruit create]
15156 @end smallexample
15157
15158 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15159 enter:
15160
15161 @smallexample
15162 list +[NSText initialize]
15163 @end smallexample
15164
15165 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15166 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15167 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15168 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15169
15170 @smallexample
15171 break create
15172 @end smallexample
15173
15174 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15175 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15176 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15177 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15178 none apply.
15179
15180 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15181 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15182
15183 @smallexample
15184 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15185 @end smallexample
15186
15187 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15188 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15189 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15190 @kindex print-object
15191 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15192
15193 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15194
15195 @smallexample
15196 print -[@var{object} hash]
15197 @end smallexample
15198
15199 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15200 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15201 @noindent
15202 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15203 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15204 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15205 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15206 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15207 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15208
15209 @node OpenCL C
15210 @subsection OpenCL C
15211
15212 @cindex OpenCL C
15213 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15214
15215 @menu
15216 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15217 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15218 * OpenCL C Operators::
15219 @end menu
15220
15221 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15222 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15223
15224 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15225 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15226 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15227 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15228 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15229
15230 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15231 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15232
15233 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15234 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15235 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15236 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15237
15238 @node OpenCL C Operators
15239 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15240
15241 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15242 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15243 vector data types.
15244
15245 @node Fortran
15246 @subsection Fortran
15247 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15248
15249 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15250 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15251
15252 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15253 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15254 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15255 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15256 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15257 underscore.
15258
15259 @menu
15260 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15261 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15262 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15263 @end menu
15264
15265 @node Fortran Operators
15266 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15267
15268 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15269
15270 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15271 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15272 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15273
15274 @table @code
15275 @item **
15276 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15277 of the second one.
15278
15279 @item :
15280 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15281 represent a section of array.
15282
15283 @item %
15284 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15285 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15286 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15287 union type.
15288 @end table
15289
15290 @node Fortran Defaults
15291 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15292
15293 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15294
15295 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15296 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15297 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15298 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15299
15300 @node Special Fortran Commands
15301 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15302
15303 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15304
15305 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15306 such as displaying common blocks.
15307
15308 @table @code
15309 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15310 @kindex info common
15311 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15312 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15313 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15314 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15315 printed.
15316 @end table
15317
15318 @node Pascal
15319 @subsection Pascal
15320
15321 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15322 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15323 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15324 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15325 syntax.
15326
15327 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15328 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15329 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15330
15331 @node Rust
15332 @subsection Rust
15333
15334 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15335 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15336 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15337 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15338
15339 @itemize @bullet
15340 @item
15341 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15342 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15343 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15344
15345 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15346 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15347 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15348 @samp{B}.
15349
15350 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15351 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15352
15353 @item
15354 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15355 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15356 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15357 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15358 @samp{K::x::y}.
15359
15360 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15361 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15362 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15363 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15364 scope.
15365
15366 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15367 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15368
15369 @item
15370 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15371 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15372
15373 @item
15374 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15375
15376 @item
15377 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15378 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15379 never be destroyed.
15380
15381 @item
15382 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15383 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15384 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15385
15386 @item
15387 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15388 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15389 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15390 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15391 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15392 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15393 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15394 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15395
15396 @item
15397 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15398 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15399 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15400 @itemize @bullet
15401
15402 @item
15403 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15404
15405 @item
15406 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15407
15408 @item
15409 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15410
15411 @item
15412 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15413 type names.
15414
15415 @item
15416 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15417
15418 @item
15419 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15420 available in the crate.
15421 @end itemize
15422 @end itemize
15423
15424 @node Modula-2
15425 @subsection Modula-2
15426
15427 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15428
15429 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15430 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15431 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15432 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15433 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15434 table.
15435
15436 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15437 @menu
15438 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15439 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15440 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15441 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15442 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15443 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15444 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15445 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15446 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15447 @end menu
15448
15449 @node M2 Operators
15450 @subsubsection Operators
15451 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15452
15453 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15454 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15455 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15456 following definitions hold:
15457
15458 @itemize @bullet
15459
15460 @item
15461 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15462 their subranges.
15463
15464 @item
15465 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15466
15467 @item
15468 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15469
15470 @item
15471 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15472 @var{type}}.
15473
15474 @item
15475 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15476
15477 @item
15478 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15479
15480 @item
15481 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15482 @end itemize
15483
15484 @noindent
15485 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15486 increasing precedence:
15487
15488 @table @code
15489 @item ,
15490 Function argument or array index separator.
15491
15492 @item :=
15493 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15494 @var{value}.
15495
15496 @item <@r{, }>
15497 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15498 types.
15499
15500 @item <=@r{, }>=
15501 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15502 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15503 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15504
15505 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15506 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15507 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15508 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15509 comment character.
15510
15511 @item IN
15512 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15513 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15514
15515 @item OR
15516 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15517
15518 @item AND@r{, }&
15519 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15520
15521 @item @@
15522 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15523
15524 @item +@r{, }-
15525 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15526 and difference on set types.
15527
15528 @item *
15529 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15530 on set types.
15531
15532 @item /
15533 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15534 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15535
15536 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15537 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15538 precedence as @code{*}.
15539
15540 @item -
15541 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15542
15543 @item ^
15544 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15545
15546 @item NOT
15547 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15548 @code{^}.
15549
15550 @item .
15551 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15552 precedence as @code{^}.
15553
15554 @item []
15555 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15556
15557 @item ()
15558 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15559 as @code{^}.
15560
15561 @item ::@r{, }.
15562 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15563 @end table
15564
15565 @quotation
15566 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15567 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15568 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15569 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15570 @end quotation
15571
15572
15573 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15574 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15575 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15576
15577 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15578 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15579
15580 @table @var
15581
15582 @item a
15583 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15584
15585 @item c
15586 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15587
15588 @item i
15589 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15590
15591 @item m
15592 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15593 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15594 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15595
15596 @item n
15597 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15598
15599 @item r
15600 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15601
15602 @item t
15603 represents a type.
15604
15605 @item v
15606 represents a variable.
15607
15608 @item x
15609 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15610 explanation of the function for details.
15611 @end table
15612
15613 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15614
15615 @table @code
15616 @item ABS(@var{n})
15617 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15618
15619 @item CAP(@var{c})
15620 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15621 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15622
15623 @item CHR(@var{i})
15624 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15625
15626 @item DEC(@var{v})
15627 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15628
15629 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15630 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15631 new value.
15632
15633 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15634 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15635 set.
15636
15637 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15638 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15639
15640 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15641 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15642
15643 @item INC(@var{v})
15644 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15645
15646 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15647 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15648 new value.
15649
15650 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15651 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15652 there. Returns the new set.
15653
15654 @item MAX(@var{t})
15655 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15656
15657 @item MIN(@var{t})
15658 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15659
15660 @item ODD(@var{i})
15661 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15662
15663 @item ORD(@var{x})
15664 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15665 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15666 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15667 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15668
15669 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15670 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15671 variable or a type.
15672
15673 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15674 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15675
15676 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15677 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15678 variable or a type.
15679
15680 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15681 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15682 @end table
15683
15684 @quotation
15685 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15686 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15687 an error.
15688 @end quotation
15689
15690 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15691 @node M2 Constants
15692 @subsubsection Constants
15693
15694 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15695 ways:
15696
15697 @itemize @bullet
15698
15699 @item
15700 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15701 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15702 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15703 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15704
15705 @item
15706 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15707 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15708 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15709 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15710 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15711 digits.
15712
15713 @item
15714 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15715 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15716 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15717 followed by a @samp{C}.
15718
15719 @item
15720 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15721 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15722 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15723 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15724 sequences.
15725
15726 @item
15727 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15728
15729 @item
15730 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15731 @code{FALSE}.
15732
15733 @item
15734 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15735
15736 @item
15737 Set constants are not yet supported.
15738 @end itemize
15739
15740 @node M2 Types
15741 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15742 @cindex Modula-2 types
15743
15744 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15745 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15746 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15747 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15748 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15749 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15750
15751 The first example contains the following section of code:
15752
15753 @smallexample
15754 VAR
15755 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15756 r: [20..40] ;
15757 @end smallexample
15758
15759 @noindent
15760 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15761 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15762
15763 @smallexample
15764 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15765 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15766 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15767 SET OF CHAR
15768 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15769 21
15770 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15771 [20..40]
15772 @end smallexample
15773
15774 @noindent
15775 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15776
15777 @smallexample
15778 VAR
15779 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15780 @end smallexample
15781
15782 @noindent
15783 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15784
15785 @smallexample
15786 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15787 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15788 @end smallexample
15789
15790 @noindent
15791 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15792 expressions using the debugger.
15793
15794 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15795 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15796
15797 @smallexample
15798 VAR
15799 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15800 @end smallexample
15801
15802 @smallexample
15803 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15804 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15805 @end smallexample
15806
15807 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15808 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15809 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15810 above.
15811
15812 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15813
15814 @smallexample
15815 TYPE
15816 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15817 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15818 VAR
15819 s: t ;
15820 BEGIN
15821 s := blue ;
15822 @end smallexample
15823
15824 @noindent
15825 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15826 and value of a variable.
15827
15828 @smallexample
15829 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15830 $1 = blue
15831 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15832 type = [blue..yellow]
15833 @end smallexample
15834
15835 @noindent
15836 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15837 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15838 their @code{C} counterparts.
15839
15840 @smallexample
15841 VAR
15842 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15843 BEGIN
15844 s[1] := 1 ;
15845 @end smallexample
15846
15847 @smallexample
15848 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15849 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15850 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15851 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15852 @end smallexample
15853
15854 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15855 pointer types as shown in this example:
15856
15857 @smallexample
15858 VAR
15859 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15860 BEGIN
15861 NEW(s) ;
15862 s^[1] := 1 ;
15863 @end smallexample
15864
15865 @noindent
15866 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15867
15868 @smallexample
15869 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15870 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15871 @end smallexample
15872
15873 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15874 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15875 types:
15876
15877 @smallexample
15878 TYPE
15879 foo = RECORD
15880 f1: CARDINAL ;
15881 f2: CHAR ;
15882 f3: myarray ;
15883 END ;
15884
15885 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15886 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15887 VAR
15888 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15889 @end smallexample
15890
15891 @noindent
15892 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15893 below.
15894
15895 @smallexample
15896 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15897 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15898 f1 : CARDINAL;
15899 f2 : CHAR;
15900 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15901 END
15902 @end smallexample
15903
15904 @node M2 Defaults
15905 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15906 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15907
15908 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15909 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15910 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15911 selected the working language.
15912
15913 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15914 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15915 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15916 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15917
15918 @node Deviations
15919 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15920 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15921
15922 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15923 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15924
15925 @itemize @bullet
15926 @item
15927 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15928 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15929 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15930 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15931 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15932 returned a pointer.)
15933
15934 @item
15935 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15936 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15937 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15938 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15939
15940 @item
15941 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15942 argument.
15943
15944 @item
15945 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15946 @end itemize
15947
15948 @node M2 Checks
15949 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15950 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15951
15952 @quotation
15953 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15954 range checking.
15955 @end quotation
15956 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15957
15958 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15959
15960 @itemize @bullet
15961 @item
15962 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15963 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15964
15965 @item
15966 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15967 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15968 @end itemize
15969
15970 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15971 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15972
15973 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15974 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15975
15976 @node M2 Scope
15977 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15978 @cindex scope
15979 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15980 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15981 @ifinfo
15982 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15983 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15984 @end ifinfo
15985 @ifnotinfo
15986 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15987 @end ifnotinfo
15988
15989 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15990 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15991 similar syntax:
15992
15993 @smallexample
15994
15995 @var{module} . @var{id}
15996 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15997 @end smallexample
15998
15999 @noindent
16000 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16001 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16002 identifier within your program, except another module.
16003
16004 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16005 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16006 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16007 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16008
16009 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16010 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16011 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16012 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16013 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16014 @var{module}.
16015
16016 @node GDB/M2
16017 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16018
16019 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16020 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16021 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16022 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16023 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16024 analogue in Modula-2.
16025
16026 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16027 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16028 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16029 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16030 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16031 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16032
16033 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16034 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16035 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16036
16037 @node Ada
16038 @subsection Ada
16039 @cindex Ada
16040
16041 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16042 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16043 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16044 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16045 to be difficult.
16046
16047
16048 @cindex expressions in Ada
16049 @menu
16050 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16051 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16052 in @value{GDBN}.
16053 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16054 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16055 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16056 subprograms.
16057 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16058 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16059 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16060 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16061 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16062 Profile
16063 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16064 @end menu
16065
16066 @node Ada Mode Intro
16067 @subsubsection Introduction
16068 @cindex Ada mode, general
16069
16070 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16071 syntax, with some extensions.
16072 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16073
16074 @itemize @bullet
16075 @item
16076 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16077 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16078 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16079 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16080
16081 @item
16082 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16083 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16084
16085 @item
16086 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16087 @end itemize
16088
16089 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16090 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16091 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16092 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16093 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16094
16095 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16096 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16097 was translated from an Ada source file.
16098
16099 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16100 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16101 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16102 middle (to allow based literals).
16103
16104 @node Omissions from Ada
16105 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16106 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16107
16108 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16109
16110 @itemize @bullet
16111 @item
16112 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16113
16114 @itemize @minus
16115 @item
16116 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16117 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16118
16119 @item
16120 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16121
16122 @item
16123 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16124
16125 @item
16126 @t{'Tag}.
16127
16128 @item
16129 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16130 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16131
16132 @item
16133 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16134 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16135
16136 @item
16137 @t{'Address}.
16138 @end itemize
16139
16140 @item
16141 The names in
16142 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16143 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16144 not currently available.
16145
16146 @item
16147 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16148 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16149 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16150 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16151 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16152 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16153 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16154 indeterminate values.
16155
16156 @item
16157 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16158 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16159 are not implemented.
16160
16161 @item
16162 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16163 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16164 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16165 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16166 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16167
16168 @smallexample
16169 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16170 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16171 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16172 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16173 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16174 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16175 @end smallexample
16176
16177 Changing a
16178 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16179 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16180 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16181 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16182 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16183 declared to have a type such as:
16184
16185 @smallexample
16186 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16187 Id : Integer;
16188 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16189 end record;
16190 @end smallexample
16191
16192 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16193 assignments:
16194
16195 @smallexample
16196 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16197 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16198 @end smallexample
16199
16200 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16201 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16202 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16203 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16204 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16205 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16206 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16207 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16208
16209 @item
16210 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16211
16212 @item
16213 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16214 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16215 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16216 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16217 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16218 the proper resolution.
16219
16220 @item
16221 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16222
16223 @item
16224 Entry calls are not implemented.
16225
16226 @item
16227 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16228 formats are not supported.
16229
16230 @item
16231 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16232
16233 @item
16234 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16235 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16236 context.
16237 Should your program
16238 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16239 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16240 @end itemize
16241
16242 @node Additions to Ada
16243 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16244 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16245
16246 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16247 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16248
16249 @itemize @bullet
16250 @item
16251 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16252 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16253 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16254 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16255 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16256 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16257 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16258 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16259
16260 @item
16261 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16262 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16263 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16264
16265 @item
16266 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16267 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16268
16269 @item
16270 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16271 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16272 @end itemize
16273
16274 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16275 additions specific to Ada:
16276
16277 @itemize @bullet
16278 @item
16279 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16280 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16281
16282 @smallexample
16283 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16284 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16285 @end smallexample
16286
16287 @item
16288 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16289 the value of its right-hand operand.
16290 This allows, for example,
16291 complex conditional breaks:
16292
16293 @smallexample
16294 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16295 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16296 @end smallexample
16297
16298 @item
16299 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16300 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16301 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16302 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16303 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16304 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16305 in strings. For example,
16306 @smallexample
16307 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16308 @end smallexample
16309 @noindent
16310 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16311 after each period.
16312
16313 @item
16314 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16315 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16316 to write
16317
16318 @smallexample
16319 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16320 @end smallexample
16321
16322 @item
16323 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16324 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16325 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16326 of 3 might print as
16327
16328 @smallexample
16329 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16330 @end smallexample
16331
16332 @noindent
16333 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16334 clause.
16335
16336 @item
16337 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16338 multi-character subsequence of
16339 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16340 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16341 in place of @t{a'length}.
16342
16343 @item
16344 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16345 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16346 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16347 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16348 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16349 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16350 For example,
16351 @smallexample
16352 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16353 @end smallexample
16354
16355 @item
16356 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16357 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16358 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16359 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16360 object.
16361
16362 @end itemize
16363
16364 @node Overloading support for Ada
16365 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16366 @cindex overloading, Ada
16367
16368 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16369 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16370 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16371 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16372 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16373 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16374
16375 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16376 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16377 use, for instance:
16378
16379 @smallexample
16380 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16381 Multiple matches for f
16382 [0] cancel
16383 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16384 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16385 >
16386 @end smallexample
16387
16388 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16389 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16390 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16391
16392 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16393 case:
16394
16395 @table @code
16396
16397 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16398 @item set ada print-signatures
16399 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16400 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16401 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16402
16403 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16404 @item show ada print-signatures
16405 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16406 overloads selection menu.
16407 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16408
16409 @end table
16410
16411 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16412 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16413
16414 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16415 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16416 before reaching the main procedure.
16417 As defined in the Ada Reference
16418 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16419 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16420 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16421 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16422
16423 @node Ada Exceptions
16424 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16425
16426 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16427
16428 @table @code
16429 @kindex info exceptions
16430 @item info exceptions
16431 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16432 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16433 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16434 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16435 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16436 @end table
16437
16438 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16439 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16440 argument.
16441
16442 @smallexample
16443 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16444 All defined Ada exceptions:
16445 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16446 program_error: 0x613d20
16447 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16448 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16449 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16450 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16451 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16452 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16453 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16454 @end smallexample
16455
16456 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16457 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16458
16459 @node Ada Tasks
16460 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16461 @cindex Ada, tasking
16462
16463 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16464 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16465
16466 @table @code
16467 @kindex info tasks
16468 @item info tasks
16469 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16470
16471
16472 @smallexample
16473 @iftex
16474 @leftskip=0.5cm
16475 @end iftex
16476 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16477 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16478 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16479 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16480 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16481 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16482
16483 @end smallexample
16484
16485 @noindent
16486 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16487 task currently being inspected.
16488
16489 @table @asis
16490 @item ID
16491 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16492
16493 @item TID
16494 The Ada task ID.
16495
16496 @item P-ID
16497 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16498
16499 @item Pri
16500 The base priority of the task.
16501
16502 @item State
16503 Current state of the task.
16504
16505 @table @code
16506 @item Unactivated
16507 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16508 executing.
16509
16510 @item Runnable
16511 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16512 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16513
16514 @item Terminated
16515 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16516 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16517 terminated themselves.
16518
16519 @item Child Activation Wait
16520 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16521
16522 @item Accept Statement
16523 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16524
16525 @item Waiting on entry call
16526 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16527
16528 @item Async Select Wait
16529 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16530 select statement.
16531
16532 @item Delay Sleep
16533 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16534 alternative open.
16535
16536 @item Child Termination Wait
16537 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16538 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16539 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16540
16541 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16542 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16543 finish terminating.
16544
16545 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16546 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16547 @end table
16548
16549 @item Name
16550 Name of the task in the program.
16551
16552 @end table
16553
16554 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16555 @item info task @var{taskno}
16556 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16557 the following example:
16558 @smallexample
16559 @iftex
16560 @leftskip=0.5cm
16561 @end iftex
16562 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16563 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16564 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16565 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16566 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16567 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16568 Name: task_1
16569 Thread: 0x807f378
16570 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16571 Base Priority: 15
16572 State: Runnable
16573 @end smallexample
16574
16575 @item task
16576 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16577 @cindex current Ada task ID
16578 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16579
16580 @smallexample
16581 @iftex
16582 @leftskip=0.5cm
16583 @end iftex
16584 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16585 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16586 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16587 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16588 (@value{GDBP}) task
16589 [Current task is 2]
16590 @end smallexample
16591
16592 @item task @var{taskno}
16593 @cindex Ada task switching
16594 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16595 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16596 from the current task to the given task.
16597
16598 @smallexample
16599 @iftex
16600 @leftskip=0.5cm
16601 @end iftex
16602 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16603 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16604 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16605 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16606 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16607 [Switching to task 1]
16608 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16609 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16610 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16611 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16612 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16613 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16614 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16615 @end smallexample
16616
16617 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16618 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16619 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16620 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16621 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16622 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16623 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16624 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16625 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16626
16627 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16628 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16629 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16630 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16631 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16632
16633 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16634 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16635 program.
16636
16637 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16638 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16639 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16640
16641 For example,
16642
16643 @smallexample
16644 @iftex
16645 @leftskip=0.5cm
16646 @end iftex
16647 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16648 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16649 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16650 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16651 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16652 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16653 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16654 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16655 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16656 Continuing.
16657 task # 1 running
16658 task # 2 running
16659
16660 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16661 15 flush;
16662 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16663 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16664 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16665 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16666 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16667 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16668 @end smallexample
16669 @end table
16670
16671 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16672 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16673 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16674
16675 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16676 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16677 the platform being used.
16678 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16679 switching is not supported.
16680
16681 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16682 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16683 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16684 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16685 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16686 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16687
16688 @node Ravenscar Profile
16689 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16690 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16691
16692 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16693 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16694 requirements.
16695
16696 @table @code
16697 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16698 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16699 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16700 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16701 Profile. This is the default.
16702
16703 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16704 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16705 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16706 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16707 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16708 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16709 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16710
16711 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16712 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16713 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16714 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16715
16716 @end table
16717
16718 @node Ada Glitches
16719 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16720 @cindex Ada, problems
16721
16722 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16723 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16724 @value{GDBN},
16725 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16726 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16727
16728 @itemize @bullet
16729 @item
16730 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16731 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16732
16733 @item
16734 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16735 argument lists are treated as positional).
16736
16737 @item
16738 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16739
16740 @item
16741 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16742 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16743 the host machine.
16744
16745 @item
16746 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16747 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16748 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16749 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16750 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16751 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16752 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16753 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16754 you can usually resolve the confusion
16755 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16756 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16757 @end itemize
16758
16759 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16760 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16761 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16762 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16763 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16764 enabled.
16765
16766 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16767 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16768 @table @code
16769
16770 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16771 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16772 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16773 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16774 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16775 This is the default.
16776
16777 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16778 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16779 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16780 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16781 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16782 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16783 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16784
16785 @end table
16786
16787 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16788 @cindex GNAT encoding
16789 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16790 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16791 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16792 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16793 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16794 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16795
16796 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16797 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16798 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16799 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16800 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16801 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16802 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16803 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16804
16805 @table @code
16806
16807 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16808 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16809 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16810 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16811
16812 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16813 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16814 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16815
16816 @end table
16817
16818 @node Unsupported Languages
16819 @section Unsupported Languages
16820
16821 @cindex unsupported languages
16822 @cindex minimal language
16823 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16824 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16825 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16826 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16827 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16828 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16829
16830 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16831 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16832 language.
16833
16834 @node Symbols
16835 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16836
16837 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16838 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16839 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16840 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16841 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16842 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16843 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16844
16845 @cindex symbol names
16846 @cindex names of symbols
16847 @cindex quoting names
16848 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16849 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16850 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16851 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16852 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16853 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16854 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16855 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16856
16857 @smallexample
16858 p 'foo.c'::x
16859 @end smallexample
16860
16861 @noindent
16862 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16863
16864 @table @code
16865 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16866 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16867 @kindex set case-sensitive
16868 @item set case-sensitive on
16869 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16870 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16871 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16872 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16873 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16874 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16875 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16876 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16877 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16878 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16879 case-insensitive matches.
16880
16881 @kindex show case-sensitive
16882 @item show case-sensitive
16883 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16884 lookups.
16885
16886 @kindex set print type methods
16887 @item set print type methods
16888 @itemx set print type methods on
16889 @itemx set print type methods off
16890 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16891 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16892 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16893 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16894 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16895 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16896
16897 @kindex show print type methods
16898 @item show print type methods
16899 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16900 classes.
16901
16902 @kindex set print type typedefs
16903 @item set print type typedefs
16904 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16905 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16906
16907 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16908 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16909 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16910 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16911 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16912 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16913 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16914 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16915 types.
16916
16917 @kindex show print type typedefs
16918 @item show print type typedefs
16919 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16920 printing classes.
16921
16922 @kindex info address
16923 @cindex address of a symbol
16924 @item info address @var{symbol}
16925 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16926 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16927 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16928 is always stored.
16929
16930 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16931 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16932 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16933
16934 @kindex info symbol
16935 @cindex symbol from address
16936 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16937 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16938 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16939 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16940 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16941
16942 @smallexample
16943 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16944 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16945 @end smallexample
16946
16947 @noindent
16948 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16949 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16950
16951 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16952 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16953
16954 @smallexample
16955 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16956 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16957 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16958 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16959 @end smallexample
16960
16961 @kindex demangle
16962 @cindex demangle
16963 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16964 Demangle @var{name}.
16965 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16966 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16967
16968 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16969 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16970
16971 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16972 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16973
16974 @kindex whatis
16975 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16976 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16977 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16978 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16979
16980 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16981 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16982 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16983
16984 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16985 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16986 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16987 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16988 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16989 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16990 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16991 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16992 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16993
16994 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16995 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16996 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16997 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16998 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16999 unroll it.
17000
17001 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17002 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17003 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17004
17005 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17006 Available flags are:
17007
17008 @table @code
17009 @item r
17010 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17011 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17012 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17013
17014 @item m
17015 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17016
17017 @item M
17018 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17019 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17020
17021 @item t
17022 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17023 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17024 names are substituted when printing other types.
17025
17026 @item T
17027 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17028 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17029 @end table
17030
17031 @kindex ptype
17032 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17033 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17034 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17035 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17036
17037 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17038 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17039 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17040 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17041 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17042 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17043 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17044 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17045
17046 For example, for this variable declaration:
17047
17048 @smallexample
17049 typedef double real_t;
17050 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17051 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17052 complex_t var;
17053 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17054 @end smallexample
17055
17056 @noindent
17057 the two commands give this output:
17058
17059 @smallexample
17060 @group
17061 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17062 type = complex_t
17063 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17064 type = struct complex @{
17065 real_t real;
17066 double imag;
17067 @}
17068 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17069 type = struct complex
17070 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17071 type = struct complex
17072 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17073 type = struct complex @{
17074 real_t real;
17075 double imag;
17076 @}
17077 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17078 type = real_t *
17079 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17080 type = double *
17081 @end group
17082 @end smallexample
17083
17084 @noindent
17085 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17086 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17087
17088 @cindex incomplete type
17089 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17090 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17091 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17092 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17093 given these declarations:
17094
17095 @smallexample
17096 struct foo;
17097 struct foo *fooptr;
17098 @end smallexample
17099
17100 @noindent
17101 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17102
17103 @smallexample
17104 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17105 $1 = <incomplete type>
17106 @end smallexample
17107
17108 @noindent
17109 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17110 completely specified.
17111
17112 @cindex unknown type
17113 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17114 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17115 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17116 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17117 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17118 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17119 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17120 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17121
17122 @smallexample
17123 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17124 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17125 @end smallexample
17126
17127 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17128 of such variables.
17129
17130 @kindex info types
17131 @item info types @var{regexp}
17132 @itemx info types
17133 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17134 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17135 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17136 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17137 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17138 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17139 name is @code{value}.
17140
17141 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17142 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17143 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17144
17145 @kindex info type-printers
17146 @item info type-printers
17147 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17148 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17149 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17150 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17151 type printers.
17152
17153 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17154
17155 @kindex enable type-printer
17156 @kindex disable type-printer
17157 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17158 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17159 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17160
17161 @kindex info scope
17162 @cindex local variables
17163 @item info scope @var{location}
17164 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17165 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17166 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17167 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17168 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17169
17170 @smallexample
17171 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17172 Scope for command_line_handler:
17173 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17174 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17175 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17176 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17177 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17178 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17179 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17180 @end smallexample
17181
17182 @noindent
17183 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17184 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17185 collect}.
17186
17187 @kindex info source
17188 @item info source
17189 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17190 the function containing the current point of execution:
17191 @itemize @bullet
17192 @item
17193 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17194 @item
17195 the directory it was compiled in,
17196 @item
17197 its length, in lines,
17198 @item
17199 which programming language it is written in,
17200 @item
17201 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17202 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17203 @item
17204 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17205 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17206 @item
17207 whether the debugging information includes information about
17208 preprocessor macros.
17209 @end itemize
17210
17211
17212 @kindex info sources
17213 @item info sources
17214 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17215 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17216 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17217
17218 @kindex info functions
17219 @item info functions
17220 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17221
17222 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17223 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17224 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17225 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17226 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17227 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17228 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17229 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17230
17231 @kindex info variables
17232 @item info variables
17233 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17234 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17235
17236 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17237 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17238 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17239 @var{regexp}.
17240
17241 @kindex info classes
17242 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17243 @item info classes
17244 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17245 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17246 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17247 expression.
17248
17249 @kindex info selectors
17250 @item info selectors
17251 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17252 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17253 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17254 expression.
17255
17256 @ignore
17257 This was never implemented.
17258 @kindex info methods
17259 @item info methods
17260 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17261 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17262 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17263 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17264 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17265 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17266 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17267 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17268 @end ignore
17269
17270 @cindex opaque data types
17271 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17272 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17273 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17274 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17275 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17276 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17277 another source file. The default is on.
17278
17279 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17280 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17281
17282 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17283 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17284 is printed as follows:
17285 @smallexample
17286 @{<no data fields>@}
17287 @end smallexample
17288
17289 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17290 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17291 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17292
17293 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17294 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17295 @item set print symbol-loading
17296 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17297 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17298 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17299 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17300 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17301 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17302 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17303 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17304 can be annoying.
17305 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17306 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17307 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17308 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17309
17310 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17311 @item show print symbol-loading
17312 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17313 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17314
17315 @kindex maint print symbols
17316 @cindex symbol dump
17317 @kindex maint print psymbols
17318 @cindex partial symbol dump
17319 @kindex maint print msymbols
17320 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17321 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17322 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17323 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17324 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17325 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17326 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17327 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17328 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17329 that objfile.
17330 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17331 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17332 @code{main}.
17333 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17334 source file.
17335
17336 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17337 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17338 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17339 tables.
17340 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17341 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17342 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17343 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17344 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17345 ``ELF symbols''.
17346
17347 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17348 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17349
17350 @kindex maint info symtabs
17351 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17352 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17353 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17354 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17355 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17356 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17357 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17358
17359 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17360 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17361 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17362 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17363 structure in more detail. For example:
17364
17365 @smallexample
17366 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17367 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17368 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17369 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17370 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17371 readin no
17372 fullname (null)
17373 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17374 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17375 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17376 dependencies (none)
17377 @}
17378 @}
17379 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17380 (@value{GDBP})
17381 @end smallexample
17382 @noindent
17383 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17384 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17385 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17386 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17387 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17388
17389 @smallexample
17390 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17391 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17392 line 1574.
17393 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17394 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17395 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17396 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17397 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17398 dirname (null)
17399 fullname (null)
17400 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17401 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17402 debugformat DWARF 2
17403 @}
17404 @}
17405 (@value{GDBP})
17406 @end smallexample
17407
17408 @kindex maint info line-table
17409 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17410 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17411 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17412
17413 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17414 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17415 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17416
17417 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17418 @cindex symbol cache size
17419 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17420 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17421 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17422 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17423 with different sizes.
17424
17425 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17426 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17427 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17428
17429 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17430 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17431 @item maint print symbol-cache
17432 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17433 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17434
17435 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17436 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17437 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17438 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17439 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17440
17441 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17442 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17443 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17444 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17445 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17446 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17447
17448 @end table
17449
17450 @node Altering
17451 @chapter Altering Execution
17452
17453 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17454 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17455 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17456 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17457 program.
17458
17459 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17460 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17461 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17462
17463 @menu
17464 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17465 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17466 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17467 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17468 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17469 * Patching:: Patching your program
17470 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17471 @end menu
17472
17473 @node Assignment
17474 @section Assignment to Variables
17475
17476 @cindex assignment
17477 @cindex setting variables
17478 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17479 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17480
17481 @smallexample
17482 print x=4
17483 @end smallexample
17484
17485 @noindent
17486 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17487 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17488 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17489 information on operators in supported languages.
17490
17491 @kindex set variable
17492 @cindex variables, setting
17493 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17494 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17495 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17496 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17497 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17498
17499 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17500 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17501 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17502 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17503 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17504 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17505 command @code{set width}:
17506
17507 @smallexample
17508 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17509 type = double
17510 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17511 $4 = 13
17512 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17513 Invalid syntax in expression.
17514 @end smallexample
17515
17516 @noindent
17517 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17518 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17519
17520 @smallexample
17521 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17522 @end smallexample
17523
17524 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17525 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17526 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17527 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17528 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17529 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17530
17531 @smallexample
17532 @group
17533 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17534 type = double
17535 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17536 $1 = 1
17537 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17538 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17539 $2 = 1
17540 (@value{GDBP}) r
17541 The program being debugged has been started already.
17542 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17543 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17544 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17545 Invalid bfd target.
17546 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17547 The current BFD target is "=4".
17548 @end group
17549 @end smallexample
17550
17551 @noindent
17552 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17553 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17554 @code{g}, use
17555
17556 @smallexample
17557 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17558 @end smallexample
17559
17560 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17561 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17562 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17563 same length or shorter.
17564 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17565 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17566
17567 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17568 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17569 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17570 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17571 and representation in memory), and
17572
17573 @smallexample
17574 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17575 @end smallexample
17576
17577 @noindent
17578 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17579
17580 @node Jumping
17581 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17582
17583 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17584 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17585 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17586
17587 @table @code
17588 @kindex jump
17589 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17590 @item jump @var{location}
17591 @itemx j @var{location}
17592 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17593 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17594 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17595 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17596 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17597
17598 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17599 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17600 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17601 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17602 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17603 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17604 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17605 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17606 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17607 @end table
17608
17609 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17610 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17611 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17612 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17613 example,
17614
17615 @smallexample
17616 set $pc = 0x485
17617 @end smallexample
17618
17619 @noindent
17620 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17621 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17622 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17623
17624 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17625 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17626 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17627 detail.
17628
17629 @c @group
17630 @node Signaling
17631 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17632 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17633
17634 @table @code
17635 @kindex signal
17636 @item signal @var{signal}
17637 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17638 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17639 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17640 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17641
17642 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17643 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17644 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17645 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17646 signal.
17647
17648 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17649 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17650 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17651 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17652 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17653 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17654 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17655 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17656
17657 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17658 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17659 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17660 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17661 passes the signal directly to your program.
17662
17663 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17664 after executing the command.
17665
17666 @kindex queue-signal
17667 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17668 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17669 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17670 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17671 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17672 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17673 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17674 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17675 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17676
17677 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17678 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17679 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17680 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17681 @code{continue} command.
17682
17683 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17684 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17685 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17686 (@pxref{Signals}).
17687 @end table
17688 @c @end group
17689
17690 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17691 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17692
17693 @node Returning
17694 @section Returning from a Function
17695
17696 @table @code
17697 @cindex returning from a function
17698 @kindex return
17699 @item return
17700 @itemx return @var{expression}
17701 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17702 command. If you give an
17703 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17704 value.
17705 @end table
17706
17707 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17708 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17709 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17710 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17711
17712 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17713 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17714 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17715 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17716 of functions.
17717
17718 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17719 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17720 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17721 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17722 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17723
17724 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17725 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17726 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17727 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17728 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17729 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17730 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17731 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17732 assignment into the right register(s).
17733
17734 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17735 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17736 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17737 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17738 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17739 into a @code{long long int}:
17740
17741 @smallexample
17742 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17743 29 return 31;
17744 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17745 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17746 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17747 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17748 (@value{GDBP})
17749 @end smallexample
17750
17751 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17752 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17753 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17754 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17755 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17756 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17757 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17758 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17759
17760 @smallexample
17761 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17762 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17763 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17764 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17765 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17766 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17767 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17768 (@value{GDBP})
17769 @end smallexample
17770
17771 @node Calling
17772 @section Calling Program Functions
17773
17774 @table @code
17775 @cindex calling functions
17776 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17777 @item print @var{expr}
17778 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17779 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17780 debugged.
17781
17782 @kindex call
17783 @item call @var{expr}
17784 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17785 returned values.
17786
17787 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17788 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17789 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17790 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17791 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17792 value history.
17793 @end table
17794
17795 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17796 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17797 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17798 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17799
17800 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17801 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17802 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17803 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17804 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17805 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17806 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17807 in that case is controlled by the
17808 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17809
17810 @table @code
17811 @item set unwindonsignal
17812 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17813 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17814 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17815 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17816 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17817 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17818 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17819 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17820 received.
17821
17822 @item show unwindonsignal
17823 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17824 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17825 @value{GDBN}.
17826
17827 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17828 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17829 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17830 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17831 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17832 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17833 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17834 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17835 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17836 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17837
17838 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17839 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17840 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17841 @value{GDBN}.
17842
17843 @end table
17844
17845 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
17846
17847 @cindex no debug info functions
17848 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
17849 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
17850 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
17851 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
17852 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
17853 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
17854
17855 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
17856 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
17857 declared return type. For example:
17858
17859 @smallexample
17860 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
17861 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
17862 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
17863 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
17864 @end smallexample
17865
17866 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
17867 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
17868 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
17869 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
17870
17871 @smallexample
17872 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
17873 @end smallexample
17874
17875 @noindent
17876 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
17877
17878 @smallexample
17879 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
17880 @end smallexample
17881
17882 @noindent
17883 these calls are equivalent:
17884
17885 @smallexample
17886 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
17887 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17888 @end smallexample
17889
17890 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
17891 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
17892 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
17893 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
17894 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
17895 float parameters, and no debug info:
17896
17897 @smallexample
17898 float
17899 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
17900 float v1, v2;
17901 @{
17902 return v1 * v2;
17903 @}
17904 @end smallexample
17905
17906 @noindent
17907 you call it like this:
17908
17909 @smallexample
17910 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17911 @end smallexample
17912
17913 @node Patching
17914 @section Patching Programs
17915
17916 @cindex patching binaries
17917 @cindex writing into executables
17918 @cindex writing into corefiles
17919
17920 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17921 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17922 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17923 patching your program's binary.
17924
17925 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17926 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17927 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17928 repairs.
17929
17930 @table @code
17931 @kindex set write
17932 @item set write on
17933 @itemx set write off
17934 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17935 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17936 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17937
17938 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17939 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17940 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17941
17942 @item show write
17943 @kindex show write
17944 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17945 as well as reading.
17946 @end table
17947
17948 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17949 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17950 @cindex injecting code
17951 @cindex writing into executables
17952 @cindex compiling code
17953
17954 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17955 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17956 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17957 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17958
17959 @table @code
17960 @kindex compile code
17961 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17962 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17963 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17964 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17965 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17966 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17967 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17968 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17969 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17970 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17971 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17972 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17973
17974 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17975 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17976 E.g.:
17977
17978 @smallexample
17979 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17980 @end smallexample
17981
17982 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17983 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17984 from actual source code. E.g.:
17985
17986 @smallexample
17987 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17988 @end smallexample
17989
17990 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17991 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17992 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17993 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17994 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17995 editor.
17996
17997 @smallexample
17998 compile code
17999 >printf ("hello\n");
18000 >printf ("world\n");
18001 >end
18002 @end smallexample
18003
18004 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18005 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18006 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18007 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18008 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18009 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18010 inferior symbols otherwise.
18011
18012 @kindex compile file
18013 @item compile file @var{filename}
18014 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18015 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18016
18017 @smallexample
18018 compile file /home/user/example.c
18019 @end smallexample
18020 @end table
18021
18022 @table @code
18023 @item compile print @var{expr}
18024 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18025 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18026 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18027 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18028 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18029 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18030 Formats}.
18031
18032 @item compile print
18033 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18034 @cindex reprint the last value
18035 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18036 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18037 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18038 multiple-line editor.
18039 @end table
18040
18041 @noindent
18042 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18043
18044 @table @code
18045 @anchor{set debug compile}
18046 @item set debug compile
18047 @cindex compile command debugging info
18048 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18049 injecting the code. The default is off.
18050
18051 @item show debug compile
18052 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18053 compiling and injecting the code.
18054 @end table
18055
18056 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18057
18058 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18059 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18060 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18061 injecting process.
18062
18063 @noindent
18064 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18065
18066 @table @asis
18067 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18068 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18069 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18070 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18071
18072 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18073 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18074 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18075 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18076 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18077 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18078 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18079 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18080
18081 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18082 @end table
18083
18084 @noindent
18085 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18086
18087 @table @code
18088 @item set compile-args
18089 @cindex compile command options override
18090 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18091 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18092 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18093 compilation.
18094
18095 @item show compile-args
18096 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18097 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18098 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18099 @end table
18100
18101 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18102
18103 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18104 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18105 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18106
18107 @table @asis
18108 @item C code examples and caveats
18109 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18110 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18111 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18112 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18113 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18114
18115 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18116 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18117 much like any other normal debugging session.
18118
18119 @smallexample
18120 void function1 (void)
18121 @{
18122 int i = 42;
18123 printf ("function 1\n");
18124 @}
18125
18126 void function2 (void)
18127 @{
18128 int j = 12;
18129 function1 ();
18130 @}
18131
18132 int main(void)
18133 @{
18134 int k = 6;
18135 int *p;
18136 function2 ();
18137 return 0;
18138 @}
18139 @end smallexample
18140
18141 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18142 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18143 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18144
18145 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18146 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18147 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18148 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18149 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18150
18151 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18152 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18153 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18154 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18155 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18156 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18157 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18158 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18159 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18160 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18161
18162 @smallexample
18163 compile code k = 3;
18164 @end smallexample
18165
18166 @noindent
18167 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18168 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18169 @code{compile} command changes it.
18170
18171 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18172 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18173 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18174 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18175 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18176
18177 @smallexample
18178 compile code j = 3;
18179 @end smallexample
18180
18181 @noindent
18182 will result in a compilation error message.
18183
18184 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18185 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18186 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18187
18188 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18189 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18190 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18191 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18192
18193 @smallexample
18194 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18195 @end smallexample
18196
18197 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18198 command has completed:
18199
18200 @smallexample
18201 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18202 @end smallexample
18203
18204 @noindent
18205 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18206 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18207 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18208 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18209 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18210
18211 @smallexample
18212 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18213 @end smallexample
18214
18215 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18216 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18217 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18218 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18219 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18220 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18221 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18222 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18223
18224 @smallexample
18225 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18226 @end smallexample
18227
18228 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18229 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18230 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18231 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18232 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18233 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18234 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18235
18236 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18237 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18238 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18239 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18240 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18241 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18242
18243 @smallexample
18244 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18245 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18246 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18247 Compilation failed.
18248 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18249 42
18250 @end smallexample
18251
18252 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18253 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18254 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18255 will print to the console.
18256 @end table
18257
18258 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18259
18260 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18261 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18262 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18263 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18264 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18265 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18266 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18267 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18268
18269
18270 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18271 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18272 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18273 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18274 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18275 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18276 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18277
18278 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18279 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18280 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18281 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18282 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18283 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18284 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18285
18286 @table @code
18287 @item set compile-gcc
18288 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18289 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18290 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18291 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18292 default.
18293
18294 @item show compile-gcc
18295 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18296 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18297 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18298 @end table
18299
18300 @node GDB Files
18301 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18302
18303 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18304 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18305 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18306 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18307
18308 @menu
18309 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18310 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18311 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18312 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18313 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18314 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18315 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18316 @end menu
18317
18318 @node Files
18319 @section Commands to Specify Files
18320
18321 @cindex symbol table
18322 @cindex core dump file
18323
18324 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18325 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18326 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18327 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18328
18329 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18330 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18331 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18332 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18333 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18334 new files are useful.
18335
18336 @table @code
18337 @cindex executable file
18338 @kindex file
18339 @item file @var{filename}
18340 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18341 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18342 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18343 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18344 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18345 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18346 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18347 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18348
18349 @cindex unlinked object files
18350 @cindex patching object files
18351 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18352 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18353 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18354 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18355 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18356 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18357 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18358 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18359
18360 @item file
18361 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18362 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18363
18364 @kindex exec-file
18365 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18366 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18367 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18368 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18369 discard information on the executable file.
18370
18371 @kindex symbol-file
18372 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18373 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18374 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18375 table and program to run from the same file.
18376
18377 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18378 program's symbol table.
18379
18380 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18381 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18382 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18383 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18384 @value{GDBN}.
18385
18386 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18387 executing it once.
18388
18389 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18390 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18391 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18392 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18393 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18394 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18395 optimized code.
18396
18397 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18398 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18399 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18400 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18401 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18402
18403 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18404 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18405 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18406 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18407 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18408 Warnings and Messages}.)
18409
18410 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18411 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18412 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18413 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18414 in stabs format.
18415
18416 @kindex readnow
18417 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18418 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18419 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18420 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18421 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18422 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18423 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18424 entire symbol table available.
18425
18426 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18427 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18428 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18429 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18430 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18431 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18432 @c files.
18433
18434 @kindex core-file
18435 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18436 @itemx core
18437 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18438 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18439 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18440 executable file itself for other parts.
18441
18442 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18443 to be used.
18444
18445 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18446 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18447 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18448 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18449 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18450
18451 @kindex add-symbol-file
18452 @cindex dynamic linking
18453 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18454 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18455 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18456 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18457 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18458 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18459 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18460 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18461 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18462 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18463 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18464 @var{address} as an expression.
18465
18466 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18467 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18468 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18469 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18470
18471 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18472
18473 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18474 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18475 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18476 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18477 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18478 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18479 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18480 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18481 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18482
18483 @itemize @bullet
18484 @item
18485 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18486 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18487 @item
18488 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18489 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18490 @item
18491 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18492 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18493 @end itemize
18494
18495 @noindent
18496 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18497 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18498 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18499 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18500 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18501 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18502 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18503 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18504 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18505 way.
18506
18507 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18508
18509 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18510 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18511 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18512 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18513 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18514 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18515
18516 @smallexample
18517 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18518 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18519 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18520 (y or n) y
18521 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18522 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18523 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18524 (gdb)
18525 @end smallexample
18526
18527
18528 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18529
18530 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18531 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18532 @cindex load symbols from memory
18533 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18534 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18535 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18536 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18537 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18538 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18539 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18540 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18541 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18542
18543 @kindex section
18544 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18545 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18546 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18547 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18548 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18549 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18550 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18551 their addresses.
18552
18553 @kindex info files
18554 @kindex info target
18555 @item info files
18556 @itemx info target
18557 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18558 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18559 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18560 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18561 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18562 current ones.
18563
18564 @kindex maint info sections
18565 @item maint info sections
18566 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18567 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18568 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18569 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18570 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18571 may be arbitrarily combined):
18572
18573 @table @code
18574 @item ALLOBJ
18575 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18576 @item @var{sections}
18577 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18578 @item @var{section-flags}
18579 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18580 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18581 @table @code
18582 @item ALLOC
18583 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18584 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18585 @item LOAD
18586 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18587 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18588 @item RELOC
18589 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18590 @item READONLY
18591 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18592 @item CODE
18593 Section contains executable code only.
18594 @item DATA
18595 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18596 @item ROM
18597 Section will reside in ROM.
18598 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18599 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18600 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18601 Section is not empty.
18602 @item NEVER_LOAD
18603 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18604 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18605 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18606 COFF shared library information.
18607 @item IS_COMMON
18608 Section contains common symbols.
18609 @end table
18610 @end table
18611 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18612 @cindex read-only sections
18613 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18614 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18615 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18616 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18617 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18618 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18619 enhancement to debugging performance.
18620
18621 The default is off.
18622
18623 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18624 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18625 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18626 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18627
18628 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18629 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18630 @end table
18631
18632 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18633 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18634 name and remembers it that way.
18635
18636 @cindex shared libraries
18637 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18638 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18639 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18640 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18641
18642 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18643 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18644
18645 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18646 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18647 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18648 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18649 debugging a core file).
18650
18651 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18652 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18653 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18654
18655 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18656 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18657 particularly large or there are many of them.
18658
18659 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18660 commands:
18661
18662 @table @code
18663 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18664 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18665 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18666 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18667 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18668 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18669 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18670 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18671
18672 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18673 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18674 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18675 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18676 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18677 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18678 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18679 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18680 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18681
18682 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18683 @item show auto-solib-add
18684 Display the current autoloading mode.
18685 @end table
18686
18687 @cindex load shared library
18688 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18689 command:
18690
18691 @table @code
18692 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18693 @kindex info share
18694 @item info share @var{regex}
18695 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18696 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18697 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18698 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18699
18700 @kindex info dll
18701 @item info dll @var{regex}
18702 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18703
18704 @kindex sharedlibrary
18705 @kindex share
18706 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18707 @itemx share @var{regex}
18708 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18709 Unix regular expression.
18710 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18711 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18712 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18713 loaded.
18714
18715 @item nosharedlibrary
18716 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18717 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18718 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18719 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18720 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18721 discarded.
18722 @end table
18723
18724 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18725 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18726 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18727 Catchpoints}).
18728
18729 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18730 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18731 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18732 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18733
18734 @table @code
18735 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18736 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18737 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18738 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18739 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18740 shared library.
18741
18742 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18743 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18744 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18745 library events happen.
18746 @end table
18747
18748 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18749 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18750 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18751 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18752 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18753 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18754 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18755 not.
18756
18757 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18758 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18759 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18760 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18761 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18762
18763 @table @code
18764 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18765 @cindex system root, alternate
18766 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18767 @kindex set sysroot
18768 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18769 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18770 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18771 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18772 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18773 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18774 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18775 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18776 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18777 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18778 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18779 @var{path}.
18780
18781 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18782 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18783 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18784 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18785 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18786 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18787 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18788 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18789 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18790 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18791 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18792 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18793 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18794 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18795
18796 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18797 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18798 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18799 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18800 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18801
18802 @smallexample
18803 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18804 @end smallexample
18805
18806 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18807 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18808 system:
18809
18810 @smallexample
18811 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18812 @end smallexample
18813
18814 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18815 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18816 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18817 colons:
18818
18819 @smallexample
18820 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18821 @end smallexample
18822
18823 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18824 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18825 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18826 @samp{z}):
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18830 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18831 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18832 @end smallexample
18833
18834 @noindent
18835 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18836 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18837 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18838
18839 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18840 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18841
18842 @smallexample
18843 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18844 @end smallexample
18845
18846 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18847 if you don't want or need to.
18848
18849 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18850 sysroot}.
18851
18852 @cindex default system root
18853 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18854 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18855 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18856 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18857 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18858 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18859 location.
18860
18861 @kindex show sysroot
18862 @item show sysroot
18863 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18864
18865 @kindex set solib-search-path
18866 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18867 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18868 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18869 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18870 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18871 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18872 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18873 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18874 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18875 of shared library symbols.
18876
18877 @kindex show solib-search-path
18878 @item show solib-search-path
18879 Display the current shared library search path.
18880
18881 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18882 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18883 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18884 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18885 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18886
18887 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18888 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18889 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18890 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18891 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18892 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18893 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18894 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18895 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18896 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18897 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18898 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18899 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18900 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18901 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18902 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18903 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18904 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18905 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18906 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18907 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18908 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18909
18910 @table @code
18911 @item unix
18912 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18913 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18914 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18915 the forward slash.
18916
18917 @item dos-based
18918 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18919 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18920 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18921 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18922 considered directory separators.
18923
18924 @item auto
18925 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18926 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18927 This is the default.
18928 @end table
18929 @end table
18930
18931 @cindex file name canonicalization
18932 @cindex base name differences
18933 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18934 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18935 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18936 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18937 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18938 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18939 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18940 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18941 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18942 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18943 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18944 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18945 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18946 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18947 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18948
18949 @table @code
18950 @item set basenames-may-differ
18951 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18952 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18953
18954 @item show basenames-may-differ
18955 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18956 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18957 @end table
18958
18959 @node File Caching
18960 @section File Caching
18961 @cindex caching of opened files
18962 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18963
18964 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18965 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18966 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18967 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18968
18969 @table @code
18970 @kindex maint info bfds
18971 @item maint info bfds
18972 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18973 @value{GDBN}.
18974
18975 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18976 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18977 @kindex bfd caching
18978 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18979 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18980 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18981 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18982 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18983 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18984 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18985 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18986 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18987
18988 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18989 @kindex bfd caching
18990 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18991 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18992
18993 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18994 @kindex bfd caching
18995 @item show debug bfd-cache
18996 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18997 @end table
18998
18999 @node Separate Debug Files
19000 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19001 @cindex separate debugging information files
19002 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19003 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19004 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19005 @cindex global debugging information directories
19006 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19007 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19008
19009 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19010 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19011 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19012 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19013 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19014 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19015 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19016
19017 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19018 file:
19019
19020 @itemize @bullet
19021 @item
19022 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19023 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19024 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19025 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19026 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19027 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19028 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19029 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19030
19031 @item
19032 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19033 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19034 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19035 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19036 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19037 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19038 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19039 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19040 below.
19041 @end itemize
19042
19043 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19044 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19045
19046 @itemize @bullet
19047 @item
19048 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19049 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19050 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19051 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19052 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19053
19054 @item
19055 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19056 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19057 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19058 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19059 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19060 hex characters, not 10.)
19061 @end itemize
19062
19063 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19064 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19065 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19066 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19067 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19068 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19069
19070 @itemize @minus
19071 @item
19072 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19073 @item
19074 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19075 @item
19076 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19077 @item
19078 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19079 @end itemize
19080
19081 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19082 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19083 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19084 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19085 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19086
19087 @table @code
19088
19089 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19090 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19091 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19092 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19093 concatenating them by a path separator.
19094
19095 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19096 @item show debug-file-directory
19097 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19098 information files.
19099
19100 @end table
19101
19102 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19103 @cindex debug link sections
19104 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19105 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19106
19107 @itemize
19108 @item
19109 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19110 a zero byte,
19111 @item
19112 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19113 boundary within the section, and
19114 @item
19115 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19116 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19117 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19118 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19119 @end itemize
19120
19121 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19122 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19123 described above.
19124
19125 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19126 @cindex build ID sections
19127 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19128 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19129 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19130 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19131 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19132 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19133 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19134 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19135 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19136
19137 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19138 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19139 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19140 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19141 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19142 in an ordinary executable.
19143
19144 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19145 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19146 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19147 following commands:
19148
19149 @smallexample
19150 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19151 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19152 @end smallexample
19153
19154 @noindent
19155 These commands remove the debugging
19156 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19157 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19158 two files:
19159
19160 @itemize @bullet
19161 @item
19162 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19163 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19164
19165 @smallexample
19166 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19167 @end smallexample
19168
19169 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19170 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19171 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19172 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19173
19174 @item
19175 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19176 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19177 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19178 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19179 @end itemize
19180
19181 @noindent
19182
19183 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19184 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19185 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19186
19187 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19188 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19189 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19190 @c different ways!
19191 @ifhtml
19192 @display
19193 @html
19194 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19195 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19196 @end html
19197 @end display
19198 @end ifhtml
19199 @ifnothtml
19200 @display
19201 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19202 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19203 @end display
19204 @end ifnothtml
19205
19206 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19207 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19208 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19209 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19210 CRC.
19211
19212 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19213 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19214 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19215 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19216 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19217
19218 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19219 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19220 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19221 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19222 @code{0xffffffff}.
19223
19224 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19225 @smallexample
19226 unsigned long
19227 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19228 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19229 @{
19230 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19231 @{
19232 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19233 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19234 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19235 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19236 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19237 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19238 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19239 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19240 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19241 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19242 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19243 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19244 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19245 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19246 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19247 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19248 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19249 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19250 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19251 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19252 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19253 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19254 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19255 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19256 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19257 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19258 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19259 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19260 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19261 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19262 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19263 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19264 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19265 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19266 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19267 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19268 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19269 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19270 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19271 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19272 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19273 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19274 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19275 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19276 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19277 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19278 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19279 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19280 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19281 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19282 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19283 0x2d02ef8d
19284 @};
19285 unsigned char *end;
19286
19287 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19288 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19289 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19290 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19291 @}
19292 @end smallexample
19293
19294 @noindent
19295 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19296
19297 @node MiniDebugInfo
19298 @section Debugging information in a special section
19299 @cindex separate debug sections
19300 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19301
19302 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19303 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19304 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19305 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19306
19307 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19308 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19309 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19310 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19311 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19312 debugging information might be included in the section.
19313
19314 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19315 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19316 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19317
19318 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19319 standard utilities:
19320
19321 @smallexample
19322 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19323 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19324 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19325 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19326
19327 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19328 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19329 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19330 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19331 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19332 | sort > funcsyms
19333
19334 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19335 # table.
19336 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19337
19338 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19339 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19340
19341 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19342 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19343 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19344 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19345
19346 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19347 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19348
19349 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19350 # original binary.
19351 xz mini_debuginfo
19352 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19353 @end smallexample
19354
19355 @node Index Files
19356 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19357 @cindex index files
19358 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19359
19360 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19361 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19362 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19363 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19364 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19365 startup.
19366
19367 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19368 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19369 using @command{objcopy}.
19370
19371 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19372
19373 @table @code
19374 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19375 @kindex save gdb-index
19376 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19377 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19378 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19379 @var{directory}.
19380 @end table
19381
19382 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19383 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19384
19385 @smallexample
19386 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19387 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19388 @end smallexample
19389
19390 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19391 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19392 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19393 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19394 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19395 The default is @code{off}.
19396 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19397 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19398
19399 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19400 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19401
19402 @smallexample
19403 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19404 @end smallexample
19405
19406 Instead you must do, for example,
19407
19408 @smallexample
19409 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19410 @end smallexample
19411
19412 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19413 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19414 currently work for programs using Ada.
19415
19416 @node Symbol Errors
19417 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19418
19419 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19420 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19421 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19422 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19423 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19424 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19425 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19426 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19427 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19428 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19429 Messages}).
19430
19431 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19432
19433 @table @code
19434 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19435
19436 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19437 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19438 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19439 in its outer scope blocks.
19440
19441 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19442 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19443 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19444 function.
19445
19446 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19447
19448 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19449 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19450 do so.
19451
19452 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19453 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19454 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19455 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19456 Messages}.)
19457
19458 @item bad block start address patched
19459
19460 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19461 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19462 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19463
19464 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19465 starting on the previous source line.
19466
19467 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19468
19469 @cindex foo
19470 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19471 larger than the size of the string table.
19472
19473 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19474 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19475 with this name.
19476
19477 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19478
19479 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19480 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19481 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19482
19483 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19484 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19485 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19486 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19487 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19488 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19489
19490 @item stub type has NULL name
19491
19492 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19493
19494 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19495 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19496 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19497 it.
19498
19499 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19500
19501 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19502
19503 @end table
19504
19505 @node Data Files
19506 @section GDB Data Files
19507
19508 @cindex prefix for data files
19509 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19510 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19511
19512 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19513 is currently using.
19514
19515 @table @code
19516 @kindex set data-directory
19517 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19518 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19519 to @var{directory}.
19520
19521 @kindex show data-directory
19522 @item show data-directory
19523 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19524 @end table
19525
19526 @cindex default data directory
19527 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19528 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19529 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19530 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19531 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19532 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19533 location.
19534
19535 The data directory may also be specified with the
19536 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19537 @xref{Mode Options}.
19538
19539 @node Targets
19540 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19541
19542 @cindex debugging target
19543 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19544
19545 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19546 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19547 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19548 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19549 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19550 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19551 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19552 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19553
19554 @cindex target architecture
19555 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19556 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19557 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19558 command.
19559
19560 @table @code
19561 @kindex set architecture
19562 @kindex show architecture
19563 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19564 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19565 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19566 supported architectures.
19567
19568 @item show architecture
19569 Show the current target architecture.
19570
19571 @item set processor
19572 @itemx processor
19573 @kindex set processor
19574 @kindex show processor
19575 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19576 and @code{show architecture}.
19577 @end table
19578
19579 @menu
19580 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19581 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19582 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19583 @end menu
19584
19585 @node Active Targets
19586 @section Active Targets
19587
19588 @cindex stacking targets
19589 @cindex active targets
19590 @cindex multiple targets
19591
19592 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19593 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19594 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19595 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19596 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19597 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19598 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19599 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19600 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19601
19602 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19603 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19604 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19605 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19606
19607 @node Target Commands
19608 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19609
19610 @table @code
19611 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19612 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19613 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19614 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19615 protocol of the target machine.
19616
19617 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19618 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19619 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19620
19621 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19622 after executing the command.
19623
19624 @kindex help target
19625 @item help target
19626 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19627 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19628 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19629
19630 @item help target @var{name}
19631 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19632 select it.
19633
19634 @kindex set gnutarget
19635 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19636 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19637 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19638 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19639 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19640 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19641
19642 @quotation
19643 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19644 you must know the actual BFD name.
19645 @end quotation
19646
19647 @noindent
19648 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19649
19650 @kindex show gnutarget
19651 @item show gnutarget
19652 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19653 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19654 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19655 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19656 @end table
19657
19658 @cindex common targets
19659 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19660 configuration):
19661
19662 @table @code
19663 @kindex target
19664 @item target exec @var{program}
19665 @cindex executable file target
19666 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19667 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19668
19669 @item target core @var{filename}
19670 @cindex core dump file target
19671 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19672 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19673
19674 @item target remote @var{medium}
19675 @cindex remote target
19676 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19677 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19678 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19679
19680 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19681 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19682
19683 @smallexample
19684 target remote /dev/ttya
19685 @end smallexample
19686
19687 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19688 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19689 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19690 clobbered by the download.
19691
19692 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19693 @cindex built-in simulator target
19694 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19695 In general,
19696 @smallexample
19697 target sim
19698 load
19699 run
19700 @end smallexample
19701 @noindent
19702 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19703 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19704 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19705 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19706 Processors}.
19707
19708 @item target native
19709 @cindex native target
19710 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19711 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19712 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19713 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19714
19715 @end table
19716
19717 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19718 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19719
19720 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19721 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19722 various aspects of this process.
19723
19724 @table @code
19725
19726 @item set hash
19727 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19728 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19729 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19730 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19731 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19732 monitor.
19733
19734 @item show hash
19735 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19736 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19737
19738 @item set debug monitor
19739 @kindex set debug monitor
19740 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19741 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19742 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19743
19744 @item show debug monitor
19745 @kindex show debug monitor
19746 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19747 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19748 @end table
19749
19750 @table @code
19751
19752 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19753 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19754 @anchor{load}
19755 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19756 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19757 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19758 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19759 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19760 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19761
19762 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19763 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19764 target is @dots{}}''
19765
19766 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19767 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19768 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19769 specifies a fixed address.
19770 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19771
19772 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19773 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19774 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19775
19776 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19777 load programs into flash memory.
19778
19779 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19780 @end table
19781
19782 @table @code
19783
19784 @kindex flash-erase
19785 @item flash-erase
19786 @anchor{flash-erase}
19787
19788 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19789
19790 @end table
19791
19792 @node Byte Order
19793 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19794
19795 @cindex choosing target byte order
19796 @cindex target byte order
19797
19798 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19799 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19800 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19801 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19802 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19803 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19804
19805 @table @code
19806 @kindex set endian
19807 @item set endian big
19808 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19809
19810 @item set endian little
19811 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19812
19813 @item set endian auto
19814 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19815 executable.
19816
19817 @item show endian
19818 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19819
19820 @end table
19821
19822 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19823 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19824 target system.
19825
19826
19827 @node Remote Debugging
19828 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19829 @cindex remote debugging
19830
19831 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19832 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19833 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19834 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19835 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19836
19837 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19838 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19839 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19840 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19841 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19842 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19843
19844 Other remote targets may be available in your
19845 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19846
19847 @menu
19848 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19849 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19850 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19851 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19852 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19853 @end menu
19854
19855 @node Connecting
19856 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19857 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19858 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19859 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19860 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19861 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19862 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19863
19864 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19865 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19866 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19867 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19868
19869 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19870
19871 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19872 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19873 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19874 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19875
19876 @table @asis
19877
19878 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19879 @item Result of detach or program exit
19880 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19881 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19882 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19883
19884 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19885 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19886 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19887 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19888
19889 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19890 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19891 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19892 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19893
19894 @item Specifying the program to debug
19895 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19896 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19897 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19898 target.
19899
19900 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19901 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19902 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19903
19904 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19905 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19906 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19907 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19908
19909 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19910 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19911 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19912 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19913 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19914 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19915 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19916 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19917 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19918
19919 @item The @code{run} command
19920 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19921 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19922 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19923 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19924 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19925
19926 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19927 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19928 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19929 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19930 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19931
19932 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19933 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19934 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19935 @code{target remote} mode.
19936
19937 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19938 @item Attaching
19939 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19940 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19941 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19942
19943 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19944 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19945 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19946 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19947 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19948
19949 @end table
19950
19951 @anchor{Host and target files}
19952 @subsection Host and Target Files
19953 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19954 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19955
19956 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19957 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19958 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19959 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19960 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19961
19962 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19963 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19964 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19965 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19966 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19967
19968 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19969 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19970 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19971 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19972 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19973 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19974 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19975 target libraries.
19976
19977 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19978 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19979 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19980 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19981 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19982 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19983 programs.
19984
19985 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19986 @cindex remote connection commands
19987 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19988 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19989 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19990 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19991 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19992 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19993 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19994
19995 @table @code
19996
19997 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19998 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19999 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20000 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20001 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20002
20003 @smallexample
20004 target remote /dev/ttyb
20005 @end smallexample
20006
20007 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20008 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20009 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20010 @code{target} command.
20011
20012 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20013 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20014 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20015 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20016 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20017 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20018 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20019 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20020 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20021 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20022 target.
20023
20024 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20025 @code{manyfarms}:
20026
20027 @smallexample
20028 target remote manyfarms:2828
20029 @end smallexample
20030
20031 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20032 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20033 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20034 port 1234 on your local machine:
20035
20036 @smallexample
20037 target remote :1234
20038 @end smallexample
20039 @noindent
20040
20041 Note that the colon is still required here.
20042
20043 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20044 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20045 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20046 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20047 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20048
20049 @smallexample
20050 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20051 @end smallexample
20052
20053 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20054 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20055 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20056 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20057
20058 @item target remote | @var{command}
20059 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20060 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20061 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20062 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20063 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20064 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20065 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20066 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20067 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20068
20069 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20070 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20071 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20072
20073 @end table
20074
20075 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20076 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20077 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20078 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20079 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20080 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20081 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20082
20083 @smallexample
20084 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20085 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20086 @end smallexample
20087
20088 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20089 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20090 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20091 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20092
20093 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20094 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20095
20096 @table @code
20097 @kindex detach (remote)
20098 @item detach
20099 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20100 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20101 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20102 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20103 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20104 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20105 still connected to the target.
20106
20107 @kindex disconnect
20108 @item disconnect
20109 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20110 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20111 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20112 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20113 another target.
20114
20115 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20116 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20117 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20118 @kindex monitor
20119 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20120 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20121 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20122 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20123 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20124 and implement.
20125 @end table
20126
20127 @node File Transfer
20128 @section Sending files to a remote system
20129 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20130 @cindex file transfer
20131 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20132
20133 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20134 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20135 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20136 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20137 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20138 the only way to upload or download files.
20139
20140 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20141
20142 @table @code
20143 @kindex remote put
20144 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20145 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20146 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20147
20148 @kindex remote get
20149 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20150 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20151 on the host system.
20152
20153 @kindex remote delete
20154 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20155 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20156
20157 @end table
20158
20159 @node Server
20160 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20161
20162 @kindex gdbserver
20163 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20164 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20165 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20166 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20167 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20168
20169 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20170 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20171 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20172 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20173 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20174 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20175 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20176 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20177 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20178 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20179 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20180 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20181 choice for debugging.
20182
20183 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20184 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20185 protocol.
20186
20187 @quotation
20188 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20189 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20190 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20191 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20192 @code{gdbserver}.
20193 @end quotation
20194
20195 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20196 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20197 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20198 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20199
20200 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20201 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20202 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20203 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20204 system does all the symbol handling.
20205
20206 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20207 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20208 syntax is:
20209
20210 @smallexample
20211 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20212 @end smallexample
20213
20214 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20215 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20216 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20217 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20218 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20219 @file{/dev/com1}:
20220
20221 @smallexample
20222 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20226 with it.
20227
20228 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20229
20230 @smallexample
20231 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20232 @end smallexample
20233
20234 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20235 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20236 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20237 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20238 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20239 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20240 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20241 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20242 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20243 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20244 @code{target remote} command.
20245
20246 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20247 with ssh:
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20254 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20255 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20256 You could elide it if you want to.
20257
20258 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20259 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20260 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20261 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20262
20263 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20264 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20265 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20266 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20267
20268 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20269 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20270
20271 @smallexample
20272 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20273 @end smallexample
20274
20275 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20276 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20277
20278 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20279 @value{GDBN} attach command
20280 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20281
20282 @pindex pidof
20283 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20284 @code{pidof} utility:
20285
20286 @smallexample
20287 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20288 @end smallexample
20289
20290 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20291 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20292 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20293
20294 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20295
20296 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20297 port.
20298
20299 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20300 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20301 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20302 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20303 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20304 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20305 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20306 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20307
20308 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20309 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20310 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20311
20312 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20313 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20314 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20315 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20316 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20317 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20318 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20319 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20320 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20321 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20322 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20323 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20324
20325 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20326 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20327
20328 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20329 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20330 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20331 program. For more information,
20332 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20333
20334 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20335 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20336 status information about the debugging process.
20337 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20338 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20339 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20340 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20341
20342 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20343 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20344 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20345 Possible options are:
20346
20347 @table @code
20348 @item none
20349 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20350 @item all
20351 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20352 @item timestamps
20353 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20354 @end table
20355
20356 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20357 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20358
20359 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20360 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20361 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20362 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20363 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20364
20365 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20366 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20367 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20368 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20369
20370 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20371 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20372 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20373 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20374
20375 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20376 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20377 environment:
20378
20379 @smallexample
20380 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20381 @end smallexample
20382
20383 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20384 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20385
20386 @smallexample
20387 $ gdbserver --selftest
20388 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20389 @end smallexample
20390
20391 These tests are disabled in release.
20392 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20393
20394 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20395 @itemize
20396
20397 @item
20398 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20399
20400 @item
20401 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20402 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20403 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20404 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20405 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20406 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20407
20408 @item
20409 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20410 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20411 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20412 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20413 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20414 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20415 program is already on the target.
20416
20417 @end itemize
20418
20419 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20420 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20421 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20422
20423 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20424 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20425 Here are the available commands.
20426
20427 @table @code
20428 @item monitor help
20429 List the available monitor commands.
20430
20431 @item monitor set debug 0
20432 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20433 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20434
20435 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20436 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20437 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20438 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20439
20440 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20441 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20442 Possible options are:
20443
20444 @table @code
20445 @item none
20446 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20447 @item all
20448 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20449 @item timestamps
20450 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20451 @end table
20452
20453 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20454 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20455
20456 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20457 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20458 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20459 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20460 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20461 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20462
20463 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20464 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20465
20466 @item monitor exit
20467 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20468 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20469 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20470 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20471 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20472
20473 @end table
20474
20475 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20476 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20477
20478 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20479 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20480
20481 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20482 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20483 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20484 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20485 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20486 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20487 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20488 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20489 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20490 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20491 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20492 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20493
20494 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20495
20496 @table @code
20497 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20498
20499 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20500 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20501 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20502
20503 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20504
20505 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20506 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20507 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20508 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20509 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20510 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20511
20512 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20513
20514 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20515 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20516 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20517 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20518 command for that. For example:
20519
20520 @smallexample
20521 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20522 @end smallexample
20523
20524 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20525 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20526 @end table
20527
20528 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20529 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20530 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20531 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20532 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20533 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20534 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20535 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20536 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20537 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20538
20539 @smallexample
20540 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20541 @end smallexample
20542
20543 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20544
20545 @smallexample
20546 $ gdb myprogram
20547 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20548 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20549 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20550 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20551 @end smallexample
20552
20553 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20554 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20555 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20556 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20557 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20558 tracing.
20559
20560 @node Remote Configuration
20561 @section Remote Configuration
20562
20563 @kindex set remote
20564 @kindex show remote
20565 This section documents the configuration options available when
20566 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20567 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20568 system-call-allowed}.
20569
20570 @table @code
20571 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20572 @cindex address size for remote targets
20573 @cindex bits in remote address
20574 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20575 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20576 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20577 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20578
20579 @item show remoteaddresssize
20580 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20581
20582 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20583 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20584 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20585 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20586 remote targets.
20587
20588 @item show serial baud
20589 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20590
20591 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20592 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20593 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20594
20595 @item show serial parity
20596 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20597
20598 @item set remotebreak
20599 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20600 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20601 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20602 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20603 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20604 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20605 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20606 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20607
20608 @item show remotebreak
20609 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20610 interrupt the remote program.
20611
20612 @item set remoteflow on
20613 @itemx set remoteflow off
20614 @kindex set remoteflow
20615 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20616 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20617
20618 @item show remoteflow
20619 @kindex show remoteflow
20620 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20621
20622 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20623 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20624 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20625 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20626 @code{ascii}.
20627
20628 @item show remotelogbase
20629 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20630 protocol.
20631
20632 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20633 @cindex record serial communications on file
20634 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20635 default is not to record at all.
20636
20637 @item show remotelogfile.
20638 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20639 serial communications.
20640
20641 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20642 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20643 @cindex remote timeout
20644 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20645 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20646
20647 @item show remotetimeout
20648 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20649 responses.
20650
20651 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20652 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20653 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20654 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20655 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20656 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20657 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20658 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20659
20660 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20661 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20662 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20663 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20664 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20665 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20666 as unlimited.
20667
20668 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20669 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20670 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20671
20672 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20673 @itemx show remote exec-file
20674 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20675 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20676 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20677 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20678 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20679 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20680
20681 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20682 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20683 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20684 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20685 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20686 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20687 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20688 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20689 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20690 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20691
20692 @item show interrupt-sequence
20693 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20694 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20695 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20696 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20697
20698 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20699 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20700 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20701 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20702 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20703 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20704
20705 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20706 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20707 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20708
20709 @kindex set tcp
20710 @kindex show tcp
20711 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20712 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20713 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20714 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20715 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20716 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20717 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20718 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20719 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20720
20721 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20722 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20723
20724 @item show tcp auto-retry
20725 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20726
20727 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20728 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20729 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20730 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20731 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20732 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20733 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20734 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20735 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20736 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20737 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20738
20739 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20740 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20741 @end table
20742
20743 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20744 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20745 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20746 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20747 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20748 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20749 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20750 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20751 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20752
20753 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20754 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20755 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20756 @value{GDBN} developers.
20757
20758 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20759 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20760 are:
20761
20762 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20763 @item Command Name
20764 @tab Remote Packet
20765 @tab Related Features
20766
20767 @item @code{fetch-register}
20768 @tab @code{p}
20769 @tab @code{info registers}
20770
20771 @item @code{set-register}
20772 @tab @code{P}
20773 @tab @code{set}
20774
20775 @item @code{binary-download}
20776 @tab @code{X}
20777 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20778
20779 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20780 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20781 @tab @code{info auxv}
20782
20783 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20784 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20785 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20786
20787 @item @code{attach}
20788 @tab @code{vAttach}
20789 @tab @code{attach}
20790
20791 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20792 @tab @code{vCont}
20793 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20794
20795 @item @code{run}
20796 @tab @code{vRun}
20797 @tab @code{run}
20798
20799 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20800 @tab @code{Z0}
20801 @tab @code{break}
20802
20803 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20804 @tab @code{Z1}
20805 @tab @code{hbreak}
20806
20807 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20808 @tab @code{Z2}
20809 @tab @code{watch}
20810
20811 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20812 @tab @code{Z3}
20813 @tab @code{rwatch}
20814
20815 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20816 @tab @code{Z4}
20817 @tab @code{awatch}
20818
20819 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20820 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20821 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20822
20823 @item @code{target-features}
20824 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20825 @tab @code{set architecture}
20826
20827 @item @code{library-info}
20828 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20829 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20830
20831 @item @code{memory-map}
20832 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20833 @tab @code{info mem}
20834
20835 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20836 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20837 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20838
20839 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20840 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20841 @tab @code{info spu}
20842
20843 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20844 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20845 @tab @code{info spu}
20846
20847 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20848 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20849 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20850
20851 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20852 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20853 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20854
20855 @item @code{threads}
20856 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20857 @tab @code{info threads}
20858
20859 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20860 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20861 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20862
20863 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20864 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20865 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20866
20867 @item @code{search-memory}
20868 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20869 @tab @code{find}
20870
20871 @item @code{supported-packets}
20872 @tab @code{qSupported}
20873 @tab Remote communications parameters
20874
20875 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20876 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20877 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20878
20879 @item @code{pass-signals}
20880 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20881 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20882
20883 @item @code{program-signals}
20884 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20885 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20886
20887 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20888 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20889 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20890
20891 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20892 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20893 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20894
20895 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20896 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20897 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20898
20899 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20900 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20901 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20902
20903 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20904 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20905 @tab @code{remote delete}
20906
20907 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20908 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20909 @tab Host I/O
20910
20911 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20912 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20913 @tab Host I/O
20914
20915 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20916 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20917 @tab Host I/O
20918
20919 @item @code{noack-packet}
20920 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20921 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20922
20923 @item @code{osdata}
20924 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20925 @tab @code{info os}
20926
20927 @item @code{query-attached}
20928 @tab @code{qAttached}
20929 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20930
20931 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20932 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20933 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20934
20935 @item @code{trace-status}
20936 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20937 @tab @code{tstatus}
20938
20939 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20940 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20941 @tab Traceframe info
20942
20943 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20944 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20945 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20946
20947 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20948 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20949 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20950
20951 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
20952 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
20953 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
20954
20955 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
20956 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
20957 @tab @code{set environment}
20958
20959 @item @code{environment-unset}
20960 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
20961 @tab @code{unset environment}
20962
20963 @item @code{environment-reset}
20964 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
20965 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
20966
20967 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20968 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20969 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20970
20971 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20972 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20973 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20974
20975 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20976 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20977 @tab @code{break}
20978
20979 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20980 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20981 @tab @code{hbreak}
20982
20983 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20984 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20985 @tab @code{fork}
20986
20987 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20988 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20989 @tab @code{vfork}
20990
20991 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20992 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20993 @tab @code{exec}
20994
20995 @item @code{thread-events}
20996 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20997 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20998
20999 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21000 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21001 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21002
21003 @end multitable
21004
21005 @node Remote Stub
21006 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21007
21008 @cindex debugging stub, example
21009 @cindex remote stub, example
21010 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21011 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21012 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21013 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21014 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21015 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21016 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21017 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21018
21019 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21020 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21021 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21022 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21023 program, you need:
21024
21025 @enumerate
21026 @item
21027 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21028 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21029 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21030
21031 @item
21032 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21033 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21034
21035 @item
21036 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21037 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21038 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21039 documentation.
21040 @end enumerate
21041
21042 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21043 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21044 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21045
21046 @table @emph
21047 @item On the host,
21048 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21049 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21050 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21051
21052 @item On the target,
21053 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21054 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21055 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21056
21057 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21058 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21059 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21060 @end table
21061
21062 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21063 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21064 @sc{sparc} boards.
21065
21066 @cindex remote serial stub list
21067 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21068
21069 @table @code
21070
21071 @item i386-stub.c
21072 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21073 @cindex Intel
21074 @cindex i386
21075 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21076
21077 @item m68k-stub.c
21078 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21079 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21080 @cindex m680x0
21081 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21082
21083 @item sh-stub.c
21084 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21085 @cindex Renesas
21086 @cindex SH
21087 For Renesas SH architectures.
21088
21089 @item sparc-stub.c
21090 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21091 @cindex Sparc
21092 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21093
21094 @item sparcl-stub.c
21095 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21096 @cindex Fujitsu
21097 @cindex SparcLite
21098 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21099
21100 @end table
21101
21102 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21103 recently added stubs.
21104
21105 @menu
21106 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21107 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21108 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21109 @end menu
21110
21111 @node Stub Contents
21112 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21113
21114 @cindex remote serial stub
21115 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21116 subroutines:
21117
21118 @table @code
21119 @item set_debug_traps
21120 @findex set_debug_traps
21121 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21122 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21123 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21124 program's startup code.
21125
21126 @item handle_exception
21127 @findex handle_exception
21128 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21129 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21130 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21131 run when a trap is triggered.
21132
21133 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21134 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21135 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21136 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21137 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21138 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21139 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21140 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21141 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21142 machine.
21143
21144 @item breakpoint
21145 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21146 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21147 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21148 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21149 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21150 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21151 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21152 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21153 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21154 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21155 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21156
21157 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21158 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21159 start of your debugging session.
21160 @end table
21161
21162 @node Bootstrapping
21163 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21164
21165 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21166 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21167 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21168 debugging target machine.
21169
21170 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21171 serial port.
21172
21173 @table @code
21174 @item int getDebugChar()
21175 @findex getDebugChar
21176 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21177 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21178 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21179
21180 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21181 @findex putDebugChar
21182 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21183 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21184 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21185 @end table
21186
21187 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21188 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21189 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21190 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21191 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21192 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21193 remote system to stop.
21194
21195 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21196 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21197 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21198 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21199
21200 Other routines you need to supply are:
21201
21202 @table @code
21203 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21204 @findex exceptionHandler
21205 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21206 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21207 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21208 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21209 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21210 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21211 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21212 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21213 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21214 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21215 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21216 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21217 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21218
21219 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21220 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21221 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21222 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21223 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21224
21225 @item void flush_i_cache()
21226 @findex flush_i_cache
21227 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21228 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21229 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21230
21231 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21232 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21233 @end table
21234
21235 @noindent
21236 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21237
21238 @table @code
21239 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21240 @findex memset
21241 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21242 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21243 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21244 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21245 @end table
21246
21247 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21248 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21249 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21250 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21251
21252
21253 @node Debug Session
21254 @subsection Putting it All Together
21255
21256 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21257 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21258 steps.
21259
21260 @enumerate
21261 @item
21262 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21263 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21264 @display
21265 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21266 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21267 @end display
21268
21269 @item
21270 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21271 procedure is called:
21272
21273 @smallexample
21274 set_debug_traps();
21275 breakpoint();
21276 @end smallexample
21277
21278 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21279 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21280 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21281 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21282 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21283 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21284 progress.
21285
21286 @item
21287 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21288 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21289
21290 @smallexample
21291 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21292 @end smallexample
21293
21294 @noindent
21295 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21296 function in your program, that function is called when
21297 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21298 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21299 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21300
21301 @item
21302 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21303 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21304
21305 @item
21306 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21307 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21308
21309 @item
21310 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21311 @c document that. FIXME.
21312 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21313 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21314
21315 @item
21316 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21317 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21318
21319 @end enumerate
21320
21321 @node Configurations
21322 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21323
21324 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21325 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21326 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21327
21328 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21329 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21330 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21331 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21332 are quite different from each other.
21333
21334 @menu
21335 * Native::
21336 * Embedded OS::
21337 * Embedded Processors::
21338 * Architectures::
21339 @end menu
21340
21341 @node Native
21342 @section Native
21343
21344 This section describes details specific to particular native
21345 configurations.
21346
21347 @menu
21348 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21349 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21350 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21351 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21352 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21353 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21354 @end menu
21355
21356 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21357 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21358
21359 @cindex libkvm
21360 @cindex kernel memory image
21361 @cindex kernel crash dump
21362
21363 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21364 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21365 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21366 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21367 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21368 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21369 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21370 @code{kvm} target:
21371
21372 @smallexample
21373 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21374 @end smallexample
21375
21376 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21377 argument:
21378
21379 @smallexample
21380 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21381 @end smallexample
21382
21383 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21384 available:
21385
21386 @table @code
21387 @kindex kvm
21388 @item kvm pcb
21389 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21390
21391 @item kvm proc
21392 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21393 modern FreeBSD systems.
21394 @end table
21395
21396 @node SVR4 Process Information
21397 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21398 @cindex /proc
21399 @cindex examine process image
21400 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21401
21402 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21403 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21404 process using file-system subroutines.
21405
21406 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21407 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21408 information about the process running your program, or about any
21409 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21410 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21411
21412 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21413 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21414
21415 @table @code
21416 @kindex info proc
21417 @cindex process ID
21418 @item info proc
21419 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21420 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21421 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21422 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21423 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21424 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21425 executable file's absolute file name.
21426
21427 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21428 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21429 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21430 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21431 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21432 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21433
21434 @item info proc cmdline
21435 @cindex info proc cmdline
21436 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21437 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21438
21439 @item info proc cwd
21440 @cindex info proc cwd
21441 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21442 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21443
21444 @item info proc exe
21445 @cindex info proc exe
21446 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21447 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21448
21449 @item info proc mappings
21450 @cindex memory address space mappings
21451 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21452 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21453 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21454 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21455 memory access rights to that range.
21456
21457 @item info proc stat
21458 @itemx info proc status
21459 @cindex process detailed status information
21460 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21461 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21462 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21463 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21464 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21465 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21466 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21467
21468 @item info proc all
21469 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21470 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21471
21472 @ignore
21473 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21474 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21475 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21476 @kindex info proc times
21477 @item info proc times
21478 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21479 its children.
21480
21481 @kindex info proc id
21482 @item info proc id
21483 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21484 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21485 @end ignore
21486
21487 @item set procfs-trace
21488 @kindex set procfs-trace
21489 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21490 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21491
21492 @item show procfs-trace
21493 @kindex show procfs-trace
21494 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21495
21496 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21497 @kindex set procfs-file
21498 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21499 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21500 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21501 standard output.
21502
21503 @item show procfs-file
21504 @kindex show procfs-file
21505 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21506
21507 @item proc-trace-entry
21508 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21509 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21510 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21511 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21512 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21513 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21514 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21515 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21516 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21517
21518 @item info pidlist
21519 @kindex info pidlist
21520 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21521 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21522 processes and all the threads within each process.
21523
21524 @item info meminfo
21525 @kindex info meminfo
21526 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21527 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21528 @end table
21529
21530 @node DJGPP Native
21531 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21532 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21533 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21534 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21535
21536 @cindex DPMI
21537 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21538 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21539 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21540 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21541
21542 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21543 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21544 subsection describes those commands.
21545
21546 @table @code
21547 @kindex info dos
21548 @item info dos
21549 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21550 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21551
21552 @kindex sysinfo
21553 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21554 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21555 @item info dos sysinfo
21556 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21557 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21558 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21559
21560 @cindex GDT
21561 @cindex LDT
21562 @cindex IDT
21563 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21564 @cindex descriptor tables display
21565 @item info dos gdt
21566 @itemx info dos ldt
21567 @itemx info dos idt
21568 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21569 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21570 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21571 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21572 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21573 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21574 rights.
21575
21576 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21577 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21578 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21579 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21580 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21581
21582 @cindex garbled pointers
21583 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21584 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21585 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21586 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21587 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21588 debugged program's data segment:
21589
21590 @smallexample
21591 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21592 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21593 @end smallexample
21594
21595 @noindent
21596 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21597 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21598
21599 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21600 @item info dos pde
21601 @itemx info dos pte
21602 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21603 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21604 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21605 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21606 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21607 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21608 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21609 that is currently in use.
21610
21611 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21612 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21613 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21614 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21615 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21616 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21617 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21618
21619 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21620 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21621 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21622 controller.
21623
21624 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21625
21626 @cindex physical address from linear address
21627 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21628 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21629 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21630 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21631 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21632 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21633 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21637 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21638 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21639 @end smallexample
21640
21641 @noindent
21642 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21643 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21644 attributes of that page.
21645
21646 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21647 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21648 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21649 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21650 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21651 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21652
21653 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21654 transfer buffer:
21655
21656 @smallexample
21657 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21658 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21659 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 @noindent
21663 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21664 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21665 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21666 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21667 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21668
21669 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21670 @end table
21671
21672 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21673 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21674 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21675 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21676
21677 @table @code
21678 @kindex set com1base
21679 @kindex set com1irq
21680 @kindex set com2base
21681 @kindex set com2irq
21682 @kindex set com3base
21683 @kindex set com3irq
21684 @kindex set com4base
21685 @kindex set com4irq
21686 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21687 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21688 port.
21689
21690 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21691 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21692 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21693
21694 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21695 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21696 other 3 COM ports.
21697
21698 @kindex show com1base
21699 @kindex show com1irq
21700 @kindex show com2base
21701 @kindex show com2irq
21702 @kindex show com3base
21703 @kindex show com3irq
21704 @kindex show com4base
21705 @kindex show com4irq
21706 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21707 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21708 lines used by the COM ports.
21709
21710 @item info serial
21711 @kindex info serial
21712 @cindex DOS serial port status
21713 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21714 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21715 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21716 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21717 @end table
21718
21719
21720 @node Cygwin Native
21721 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21722 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21723 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21724 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21725
21726 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21727 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21728
21729 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21730 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21731 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21732 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21733 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21734 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21735 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21736 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21737
21738 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21739 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21740 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21741
21742 @table @code
21743 @kindex info w32
21744 @item info w32
21745 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21746 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21747
21748 @item info w32 selector
21749 This command displays information returned by
21750 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21751 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21752 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21753 Without argument, this command displays information
21754 about the six segment registers.
21755
21756 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21757 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21758 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21759 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21760
21761 @kindex signal-event
21762 @item signal-event @var{id}
21763 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21764 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21765
21766 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21767 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21768 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21769 (for x86_64 versions):
21770
21771 @itemize @minus
21772 @item
21773 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21774 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21775 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21776
21777 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21778 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21779 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21780 to attach.
21781
21782 @item
21783 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21784 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21785 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21786 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21787 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21788 @end itemize
21789
21790 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21791 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21792 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21793 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21794 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21795 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21796 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21797 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21798 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21799 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21800 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21801
21802 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21803 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21804 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21805 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21806
21807 @kindex set new-console
21808 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21809 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21810 be started in a new console on next start.
21811 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21812 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21813
21814 @kindex show new-console
21815 @item show new-console
21816 Displays whether a new console is used
21817 when the debuggee is started.
21818
21819 @kindex set new-group
21820 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21821 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21822 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21823 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21824 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21825
21826 @kindex show new-group
21827 @item show new-group
21828 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21829
21830 @kindex set debugevents
21831 @item set debugevents
21832 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21833 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21834 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21835 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21836 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21837
21838 @kindex set debugexec
21839 @item set debugexec
21840 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21841 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21842
21843 @kindex set debugexceptions
21844 @item set debugexceptions
21845 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21846 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21847
21848 @kindex set debugmemory
21849 @item set debugmemory
21850 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21851 and writes by the debugger.
21852
21853 @kindex set shell
21854 @item set shell
21855 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21856 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21857
21858 @kindex show shell
21859 @item show shell
21860 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21861
21862 @end table
21863
21864 @menu
21865 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21866 @end menu
21867
21868 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21869 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21870 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21871 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21872
21873 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21874 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21875 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21876 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21877 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21878 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21879 ``minimal symbols''.
21880
21881 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21882 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21883 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21884 program run once to completion.
21885
21886 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21887
21888 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21889 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21890 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21891 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21892 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21893 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21894 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21895 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21896 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21897
21898 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21899 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21900 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21901 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21902 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21903 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21904
21905 @smallexample
21906 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21907 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21908
21909 Non-debugging symbols:
21910 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21911 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21912 @end smallexample
21913
21914 @smallexample
21915 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21916 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21917
21918 Non-debugging symbols:
21919 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21920 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21921 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21922 [etc...]
21923 @end smallexample
21924
21925 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21926
21927 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21928 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21929 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21930 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21931 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21932 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21933 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21934
21935 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21936 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21937 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21938 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21939 problem:
21940
21941 @smallexample
21942 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21943 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21944 @end smallexample
21945
21946 @smallexample
21947 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21948 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21949 @end smallexample
21950
21951 And two possible solutions:
21952
21953 @smallexample
21954 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21955 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21956 @end smallexample
21957
21958 @smallexample
21959 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21960 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21961 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21962 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21963 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21964 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21965 @end smallexample
21966
21967 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21968 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21969 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21970 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21971 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21972
21973 @smallexample
21974 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21975 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21976 @end smallexample
21977
21978 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21979 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21980 safe.
21981
21982 @node Hurd Native
21983 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21984 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21985
21986 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21987 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21988
21989 @table @code
21990 @item set signals
21991 @itemx set sigs
21992 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21993 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21994 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21995 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21996 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21997 @code{signals}.
21998
21999 @item show signals
22000 @itemx show sigs
22001 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22002 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22003 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22004
22005 @item set signal-thread
22006 @itemx set sigthread
22007 @kindex set signal-thread
22008 @kindex set sigthread
22009 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22010 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22011 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22012 signal-thread}.
22013
22014 @item show signal-thread
22015 @itemx show sigthread
22016 @kindex show signal-thread
22017 @kindex show sigthread
22018 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22019 delivered a signal.
22020
22021 @item set stopped
22022 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22023 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22024 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22025 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22026
22027 @item show stopped
22028 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22029 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22030 stopped.
22031
22032 @item set exceptions
22033 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22034 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22035 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22036 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22037 trapping on.
22038
22039 @item show exceptions
22040 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22041 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22042
22043 @item set task pause
22044 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22045 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22046 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22047 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22048 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22049 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22050 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22051 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22052 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22053
22054 @item show task pause
22055 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22056 Show the current state of task suspension.
22057
22058 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22059 @cindex task suspend count
22060 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22061 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22062 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22063
22064 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22065 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22066
22067 @item set task exception-port
22068 @itemx set task excp
22069 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22070 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22071 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22072 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22073
22074 @item set noninvasive
22075 @cindex noninvasive task options
22076 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22077 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22078 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22079 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22080
22081 @item info send-rights
22082 @itemx info receive-rights
22083 @itemx info port-rights
22084 @itemx info port-sets
22085 @itemx info dead-names
22086 @itemx info ports
22087 @itemx info psets
22088 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22089 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22090 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22091 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22092 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22093 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22094 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22095 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22096 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22097
22098 @item set thread pause
22099 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22100 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22101 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22102 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22103 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22104 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22105 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22106 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22107 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22108 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22109 only the current thread.
22110
22111 @item show thread pause
22112 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22113 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22114
22115 @item set thread run
22116 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22117
22118 @item show thread run
22119 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22120
22121 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22122 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22123 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22124 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22125 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22126 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22127 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22128
22129 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22130 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22131 detaching.
22132
22133 @item set thread exception-port
22134 @itemx set thread excp
22135 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22136 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22137 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22138
22139 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22140 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22141 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22142 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22143
22144 @item set thread default
22145 @itemx show thread default
22146 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22147 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22148 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22149 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22150 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22151 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22152 the non-default commands.
22153 @end table
22154
22155 @node Darwin
22156 @subsection Darwin
22157 @cindex Darwin
22158
22159 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22160
22161 @table @code
22162 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22163 @kindex set debug darwin
22164 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22165 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22166
22167 @item show debug darwin
22168 @kindex show debug darwin
22169 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22170
22171 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22172 @kindex set debug mach-o
22173 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22174 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22175 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22176 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22177 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22178 usage.
22179
22180 @item show debug mach-o
22181 @kindex show debug mach-o
22182 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22183
22184 @item set mach-exceptions on
22185 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22186 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22187 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22188 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22189 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22190 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22191
22192 @item show mach-exceptions
22193 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22194 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22195 @end table
22196
22197
22198 @node Embedded OS
22199 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22200
22201 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22202 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22203 architectures.
22204
22205 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22206 various real-time operating systems.
22207
22208 @node Embedded Processors
22209 @section Embedded Processors
22210
22211 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22212 configurations.
22213
22214 @cindex send command to simulator
22215 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22216 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22217
22218 @table @code
22219 @item sim @var{command}
22220 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22221 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22222 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22223 acceptable commands.
22224 @end table
22225
22226
22227 @menu
22228 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22229 * ARM:: ARM
22230 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22231 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22232 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22233 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22234 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22235 * CRIS:: CRIS
22236 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22237 @end menu
22238
22239 @node ARC
22240 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22241 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22242 @cindex ARC specific commands
22243 @cindex ARC600
22244 @cindex ARC700
22245 @cindex ARC EM
22246 @cindex ARC HS
22247
22248 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22249
22250 @table @code
22251 @item set debug arc
22252 @kindex set debug arc
22253 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22254 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22255
22256 @item show debug arc
22257 @kindex show debug arc
22258 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22259
22260 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22261 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22262 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22263
22264 @end table
22265
22266 @node ARM
22267 @subsection ARM
22268
22269 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22270
22271 @table @code
22272 @item set arm disassembler
22273 @kindex set arm
22274 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22275 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22276
22277 @item show arm disassembler
22278 @kindex show arm
22279 Show the current disassembly style.
22280
22281 @item set arm apcs32
22282 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22283 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22284
22285 @item show arm apcs32
22286 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22287
22288 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22289 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22290 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22291
22292 @table @code
22293 @item auto
22294 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22295 @item softfpa
22296 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22297 processors.
22298 @item fpa
22299 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22300 @item softvfp
22301 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22302 @item vfp
22303 VFP co-processor.
22304 @end table
22305
22306 @item show arm fpu
22307 Show the current type of the FPU.
22308
22309 @item set arm abi
22310 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22311
22312 @item show arm abi
22313 Show the currently used ABI.
22314
22315 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22316 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22317 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22318 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22319 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22320 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22321 register).
22322
22323 @item show arm fallback-mode
22324 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22325
22326 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22327 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22328 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22329 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22330 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22331
22332 @item show arm force-mode
22333 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22334
22335 @item set debug arm
22336 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22337 target support subsystem.
22338
22339 @item show debug arm
22340 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22341 @end table
22342
22343 @table @code
22344 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22345 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22346
22347 @table @code
22348 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22349 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22350 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22351 The default value is @code{all}.
22352
22353 @table @code
22354 @item none
22355 @item demon
22356 @item angel
22357 @item redboot
22358 @item all
22359 @end table
22360 @end table
22361 @end table
22362
22363 @node M68K
22364 @subsection M68k
22365
22366 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22367
22368 @node MicroBlaze
22369 @subsection MicroBlaze
22370 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22371 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22372
22373 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22374 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22375 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22376 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22377 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22378 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22379 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22380 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22381 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22382 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22383 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22384
22385 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22386
22387 @table @code
22388 @item target remote :1234
22389 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22390 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22391
22392 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22393 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22394 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22395
22396 @item load
22397 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22398
22399 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22400 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22401
22402 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22403 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22404 @end table
22405
22406 @node MIPS Embedded
22407 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22408
22409 @noindent
22410 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22411
22412 @table @code
22413 @item set mipsfpu double
22414 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22415 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22416 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22417 @itemx show mipsfpu
22418 @kindex set mipsfpu
22419 @kindex show mipsfpu
22420 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22421 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22422 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22423 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22424 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22425 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22426 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22427 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22428 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22429 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22430 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22431 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22432 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22433
22434 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22435 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22436 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22437
22438 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22439 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22440 @end table
22441
22442 @node PowerPC Embedded
22443 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22444
22445 @cindex DVC register
22446 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22447 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22448
22449 @smallexample
22450 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22451 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22452 @end smallexample
22453
22454 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22455 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22456 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22457 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22458 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22459 or newer.
22460
22461 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22462 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22463 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22464 watching variables of scalar types.
22465
22466 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22467 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22468
22469 @smallexample
22470 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22471 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22472 @end smallexample
22473
22474 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22475 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22476
22477 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22478 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22479 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22480 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22481 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22482 use the @code{break-range} command.
22483
22484 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22485
22486 @table @code
22487 @kindex break-range
22488 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22489 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22490 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22491 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22492 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22493 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22494 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22495 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22496 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22497
22498 @kindex set powerpc
22499 @item set powerpc soft-float
22500 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22501 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22502 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22503 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22504
22505 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22506 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22507 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22508 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22509 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22510 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22511 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22512 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22513
22514 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22515 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22516 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22517 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22518 address of its first byte.
22519
22520 @end table
22521
22522 @node AVR
22523 @subsection Atmel AVR
22524 @cindex AVR
22525
22526 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22527 following AVR-specific commands:
22528
22529 @table @code
22530 @item info io_registers
22531 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22532 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22533 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22534 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22535 @end table
22536
22537 @node CRIS
22538 @subsection CRIS
22539 @cindex CRIS
22540
22541 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22542 following CRIS-specific commands:
22543
22544 @table @code
22545 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22546 @cindex CRIS version
22547 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22548 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22549 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22550
22551 @item show cris-version
22552 Show the current CRIS version.
22553
22554 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22555 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22556 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22557 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22558 @code{R59}.
22559
22560 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22561 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22562
22563 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22564 @cindex CRIS mode
22565 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22566 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22567 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22568
22569 @item show cris-mode
22570 Show the current CRIS mode.
22571 @end table
22572
22573 @node Super-H
22574 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22575 @cindex Super-H
22576
22577 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22578 commands:
22579
22580 @table @code
22581 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22582 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22583 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22584 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22585 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22586 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22587 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22588 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22589 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22590 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22591 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22592 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22593
22594 @item show sh calling-convention
22595 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22596 Show the current calling convention setting.
22597
22598 @end table
22599
22600
22601 @node Architectures
22602 @section Architectures
22603
22604 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22605 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22606
22607 @menu
22608 * AArch64::
22609 * i386::
22610 * Alpha::
22611 * MIPS::
22612 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22613 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22614 * PowerPC::
22615 * Nios II::
22616 * Sparc64::
22617 @end menu
22618
22619 @node AArch64
22620 @subsection AArch64
22621 @cindex AArch64 support
22622
22623 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22624 following special commands:
22625
22626 @table @code
22627 @item set debug aarch64
22628 @kindex set debug aarch64
22629 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22630 messages are to be displayed.
22631
22632 @item show debug aarch64
22633 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22634
22635 @end table
22636
22637 @node i386
22638 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22639
22640 @table @code
22641 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22642 @kindex set struct-convention
22643 @cindex struct return convention
22644 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22645 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22646 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22647 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22648 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22649 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22650 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22651 be returned in a register.
22652
22653 @item show struct-convention
22654 @kindex show struct-convention
22655 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22656 from functions.
22657 @end table
22658
22659
22660 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22661 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22662
22663 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22664 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22665 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22666 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22667 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22668 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22669 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22670
22671 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22672 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22673 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22674 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22675 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22676 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22677
22678 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22679 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22680 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22681
22682 @smallexample
22683 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22684 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22685 @end smallexample
22686
22687 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22688 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22689 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22690 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22691 the pointer.
22692
22693 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22694 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22695 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22696 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22697 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22698
22699 @table @code
22700 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22701 @kindex show mpx bound
22702 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22703
22704 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22705 @kindex set mpx bound
22706 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22707 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22708 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22709 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22710 @end table
22711
22712 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22713 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22714 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22715 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22716
22717 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22718 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22719 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22720 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22721 function.
22722
22723 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22724 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22725 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22726 continuing the execution. For example:
22727
22728 @smallexample
22729 $ break *upper
22730 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22731 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22732 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22733 $ print $bnd0
22734 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22735 @end smallexample
22736
22737 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22738 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22739 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22740
22741 @node Alpha
22742 @subsection Alpha
22743
22744 See the following section.
22745
22746 @node MIPS
22747 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22748
22749 @cindex stack on Alpha
22750 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22751 @cindex Alpha stack
22752 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22753 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22754 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22755 find the beginning of a function.
22756
22757 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22758 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22759 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22760 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22761 commands:
22762
22763 @table @code
22764 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22765 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22766 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22767 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22768 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22769 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22770 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22771 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22772
22773 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22774 Display the current limit.
22775 @end table
22776
22777 @noindent
22778 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22779 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22780
22781 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22782 programs:
22783
22784 @table @code
22785 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22786 @kindex set mips abi
22787 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22788 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22789 values of @var{arg} are:
22790
22791 @table @samp
22792 @item auto
22793 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22794 default).
22795 @item o32
22796 @item o64
22797 @item n32
22798 @item n64
22799 @item eabi32
22800 @item eabi64
22801 @end table
22802
22803 @item show mips abi
22804 @kindex show mips abi
22805 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22806
22807 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22808 @kindex set mips compression
22809 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22810 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22811 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22812 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22813 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22814 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22815 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22816 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22817 provided by the executable.
22818
22819 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22820 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22821 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22822 identified as such.
22823
22824 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22825 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22826 implicitly from an executable.
22827
22828 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22829 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22830 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22831 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22832 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22833
22834 @item show mips compression
22835 @kindex show mips compression
22836 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22837 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22838
22839 @item set mipsfpu
22840 @itemx show mipsfpu
22841 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22842
22843 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22844 @kindex set mips mask-address
22845 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22846 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22847 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22848 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22849 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22850
22851 @item show mips mask-address
22852 @kindex show mips mask-address
22853 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22854 not.
22855
22856 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22857 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22858 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22859 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22860 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22861 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22862
22863 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22864 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22865 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22866
22867 @item set debug mips
22868 @kindex set debug mips
22869 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22870 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22871
22872 @item show debug mips
22873 @kindex show debug mips
22874 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22875 @end table
22876
22877
22878 @node HPPA
22879 @subsection HPPA
22880 @cindex HPPA support
22881
22882 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22883 following special commands:
22884
22885 @table @code
22886 @item set debug hppa
22887 @kindex set debug hppa
22888 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22889 messages are to be displayed.
22890
22891 @item show debug hppa
22892 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22893
22894 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22895 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22896 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22897 given @var{address}.
22898
22899 @end table
22900
22901
22902 @node SPU
22903 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22904 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22905 @cindex SPU
22906
22907 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22908 it provides the following special commands:
22909
22910 @table @code
22911 @item info spu event
22912 @kindex info spu
22913 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22914 and pending event status.
22915
22916 @item info spu signal
22917 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22918 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22919 notification channels.
22920
22921 @item info spu mailbox
22922 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22923 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22924 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22925
22926 @item info spu dma
22927 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22928 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22929 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22930
22931 @item info spu proxydma
22932 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22933 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22934 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22935
22936 @end table
22937
22938 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22939 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22940 special commands:
22941
22942 @table @code
22943 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22944 @kindex set spu
22945 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22946 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22947 function. The default is @code{off}.
22948
22949 @item show spu stop-on-load
22950 @kindex show spu
22951 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22952
22953 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22954 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22955 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22956 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22957 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22958 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22959
22960 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22961 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22962
22963 @end table
22964
22965 @node PowerPC
22966 @subsection PowerPC
22967 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22968
22969 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22970 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22971 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22972 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22973 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22974
22975 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22976 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22977 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22978
22979 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22980 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22981
22982 @node Nios II
22983 @subsection Nios II
22984 @cindex Nios II architecture
22985
22986 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22987 it provides the following special commands:
22988
22989 @table @code
22990
22991 @item set debug nios2
22992 @kindex set debug nios2
22993 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22994 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22995
22996 @item show debug nios2
22997 @kindex show debug nios2
22998 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22999 @end table
23000
23001 @node Sparc64
23002 @subsection Sparc64
23003 @cindex Sparc64 support
23004 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23005 @subsubsection ADI Support
23006
23007 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23008 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23009 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23010 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23011 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23012 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23013 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23014 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23015 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23016 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23017 signal.
23018
23019 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23020 ADI-enabled.
23021
23022 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23023 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23024
23025
23026 @table @code
23027 @kindex adi examine
23028 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23029
23030 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23031 cacheline.
23032
23033 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23034 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23035 block size, to display.
23036
23037 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23038 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23039
23040 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23041
23042 @smallexample
23043 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23044 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23045 @end smallexample
23046
23047 @kindex adi assign
23048 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23049
23050 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23051 to an address.
23052
23053 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23054 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23055 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23056
23057 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23058 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23059
23060 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23061
23062 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23063 variable "shmaddr":
23064
23065 @smallexample
23066 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23067 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23068 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23069 @end smallexample
23070
23071 @end table
23072
23073 @node Controlling GDB
23074 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23075
23076 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23077 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23078 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23079 described here.
23080
23081 @menu
23082 * Prompt:: Prompt
23083 * Editing:: Command editing
23084 * Command History:: Command history
23085 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23086 * Numbers:: Numbers
23087 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23088 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23089 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23090 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23091 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23092 @end menu
23093
23094 @node Prompt
23095 @section Prompt
23096
23097 @cindex prompt
23098
23099 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23100 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23101 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23102 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23103 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23104 which one you are talking to.
23105
23106 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23107 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23108 or a prompt that does not.
23109
23110 @table @code
23111 @kindex set prompt
23112 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23113 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23114
23115 @kindex show prompt
23116 @item show prompt
23117 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23118 @end table
23119
23120 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23121 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23122 are:
23123
23124 @table @code
23125 @kindex set extended-prompt
23126 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23127 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23128 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23129 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23130 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23131 is displayed.
23132
23133 For example:
23134
23135 @smallexample
23136 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23137 @end smallexample
23138
23139 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23140 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23141
23142 @kindex show extended-prompt
23143 @item show extended-prompt
23144 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23145 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23146 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23147 @end table
23148
23149 @node Editing
23150 @section Command Editing
23151 @cindex readline
23152 @cindex command line editing
23153
23154 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23155 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23156 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23157 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23158 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23159 debugging sessions.
23160
23161 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23162 command @code{set}.
23163
23164 @table @code
23165 @kindex set editing
23166 @cindex editing
23167 @item set editing
23168 @itemx set editing on
23169 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23170
23171 @item set editing off
23172 Disable command line editing.
23173
23174 @kindex show editing
23175 @item show editing
23176 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23177 @end table
23178
23179 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23180 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23181 @end ifset
23182 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23183 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23184 @end ifclear
23185 for more details about the Readline
23186 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23187 encouraged to read that chapter.
23188
23189 @node Command History
23190 @section Command History
23191 @cindex command history
23192
23193 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23194 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23195 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23196 history facility.
23197
23198 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23199 package, to provide the history facility.
23200 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23201 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23202 @end ifset
23203 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23204 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23205 @end ifclear
23206 for the detailed description of the History library.
23207
23208 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23209 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23210 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23211 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23212 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23213 pressed on a line by itself.
23214
23215 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23216 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23217 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23218 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23219
23220 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23221 history.
23222
23223 @table @code
23224 @cindex history substitution
23225 @cindex history file
23226 @kindex set history filename
23227 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23228 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23229 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23230 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23231 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23232 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23233 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23234 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23235 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23236 is not set.
23237
23238 @cindex save command history
23239 @kindex set history save
23240 @item set history save
23241 @itemx set history save on
23242 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23243 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23244
23245 @item set history save off
23246 Stop recording command history in a file.
23247
23248 @cindex history size
23249 @kindex set history size
23250 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23251 @item set history size @var{size}
23252 @itemx set history size unlimited
23253 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23254 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23255 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23256 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23257 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23258 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23259
23260 @cindex remove duplicate history
23261 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23262 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23263 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23264 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23265 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23266 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23267 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23268 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23269 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23270
23271 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23272 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23273
23274 @end table
23275
23276 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23277 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23278 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23279 @end ifset
23280 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23281 @xref{Event Designators},
23282 @end ifclear
23283 for more details.
23284
23285 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23286 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23287 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23288 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23289 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23290 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23291 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23292 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23293
23294 The commands to control history expansion are:
23295
23296 @table @code
23297 @item set history expansion on
23298 @itemx set history expansion
23299 @kindex set history expansion
23300 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23301
23302 @item set history expansion off
23303 Disable history expansion.
23304
23305 @c @group
23306 @kindex show history
23307 @item show history
23308 @itemx show history filename
23309 @itemx show history save
23310 @itemx show history size
23311 @itemx show history expansion
23312 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23313 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23314 @c @end group
23315 @end table
23316
23317 @table @code
23318 @kindex show commands
23319 @cindex show last commands
23320 @cindex display command history
23321 @item show commands
23322 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23323
23324 @item show commands @var{n}
23325 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23326
23327 @item show commands +
23328 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23329 @end table
23330
23331 @node Screen Size
23332 @section Screen Size
23333 @cindex size of screen
23334 @cindex screen size
23335 @cindex pagination
23336 @cindex page size
23337 @cindex pauses in output
23338
23339 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23340 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23341 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23342 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23343 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23344 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23345 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23346 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23347
23348 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23349 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23350 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23351 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23352 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23353 width} commands:
23354
23355 @table @code
23356 @kindex set height
23357 @kindex set width
23358 @kindex show width
23359 @kindex show height
23360 @item set height @var{lpp}
23361 @itemx set height unlimited
23362 @itemx show height
23363 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23364 @itemx set width unlimited
23365 @itemx show width
23366 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23367 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23368 commands display the current settings.
23369
23370 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23371 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23372 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23373 buffer.
23374
23375 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23376 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23377
23378 @item set pagination on
23379 @itemx set pagination off
23380 @kindex set pagination
23381 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23382 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23383 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23384 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23385
23386 @item show pagination
23387 @kindex show pagination
23388 Show the current pagination mode.
23389 @end table
23390
23391 @node Numbers
23392 @section Numbers
23393 @cindex number representation
23394 @cindex entering numbers
23395
23396 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23397 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23398 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23399 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23400 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23401 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23402 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23403 both input and output with the commands described below.
23404
23405 @table @code
23406 @kindex set input-radix
23407 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23408 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23409 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23410 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23411 example, any of
23412
23413 @smallexample
23414 set input-radix 012
23415 set input-radix 10.
23416 set input-radix 0xa
23417 @end smallexample
23418
23419 @noindent
23420 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23421 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23422 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23423 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23424 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23425 change the radix.
23426
23427 @kindex set output-radix
23428 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23429 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23430 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23431 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23432
23433 @kindex show input-radix
23434 @item show input-radix
23435 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23436
23437 @kindex show output-radix
23438 @item show output-radix
23439 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23440
23441 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23442 @itemx show radix
23443 @kindex set radix
23444 @kindex show radix
23445 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23446 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23447 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23448 default value of 10.
23449
23450 @end table
23451
23452 @node ABI
23453 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23454
23455 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23456 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23457 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23458 current ABI.
23459
23460 @cindex OS ABI
23461 @kindex set osabi
23462 @kindex show osabi
23463 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23464
23465 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23466 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23467 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23468 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23469 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23470 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23471 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23472 platform provides.
23473
23474 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23475 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23476 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23477 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23478
23479 @table @code
23480 @item show osabi
23481 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23482
23483 @item set osabi
23484 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23485
23486 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23487 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23488 @end table
23489
23490 @cindex float promotion
23491
23492 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23493 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23494 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23495 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23496 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23497 @code{double} and then passed.
23498
23499 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23500 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23501 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23502
23503 @table @code
23504 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23505 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23506 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23507 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23508 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23509
23510 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23511 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23512 functions.
23513
23514 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23515 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23516 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23517 @end table
23518
23519 @kindex set cp-abi
23520 @kindex show cp-abi
23521 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23522 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23523 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23524 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23525 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23526 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23527 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23528 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23529 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23530 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23531 ``auto''.
23532
23533 @table @code
23534 @item show cp-abi
23535 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23536
23537 @item set cp-abi
23538 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23539
23540 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23541 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23542 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23543 @end table
23544
23545 @node Auto-loading
23546 @section Automatically loading associated files
23547 @cindex auto-loading
23548
23549 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23550 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23551 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23552 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23553 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23554 sources).
23555
23556 @menu
23557 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23558 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23559
23560 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23561 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23562 @end menu
23563
23564 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23565 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23566 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23567
23568 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23569 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23570 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23571
23572 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23573 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23574
23575 @table @code
23576 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23577 @kindex set auto-load off
23578 @item set auto-load off
23579 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23580 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23581 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23582 @smallexample
23583 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23584 @end smallexample
23585
23586 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23587 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23588 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23589 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23590 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23591 @code{set auto-load no}.
23592
23593 @anchor{show auto-load}
23594 @kindex show auto-load
23595 @item show auto-load
23596 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23597 or disabled.
23598
23599 @smallexample
23600 (gdb) show auto-load
23601 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23602 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23603 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23604 is on.
23605 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23606 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23607 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23608 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23609 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23610 @end smallexample
23611
23612 @anchor{info auto-load}
23613 @kindex info auto-load
23614 @item info auto-load
23615 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23616 not.
23617
23618 @smallexample
23619 (gdb) info auto-load
23620 gdb-scripts:
23621 Loaded Script
23622 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23623 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23624 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23625 loaded.
23626 python-scripts:
23627 Loaded Script
23628 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23629 @end smallexample
23630 @end table
23631
23632 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23633
23634 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23635 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23636 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23637 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23638 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23639 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23640 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23641 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23642 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23643 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23644 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23645 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23646 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23647 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23648 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23649 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23650 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23651 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23652 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23653 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23654 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23655 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23656 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23657 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23658 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23659 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23660 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23661 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23662 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23663 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23664 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23665 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23666 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23667 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23668 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23669 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23670 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23671 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23672 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23673 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23674 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23675 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23676 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23677 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23678 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23679 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23680 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23681 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23682 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23683 @end multitable
23684
23685 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23686 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23687 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23688
23689 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23690 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23691 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23692
23693 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23694 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23695
23696 @table @code
23697 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23698 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23699 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23700 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23701 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23702
23703 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23704 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23705 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23706 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23707 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23708
23709 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23710 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23711 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23712 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23713 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23714 @end table
23715
23716 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23717 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23718 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23719
23720 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23721
23722 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23723 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23724
23725 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23726 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23727 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23728 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23729 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23730 library.
23731
23732 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23733 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23734
23735 @table @code
23736 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23737 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23738 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23739 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23740
23741 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23742 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23743 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23744 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23745 enabled or disabled.
23746
23747 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23748 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23749 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23750 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23751 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23752 @end table
23753
23754 @node Auto-loading safe path
23755 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23756 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23757
23758 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23759 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23760 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23761 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23762 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23763
23764 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23765 get loaded:
23766
23767 @smallexample
23768 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23769 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23770 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23771 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23772 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23773 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23774 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23775 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23776 @end smallexample
23777
23778 @noindent
23779 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23780 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23781
23782 @smallexample
23783 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23784 @end smallexample
23785
23786 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23787
23788 @table @code
23789 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23790 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23791 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23792 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23793 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23794 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23795 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23796 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23797 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23798 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23799
23800 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23801 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23802 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23803
23804 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23805 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23806 @item show auto-load safe-path
23807 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23808 scripts.
23809
23810 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23811 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23812 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23813 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23814 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23815 by the host platform path separator in use.
23816 @end table
23817
23818 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23819 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23820 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23821 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23822 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23823
23824 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23825 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23826 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23827 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23828 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23829 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23830 init file in the current directory
23831 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23832
23833 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23834 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23835
23836 @table @asis
23837 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23838 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23839 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23840 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23841
23842 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23843 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23844 @value{GDBN} session.
23845
23846 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23847 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23848 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23849 from trusted sources.
23850
23851 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23852 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23853 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23854 trusted sources.
23855 @end table
23856
23857 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23858 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23859
23860 @table @asis
23861 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23862 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23863
23864 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23865 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23866 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23867 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23868 @end table
23869
23870 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23871 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23872 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23873 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23874 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23875 recommended to be entered.
23876
23877 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23878 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23879 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23880
23881 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23882 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23883 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23884 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23885 be printed.
23886
23887 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23888 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23889 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23890
23891 @smallexample
23892 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23893 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23894 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23895 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23896 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23897 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23898 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23899 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23900 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23901 @end smallexample
23902
23903 @table @code
23904 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23905 @kindex set debug auto-load
23906 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23907 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23908
23909 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23910 @kindex show debug auto-load
23911 @item show debug auto-load
23912 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23913 on or off.
23914 @end table
23915
23916 @node Messages/Warnings
23917 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23918
23919 @cindex verbose operation
23920 @cindex optional warnings
23921 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23922 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23923 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23924 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23925
23926 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23927 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23928 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23929
23930 @table @code
23931 @kindex set verbose
23932 @item set verbose on
23933 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23934
23935 @item set verbose off
23936 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23937
23938 @kindex show verbose
23939 @item show verbose
23940 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23941 @end table
23942
23943 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23944 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23945 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23946 Symbol Files}).
23947
23948 @table @code
23949
23950 @kindex set complaints
23951 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23952 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23953 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23954 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23955 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23956
23957 @kindex show complaints
23958 @item show complaints
23959 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23960
23961 @end table
23962
23963 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23964 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23965 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23966 you try to run a program which is already running:
23967
23968 @smallexample
23969 (@value{GDBP}) run
23970 The program being debugged has been started already.
23971 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23972 @end smallexample
23973
23974 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23975 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23976
23977 @table @code
23978
23979 @kindex set confirm
23980 @cindex flinching
23981 @cindex confirmation
23982 @cindex stupid questions
23983 @item set confirm off
23984 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23985 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23986 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23987
23988 @item set confirm on
23989 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23990
23991 @kindex show confirm
23992 @item show confirm
23993 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23994
23995 @end table
23996
23997 @cindex command tracing
23998 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23999 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24000 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24001 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24002
24003 @table @code
24004 @kindex set trace-commands
24005 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24006 @item set trace-commands on
24007 Enable command tracing.
24008 @item set trace-commands off
24009 Disable command tracing.
24010 @item show trace-commands
24011 Display the current state of command tracing.
24012 @end table
24013
24014 @node Debugging Output
24015 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24016 @cindex optional debugging messages
24017
24018 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24019 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24020 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24021 section documents those commands.
24022
24023 @table @code
24024 @kindex set exec-done-display
24025 @item set exec-done-display
24026 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24027 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24028 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24029 @kindex show exec-done-display
24030 @item show exec-done-display
24031 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24032 notification.
24033 @kindex set debug
24034 @cindex ARM AArch64
24035 @item set debug aarch64
24036 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24037 The default is off.
24038 @kindex show debug
24039 @item show debug aarch64
24040 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24041 ARM AArch64.
24042 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24043 @cindex architecture debugging info
24044 @item set debug arch
24045 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24046 @item show debug arch
24047 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24048 @item set debug aix-solib
24049 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24050 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24051 support module. The default is off.
24052 @item show debug aix-thread
24053 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24054 @item set debug aix-thread
24055 @cindex AIX threads
24056 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24057 module.
24058 @item show debug aix-thread
24059 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24060 @item set debug check-physname
24061 @cindex physname
24062 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24063 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24064 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24065 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24066 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24067 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24068 @item show debug check-physname
24069 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24070 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24071 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24072 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24073 exported symbols. The default is off.
24074 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24075 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24076 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24077 @item set debug dwarf-die
24078 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24079 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24080 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24081 A value of zero turns off the display.
24082 @item show debug dwarf-die
24083 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24084 @item set debug dwarf-line
24085 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24086 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24087 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24088 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24089 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24090 @item show debug dwarf-line
24091 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24092 @item set debug dwarf-read
24093 @cindex DWARF Reading
24094 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24095 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24096 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24097 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24098 @item show debug dwarf-read
24099 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24100 @item set debug displaced
24101 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24102 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24103 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24104 @item show debug displaced
24105 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24106 related to displaced stepping.
24107 @item set debug event
24108 @cindex event debugging info
24109 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24110 default is off.
24111 @item show debug event
24112 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24113 info.
24114 @item set debug expression
24115 @cindex expression debugging info
24116 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24117 expression parsing. The default is off.
24118 @item show debug expression
24119 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24120 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24121 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24122 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24123 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24124 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24125 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24126 @item set debug frame
24127 @cindex frame debugging info
24128 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24129 default is off.
24130 @item show debug frame
24131 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24132 info.
24133 @item set debug gnu-nat
24134 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24135 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24136 @item show debug gnu-nat
24137 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24138 @item set debug infrun
24139 @cindex inferior debugging info
24140 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24141 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24142 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24143 @item show debug infrun
24144 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24145 @item set debug jit
24146 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24147 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24148 @item show debug jit
24149 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24150 @item set debug lin-lwp
24151 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24152 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24153 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24154 @item show debug lin-lwp
24155 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24156 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24157 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24158 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24159 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24160 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24161 @item set debug mach-o
24162 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24163 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24164 processing. The default is off.
24165 @item show debug mach-o
24166 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24167 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24168 @item set debug notification
24169 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24170 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24171 The default is off.
24172 @item show debug notification
24173 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24174 @item set debug observer
24175 @cindex observer debugging info
24176 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24177 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24178 @item show debug observer
24179 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24180 @item set debug overload
24181 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24182 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24183 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24184 is off.
24185 @item show debug overload
24186 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24187 debugging info.
24188 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24189 @cindex debug expression parser
24190 @item set debug parser
24191 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24192 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24193 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24194 details. The default is off.
24195 @item show debug parser
24196 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24197 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24198 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24199 @cindex debug remote protocol
24200 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24201 @cindex display remote packets
24202 @item set debug remote
24203 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24204 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24205 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24206 @item show debug remote
24207 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24208
24209 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24210 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24211 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24212 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24213
24214 @item set debug serial
24215 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24216 default is off.
24217 @item show debug serial
24218 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24219 info.
24220 @item set debug solib-frv
24221 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24222 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24223 @item show debug solib-frv
24224 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24225 messages.
24226 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24227 @cindex symbol lookup
24228 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24229 The default is 0 (off).
24230 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24231 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24232 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24233 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24234 @item set debug symfile
24235 @cindex symbol file functions
24236 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24237 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24238 @item show debug symfile
24239 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24240 @item set debug symtab-create
24241 @cindex symbol table creation
24242 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24243 The default is 0 (off).
24244 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24245 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24246 @item show debug symtab-create
24247 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24248 @item set debug target
24249 @cindex target debugging info
24250 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24251 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24252 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24253 value of large memory transfers.
24254 @item show debug target
24255 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24256 info.
24257 @item set debug timestamp
24258 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24259 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24260 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24261 message.
24262 @item show debug timestamp
24263 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24264 debugging info.
24265 @item set debug varobj
24266 @cindex variable object debugging info
24267 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24268 info. The default is off.
24269 @item show debug varobj
24270 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24271 debugging info.
24272 @item set debug xml
24273 @cindex XML parser debugging
24274 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24275 @item show debug xml
24276 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24277 @end table
24278
24279 @node Other Misc Settings
24280 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24281 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24282
24283 @table @code
24284 @kindex set interactive-mode
24285 @item set interactive-mode
24286 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24287 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24288 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24289 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24290 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24291 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24292 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24293 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24294
24295 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24296 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24297 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24298 inside a cygwin window.
24299
24300 @kindex show interactive-mode
24301 @item show interactive-mode
24302 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24303 @end table
24304
24305 @node Extending GDB
24306 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24307 @cindex extending GDB
24308
24309 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24310 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24311 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24312 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24313 being debugged.
24314
24315 @menu
24316 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24317 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24318 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24319 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24320 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24321 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24322 @end menu
24323
24324 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24325 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24326 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24327 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24328 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24329 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24330
24331 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24332 setting:
24333
24334 @table @code
24335 @kindex set script-extension
24336 @kindex show script-extension
24337 @item set script-extension off
24338 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24339
24340 @item set script-extension soft
24341 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24342 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24343 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24344 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24345
24346 @item set script-extension strict
24347 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24348 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24349 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24350
24351 @item show script-extension
24352 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24353
24354 @end table
24355
24356 @node Sequences
24357 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24358
24359 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24360 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24361 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24362 files.
24363
24364 @menu
24365 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24366 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24367 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24368 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24369 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24370 @end menu
24371
24372 @node Define
24373 @subsection User-defined Commands
24374
24375 @cindex user-defined command
24376 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24377 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24378 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24379 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24380 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24381 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24382
24383 @smallexample
24384 define adder
24385 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24386 end
24387 @end smallexample
24388
24389 @noindent
24390 To execute the command use:
24391
24392 @smallexample
24393 adder 1 2 3
24394 @end smallexample
24395
24396 @noindent
24397 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24398 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24399 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24400 functions calls.
24401
24402 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24403 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24404 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24405 been passed.
24406
24407 @smallexample
24408 define adder
24409 if $argc == 2
24410 print $arg0 + $arg1
24411 end
24412 if $argc == 3
24413 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24414 end
24415 end
24416 @end smallexample
24417
24418 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24419 to process a variable number of arguments:
24420
24421 @smallexample
24422 define adder
24423 set $i = 0
24424 set $sum = 0
24425 while $i < $argc
24426 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24427 set $i = $i + 1
24428 end
24429 print $sum
24430 end
24431 @end smallexample
24432
24433 @table @code
24434
24435 @kindex define
24436 @item define @var{commandname}
24437 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24438 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24439 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24440 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24441 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24442 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24443
24444 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24445 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24446 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24447
24448 @kindex document
24449 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24450 @item document @var{commandname}
24451 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24452 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24453 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24454 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24455 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24456 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24457
24458 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24459 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24460 does not change the documentation.
24461
24462 @kindex dont-repeat
24463 @cindex don't repeat command
24464 @item dont-repeat
24465 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24466 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24467 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24468
24469 @kindex help user-defined
24470 @item help user-defined
24471 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24472 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24473 included (if any).
24474
24475 @kindex show user
24476 @item show user
24477 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24478 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24479 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24480 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24481 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24482
24483 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24484 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24485 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24486 @item show max-user-call-depth
24487 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24488 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24489 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24490 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24491 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24492 @end table
24493
24494 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24495 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24496
24497 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24498 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24499 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24500
24501 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24502 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24503 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24504 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24505
24506 @node Hooks
24507 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24508 @cindex command hooks
24509 @cindex hooks, for commands
24510 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24511
24512 @kindex hook
24513 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24514 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24515 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24516 before that command.
24517
24518 @cindex hooks, post-command
24519 @kindex hookpost
24520 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24521 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24522 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24523 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24524 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24525
24526 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24527 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24528
24529 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24530 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24531
24532 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24533 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24534 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24535 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24536 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24537
24538 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24539 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24540 you could define:
24541
24542 @smallexample
24543 define hook-stop
24544 handle SIGALRM nopass
24545 end
24546
24547 define hook-run
24548 handle SIGALRM pass
24549 end
24550
24551 define hook-continue
24552 handle SIGALRM pass
24553 end
24554 @end smallexample
24555
24556 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24557 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24558 you could define:
24559
24560 @smallexample
24561 define hook-echo
24562 echo <<<---
24563 end
24564
24565 define hookpost-echo
24566 echo --->>>\n
24567 end
24568
24569 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24570 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24571 (@value{GDBP})
24572
24573 @end smallexample
24574
24575 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24576 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24577 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24578 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24579 @c or not?
24580 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24581 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24582 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24583
24584 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24585 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24586 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24587
24588 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24589 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24590
24591 @node Command Files
24592 @subsection Command Files
24593
24594 @cindex command files
24595 @cindex scripting commands
24596 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24597 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24598 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24599 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24600 terminal.
24601
24602 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24603 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24604 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24605 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24606 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24607
24608 @table @code
24609 @kindex source
24610 @cindex execute commands from a file
24611 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24612 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24613 @end table
24614
24615 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24616 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24617 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24618 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24619 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24620
24621 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24622 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24623 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24624 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24625 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24626 is not relevant to scripts.
24627
24628 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24629 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24630 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24631 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24632 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24633 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24634 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24635 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24636 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24637 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24638 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24639 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24640 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24641 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24642
24643 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24644 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24645 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24646
24647 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24648 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24649 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24650 when called from command files.
24651
24652 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24653 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24654 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24655 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24656 the next command.
24657
24658 @smallexample
24659 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24660 @end smallexample
24661
24662 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24663 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24664 would be directed to @file{log}.
24665
24666 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24667 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24668 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24669 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24670 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24671 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24672 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24673 conditionally, etc.
24674
24675 @table @code
24676 @kindex if
24677 @kindex else
24678 @item if
24679 @itemx else
24680 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24681 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24682 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24683 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24684 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24685 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24686 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24687
24688 @kindex while
24689 @item while
24690 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24691 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24692 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24693 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24694 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24695 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24696
24697 @kindex loop_break
24698 @item loop_break
24699 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24700 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24701 line.
24702
24703 @kindex loop_continue
24704 @item loop_continue
24705 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24706 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24707 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24708 the controlling expression.
24709
24710 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24711 @item end
24712 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24713 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24714 @end table
24715
24716
24717 @node Output
24718 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24719
24720 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24721 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24722 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24723 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24724 want.
24725
24726 @table @code
24727 @kindex echo
24728 @item echo @var{text}
24729 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24730 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24731 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24732 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24733 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24734 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24735 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24736 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24737 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24738 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24739 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24740
24741 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24742 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24743
24744 @smallexample
24745 echo This is some text\n\
24746 which is continued\n\
24747 onto several lines.\n
24748 @end smallexample
24749
24750 produces the same output as
24751
24752 @smallexample
24753 echo This is some text\n
24754 echo which is continued\n
24755 echo onto several lines.\n
24756 @end smallexample
24757
24758 @kindex output
24759 @item output @var{expression}
24760 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24761 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24762 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24763 on expressions.
24764
24765 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24766 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24767 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24768 Formats}, for more information.
24769
24770 @kindex printf
24771 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24772 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24773 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24774 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24775 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24776 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24777 executing the code below:
24778
24779 @smallexample
24780 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24781 @end smallexample
24782
24783 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24784 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24785 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24786 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24787 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24788 printed.
24789
24790 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24791
24792 @smallexample
24793 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24794 @end smallexample
24795
24796 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24797 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24798 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24799
24800 @itemize @bullet
24801 @item
24802 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24803
24804 @item
24805 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24806 width.
24807
24808 @item
24809 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24810 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24811
24812 @item
24813 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24814 supported.
24815
24816 @item
24817 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24818
24819 @item
24820 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24821 @end itemize
24822
24823 @noindent
24824 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24825 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24826 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24827 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24828
24829 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24830 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24831 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24832 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24833 supported.
24834
24835 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24836 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24837 together with a floating point specifier.
24838 letters:
24839
24840 @itemize @bullet
24841 @item
24842 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24843
24844 @item
24845 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24846
24847 @item
24848 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24849 @end itemize
24850
24851 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24852 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24853 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24854
24855 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24856 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24857
24858 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24859 @smallexample
24860 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24861 @end smallexample
24862
24863 @anchor{eval}
24864 @kindex eval
24865 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24866 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24867 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24868
24869 @end table
24870
24871 @node Auto-loading sequences
24872 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24873 @cindex native script auto-loading
24874
24875 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24876 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24877 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24878 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24879
24880 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24881 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24882
24883 @table @code
24884 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24885 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24886 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24887 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24888
24889 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24890 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24891 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24892 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24893 disabled.
24894
24895 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24896 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24897 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24898 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24899 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24900 auto-loaded.
24901 @end table
24902
24903 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24904 matching names are printed.
24905
24906 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24907 @include python.texi
24908
24909 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24910 @include guile.texi
24911
24912 @node Auto-loading extensions
24913 @section Auto-loading extensions
24914 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24915
24916 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24917 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24918 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24919 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24920 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24921
24922 @menu
24923 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24924 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24925 * Which flavor to choose?::
24926 @end menu
24927
24928 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24929 debugging commands and features.
24930
24931 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24932 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24933 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24934 for more information.
24935 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24936 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24937
24938 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24939 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24940
24941 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24942 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24943 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24944 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24945 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24946
24947 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24948 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24949 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24950 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24951
24952 @table @code
24953 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24954 GDB's own command language
24955 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24956 Python
24957 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24958 Guile
24959 @end table
24960
24961 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24962 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24963 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24964 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24965 script in the specified extension language.
24966
24967 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24968 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24969
24970 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24971 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24972
24973 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24974 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24975 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24976 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24977 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24978 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24979
24980 @table @code
24981 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24982 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24983 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24984 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24985 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24986 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24987
24988 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24989 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24990
24991 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24992 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24993 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24994 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24995
24996 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24997 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24998 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24999 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25000 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25001 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25002 platform.
25003
25004 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25005 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25006 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25007
25008 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25009 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25010 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25011 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25012
25013 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25014 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25015 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25016 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25017 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25018 @end table
25019
25020 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25021 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25022 @var{objfile} is opened.
25023 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25024 is evaluated more than once.
25025
25026 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25027 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25028 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25029
25030 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25031 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25032 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25033 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25034 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25035 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25036 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25037
25038 The following entries are supported:
25039
25040 @table @code
25041 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25042 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25043 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25044 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25045 @end table
25046
25047 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25048
25049 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25050 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25051 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25052 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25053 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25054
25055 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25056 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25057
25058 @example
25059 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25060 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25061 asm("\
25062 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25063 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25064 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25065 .popsection \n\
25066 ");
25067 @end example
25068
25069 @noindent
25070 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25071 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25072
25073 @example
25074 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25075 @end example
25076
25077 The script name may include directories if desired.
25078
25079 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25080 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25081
25082 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25083 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25084 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25085 will remove duplicates.
25086
25087 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25088
25089 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25090 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25091 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25092 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25093 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25094 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25095 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25096 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25097 on its name.
25098
25099 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25100 testsuite.
25101
25102 @example
25103 #include "symcat.h"
25104 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25105 asm(
25106 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25107 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25108 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25109 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25110 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25111 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25112 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25113 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25114 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25115 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25116 ".byte 0\n"
25117 ".popsection\n"
25118 );
25119 @end example
25120
25121 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25122 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25123 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25124 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25125
25126 @node Which flavor to choose?
25127 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25128
25129 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25130 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25131
25132 @noindent
25133 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25134
25135 @itemize @bullet
25136 @item
25137 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25138
25139 @item
25140 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25141
25142 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25143 in the source search path.
25144 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25145 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25146
25147 @item
25148 Doesn't require source code additions.
25149 @end itemize
25150
25151 @noindent
25152 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25153
25154 @itemize @bullet
25155 @item
25156 Works with static linking.
25157
25158 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25159 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25160 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25161 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25162 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25163
25164 @item
25165 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25166
25167 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25168 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25169
25170 @item
25171 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25172
25173 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25174 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25175 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25176 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25177 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25178 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25179 @end itemize
25180
25181 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25182 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25183
25184 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25185 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25186 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25187
25188 @subsection Python comes first
25189
25190 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25191 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25192 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25193 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25194 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25195 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25196 pretty-printed form of a value).
25197 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25198 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25199 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25200
25201 @node Aliases
25202 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25203 @cindex aliases for commands
25204
25205 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25206 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25207 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25208 that involves less typing.
25209
25210 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25211 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25212 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25213
25214 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25215 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25216 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25217
25218 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25219
25220 @table @code
25221
25222 @kindex alias
25223 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25224
25225 @end table
25226
25227 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25228 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25229 underscores.
25230
25231 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25232 that is being aliased.
25233
25234 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25235 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25236 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25237
25238 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25239 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25240
25241 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25242 of a command so that there is less to type.
25243 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25244 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25245 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25246 The following will accomplish this.
25247
25248 @smallexample
25249 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25250 @end smallexample
25251
25252 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25253 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25254 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25255 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25256
25257 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25258 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25259 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25260 of a command.
25261
25262 @smallexample
25263 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25264 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25265 (gdb) set p elms 20
25266 (gdb) show p elms
25267 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25268 @end smallexample
25269
25270 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25271 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25272 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25273
25274 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25275 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25276
25277 @smallexample
25278 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25279 @end smallexample
25280
25281 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25282 alias for a more complex command.
25283 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25284
25285 @smallexample
25286 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25287 (gdb) spe 20
25288 @end smallexample
25289
25290 @node Interpreters
25291 @chapter Command Interpreters
25292 @cindex command interpreters
25293
25294 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25295 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25296 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25297
25298 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25299 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25300 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25301 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25302
25303 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25304 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25305 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25306 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25307
25308 @table @code
25309 @item console
25310 @cindex console interpreter
25311 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25312 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25313 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25314
25315 @item mi
25316 @cindex mi interpreter
25317 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25318 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25319 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25320 Interface}.
25321
25322 @item mi2
25323 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25324 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25325
25326 @item mi1
25327 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25328 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25329
25330 @end table
25331
25332 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25333
25334 @kindex interpreter-exec
25335 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25336 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25337 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25338
25339 @smallexample
25340 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25341 @end smallexample
25342
25343 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25344 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25345
25346 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25347 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25348 permanently.
25349
25350 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25351
25352 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25353 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25354 device (usually a tty).
25355
25356 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25357 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25358 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25359 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25360 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25361 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25362 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25363 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25364 the separate MI interpreter.
25365
25366 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25367 @code{new-ui} command:
25368
25369 @kindex new-ui
25370 @cindex new user interface
25371 @smallexample
25372 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25373 @end smallexample
25374
25375 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25376 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25377 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25378 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25379 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25380 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25381
25382 @smallexample
25383 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25384 @end smallexample
25385
25386 @noindent
25387 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25388
25389 @node TUI
25390 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25391 @cindex TUI
25392 @cindex Text User Interface
25393
25394 @menu
25395 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25396 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25397 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25398 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25399 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25400 @end menu
25401
25402 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25403 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25404 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25405 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25406 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25407 is available.
25408
25409 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25410 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25411 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25412 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25413 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25414 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25415
25416 @node TUI Overview
25417 @section TUI Overview
25418
25419 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25420
25421 @table @emph
25422 @item command
25423 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25424 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25425 managed using readline.
25426
25427 @item source
25428 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25429 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25430
25431 @item assembly
25432 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25433
25434 @item register
25435 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25436 when their values change.
25437 @end table
25438
25439 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25440 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25441 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25442 indicates the breakpoint type:
25443
25444 @table @code
25445 @item B
25446 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25447
25448 @item b
25449 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25450
25451 @item H
25452 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25453
25454 @item h
25455 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25456 @end table
25457
25458 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25459
25460 @table @code
25461 @item +
25462 Breakpoint is enabled.
25463
25464 @item -
25465 Breakpoint is disabled.
25466 @end table
25467
25468 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25469 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25470 changes.
25471
25472 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25473 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25474 layouts:
25475
25476 @itemize @bullet
25477 @item
25478 source only,
25479
25480 @item
25481 assembly only,
25482
25483 @item
25484 source and assembly,
25485
25486 @item
25487 source and registers, or
25488
25489 @item
25490 assembly and registers.
25491 @end itemize
25492
25493 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25494
25495 @table @emph
25496 @item target
25497 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25498 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25499
25500 @item process
25501 Gives the current process or thread number.
25502 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25503
25504 @item function
25505 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25506 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25507 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25508 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25509
25510 @item line
25511 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25512 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25513
25514 @item pc
25515 Indicates the current program counter address.
25516 @end table
25517
25518 @node TUI Keys
25519 @section TUI Key Bindings
25520 @cindex TUI key bindings
25521
25522 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25523 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25524 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25525 @end ifset
25526 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25527 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25528 @end ifclear
25529 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25530 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25531
25532 @table @kbd
25533 @kindex C-x C-a
25534 @item C-x C-a
25535 @kindex C-x a
25536 @itemx C-x a
25537 @kindex C-x A
25538 @itemx C-x A
25539 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25540 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25541 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25542 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25543 The screen is then refreshed.
25544
25545 @kindex C-x 1
25546 @item C-x 1
25547 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25548 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25549 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25550
25551 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25552
25553 @kindex C-x 2
25554 @item C-x 2
25555 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25556 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25557 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25558 previous layout and the new one.
25559
25560 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25561
25562 @kindex C-x o
25563 @item C-x o
25564 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25565 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25566 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25567
25568 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25569
25570 @kindex C-x s
25571 @item C-x s
25572 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25573 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25574 @end table
25575
25576 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25577
25578 @table @asis
25579 @kindex PgUp
25580 @item @key{PgUp}
25581 Scroll the active window one page up.
25582
25583 @kindex PgDn
25584 @item @key{PgDn}
25585 Scroll the active window one page down.
25586
25587 @kindex Up
25588 @item @key{Up}
25589 Scroll the active window one line up.
25590
25591 @kindex Down
25592 @item @key{Down}
25593 Scroll the active window one line down.
25594
25595 @kindex Left
25596 @item @key{Left}
25597 Scroll the active window one column left.
25598
25599 @kindex Right
25600 @item @key{Right}
25601 Scroll the active window one column right.
25602
25603 @kindex C-L
25604 @item @kbd{C-L}
25605 Refresh the screen.
25606 @end table
25607
25608 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25609 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25610 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25611 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25612 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25613
25614 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25615 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25616 @cindex TUI single key mode
25617
25618 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25619 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25620 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25621
25622 @table @kbd
25623 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25624 @item c
25625 continue
25626
25627 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25628 @item d
25629 down
25630
25631 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25632 @item f
25633 finish
25634
25635 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25636 @item n
25637 next
25638
25639 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25640 @item o
25641 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25642
25643 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25644 @item q
25645 exit the SingleKey mode.
25646
25647 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25648 @item r
25649 run
25650
25651 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25652 @item s
25653 step
25654
25655 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25656 @item i
25657 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25658
25659 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25660 @item u
25661 up
25662
25663 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25664 @item v
25665 info locals
25666
25667 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25668 @item w
25669 where
25670 @end table
25671
25672 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25673 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25674 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25675 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25676 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25677 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25678
25679
25680 @node TUI Commands
25681 @section TUI-specific Commands
25682 @cindex TUI commands
25683
25684 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25685 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25686 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25687 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25688
25689 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25690 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25691 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25692 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25693 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25694
25695 @table @code
25696 @item tui enable
25697 @kindex tui enable
25698 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25699 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25700 otherwise a default layout is used.
25701
25702 @item tui disable
25703 @kindex tui disable
25704 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25705
25706 @item info win
25707 @kindex info win
25708 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25709
25710 @item layout @var{name}
25711 @kindex layout
25712 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25713 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25714 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25715
25716 @table @code
25717 @item next
25718 Display the next layout.
25719
25720 @item prev
25721 Display the previous layout.
25722
25723 @item src
25724 Display the source and command windows.
25725
25726 @item asm
25727 Display the assembly and command windows.
25728
25729 @item split
25730 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25731
25732 @item regs
25733 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25734 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25735 register, assembler, and command windows.
25736 @end table
25737
25738 @item focus @var{name}
25739 @kindex focus
25740 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25741 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25742
25743 @table @code
25744 @item next
25745 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25746
25747 @item prev
25748 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25749
25750 @item src
25751 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25752
25753 @item asm
25754 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25755
25756 @item regs
25757 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25758
25759 @item cmd
25760 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25761 @end table
25762
25763 @item refresh
25764 @kindex refresh
25765 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25766
25767 @item tui reg @var{group}
25768 @kindex tui reg
25769 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25770 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25771 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25772 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25773 following groups are available on most targets:
25774 @table @code
25775 @item next
25776 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25777 through all of the available register groups.
25778
25779 @item prev
25780 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25781 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25782 @var{next}.
25783
25784 @item general
25785 Display the general registers.
25786 @item float
25787 Display the floating point registers.
25788 @item system
25789 Display the system registers.
25790 @item vector
25791 Display the vector registers.
25792 @item all
25793 Display all registers.
25794 @end table
25795
25796 @item update
25797 @kindex update
25798 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25799
25800 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25801 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25802 @kindex winheight
25803 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25804 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25805 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25806 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25807 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25808
25809 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25810 @kindex tabset
25811 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25812 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25813 assembly windows.
25814 @end table
25815
25816 @node TUI Configuration
25817 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25818 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25819
25820 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25821
25822 @table @code
25823 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25824 @kindex set tui border-kind
25825 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25826 The possible values are the following:
25827 @table @code
25828 @item space
25829 Use a space character to draw the border.
25830
25831 @item ascii
25832 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25833
25834 @item acs
25835 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25836 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25837 @end table
25838
25839 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25840 @kindex set tui border-mode
25841 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25842 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25843 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25844 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25845 @table @code
25846 @item normal
25847 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25848
25849 @item standout
25850 Use standout mode.
25851
25852 @item reverse
25853 Use reverse video mode.
25854
25855 @item half
25856 Use half bright mode.
25857
25858 @item half-standout
25859 Use half bright and standout mode.
25860
25861 @item bold
25862 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25863
25864 @item bold-standout
25865 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25866 @end table
25867 @end table
25868
25869 @node Emacs
25870 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25871
25872 @cindex Emacs
25873 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25874 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25875 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25876 @value{GDBN}.
25877
25878 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25879 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25880 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25881 created Emacs buffer.
25882 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25883
25884 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25885 things:
25886
25887 @itemize @bullet
25888 @item
25889 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25890 the GUD buffer.
25891
25892 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25893 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25894
25895 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25896 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25897 in this way.
25898
25899 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25900 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25901 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25902 stop.
25903
25904 @item
25905 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25906
25907 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25908 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25909 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25910 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25911 and the source.
25912
25913 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25914 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25915 @end itemize
25916
25917 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25918 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25919 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25920 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25921
25922 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25923 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25924 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25925 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25926 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25927 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25928 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25929 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25930 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25931
25932 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25933 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25934 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25935 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25936
25937 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25938 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25939 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25940 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25941 one you want.
25942
25943 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25944 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25945
25946 @table @kbd
25947 @item C-h m
25948 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25949
25950 @item C-c C-s
25951 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25952 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25953
25954 @item C-c C-n
25955 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25956 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25957 to show the current file and location.
25958
25959 @item C-c C-i
25960 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25961 display window accordingly.
25962
25963 @item C-c C-f
25964 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25965 @code{finish} command.
25966
25967 @item C-c C-r
25968 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25969 command.
25970
25971 @item C-c <
25972 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25973 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25974 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25975
25976 @item C-c >
25977 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25978 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25979 @end table
25980
25981 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25982 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25983
25984 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25985 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25986 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25987 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25988 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25989 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25990 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25991
25992 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25993 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25994 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25995 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25996 frame.
25997
25998 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25999 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26000 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26001 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26002 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26003 to correspond properly with the code.
26004
26005 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26006 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26007 Emacs Manual}).
26008
26009 @node GDB/MI
26010 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26011
26012 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26013
26014 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26015 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26016 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26017 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26018 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26019 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26020
26021 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26022 in the form of a reference manual.
26023
26024 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26025 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26026 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26027
26028 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26029
26030 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26031 This chapter uses the following notation:
26032
26033 @itemize @bullet
26034 @item
26035 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26036
26037 @item
26038 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26039 it may or may not be given.
26040
26041 @item
26042 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26043 may repeat zero or more times.
26044
26045 @item
26046 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26047 may repeat one or more times.
26048
26049 @item
26050 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26051 @end itemize
26052
26053 @ignore
26054 @heading Dependencies
26055 @end ignore
26056
26057 @menu
26058 * GDB/MI General Design::
26059 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26060 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26061 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26062 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26063 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26064 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26065 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26066 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26067 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26068 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26069 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26070 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26071 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26072 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26073 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26074 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26075 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26076 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26077 @ignore
26078 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26079 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26080 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26081 @end ignore
26082 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26083 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26084 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26085 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26086 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26087 @end menu
26088
26089 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26090 @node GDB/MI General Design
26091 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26092 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26093
26094 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26095 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26096 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26097 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26098 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26099 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26100 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26101 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26102 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26103 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26104
26105 The important examples of notifications are:
26106 @itemize @bullet
26107
26108 @item
26109 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26110 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26111 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26112 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26113 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26114 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26115 command itself was successfully executed.
26116
26117 @item
26118 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26119 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26120 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26121 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26122 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26123 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26124
26125 @item
26126 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26127 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26128 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26129 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26130 orthogonal frontend design.
26131
26132 @end itemize
26133
26134 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26135 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26136 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26137 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26138 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26139 the user interface.
26140
26141
26142 @menu
26143 * Context management::
26144 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26145 * Thread groups::
26146 @end menu
26147
26148 @node Context management
26149 @subsection Context management
26150
26151 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26152
26153 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26154 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26155 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26156 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26157 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26158 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26159 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26160 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26161 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26162
26163 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26164 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26165 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26166 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26167 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26168 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26169 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26170 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26171 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26172 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26173 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26174
26175 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26176 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26177 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26178 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26179 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26180 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26181 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26182 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26183 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26184 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26185
26186 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26187 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26188 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26189 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26190 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26191 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26192 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26193 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26194 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26195 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26196 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26197 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26198 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26199 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26200 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26201 @samp{--frame} options.
26202
26203 @subsubsection Language
26204
26205 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26206 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26207 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26208 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26209 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26210 For instance:
26211
26212 @smallexample
26213 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26214 ^done,value="4"
26215 (gdb)
26216 @end smallexample
26217
26218 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26219 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26220 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26221
26222 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26223 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26224
26225 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26226 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26227 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26228 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26229 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26230 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26231 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26232 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26233 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26234
26235 @table @code
26236 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26237 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26238 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26239
26240 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26241 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26242 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26243
26244 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26245 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26246 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26247 MI commands even while the target is running.
26248
26249 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26250 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26251 @end table
26252
26253 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26254 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26255 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26256 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26257 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26258 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26259
26260 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26261 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26262 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26263 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26264 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26265 are running.
26266
26267 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26268 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26269 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26270 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26271 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26272 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26273 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26274 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26275 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26276 @samp{--thread} option).
26277
26278 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26279 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26280 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26281 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26282
26283 @node Thread groups
26284 @subsection Thread groups
26285 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26286 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26287 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26288 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26289 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26290
26291 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26292 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26293 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26294 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26295 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26296 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26297 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26298 into processes.
26299
26300 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26301 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26302 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26303 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26304 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26305 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26306 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26307 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26308 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26309 the members of specific thread group.
26310
26311 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26312 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26313 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26314 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26315 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26316 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26317 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26318 after attaching to that thread group.
26319
26320 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26321 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26322 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26323 such thread groups.
26324
26325 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26326 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26327 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26328
26329 @menu
26330 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26331 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26332 @end menu
26333
26334 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26335 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26336
26337 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26338 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26339 @table @code
26340 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26341 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26342
26343 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26344 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26345 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26346
26347 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26348 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26349 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26350
26351 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26352 "any sequence of digits"
26353
26354 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26355 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26356
26357 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26358 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26359
26360 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26361 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26362
26363 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26364 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26365 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26366
26367 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26368 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26369
26370 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26371 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26372 @end table
26373
26374 @noindent
26375 Notes:
26376
26377 @itemize @bullet
26378 @item
26379 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26380 output is described below.
26381
26382 @item
26383 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26384 finishes.
26385
26386 @item
26387 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26388 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26389 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26390 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26391 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26392 @end itemize
26393
26394 Pragmatics:
26395
26396 @itemize @bullet
26397 @item
26398 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26399
26400 @item
26401 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26402 @end itemize
26403
26404 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26405 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26406
26407 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26408 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26409 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26410 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26411 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26412 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26413
26414 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26415 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26416 @var{token}.
26417
26418 @table @code
26419 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26420 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26421
26422 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26423 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26424
26425 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26426 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26427
26428 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26429 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26430
26431 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26432 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26433
26434 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26435 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26436
26437 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26438 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26439
26440 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26441 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26442
26443 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26444 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26445
26446 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26447 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26448 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26449
26450 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26451 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26452
26453 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26454 @code{ @var{string} }
26455
26456 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26457 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26458
26459 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26460 @code{@var{c-string}}
26461
26462 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26463 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26464
26465 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26466 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26467 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26468
26469 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26470 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26471
26472 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26473 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26474
26475 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26476 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26477
26478 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26479 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26480
26481 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26482 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26483
26484 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26485 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26486 @end table
26487
26488 @noindent
26489 Notes:
26490
26491 @itemize @bullet
26492 @item
26493 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26494
26495 @item
26496 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26497 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26498 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26499 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26500 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26501 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26502 prior command.
26503
26504 @item
26505 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26506 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26507 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26508 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26509
26510 @item
26511 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26512 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26513 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26514 @samp{*}.
26515
26516 @item
26517 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26518 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26519 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26520 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26521
26522 @item
26523 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26524 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26525 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26526 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26527
26528 @item
26529 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26530 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26531 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26532
26533 @item
26534 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26535 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26536 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26537 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26538
26539 @item
26540 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26541 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26542 @var{values}.
26543
26544
26545 @end itemize
26546
26547 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26548 details about the various output records.
26549
26550 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26551 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26552 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26553
26554 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26555 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26556
26557 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26558 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26559 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26560 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26561 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26562 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26563
26564 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26565 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26566 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26567
26568 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26569 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26570 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26571 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26572
26573 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26574 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26575
26576 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26577 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26578 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26579 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26580 might change.
26581
26582 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26583 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26584 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26585 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26586
26587 @itemize @bullet
26588 @item
26589 New MI commands may be added.
26590
26591 @item
26592 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26593
26594 @item
26595 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26596 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26597
26598 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26599 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26600
26601 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26602 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26603 @end itemize
26604
26605 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26606 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26607 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26608 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26609 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26610
26611 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26612 @c version?
26613
26614 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26615 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26616 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26617 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26618 @cindex mailing lists
26619
26620 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26621 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26622 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26623
26624 @menu
26625 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26626 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26627 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26628 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26629 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26630 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26631 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26632 @end menu
26633
26634 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26635 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26636
26637 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26638 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26639 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26640 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26641
26642 @table @code
26643 @findex ^done
26644 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26645 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26646 values.
26647
26648 @item "^running"
26649 @findex ^running
26650 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26651 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26652 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26653 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26654 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26655 which threads are resumed.
26656
26657 @item "^connected"
26658 @findex ^connected
26659 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26660
26661 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26662 @findex ^error
26663 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26664 the corresponding error message.
26665
26666 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26667 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26668 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26669
26670 @table @samp
26671 @item "undefined-command"
26672 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26673 @end table
26674
26675 @item "^exit"
26676 @findex ^exit
26677 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26678
26679 @end table
26680
26681 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26682 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26683
26684 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26685 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26686 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26687 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26688 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26689
26690 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26691 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26692 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26693 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26694 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26695
26696 @table @code
26697 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26698 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26699 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26700
26701 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26702 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26703 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26704 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26705
26706 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26707 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26708 internals.
26709 @end table
26710
26711 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26712 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26713
26714 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26715 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26716 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26717 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26718 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26719 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26720
26721 The following is the list of possible async records:
26722
26723 @table @code
26724
26725 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26726 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26727 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26728 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26729 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26730 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26731 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26732 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26733 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26734 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26735 it run freely.
26736
26737 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26738 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26739 following values:
26740
26741 @table @code
26742 @item breakpoint-hit
26743 A breakpoint was reached.
26744 @item watchpoint-trigger
26745 A watchpoint was triggered.
26746 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26747 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26748 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26749 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26750 @item function-finished
26751 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26752 @item location-reached
26753 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26754 @item watchpoint-scope
26755 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26756 @item end-stepping-range
26757 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26758 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26759 @item exited-signalled
26760 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26761 @item exited
26762 The inferior exited.
26763 @item exited-normally
26764 The inferior exited normally.
26765 @item signal-received
26766 A signal was received by the inferior.
26767 @item solib-event
26768 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26769 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26770 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26771 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26772 @item fork
26773 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26774 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26775 @item vfork
26776 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26777 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26778 @item syscall-entry
26779 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26780 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26781 @item syscall-return
26782 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26783 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26784 @item exec
26785 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26786 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26787 @end table
26788
26789 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26790 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26791 Depending on whether all-stop
26792 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26793 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26794 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26795 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26796 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26797 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26798 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26799 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26800 if such information is not available.
26801
26802 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26803 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26804 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26805 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26806 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26807 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26808 cannot be used in any way.
26809
26810 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26811 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26812 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26813 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26814 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26815 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26816
26817 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26818 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26819 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26820 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26821 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26822 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26823
26824 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26825 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26826 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26827 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26828 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26829
26830 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26831 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26832 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26833 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26834 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26835 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26836 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26837 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26838 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26839
26840 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26841 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26842
26843 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26844 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26845 that thread.
26846
26847 @item =library-loaded,...
26848 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26849 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26850 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26851 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26852 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26853 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26854 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26855 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26856 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26857 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26858 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26859 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26860 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26861 to this library.
26862
26863 @item =library-unloaded,...
26864 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26865 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26866 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26867 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26868 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26869 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26870 thread groups.
26871
26872 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26873 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26874 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26875 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26876 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26877
26878 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26879 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26880 initial value @var{initial}.
26881
26882 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26883 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26884 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26885 trace state variables are deleted.
26886
26887 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26888 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26889 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26890 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26891 value of trace state variable is known.
26892
26893 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26894 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26895 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26896 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26897 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26898 user.
26899
26900 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26901 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26902 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26903
26904 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26905 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26906
26907 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26908 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26909 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26910 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26911 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26912
26913 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26914 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26915 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26916 for existing method and format values.
26917
26918 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26919 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26920 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26921 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26922 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26923 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26924
26925 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26926 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26927 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26928 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26929 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26930 executable code.
26931 @end table
26932
26933 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26934 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26935
26936 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26937 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26938 following fields:
26939
26940 @table @code
26941 @item number
26942 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26943 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26944 @samp{1.2}.
26945
26946 @item type
26947 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26948 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26949
26950 @item catch-type
26951 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26952 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26953
26954 @item disp
26955 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26956 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26957 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26958
26959 @item enabled
26960 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26961 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26962 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26963
26964 @item addr
26965 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26966 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26967 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26968 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26969 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26970
26971 @item func
26972 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26973 If not known, this field is not present.
26974
26975 @item filename
26976 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26977 If not known, this field is not present.
26978
26979 @item fullname
26980 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26981 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26982
26983 @item line
26984 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26985 If not known, this field is not present.
26986
26987 @item at
26988 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26989 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26990 by a symbol name.
26991
26992 @item pending
26993 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26994 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26995
26996 @item evaluated-by
26997 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26998 @samp{target}.
26999
27000 @item thread
27001 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27002 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27003
27004 @item task
27005 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27006 field will hold the task identifier.
27007
27008 @item cond
27009 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27010
27011 @item ignore
27012 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27013
27014 @item enable
27015 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27016
27017 @item traceframe-usage
27018 FIXME.
27019
27020 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27021 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27022
27023 @item mask
27024 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27025
27026 @item pass
27027 A tracepoint's pass count.
27028
27029 @item original-location
27030 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27031 This field is optional.
27032
27033 @item times
27034 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27035
27036 @item installed
27037 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27038 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27039 is not.
27040
27041 @item what
27042 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27043
27044 @end table
27045
27046 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27047 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27048
27049 @smallexample
27050 -> -break-insert main
27051 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27052 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27053 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27054 times="0"@}
27055 <- (gdb)
27056 @end smallexample
27057
27058 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27059 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27060
27061 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27062 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27063 fields:
27064
27065 @table @code
27066 @item level
27067 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27068 zero. This field is always present.
27069
27070 @item func
27071 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27072 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27073
27074 @item addr
27075 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27076
27077 @item file
27078 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27079 address. This field may be absent.
27080
27081 @item line
27082 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27083 may be absent.
27084
27085 @item from
27086 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27087 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27088
27089 @end table
27090
27091 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27092 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27093
27094 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27095 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27096 stated otherwise.
27097
27098 @table @code
27099 @item id
27100 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27101
27102 @item target-id
27103 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27104
27105 @item details
27106 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27107 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27108 frontend. This field is optional.
27109
27110 @item name
27111 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27112 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27113 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27114 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27115 field is omitted.
27116
27117 @item state
27118 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27119 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27120
27121 @item frame
27122 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27123 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27124 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27125
27126 @item core
27127 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27128 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27129 @end table
27130
27131 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27132 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27133
27134 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27135 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27136 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27137 the @code{exception-name} field.
27138
27139 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27140 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27141 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27142 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27143
27144 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27145 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27146 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27147 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27148
27149 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27150 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27151
27152 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27153
27154 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27155 information of the breakpoint.
27156
27157 @smallexample
27158 -> -break-insert main
27159 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27160 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27161 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27162 times="0"@}
27163 <- (gdb)
27164 @end smallexample
27165
27166 @subheading Program Execution
27167
27168 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27169 reason that execution stopped.
27170
27171 @smallexample
27172 -> -exec-run
27173 <- ^running
27174 <- (gdb)
27175 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27176 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27177 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27178 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27179 <- (gdb)
27180 -> -exec-continue
27181 <- ^running
27182 <- (gdb)
27183 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27184 <- (gdb)
27185 @end smallexample
27186
27187 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27188
27189 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27190
27191 @smallexample
27192 -> (gdb)
27193 <- -gdb-exit
27194 <- ^exit
27195 @end smallexample
27196
27197 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27198 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27199 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27200 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27201 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27202 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27203
27204 @subheading A Bad Command
27205
27206 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27207
27208 @smallexample
27209 -> -rubbish
27210 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27211 <- (gdb)
27212 @end smallexample
27213
27214
27215 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27216 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27217 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27218
27219 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27220 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27221
27222 @subheading Motivation
27223
27224 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27225
27226 @subheading Introduction
27227
27228 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27229
27230 @subheading Commands
27231
27232 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27233
27234 @subsubheading Synopsis
27235
27236 @smallexample
27237 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27238 @end smallexample
27239
27240 @subsubheading Result
27241
27242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27243
27244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27245
27246 @subsubheading Example
27247
27248 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27249 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27250
27251
27252 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27253 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27254 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27255
27256 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27257 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27258 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27259 breakpoints.
27260
27261 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27262 @findex -break-after
27263
27264 @subsubheading Synopsis
27265
27266 @smallexample
27267 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27271 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27272 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27273 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27274
27275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27276
27277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27278
27279 @subsubheading Example
27280
27281 @smallexample
27282 (gdb)
27283 -break-insert main
27284 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27285 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27286 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27287 times="0"@}
27288 (gdb)
27289 -break-after 1 3
27290 ~
27291 ^done
27292 (gdb)
27293 -break-list
27294 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27295 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27296 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27297 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27298 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27299 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27300 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27301 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27302 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27303 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27304 (gdb)
27305 @end smallexample
27306
27307 @ignore
27308 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27309 @findex -break-catch
27310 @end ignore
27311
27312 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27313 @findex -break-commands
27314
27315 @subsubheading Synopsis
27316
27317 @smallexample
27318 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27319 @end smallexample
27320
27321 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27322 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27323 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27324 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27325 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27326 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27327
27328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27329
27330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27331
27332 @subsubheading Example
27333
27334 @smallexample
27335 (gdb)
27336 -break-insert main
27337 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27338 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27339 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27340 times="0"@}
27341 (gdb)
27342 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27343 ^done
27344 (gdb)
27345 @end smallexample
27346
27347 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27348 @findex -break-condition
27349
27350 @subsubheading Synopsis
27351
27352 @smallexample
27353 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27357 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27358 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27359 command below).
27360
27361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27362
27363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27364
27365 @subsubheading Example
27366
27367 @smallexample
27368 (gdb)
27369 -break-condition 1 1
27370 ^done
27371 (gdb)
27372 -break-list
27373 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27374 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27375 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27376 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27377 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27378 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27379 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27380 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27381 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27382 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27383 (gdb)
27384 @end smallexample
27385
27386 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27387 @findex -break-delete
27388
27389 @subsubheading Synopsis
27390
27391 @smallexample
27392 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27393 @end smallexample
27394
27395 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27396 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27397
27398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27399
27400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27401
27402 @subsubheading Example
27403
27404 @smallexample
27405 (gdb)
27406 -break-delete 1
27407 ^done
27408 (gdb)
27409 -break-list
27410 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27411 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27412 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27413 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27414 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27415 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27416 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27417 body=[]@}
27418 (gdb)
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27422 @findex -break-disable
27423
27424 @subsubheading Synopsis
27425
27426 @smallexample
27427 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27428 @end smallexample
27429
27430 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27431 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27432
27433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27434
27435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27436
27437 @subsubheading Example
27438
27439 @smallexample
27440 (gdb)
27441 -break-disable 2
27442 ^done
27443 (gdb)
27444 -break-list
27445 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27446 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27447 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27448 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27449 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27450 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27451 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27452 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27453 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27454 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27455 (gdb)
27456 @end smallexample
27457
27458 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27459 @findex -break-enable
27460
27461 @subsubheading Synopsis
27462
27463 @smallexample
27464 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27465 @end smallexample
27466
27467 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27468
27469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27470
27471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27472
27473 @subsubheading Example
27474
27475 @smallexample
27476 (gdb)
27477 -break-enable 2
27478 ^done
27479 (gdb)
27480 -break-list
27481 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27482 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27483 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27484 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27485 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27486 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27487 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27488 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27489 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27490 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27491 (gdb)
27492 @end smallexample
27493
27494 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27495 @findex -break-info
27496
27497 @subsubheading Synopsis
27498
27499 @smallexample
27500 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27501 @end smallexample
27502
27503 @c REDUNDANT???
27504 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27505
27506 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27507 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27508 table.
27509
27510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27511
27512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27513
27514 @subsubheading Example
27515 N.A.
27516
27517 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27518 @findex -break-insert
27519 @anchor{-break-insert}
27520
27521 @subsubheading Synopsis
27522
27523 @smallexample
27524 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27525 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27526 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27527 @end smallexample
27528
27529 @noindent
27530 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27531
27532 @table @var
27533 @item linespec location
27534 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27535
27536 @item explicit location
27537 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27538 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27539 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27540
27541 @table @samp
27542 @item --source @var{filename}
27543 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27544 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27545
27546 @item --function @var{function}
27547 The name of a function or method.
27548
27549 @item --label @var{label}
27550 The name of a label.
27551
27552 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27553 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27554 @end table
27555
27556 @item address location
27557 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27558 @end table
27559
27560 @noindent
27561 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27562
27563 @table @samp
27564 @item -t
27565 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27566 @item -h
27567 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27568 @item -f
27569 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27570 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27571 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27572 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27573 cannot be parsed.
27574 @item -d
27575 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27576 @item -a
27577 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27578 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27579 @item -c @var{condition}
27580 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27581 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27582 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27583 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27584 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27585 @var{thread-id}.
27586 @end table
27587
27588 @subsubheading Result
27589
27590 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27591 resulting breakpoint.
27592
27593 Note: this format is open to change.
27594 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27595
27596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27597
27598 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27599 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27600
27601 @subsubheading Example
27602
27603 @smallexample
27604 (gdb)
27605 -break-insert main
27606 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27607 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27608 times="0"@}
27609 (gdb)
27610 -break-insert -t foo
27611 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27612 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27613 times="0"@}
27614 (gdb)
27615 -break-list
27616 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27617 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27618 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27619 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27620 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27621 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27622 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27623 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27624 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27625 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27626 times="0"@},
27627 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27628 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27629 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27630 times="0"@}]@}
27631 (gdb)
27632 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27633 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27634 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27635 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27636 @c times="0"@}
27637 @c (gdb)
27638 @end smallexample
27639
27640 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27641 @findex -dprintf-insert
27642
27643 @subsubheading Synopsis
27644
27645 @smallexample
27646 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27647 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27648 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27649 [ @var{argument} ]
27650 @end smallexample
27651
27652 @noindent
27653 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27654 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27655
27656 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27657
27658 @table @samp
27659 @item -t
27660 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27661 @item -f
27662 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27663 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27664 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27665 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27666 cannot be parsed.
27667 @item -d
27668 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27669 @item -c @var{condition}
27670 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27671 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27672 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27673 to @var{ignore-count}.
27674 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27675 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27676 @var{thread-id}.
27677 @end table
27678
27679 @subsubheading Result
27680
27681 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27682 resulting breakpoint.
27683
27684 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27685
27686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27687
27688 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27689
27690 @subsubheading Example
27691
27692 @smallexample
27693 (gdb)
27694 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27695 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27696 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27697 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27698 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27699 original-location="foo"@}
27700 (gdb)
27701 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27702 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27703 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27704 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27705 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27706 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27707 (gdb)
27708 @end smallexample
27709
27710 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27711 @findex -break-list
27712
27713 @subsubheading Synopsis
27714
27715 @smallexample
27716 -break-list
27717 @end smallexample
27718
27719 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27720
27721 @table @samp
27722 @item Number
27723 number of the breakpoint
27724 @item Type
27725 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27726 @item Disposition
27727 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27728 or @samp{nokeep}
27729 @item Enabled
27730 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27731 @item Address
27732 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27733 @item What
27734 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27735 name, line number
27736 @item Thread-groups
27737 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27738 @item Times
27739 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27740 @end table
27741
27742 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27743 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27744
27745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27746
27747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27748
27749 @subsubheading Example
27750
27751 @smallexample
27752 (gdb)
27753 -break-list
27754 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27755 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27756 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27757 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27758 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27759 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27760 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27761 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27762 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27763 times="0"@},
27764 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27765 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27766 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27767 (gdb)
27768 @end smallexample
27769
27770 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27771
27772 @smallexample
27773 (gdb)
27774 -break-list
27775 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27776 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27777 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27778 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27779 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27780 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27781 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27782 body=[]@}
27783 (gdb)
27784 @end smallexample
27785
27786 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27787 @findex -break-passcount
27788
27789 @subsubheading Synopsis
27790
27791 @smallexample
27792 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27793 @end smallexample
27794
27795 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27796 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27797 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27798 command @samp{passcount}.
27799
27800 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27801 @findex -break-watch
27802
27803 @subsubheading Synopsis
27804
27805 @smallexample
27806 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27807 @end smallexample
27808
27809 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27810 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27811 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27812 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27813 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27814 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27815 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27816 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27817
27818 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27819 breakpoints inserted.
27820
27821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27822
27823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27824 @samp{rwatch}.
27825
27826 @subsubheading Example
27827
27828 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27829
27830 @smallexample
27831 (gdb)
27832 -break-watch x
27833 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27834 (gdb)
27835 -exec-continue
27836 ^running
27837 (gdb)
27838 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27839 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27840 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27841 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27842 (gdb)
27843 @end smallexample
27844
27845 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27846 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27847 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27848
27849 @smallexample
27850 (gdb)
27851 -break-watch C
27852 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27853 (gdb)
27854 -exec-continue
27855 ^running
27856 (gdb)
27857 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27858 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27859 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27860 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27861 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27862 (gdb)
27863 -exec-continue
27864 ^running
27865 (gdb)
27866 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27867 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27868 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27869 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27870 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27871 (gdb)
27872 @end smallexample
27873
27874 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27875 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27876 deleted.
27877
27878 @smallexample
27879 (gdb)
27880 -break-watch C
27881 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27882 (gdb)
27883 -break-list
27884 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27885 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27886 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27887 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27888 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27889 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27890 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27891 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27892 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27893 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27894 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27895 times="1"@},
27896 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27897 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27898 (gdb)
27899 -exec-continue
27900 ^running
27901 (gdb)
27902 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27903 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27904 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27905 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27906 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27907 (gdb)
27908 -break-list
27909 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27910 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27911 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27912 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27913 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27914 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27915 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27916 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27917 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27918 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27919 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27920 times="1"@},
27921 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27922 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27923 (gdb)
27924 -exec-continue
27925 ^running
27926 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27927 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27928 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27929 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27930 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27931 (gdb)
27932 -break-list
27933 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27934 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27935 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27936 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27937 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27938 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27939 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27940 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27941 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27942 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27943 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27944 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27945 (gdb)
27946 @end smallexample
27947
27948
27949 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27950 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27951 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27952
27953 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27954 catchpoints.
27955
27956 @menu
27957 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27958 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27959 @end menu
27960
27961 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27962 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27963
27964 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27965 @findex -catch-load
27966
27967 @subsubheading Synopsis
27968
27969 @smallexample
27970 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27971 @end smallexample
27972
27973 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27974 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27975 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27976 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27977 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27978
27979
27980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27981
27982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27983
27984 @subsubheading Example
27985
27986 @smallexample
27987 -catch-load -t foo.so
27988 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27989 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27990 (gdb)
27991 @end smallexample
27992
27993
27994 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27995 @findex -catch-unload
27996
27997 @subsubheading Synopsis
27998
27999 @smallexample
28000 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28001 @end smallexample
28002
28003 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28004 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28005 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28006 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28007 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28008
28009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28010
28011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28012
28013 @subsubheading Example
28014
28015 @smallexample
28016 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28017 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28018 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28019 (gdb)
28020 @end smallexample
28021
28022 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28023 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28024
28025 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28026 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28027
28028 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28029 @findex -catch-assert
28030
28031 @subsubheading Synopsis
28032
28033 @smallexample
28034 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28035 @end smallexample
28036
28037 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28038
28039 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28040
28041 @table @samp
28042 @item -c @var{condition}
28043 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28044 @item -d
28045 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28046 @item -t
28047 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28048 @end table
28049
28050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28051
28052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28053
28054 @subsubheading Example
28055
28056 @smallexample
28057 -catch-assert
28058 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28059 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28060 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28061 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28062 (gdb)
28063 @end smallexample
28064
28065 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28066 @findex -catch-exception
28067
28068 @subsubheading Synopsis
28069
28070 @smallexample
28071 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28072 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28073 @end smallexample
28074
28075 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28076 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28077 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28078 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28079 catchpoints.
28080
28081 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28082
28083 @table @samp
28084 @item -c @var{condition}
28085 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28086 @item -d
28087 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28088 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28089 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28090 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28091 @item -t
28092 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28093 @item -u
28094 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28095 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28096 @end table
28097
28098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28099
28100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28101 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28102
28103 @subsubheading Example
28104
28105 @smallexample
28106 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28107 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28108 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28109 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28110 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28111 (gdb)
28112 @end smallexample
28113
28114 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28115 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28116 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28117
28118 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28119 @findex -exec-arguments
28120
28121
28122 @subsubheading Synopsis
28123
28124 @smallexample
28125 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28126 @end smallexample
28127
28128 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28129 @samp{-exec-run}.
28130
28131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28132
28133 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28134
28135 @subsubheading Example
28136
28137 @smallexample
28138 (gdb)
28139 -exec-arguments -v word
28140 ^done
28141 (gdb)
28142 @end smallexample
28143
28144
28145 @ignore
28146 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28147 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28148
28149 @subsubheading Synopsis
28150
28151 @smallexample
28152 -exec-show-arguments
28153 @end smallexample
28154
28155 Print the arguments of the program.
28156
28157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28158
28159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28160
28161 @subsubheading Example
28162 N.A.
28163 @end ignore
28164
28165
28166 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28167 @findex -environment-cd
28168
28169 @subsubheading Synopsis
28170
28171 @smallexample
28172 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28173 @end smallexample
28174
28175 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28176
28177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28178
28179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28180
28181 @subsubheading Example
28182
28183 @smallexample
28184 (gdb)
28185 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28186 ^done
28187 (gdb)
28188 @end smallexample
28189
28190
28191 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28192 @findex -environment-directory
28193
28194 @subsubheading Synopsis
28195
28196 @smallexample
28197 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28198 @end smallexample
28199
28200 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28201 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28202 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28203 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28204 occurs as normal.
28205 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28206 multiple directories in a single command
28207 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28208 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28209 If blanks are needed as
28210 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28211 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28212 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28213 character must not be used
28214 in any directory name.
28215 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28216
28217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28218
28219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28220
28221 @subsubheading Example
28222
28223 @smallexample
28224 (gdb)
28225 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28226 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28227 (gdb)
28228 -environment-directory ""
28229 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28230 (gdb)
28231 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28232 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28233 (gdb)
28234 -environment-directory -r
28235 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28236 (gdb)
28237 @end smallexample
28238
28239
28240 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28241 @findex -environment-path
28242
28243 @subsubheading Synopsis
28244
28245 @smallexample
28246 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28247 @end smallexample
28248
28249 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28250 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28251 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28252 supplied in addition to the
28253 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28254 occurs as normal.
28255 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28256 multiple directories in a single command
28257 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28258 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28259 If blanks are needed as
28260 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28261 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28262 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28263 character must not be used
28264 in any directory name.
28265 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28266
28267
28268 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28269
28270 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28271
28272 @subsubheading Example
28273
28274 @smallexample
28275 (gdb)
28276 -environment-path
28277 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28278 (gdb)
28279 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28280 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28281 (gdb)
28282 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28283 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28284 (gdb)
28285 @end smallexample
28286
28287
28288 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28289 @findex -environment-pwd
28290
28291 @subsubheading Synopsis
28292
28293 @smallexample
28294 -environment-pwd
28295 @end smallexample
28296
28297 Show the current working directory.
28298
28299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28300
28301 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28302
28303 @subsubheading Example
28304
28305 @smallexample
28306 (gdb)
28307 -environment-pwd
28308 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28309 (gdb)
28310 @end smallexample
28311
28312 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28313 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28314 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28315
28316
28317 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28318 @findex -thread-info
28319
28320 @subsubheading Synopsis
28321
28322 @smallexample
28323 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28324 @end smallexample
28325
28326 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28327 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28328 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28329 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28330 current thread.
28331
28332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28333
28334 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28335 about all threads.
28336
28337 @subsubheading Result
28338
28339 The result contains the following attributes:
28340
28341 @table @samp
28342 @item threads
28343 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28344 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28345
28346 @item current-thread-id
28347 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28348 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28349 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28350 the command.
28351
28352 @end table
28353
28354 @subsubheading Example
28355
28356 @smallexample
28357 -thread-info
28358 ^done,threads=[
28359 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28360 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28361 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28362 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28363 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28364 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28365 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28366 state="running"@}],
28367 current-thread-id="1"
28368 (gdb)
28369 @end smallexample
28370
28371 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28372 @findex -thread-list-ids
28373
28374 @subsubheading Synopsis
28375
28376 @smallexample
28377 -thread-list-ids
28378 @end smallexample
28379
28380 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28381 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28382 threads.
28383
28384 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28385 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28386
28387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28388
28389 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28390
28391 @subsubheading Example
28392
28393 @smallexample
28394 (gdb)
28395 -thread-list-ids
28396 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28397 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28398 (gdb)
28399 @end smallexample
28400
28401
28402 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28403 @findex -thread-select
28404
28405 @subsubheading Synopsis
28406
28407 @smallexample
28408 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28409 @end smallexample
28410
28411 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28412 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28413 topmost frame for that thread.
28414
28415 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28416 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28417
28418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28419
28420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28421
28422 @subsubheading Example
28423
28424 @smallexample
28425 (gdb)
28426 -exec-next
28427 ^running
28428 (gdb)
28429 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28430 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28431 (gdb)
28432 -thread-list-ids
28433 ^done,
28434 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28435 number-of-threads="3"
28436 (gdb)
28437 -thread-select 3
28438 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28439 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28440 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28441 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28442 (gdb)
28443 @end smallexample
28444
28445 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28446 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28447 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28448
28449 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28450 @findex -ada-task-info
28451
28452 @subsubheading Synopsis
28453
28454 @smallexample
28455 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28456 @end smallexample
28457
28458 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28459 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28460
28461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28462
28463 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28464 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28465
28466 @subsubheading Result
28467
28468 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28469 defined for each Ada task:
28470
28471 @table @samp
28472 @item current
28473 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28474
28475 @item id
28476 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28477
28478 @item task-id
28479 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28480
28481 @item thread-id
28482 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28483 task.
28484
28485 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28486 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28487 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28488
28489 @item parent-id
28490 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28491 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28492
28493 @item priority
28494 The base priority of the task.
28495
28496 @item state
28497 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28498 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28499
28500 @item name
28501 The name of the task.
28502
28503 @end table
28504
28505 @subsubheading Example
28506
28507 @smallexample
28508 -ada-task-info
28509 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28510 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28511 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28512 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28513 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28514 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28515 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28516 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28517 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28518 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28519 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28520 (gdb)
28521 @end smallexample
28522
28523 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28524 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28525 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28526
28527 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28528 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28529 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28530 other cases.
28531
28532 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28533 @findex -exec-continue
28534
28535 @subsubheading Synopsis
28536
28537 @smallexample
28538 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28539 @end smallexample
28540
28541 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28542 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28543 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28544 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28545 @itemize @bullet
28546 @item
28547 breakpoints or watchpoints
28548 @item
28549 signals or exceptions
28550 @item
28551 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28552 @item
28553 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28554 @end itemize
28555 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28556 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28557 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28558 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28559 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28560 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28561
28562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28563
28564 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28565
28566 @subsubheading Example
28567
28568 @smallexample
28569 -exec-continue
28570 ^running
28571 (gdb)
28572 @@Hello world
28573 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28574 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28575 line="13"@}
28576 (gdb)
28577 @end smallexample
28578
28579
28580 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28581 @findex -exec-finish
28582
28583 @subsubheading Synopsis
28584
28585 @smallexample
28586 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28587 @end smallexample
28588
28589 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28590 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28591 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28592 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28593 function was called.
28594
28595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28596
28597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28598
28599 @subsubheading Example
28600
28601 Function returning @code{void}.
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 -exec-finish
28605 ^running
28606 (gdb)
28607 @@hello from foo
28608 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28609 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28610 (gdb)
28611 @end smallexample
28612
28613 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28614 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28615 value itself.
28616
28617 @smallexample
28618 -exec-finish
28619 ^running
28620 (gdb)
28621 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28622 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28623 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28624 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28625 (gdb)
28626 @end smallexample
28627
28628
28629 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28630 @findex -exec-interrupt
28631
28632 @subsubheading Synopsis
28633
28634 @smallexample
28635 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28636 @end smallexample
28637
28638 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28639 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28640 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28641 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28642 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28643
28644 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28645 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28646 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28647 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28648
28649 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28650 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28651 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28652 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28653
28654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28655
28656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28657
28658 @subsubheading Example
28659
28660 @smallexample
28661 (gdb)
28662 111-exec-continue
28663 111^running
28664
28665 (gdb)
28666 222-exec-interrupt
28667 222^done
28668 (gdb)
28669 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28670 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28671 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28672 (gdb)
28673
28674 (gdb)
28675 -exec-interrupt
28676 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28677 (gdb)
28678 @end smallexample
28679
28680 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28681 @findex -exec-jump
28682
28683 @subsubheading Synopsis
28684
28685 @smallexample
28686 -exec-jump @var{location}
28687 @end smallexample
28688
28689 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28690 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28691 different forms of @var{location}.
28692
28693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28694
28695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28696
28697 @subsubheading Example
28698
28699 @smallexample
28700 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28701 *running,thread-id="all"
28702 ^running
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705
28706 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28707 @findex -exec-next
28708
28709 @subsubheading Synopsis
28710
28711 @smallexample
28712 -exec-next [--reverse]
28713 @end smallexample
28714
28715 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28716 of the next source line is reached.
28717
28718 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28719 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28720 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28721 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28722 source line where the function was called.
28723
28724
28725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28726
28727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28728
28729 @subsubheading Example
28730
28731 @smallexample
28732 -exec-next
28733 ^running
28734 (gdb)
28735 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28736 (gdb)
28737 @end smallexample
28738
28739
28740 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28741 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28742
28743 @subsubheading Synopsis
28744
28745 @smallexample
28746 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28747 @end smallexample
28748
28749 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28750 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28751 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28752 printed as well.
28753
28754 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28755 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28756 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28757 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28758 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28759
28760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28761
28762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28763
28764 @subsubheading Example
28765
28766 @smallexample
28767 (gdb)
28768 -exec-next-instruction
28769 ^running
28770
28771 (gdb)
28772 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28773 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28774 (gdb)
28775 @end smallexample
28776
28777
28778 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28779 @findex -exec-return
28780
28781 @subsubheading Synopsis
28782
28783 @smallexample
28784 -exec-return
28785 @end smallexample
28786
28787 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28788 Displays the new current frame.
28789
28790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28791
28792 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28793
28794 @subsubheading Example
28795
28796 @smallexample
28797 (gdb)
28798 200-break-insert callee4
28799 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28800 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28801 (gdb)
28802 000-exec-run
28803 000^running
28804 (gdb)
28805 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28806 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28807 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28808 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28809 (gdb)
28810 205-break-delete
28811 205^done
28812 (gdb)
28813 111-exec-return
28814 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28815 args=[@{name="strarg",
28816 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28817 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28818 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28819 (gdb)
28820 @end smallexample
28821
28822
28823 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28824 @findex -exec-run
28825
28826 @subsubheading Synopsis
28827
28828 @smallexample
28829 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28830 @end smallexample
28831
28832 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28833 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28834 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28835 the program has exited exceptionally.
28836
28837 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28838 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28839 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28840 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28841 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28842
28843 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28844 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28845 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28846 (@pxref{Starting}).
28847
28848 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28849
28850 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28851
28852 @subsubheading Examples
28853
28854 @smallexample
28855 (gdb)
28856 -break-insert main
28857 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28858 (gdb)
28859 -exec-run
28860 ^running
28861 (gdb)
28862 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28863 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28864 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28865 (gdb)
28866 @end smallexample
28867
28868 @noindent
28869 Program exited normally:
28870
28871 @smallexample
28872 (gdb)
28873 -exec-run
28874 ^running
28875 (gdb)
28876 x = 55
28877 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28878 (gdb)
28879 @end smallexample
28880
28881 @noindent
28882 Program exited exceptionally:
28883
28884 @smallexample
28885 (gdb)
28886 -exec-run
28887 ^running
28888 (gdb)
28889 x = 55
28890 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28891 (gdb)
28892 @end smallexample
28893
28894 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28895 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28896
28897 @smallexample
28898 (gdb)
28899 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28900 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28901 @end smallexample
28902
28903
28904 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28905
28906
28907 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28908 @findex -exec-step
28909
28910 @subsubheading Synopsis
28911
28912 @smallexample
28913 -exec-step [--reverse]
28914 @end smallexample
28915
28916 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28917 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28918 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28919 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28920 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28921 previously executed source line.
28922
28923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28924
28925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28926
28927 @subsubheading Example
28928
28929 Stepping into a function:
28930
28931 @smallexample
28932 -exec-step
28933 ^running
28934 (gdb)
28935 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28936 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28937 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28938 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28939 (gdb)
28940 @end smallexample
28941
28942 Regular stepping:
28943
28944 @smallexample
28945 -exec-step
28946 ^running
28947 (gdb)
28948 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28949 (gdb)
28950 @end smallexample
28951
28952
28953 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28954 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28955
28956 @subsubheading Synopsis
28957
28958 @smallexample
28959 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28960 @end smallexample
28961
28962 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28963 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28964 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28965 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28966 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28967 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28968 as well.
28969
28970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28971
28972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28973
28974 @subsubheading Example
28975
28976 @smallexample
28977 (gdb)
28978 -exec-step-instruction
28979 ^running
28980
28981 (gdb)
28982 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28983 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28984 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28985 (gdb)
28986 -exec-step-instruction
28987 ^running
28988
28989 (gdb)
28990 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28991 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28992 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28993 (gdb)
28994 @end smallexample
28995
28996
28997 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28998 @findex -exec-until
28999
29000 @subsubheading Synopsis
29001
29002 @smallexample
29003 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29004 @end smallexample
29005
29006 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29007 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29008 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29009 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29010
29011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29012
29013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29014
29015 @subsubheading Example
29016
29017 @smallexample
29018 (gdb)
29019 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29020 ^running
29021 (gdb)
29022 x = 55
29023 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29024 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29025 (gdb)
29026 @end smallexample
29027
29028 @ignore
29029 @subheading -file-clear
29030 Is this going away????
29031 @end ignore
29032
29033 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29034 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29035 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29036
29037 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29038 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29039
29040 @smallexample
29041 -enable-frame-filters
29042 @end smallexample
29043
29044 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29045 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29046 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29047 request that this functionality be enabled.
29048
29049 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29050
29051 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29052 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29053
29054 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29055 @findex -stack-info-frame
29056
29057 @subsubheading Synopsis
29058
29059 @smallexample
29060 -stack-info-frame
29061 @end smallexample
29062
29063 Get info on the selected frame.
29064
29065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29066
29067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29068 (without arguments).
29069
29070 @subsubheading Example
29071
29072 @smallexample
29073 (gdb)
29074 -stack-info-frame
29075 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29076 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29077 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29078 (gdb)
29079 @end smallexample
29080
29081 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29082 @findex -stack-info-depth
29083
29084 @subsubheading Synopsis
29085
29086 @smallexample
29087 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29088 @end smallexample
29089
29090 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29091 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29092
29093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29094
29095 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29096
29097 @subsubheading Example
29098
29099 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29100
29101 @smallexample
29102 (gdb)
29103 -stack-info-depth
29104 ^done,depth="12"
29105 (gdb)
29106 -stack-info-depth 4
29107 ^done,depth="4"
29108 (gdb)
29109 -stack-info-depth 12
29110 ^done,depth="12"
29111 (gdb)
29112 -stack-info-depth 11
29113 ^done,depth="11"
29114 (gdb)
29115 -stack-info-depth 13
29116 ^done,depth="12"
29117 (gdb)
29118 @end smallexample
29119
29120 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29121 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29122 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29123
29124 @subsubheading Synopsis
29125
29126 @smallexample
29127 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29128 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29129 @end smallexample
29130
29131 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29132 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29133 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29134 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29135 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29136 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29137 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29138 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29139
29140 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29141 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29142 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29143 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29144 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29145 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29146
29147 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29148 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29149 are still displayed, however.
29150
29151 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29152 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29153
29154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29155
29156 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29157 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29158 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29159
29160 @subsubheading Example
29161
29162 @smallexample
29163 (gdb)
29164 -stack-list-frames
29165 ^done,
29166 stack=[
29167 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29168 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29169 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29170 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29171 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29172 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29173 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29174 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29175 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29176 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29177 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29178 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29179 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29180 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29181 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29182 (gdb)
29183 -stack-list-arguments 0
29184 ^done,
29185 stack-args=[
29186 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29187 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29188 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29189 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29190 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29191 (gdb)
29192 -stack-list-arguments 1
29193 ^done,
29194 stack-args=[
29195 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29196 frame=@{level="1",
29197 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29198 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29199 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29200 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29201 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29202 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29203 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29204 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29205 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29206 (gdb)
29207 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29208 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29209 (gdb)
29210 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29211 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29212 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29213 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29214 (gdb)
29215 @end smallexample
29216
29217 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29218
29219
29220 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29221 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29222 @findex -stack-list-frames
29223
29224 @subsubheading Synopsis
29225
29226 @smallexample
29227 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29228 @end smallexample
29229
29230 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29231 following info:
29232
29233 @table @samp
29234 @item @var{level}
29235 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29236 @item @var{addr}
29237 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29238 @item @var{func}
29239 Function name.
29240 @item @var{file}
29241 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29242 @item @var{fullname}
29243 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29244 @item @var{line}
29245 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29246 @item @var{from}
29247 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29248 if the frame's function is not known.
29249 @end table
29250
29251 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29252 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29253 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29254 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29255 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29256 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29257 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29258 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29259 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29260
29261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29262
29263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29264
29265 @subsubheading Example
29266
29267 Full stack backtrace:
29268
29269 @smallexample
29270 (gdb)
29271 -stack-list-frames
29272 ^done,stack=
29273 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29274 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29275 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29276 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29277 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29278 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29279 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29280 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29281 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29282 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29283 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29284 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29285 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29286 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29287 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29288 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29289 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29290 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29291 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29292 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29293 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29294 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29295 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29296 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29297 (gdb)
29298 @end smallexample
29299
29300 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29301
29302 @smallexample
29303 (gdb)
29304 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29305 ^done,stack=
29306 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29307 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29308 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29309 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29310 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29311 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29312 (gdb)
29313 @end smallexample
29314
29315 Show a single frame:
29316
29317 @smallexample
29318 (gdb)
29319 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29320 ^done,stack=
29321 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29322 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29323 (gdb)
29324 @end smallexample
29325
29326
29327 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29328 @findex -stack-list-locals
29329 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29330
29331 @subsubheading Synopsis
29332
29333 @smallexample
29334 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29335 @end smallexample
29336
29337 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29338 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29339 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29340 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29341 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29342 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29343 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29344 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29345 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29346 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29347
29348 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29349 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29350 variables are still displayed, however.
29351
29352 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29353 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29354
29355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29356
29357 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29358
29359 @subsubheading Example
29360
29361 @smallexample
29362 (gdb)
29363 -stack-list-locals 0
29364 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29365 (gdb)
29366 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29367 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29368 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29369 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29370 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29371 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29372 (gdb)
29373 @end smallexample
29374
29375 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29376 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29377 @findex -stack-list-variables
29378
29379 @subsubheading Synopsis
29380
29381 @smallexample
29382 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29383 @end smallexample
29384
29385 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29386 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29387 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29388 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29389 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29390 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29391 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29392
29393 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29394 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29395 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29396
29397 @subsubheading Example
29398
29399 @smallexample
29400 (gdb)
29401 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29402 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29403 (gdb)
29404 @end smallexample
29405
29406
29407 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29408 @findex -stack-select-frame
29409
29410 @subsubheading Synopsis
29411
29412 @smallexample
29413 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29414 @end smallexample
29415
29416 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29417 the stack.
29418
29419 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29420 option to every command.
29421
29422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29423
29424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29425 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29426
29427 @subsubheading Example
29428
29429 @smallexample
29430 (gdb)
29431 -stack-select-frame 2
29432 ^done
29433 (gdb)
29434 @end smallexample
29435
29436 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29437 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29438 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29439
29440 @ignore
29441
29442 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29443
29444 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29445 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29446 used by @code{Insight}.
29447
29448 The two main reasons for that are:
29449
29450 @enumerate 1
29451 @item
29452 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29453
29454 @item
29455 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29456 now).
29457 @end enumerate
29458
29459 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29460 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29461 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29462 hints about their use.
29463
29464 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29465 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29466 least, the following operations:
29467
29468 @itemize @bullet
29469 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29470 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29471 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29472 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29473 @end itemize
29474
29475 @end ignore
29476
29477 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29478
29479 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29480
29481 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29482 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29483 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29484 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29485 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29486 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29487 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29488 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29489 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29490 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29491 object, or to change display format.
29492
29493 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29494 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29495 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29496 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29497 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29498 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29499 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29500 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29501 child will be created.
29502
29503 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29504 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29505 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29506 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29507 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29508
29509 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29510 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29511 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29512 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29513 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29514 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29515 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29516 variables that frontend has created.
29517
29518 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29519 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29520 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29521 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29522 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29523 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29524 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29525 implicitly updated.
29526
29527 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29528 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29529 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29530 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29531 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29532 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29533 frame. Consider this example:
29534
29535 @smallexample
29536 void do_work(...)
29537 @{
29538 struct work_state state;
29539
29540 if (...)
29541 do_work(...);
29542 @}
29543 @end smallexample
29544
29545 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29546 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29547 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29548 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29549 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29550
29551 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29552 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29553 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29554 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29555 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29556 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29557
29558 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29559 access this functionality:
29560
29561 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29562 @item @strong{Operation}
29563 @tab @strong{Description}
29564
29565 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29566 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29567 @item @code{-var-create}
29568 @tab create a variable object
29569 @item @code{-var-delete}
29570 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29571 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29572 @tab set the display format of this variable
29573 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29574 @tab show the display format of this variable
29575 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29576 @tab tells how many children this object has
29577 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29578 @tab return a list of the object's children
29579 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29580 @tab show the type of this variable object
29581 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29582 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29583 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29584 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29585 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29586 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29587 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29588 @tab get the value of this variable
29589 @item @code{-var-assign}
29590 @tab set the value of this variable
29591 @item @code{-var-update}
29592 @tab update the variable and its children
29593 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29594 @tab set frozeness attribute
29595 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29596 @tab set range of children to display on update
29597 @end multitable
29598
29599 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29600 how it can be used.
29601
29602 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29603
29604 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29605 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29606
29607 @smallexample
29608 -enable-pretty-printing
29609 @end smallexample
29610
29611 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29612 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29613 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29614 request that this functionality be enabled.
29615
29616 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29617
29618 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29619 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29620
29621 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29622 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29623
29624 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29625 @findex -var-create
29626
29627 @subsubheading Synopsis
29628
29629 @smallexample
29630 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29631 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29632 @end smallexample
29633
29634 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29635 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29636 register.
29637
29638 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29639 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29640 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29641 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29642 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29643
29644 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29645 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29646 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29647 object must be created.
29648
29649 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29650 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29651
29652 @itemize @bullet
29653 @item
29654 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29655
29656 @item
29657 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29658
29659 @item
29660 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29661 @end itemize
29662
29663 @cindex dynamic varobj
29664 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29665 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29666 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29667 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29668 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29669 compatibility for existing clients.
29670
29671 @subsubheading Result
29672
29673 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29674 are:
29675
29676 @table @samp
29677 @item name
29678 The name of the varobj.
29679
29680 @item numchild
29681 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29682 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29683 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29684
29685 @item value
29686 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29687 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29688 will not be interesting.
29689
29690 @item type
29691 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29692 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29693 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29694 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29695 @emph{declared} one.
29696
29697 @item thread-id
29698 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29699 thread's global identifier.
29700
29701 @item has_more
29702 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29703 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29704
29705 @item dynamic
29706 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29707 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29708 then this attribute will not be present.
29709
29710 @item displayhint
29711 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29712 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29713 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29714 @end table
29715
29716 Typical output will look like this:
29717
29718 @smallexample
29719 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29720 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723
29724 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29725 @findex -var-delete
29726
29727 @subsubheading Synopsis
29728
29729 @smallexample
29730 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29731 @end smallexample
29732
29733 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29734 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29735
29736 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29737
29738
29739 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29740 @findex -var-set-format
29741
29742 @subsubheading Synopsis
29743
29744 @smallexample
29745 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29746 @end smallexample
29747
29748 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29749 @var{format-spec}.
29750
29751 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29752 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29753
29754 @smallexample
29755 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29756 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29757 @end smallexample
29758
29759 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29760 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29761 for pointers, etc.).
29762
29763 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29764 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29765 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29766 zero-hexadecimal format.
29767
29768 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29769 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29770
29771 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29772 @findex -var-show-format
29773
29774 @subsubheading Synopsis
29775
29776 @smallexample
29777 -var-show-format @var{name}
29778 @end smallexample
29779
29780 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29781
29782 @smallexample
29783 @var{format} @expansion{}
29784 @var{format-spec}
29785 @end smallexample
29786
29787
29788 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29789 @findex -var-info-num-children
29790
29791 @subsubheading Synopsis
29792
29793 @smallexample
29794 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29795 @end smallexample
29796
29797 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29798
29799 @smallexample
29800 numchild=@var{n}
29801 @end smallexample
29802
29803 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29804 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29805 be available.
29806
29807
29808 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29809 @findex -var-list-children
29810
29811 @subsubheading Synopsis
29812
29813 @smallexample
29814 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29815 @end smallexample
29816 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29817
29818 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29819 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29820 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29821 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29822 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29823 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29824 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29825 and unions.
29826
29827 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29828 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29829 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29830 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29831 reported.
29832
29833 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29834 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29835 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29836 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29837 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29838 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29839 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29840 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29841 the visible items.
29842
29843 For each child the following results are returned:
29844
29845 @table @var
29846
29847 @item name
29848 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29849
29850 @item exp
29851 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29852 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29853
29854 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29855 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29856
29857 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29858 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29859 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29860 type and value are not present.
29861
29862 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29863 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29864 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29865
29866 @item numchild
29867 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29868 0.
29869
29870 @item type
29871 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29872 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29873 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29874 @emph{declared} one.
29875
29876 @item value
29877 If values were requested, this is the value.
29878
29879 @item thread-id
29880 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29881 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29882
29883 @item frozen
29884 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29885
29886 @item displayhint
29887 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29888 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29889 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29890
29891 @item dynamic
29892 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29893 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29894 then this attribute will not be present.
29895
29896 @end table
29897
29898 The result may have its own attributes:
29899
29900 @table @samp
29901 @item displayhint
29902 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29903 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29904 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29905
29906 @item has_more
29907 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29908 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29909 @end table
29910
29911 @subsubheading Example
29912
29913 @smallexample
29914 (gdb)
29915 -var-list-children n
29916 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29917 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29918 (gdb)
29919 -var-list-children --all-values n
29920 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29921 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29922 @end smallexample
29923
29924
29925 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29926 @findex -var-info-type
29927
29928 @subsubheading Synopsis
29929
29930 @smallexample
29931 -var-info-type @var{name}
29932 @end smallexample
29933
29934 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29935 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29936 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29937
29938 @smallexample
29939 type=@var{typename}
29940 @end smallexample
29941
29942
29943 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29944 @findex -var-info-expression
29945
29946 @subsubheading Synopsis
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29950 @end smallexample
29951
29952 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29953 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29954 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29955
29956 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29957 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29958
29959 @smallexample
29960 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29961 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29962 @end smallexample
29963
29964 @noindent
29965 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29966 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29967
29968 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29969 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29970 is of limited use.
29971
29972 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29973 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29974
29975 @subsubheading Synopsis
29976
29977 @smallexample
29978 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29982 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29983 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29984 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29985 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29986 watchpoint from a variable object.
29987
29988 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29989 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29990
29991 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29992 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29993 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29994 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29995 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29996 @smallexample
29997 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29998 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29999 @end smallexample
30000
30001 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30002 @findex -var-show-attributes
30003
30004 @subsubheading Synopsis
30005
30006 @smallexample
30007 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30008 @end smallexample
30009
30010 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30011
30012 @smallexample
30013 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30014 @end smallexample
30015
30016 @noindent
30017 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30018
30019 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30020 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30021
30022 @subsubheading Synopsis
30023
30024 @smallexample
30025 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30026 @end smallexample
30027
30028 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30029 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30030 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30031 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30032 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30033 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30034 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30035
30036 @smallexample
30037 value=@var{value}
30038 @end smallexample
30039
30040 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30041 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30042
30043 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30044 @findex -var-assign
30045
30046 @subsubheading Synopsis
30047
30048 @smallexample
30049 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30050 @end smallexample
30051
30052 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30053 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30054 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30055 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30056
30057 @subsubheading Example
30058
30059 @smallexample
30060 (gdb)
30061 -var-assign var1 3
30062 ^done,value="3"
30063 (gdb)
30064 -var-update *
30065 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30066 (gdb)
30067 @end smallexample
30068
30069 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30070 @findex -var-update
30071
30072 @subsubheading Synopsis
30073
30074 @smallexample
30075 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30076 @end smallexample
30077
30078 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30079 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30080 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30081 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30082 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30083 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30084 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30085 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30086 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30087 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30088 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30089 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30090 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30091
30092 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30093 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30094 diagnostic.
30095
30096 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30097 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30098
30099 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30100 @samp{changelist}.
30101
30102 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30103
30104 @table @samp
30105 @item name
30106 The name of the varobj.
30107
30108 @item value
30109 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30110 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30111
30112 @item in_scope
30113 @anchor{-var-update}
30114 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30115
30116 @table @code
30117 @item "true"
30118 The variable object's current value is valid.
30119
30120 @item "false"
30121 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30122 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30123 scope.
30124
30125 @item "invalid"
30126 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30127 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30128 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30129 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30130 objects.
30131 @end table
30132
30133 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30134 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30135
30136 @item type_changed
30137 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30138 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30139 be @samp{false}.
30140
30141 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30142 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30143 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30144 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30145 unset.
30146
30147 @item new_type
30148 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30149 hold the new type.
30150
30151 @item new_num_children
30152 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30153 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30154
30155 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30156 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30157 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30158 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30159 children which may be available.
30160
30161 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30162 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30163 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30164 only happen at the end of the update range).
30165
30166 @item displayhint
30167 The display hint, if any.
30168
30169 @item has_more
30170 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30171 available outside the varobj's update range.
30172
30173 @item dynamic
30174 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30175 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30176 then this attribute will not be present.
30177
30178 @item new_children
30179 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30180 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30181 be listed in this attribute.
30182 @end table
30183
30184 @subsubheading Example
30185
30186 @smallexample
30187 (gdb)
30188 -var-assign var1 3
30189 ^done,value="3"
30190 (gdb)
30191 -var-update --all-values var1
30192 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30193 type_changed="false"@}]
30194 (gdb)
30195 @end smallexample
30196
30197 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30198 @findex -var-set-frozen
30199 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30200
30201 @subsubheading Synopsis
30202
30203 @smallexample
30204 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30205 @end smallexample
30206
30207 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30208 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30209 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30210 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30211 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30212 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30213 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30214 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30215 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30216 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30217 @code{-var-update} does.
30218
30219 @subsubheading Example
30220
30221 @smallexample
30222 (gdb)
30223 -var-set-frozen V 1
30224 ^done
30225 (gdb)
30226 @end smallexample
30227
30228 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30229 @findex -var-set-update-range
30230 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30231
30232 @subsubheading Synopsis
30233
30234 @smallexample
30235 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30236 @end smallexample
30237
30238 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30239 @code{-var-update}.
30240
30241 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30242 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30243 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30244 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30245
30246 @subsubheading Example
30247
30248 @smallexample
30249 (gdb)
30250 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30251 ^done
30252 @end smallexample
30253
30254 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30255 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30256 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30257
30258 @subsubheading Synopsis
30259
30260 @smallexample
30261 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30265
30266 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30267 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30268
30269 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30270 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30271 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30272 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30273 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30274 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30275 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30276
30277 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30278 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30279 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30280 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30281
30282 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30283 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30284 can be used to check this.
30285
30286 @subsubheading Example
30287
30288 Resetting the visualizer:
30289
30290 @smallexample
30291 (gdb)
30292 -var-set-visualizer V None
30293 ^done
30294 @end smallexample
30295
30296 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30297
30298 @smallexample
30299 (gdb)
30300 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30301 ^done
30302 @end smallexample
30303
30304 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30305 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30306
30307 @smallexample
30308 (gdb)
30309 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30310 ^done
30311 @end smallexample
30312
30313 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30314 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30315 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30316
30317 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30318 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30319 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30320 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30321
30322 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30323 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30324
30325 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30326 @c @subheading -data-assign
30327 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30328 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30329 @c set variable
30330 @c @subsubheading Example
30331 @c N.A.
30332
30333 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30334 @findex -data-disassemble
30335
30336 @subsubheading Synopsis
30337
30338 @smallexample
30339 -data-disassemble
30340 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30341 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30342 -- @var{mode}
30343 @end smallexample
30344
30345 @noindent
30346 Where:
30347
30348 @table @samp
30349 @item @var{start-addr}
30350 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30351 @item @var{end-addr}
30352 is the end address
30353 @item @var{filename}
30354 is the name of the file to disassemble
30355 @item @var{linenum}
30356 is the line number to disassemble around
30357 @item @var{lines}
30358 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30359 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30360 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30361 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30362 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30363 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30364 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30365 are displayed.
30366 @item @var{mode}
30367 is one of:
30368 @itemize @bullet
30369 @item 0 disassembly only
30370 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30371 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30372 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30373 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30374 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30375 @end itemize
30376
30377 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30378 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30379 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30380 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30381 @end table
30382
30383 @subsubheading Result
30384
30385 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30386 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30387 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30388
30389 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30390 following fields:
30391
30392 @table @code
30393 @item address
30394 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30395
30396 @item func-name
30397 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30398
30399 @item offset
30400 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30401
30402 @item inst
30403 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30404
30405 @item opcodes
30406 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30407 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30408
30409 @end table
30410
30411 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30412 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30413
30414 @table @code
30415 @item line
30416 The line number within @samp{file}.
30417
30418 @item file
30419 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30420 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30421 used.
30422
30423 @item fullname
30424 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30425 using the source file search path
30426 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30427 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30428
30429 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30430 present in the debug information.
30431
30432 @item line_asm_insn
30433 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30434 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30435 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30436 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30437 @samp{opcodes}.
30438
30439 @end table
30440
30441 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30442 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30443 adjust its format.
30444
30445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30446
30447 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30448
30449 @subsubheading Example
30450
30451 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30452
30453 @smallexample
30454 (gdb)
30455 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30456 ^done,
30457 asm_insns=[
30458 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30459 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30460 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30461 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30462 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30463 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30464 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30465 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30466 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30467 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30468 (gdb)
30469 @end smallexample
30470
30471 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30472 @code{main}.
30473
30474 @smallexample
30475 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30476 ^done,asm_insns=[
30477 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30478 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30479 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30480 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30481 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30482 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30483 [@dots{}]
30484 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30485 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30486 (gdb)
30487 @end smallexample
30488
30489 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30490
30491 @smallexample
30492 (gdb)
30493 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30494 ^done,asm_insns=[
30495 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30496 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30497 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30498 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30499 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30500 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30501 (gdb)
30502 @end smallexample
30503
30504 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30505
30506 @smallexample
30507 (gdb)
30508 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30509 ^done,asm_insns=[
30510 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30511 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30512 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30513 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30514 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30515 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30516 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30517 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30518 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30519 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30520 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30521 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30522 (gdb)
30523 @end smallexample
30524
30525
30526 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30527 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30528
30529 @subsubheading Synopsis
30530
30531 @smallexample
30532 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30533 @end smallexample
30534
30535 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30536 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30537 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30538
30539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30540
30541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30542 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30543 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30544
30545 @subsubheading Example
30546
30547 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30548 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30549 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30550 output.
30551
30552 @smallexample
30553 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30554 211^done,value="1"
30555 (gdb)
30556 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30557 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30558 (gdb)
30559 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30560 411^done,value="4"
30561 (gdb)
30562 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30563 511^done,value="4"
30564 (gdb)
30565 @end smallexample
30566
30567
30568 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30569 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30570
30571 @subsubheading Synopsis
30572
30573 @smallexample
30574 -data-list-changed-registers
30575 @end smallexample
30576
30577 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30578
30579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30580
30581 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30582 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30583
30584 @subsubheading Example
30585
30586 On a PPC MBX board:
30587
30588 @smallexample
30589 (gdb)
30590 -exec-continue
30591 ^running
30592
30593 (gdb)
30594 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30595 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30596 line="5"@}
30597 (gdb)
30598 -data-list-changed-registers
30599 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30600 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30601 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30602 (gdb)
30603 @end smallexample
30604
30605
30606 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30607 @findex -data-list-register-names
30608
30609 @subsubheading Synopsis
30610
30611 @smallexample
30612 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30613 @end smallexample
30614
30615 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30616 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30617 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30618 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30619 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30620 include empty register names.
30621
30622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30623
30624 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30625 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30626 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30627
30628 @subsubheading Example
30629
30630 For the PPC MBX board:
30631 @smallexample
30632 (gdb)
30633 -data-list-register-names
30634 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30635 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30636 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30637 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30638 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30639 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30640 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30641 (gdb)
30642 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30643 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30644 (gdb)
30645 @end smallexample
30646
30647 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30648 @findex -data-list-register-values
30649
30650 @subsubheading Synopsis
30651
30652 @smallexample
30653 -data-list-register-values
30654 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30655 @end smallexample
30656
30657 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30658 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30659 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30660 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30661 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30662 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30663
30664 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30665
30666 @table @code
30667 @item x
30668 Hexadecimal
30669 @item o
30670 Octal
30671 @item t
30672 Binary
30673 @item d
30674 Decimal
30675 @item r
30676 Raw
30677 @item N
30678 Natural
30679 @end table
30680
30681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30682
30683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30684 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30685
30686 @subsubheading Example
30687
30688 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30689 don't appear in the actual output):
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 (gdb)
30693 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30694 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30695 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30696 (gdb)
30697 -data-list-register-values x
30698 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30699 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30700 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30701 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30702 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30703 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30704 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30705 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30706 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30707 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30708 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30709 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30710 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30711 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30712 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30713 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30714 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30715 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30716 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30717 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30718 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30719 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30720 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30721 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30722 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30723 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30724 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30725 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30726 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30727 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30728 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30729 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30730 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30731 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30732 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30733 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30734 (gdb)
30735 @end smallexample
30736
30737
30738 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30739 @findex -data-read-memory
30740
30741 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30742
30743 @subsubheading Synopsis
30744
30745 @smallexample
30746 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30747 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30748 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751 @noindent
30752 where:
30753
30754 @table @samp
30755 @item @var{address}
30756 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30757 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30758 quoted using the C convention.
30759
30760 @item @var{word-format}
30761 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30762 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30763 ,Output Formats}).
30764
30765 @item @var{word-size}
30766 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30767
30768 @item @var{nr-rows}
30769 The number of rows in the output table.
30770
30771 @item @var{nr-cols}
30772 The number of columns in the output table.
30773
30774 @item @var{aschar}
30775 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30776 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30777 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30778 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30779
30780 @item @var{byte-offset}
30781 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30782 @end table
30783
30784 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30785 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30786 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30787 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30788 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30789 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30790 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30791 @samp{addr}.
30792
30793 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30794 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30795 @samp{prev-page}.
30796
30797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30798
30799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30800 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30801
30802 @subsubheading Example
30803
30804 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30805 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30806 word. Display each word in hex.
30807
30808 @smallexample
30809 (gdb)
30810 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30811 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30812 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30813 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30814 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30815 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30816 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30817 (gdb)
30818 @end smallexample
30819
30820 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30821 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30822
30823 @smallexample
30824 (gdb)
30825 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30826 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30827 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30828 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30829 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30830 (gdb)
30831 @end smallexample
30832
30833 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30834 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30835 used as the non-printable character.
30836
30837 @smallexample
30838 (gdb)
30839 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30840 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30841 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30842 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30843 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30844 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30845 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30846 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30847 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30848 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30849 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30850 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30851 (gdb)
30852 @end smallexample
30853
30854 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30855 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30856
30857 @subsubheading Synopsis
30858
30859 @smallexample
30860 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30861 @var{address} @var{count}
30862 @end smallexample
30863
30864 @noindent
30865 where:
30866
30867 @table @samp
30868 @item @var{address}
30869 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30870 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30871 quoted using the C convention.
30872
30873 @item @var{count}
30874 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30875 literal.
30876
30877 @item @var{offset}
30878 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30879 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30880 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30881 arithmetics itself.
30882
30883 @end table
30884
30885 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30886 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30887 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30888 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30889 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30890 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30891
30892 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30893 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30894 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30895 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30896 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30897 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30898 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30899 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30900
30901 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30902 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30903 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30904 and has the following fields:
30905
30906 @table @code
30907 @item begin
30908 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30909
30910 @item end
30911 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30912
30913 @item offset
30914 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30915 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30916
30917 @item contents
30918 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30919
30920 @end table
30921
30922
30923
30924 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30925
30926 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30927
30928 @subsubheading Example
30929
30930 @smallexample
30931 (gdb)
30932 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30933 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30934 end="0xbffff15e",
30935 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30936 (gdb)
30937 @end smallexample
30938
30939
30940 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30941 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30942
30943 @subsubheading Synopsis
30944
30945 @smallexample
30946 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30947 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30948 @end smallexample
30949
30950 @noindent
30951 where:
30952
30953 @table @samp
30954 @item @var{address}
30955 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30956 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30957 be quoted using the C convention.
30958
30959 @item @var{contents}
30960 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30961 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30962
30963 @item @var{count}
30964 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30965 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30966 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30967 @var{count} memory units.
30968
30969 @end table
30970
30971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30972
30973 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30974
30975 @subsubheading Example
30976
30977 @smallexample
30978 (gdb)
30979 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30980 ^done
30981 (gdb)
30982 @end smallexample
30983
30984 @smallexample
30985 (gdb)
30986 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30987 ^done
30988 (gdb)
30989 @end smallexample
30990
30991 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30992 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30993 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30994
30995 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30996 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30997
30998 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30999 @findex -trace-find
31000
31001 @subsubheading Synopsis
31002
31003 @smallexample
31004 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31005 @end smallexample
31006
31007 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31008 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31009 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31010
31011 @table @samp
31012
31013 @item none
31014 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31015
31016 @item frame-number
31017 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31018 that index.
31019
31020 @item tracepoint-number
31021 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31022 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31023
31024 @item pc
31025 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31026 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31027 address.
31028
31029 @item pc-inside-range
31030 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31031 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31032 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31033
31034 @item pc-outside-range
31035 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31036 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31037 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31038
31039 @item line
31040 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31041 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31042 the specified location.
31043
31044 @end table
31045
31046 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31047 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31048
31049 @table @samp
31050 @item found
31051 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31052 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31053
31054 @item traceframe
31055 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31056 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31057
31058 @item tracepoint
31059 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31060 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31061
31062 @item frame
31063 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31064 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31065 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31066
31067 @end table
31068
31069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31070
31071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31072
31073 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31074 @findex -trace-define-variable
31075
31076 @subsubheading Synopsis
31077
31078 @smallexample
31079 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31080 @end smallexample
31081
31082 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31083 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31084 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31085 with the @samp{$} character.
31086
31087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31088
31089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31090
31091 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31092 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31093
31094 @subsubheading Synopsis
31095
31096 @smallexample
31097 -trace-frame-collected
31098 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31099 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31100 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31101 [--memory-contents]
31102 @end smallexample
31103
31104 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31105 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31106 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31107 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31108 See the output description table below for more details.
31109
31110 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31111 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31112 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31113 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31114 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31115
31116 For instance, if the actions were
31117 @smallexample
31118 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31119 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31120 @end smallexample
31121
31122 @noindent
31123 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31124 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31125 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31126 objects would be computed expressions.
31127
31128 An example output would be:
31129
31130 @smallexample
31131 (gdb)
31132 -trace-frame-collected
31133 ^done,
31134 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31135 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31136 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31137 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31138 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31139 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31140 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31141 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31142 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31143 ...
31144 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31145 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31146 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31147 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31148 (gdb)
31149 @end smallexample
31150
31151 Where:
31152
31153 @table @code
31154 @item explicit-variables
31155 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31156 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31157 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31158 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31159 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31160 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31161 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31162 arrays, structures and unions.
31163
31164 @item computed-expressions
31165 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31166 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31167 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31168 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31169
31170 @item registers
31171 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31172 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31173 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31174 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31175 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31176
31177 @item tvars
31178 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31179 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31180 current value are returned.
31181
31182 @item memory
31183 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31184 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31185 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31186
31187 @table @code
31188 @item address
31189 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31190
31191 @item length
31192 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31193
31194 @item contents
31195 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31196 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31197
31198 @end table
31199
31200 @end table
31201
31202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31203
31204 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31205
31206 @subsubheading Example
31207
31208 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31209 @findex -trace-list-variables
31210
31211 @subsubheading Synopsis
31212
31213 @smallexample
31214 -trace-list-variables
31215 @end smallexample
31216
31217 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31218 table has the following fields:
31219
31220 @table @samp
31221 @item name
31222 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31223
31224 @item initial
31225 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31226 field is always present.
31227
31228 @item current
31229 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31230 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31231 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31232 presently running.
31233
31234 @end table
31235
31236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31237
31238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31239
31240 @subsubheading Example
31241
31242 @smallexample
31243 (gdb)
31244 -trace-list-variables
31245 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31246 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31247 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31248 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31249 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31250 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31251 (gdb)
31252 @end smallexample
31253
31254 @subheading -trace-save
31255 @findex -trace-save
31256
31257 @subsubheading Synopsis
31258
31259 @smallexample
31260 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31261 @end smallexample
31262
31263 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31264 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31265 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31266 to perform the save.
31267
31268 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31269 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31270 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31271
31272 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31273
31274 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31275
31276
31277 @subheading -trace-start
31278 @findex -trace-start
31279
31280 @subsubheading Synopsis
31281
31282 @smallexample
31283 -trace-start
31284 @end smallexample
31285
31286 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31287 have any fields.
31288
31289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31290
31291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31292
31293 @subheading -trace-status
31294 @findex -trace-status
31295
31296 @subsubheading Synopsis
31297
31298 @smallexample
31299 -trace-status
31300 @end smallexample
31301
31302 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31303 the following fields:
31304
31305 @table @samp
31306
31307 @item supported
31308 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31309 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31310 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31311 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31312 started. This field is always present.
31313
31314 @item running
31315 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31316 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31317 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31318
31319 @item stop-reason
31320 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31321 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31322 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31323 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31324 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31325 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31326 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31327 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31328 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31329
31330 @item stopping-tracepoint
31331 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31332 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31333 @samp{passcount}.
31334
31335 @item frames
31336 @itemx frames-created
31337 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31338 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31339 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31340 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31341
31342 @item buffer-size
31343 @itemx buffer-free
31344 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31345 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31346
31347 @item circular
31348 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31349 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31350 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31351 and may fill up.
31352
31353 @item disconnected
31354 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31355 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31356 that the trace run will stop.
31357
31358 @item trace-file
31359 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31360 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31361
31362 @end table
31363
31364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31365
31366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31367
31368 @subheading -trace-stop
31369 @findex -trace-stop
31370
31371 @subsubheading Synopsis
31372
31373 @smallexample
31374 -trace-stop
31375 @end smallexample
31376
31377 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31378 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31379 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31380
31381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31382
31383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31384
31385
31386 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31387 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31388 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31389
31390
31391 @ignore
31392 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31393 @findex -symbol-info-address
31394
31395 @subsubheading Synopsis
31396
31397 @smallexample
31398 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31399 @end smallexample
31400
31401 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31402
31403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31404
31405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31406
31407 @subsubheading Example
31408 N.A.
31409
31410
31411 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31412 @findex -symbol-info-file
31413
31414 @subsubheading Synopsis
31415
31416 @smallexample
31417 -symbol-info-file
31418 @end smallexample
31419
31420 Show the file for the symbol.
31421
31422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31423
31424 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31425 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31426
31427 @subsubheading Example
31428 N.A.
31429
31430
31431 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31432 @findex -symbol-info-function
31433
31434 @subsubheading Synopsis
31435
31436 @smallexample
31437 -symbol-info-function
31438 @end smallexample
31439
31440 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31441
31442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31443
31444 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31445
31446 @subsubheading Example
31447 N.A.
31448
31449
31450 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31451 @findex -symbol-info-line
31452
31453 @subsubheading Synopsis
31454
31455 @smallexample
31456 -symbol-info-line
31457 @end smallexample
31458
31459 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31460
31461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31462
31463 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31464 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31465
31466 @subsubheading Example
31467 N.A.
31468
31469
31470 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31471 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31472
31473 @subsubheading Synopsis
31474
31475 @smallexample
31476 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31477 @end smallexample
31478
31479 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31480
31481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31482
31483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31484
31485 @subsubheading Example
31486 N.A.
31487
31488
31489 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31490 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31491
31492 @subsubheading Synopsis
31493
31494 @smallexample
31495 -symbol-list-functions
31496 @end smallexample
31497
31498 List the functions in the executable.
31499
31500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31501
31502 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31503 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31504
31505 @subsubheading Example
31506 N.A.
31507 @end ignore
31508
31509
31510 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31511 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31512
31513 @subsubheading Synopsis
31514
31515 @smallexample
31516 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31517 @end smallexample
31518
31519 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31520 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31521 ascending PC order.
31522
31523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31524
31525 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31526
31527 @subsubheading Example
31528 @smallexample
31529 (gdb)
31530 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31531 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31532 (gdb)
31533 @end smallexample
31534
31535
31536 @ignore
31537 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31538 @findex -symbol-list-types
31539
31540 @subsubheading Synopsis
31541
31542 @smallexample
31543 -symbol-list-types
31544 @end smallexample
31545
31546 List all the type names.
31547
31548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31549
31550 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31551 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31552
31553 @subsubheading Example
31554 N.A.
31555
31556
31557 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31558 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31559
31560 @subsubheading Synopsis
31561
31562 @smallexample
31563 -symbol-list-variables
31564 @end smallexample
31565
31566 List all the global and static variable names.
31567
31568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31569
31570 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31571
31572 @subsubheading Example
31573 N.A.
31574
31575
31576 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31577 @findex -symbol-locate
31578
31579 @subsubheading Synopsis
31580
31581 @smallexample
31582 -symbol-locate
31583 @end smallexample
31584
31585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31586
31587 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31588
31589 @subsubheading Example
31590 N.A.
31591
31592
31593 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31594 @findex -symbol-type
31595
31596 @subsubheading Synopsis
31597
31598 @smallexample
31599 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31600 @end smallexample
31601
31602 Show type of @var{variable}.
31603
31604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31605
31606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31607 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31608
31609 @subsubheading Example
31610 N.A.
31611 @end ignore
31612
31613
31614 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31615 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31616 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31617
31618 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31619 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31620
31621 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31622 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31623
31624 @subsubheading Synopsis
31625
31626 @smallexample
31627 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31628 @end smallexample
31629
31630 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31631 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31632 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31633 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31634 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31635 notification.
31636
31637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31638
31639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31640
31641 @subsubheading Example
31642
31643 @smallexample
31644 (gdb)
31645 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31646 ^done
31647 (gdb)
31648 @end smallexample
31649
31650
31651 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31652 @findex -file-exec-file
31653
31654 @subsubheading Synopsis
31655
31656 @smallexample
31657 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31658 @end smallexample
31659
31660 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31661 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31662 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31663 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31664 notification.
31665
31666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31667
31668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31669
31670 @subsubheading Example
31671
31672 @smallexample
31673 (gdb)
31674 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31675 ^done
31676 (gdb)
31677 @end smallexample
31678
31679
31680 @ignore
31681 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31682 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31683
31684 @subsubheading Synopsis
31685
31686 @smallexample
31687 -file-list-exec-sections
31688 @end smallexample
31689
31690 List the sections of the current executable file.
31691
31692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31693
31694 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31695 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31696 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31697
31698 @subsubheading Example
31699 N.A.
31700 @end ignore
31701
31702
31703 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31704 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31705
31706 @subsubheading Synopsis
31707
31708 @smallexample
31709 -file-list-exec-source-file
31710 @end smallexample
31711
31712 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31713 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31714 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31715 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31716
31717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31718
31719 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31720
31721 @subsubheading Example
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 (gdb)
31725 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31726 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31727 (gdb)
31728 @end smallexample
31729
31730
31731 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31732 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31733
31734 @subsubheading Synopsis
31735
31736 @smallexample
31737 -file-list-exec-source-files
31738 @end smallexample
31739
31740 List the source files for the current executable.
31741
31742 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31743 name) of a source file.
31744
31745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31746
31747 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31748 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31749
31750 @subsubheading Example
31751 @smallexample
31752 (gdb)
31753 -file-list-exec-source-files
31754 ^done,files=[
31755 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31756 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31757 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31758 (gdb)
31759 @end smallexample
31760
31761 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31762 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31763
31764 @subsubheading Synopsis
31765
31766 @smallexample
31767 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31768 @end smallexample
31769
31770 List the shared libraries in the program.
31771 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31772 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31773
31774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31775
31776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31777 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31778 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31779 library. Each range has the following fields:
31780
31781 @table @samp
31782 @item from
31783 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31784 @item to
31785 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31786 @end table
31787
31788 @subsubheading Example
31789 @smallexample
31790 (gdb)
31791 -file-list-exec-source-files
31792 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31793 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31794 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31795 (gdb)
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798
31799 @ignore
31800 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31801 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31802
31803 @subsubheading Synopsis
31804
31805 @smallexample
31806 -file-list-symbol-files
31807 @end smallexample
31808
31809 List symbol files.
31810
31811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31812
31813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31814
31815 @subsubheading Example
31816 N.A.
31817 @end ignore
31818
31819
31820 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31821 @findex -file-symbol-file
31822
31823 @subsubheading Synopsis
31824
31825 @smallexample
31826 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31827 @end smallexample
31828
31829 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31830 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31831 produced, except for a completion notification.
31832
31833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31834
31835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31836
31837 @subsubheading Example
31838
31839 @smallexample
31840 (gdb)
31841 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31842 ^done
31843 (gdb)
31844 @end smallexample
31845
31846 @ignore
31847 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31848 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31849 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31850
31851 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31852
31853 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31854
31855 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31856
31857 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31858
31859 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31860
31861 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31862
31863 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31864
31865 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31866
31867 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31868 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31869 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31870
31871 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31872
31873 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31874
31875 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31876
31877 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31878 @end ignore
31879
31880
31881 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31882 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31883 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31884
31885
31886 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31887 @findex -target-attach
31888
31889 @subsubheading Synopsis
31890
31891 @smallexample
31892 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31893 @end smallexample
31894
31895 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31896 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31897 group, the id previously returned by
31898 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31899
31900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31901
31902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31903
31904 @subsubheading Example
31905 @smallexample
31906 (gdb)
31907 -target-attach 34
31908 =thread-created,id="1"
31909 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31910 ^done
31911 (gdb)
31912 @end smallexample
31913
31914 @ignore
31915 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31916 @findex -target-compare-sections
31917
31918 @subsubheading Synopsis
31919
31920 @smallexample
31921 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31922 @end smallexample
31923
31924 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31925 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31926
31927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31928
31929 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31930
31931 @subsubheading Example
31932 N.A.
31933 @end ignore
31934
31935
31936 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31937 @findex -target-detach
31938
31939 @subsubheading Synopsis
31940
31941 @smallexample
31942 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31943 @end smallexample
31944
31945 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31946 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31947 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31948
31949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31950
31951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31952
31953 @subsubheading Example
31954
31955 @smallexample
31956 (gdb)
31957 -target-detach
31958 ^done
31959 (gdb)
31960 @end smallexample
31961
31962
31963 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31964 @findex -target-disconnect
31965
31966 @subsubheading Synopsis
31967
31968 @smallexample
31969 -target-disconnect
31970 @end smallexample
31971
31972 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31973 generally not resumed.
31974
31975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31976
31977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31978
31979 @subsubheading Example
31980
31981 @smallexample
31982 (gdb)
31983 -target-disconnect
31984 ^done
31985 (gdb)
31986 @end smallexample
31987
31988
31989 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31990 @findex -target-download
31991
31992 @subsubheading Synopsis
31993
31994 @smallexample
31995 -target-download
31996 @end smallexample
31997
31998 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31999 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32000
32001 @table @samp
32002 @item section
32003 The name of the section.
32004 @item section-sent
32005 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32006 @item section-size
32007 The size of the section.
32008 @item total-sent
32009 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32010 @item total-size
32011 The size of the overall executable to download.
32012 @end table
32013
32014 @noindent
32015 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32016 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32017
32018 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32019 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32020
32021 @table @samp
32022 @item section
32023 The name of the section.
32024 @item section-size
32025 The size of the section.
32026 @item total-size
32027 The size of the overall executable to download.
32028 @end table
32029
32030 @noindent
32031 At the end, a summary is printed.
32032
32033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32034
32035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32036
32037 @subsubheading Example
32038
32039 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32040 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32041
32042 @smallexample
32043 (gdb)
32044 -target-download
32045 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32046 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32047 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32048 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32049 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32050 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32051 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32052 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32053 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32054 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32055 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32056 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32057 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32058 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32059 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32060 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32061 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32062 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32063 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32064 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32065 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32066 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32067 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32068 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32069 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32070 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32071 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32072 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32073 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32074 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32075 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32076 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32077 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32078 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32079 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32080 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32081 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32082 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32083 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32084 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32085 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32086 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32087 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32088 write-rate="429"
32089 (gdb)
32090 @end smallexample
32091
32092
32093 @ignore
32094 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32095 @findex -target-exec-status
32096
32097 @subsubheading Synopsis
32098
32099 @smallexample
32100 -target-exec-status
32101 @end smallexample
32102
32103 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32104 not, for instance).
32105
32106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32107
32108 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32109
32110 @subsubheading Example
32111 N.A.
32112
32113
32114 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32115 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32116
32117 @subsubheading Synopsis
32118
32119 @smallexample
32120 -target-list-available-targets
32121 @end smallexample
32122
32123 List the possible targets to connect to.
32124
32125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32126
32127 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32128
32129 @subsubheading Example
32130 N.A.
32131
32132
32133 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32134 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32135
32136 @subsubheading Synopsis
32137
32138 @smallexample
32139 -target-list-current-targets
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 Describe the current target.
32143
32144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32145
32146 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32147 other things).
32148
32149 @subsubheading Example
32150 N.A.
32151
32152
32153 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32154 @findex -target-list-parameters
32155
32156 @subsubheading Synopsis
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 -target-list-parameters
32160 @end smallexample
32161
32162 @c ????
32163 @end ignore
32164
32165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32166
32167 No equivalent.
32168
32169 @subsubheading Example
32170 N.A.
32171
32172 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32173 @findex -target-flash-erase
32174
32175 @subsubheading Synopsis
32176
32177 @smallexample
32178 -target-flash-erase
32179 @end smallexample
32180
32181 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32182
32183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32184
32185 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32186 addresses and memory region sizes.
32187
32188 @smallexample
32189 (gdb)
32190 -target-flash-erase
32191 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32192 (gdb)
32193 @end smallexample
32194
32195 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32196 @findex -target-select
32197
32198 @subsubheading Synopsis
32199
32200 @smallexample
32201 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32202 @end smallexample
32203
32204 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32205
32206 @table @samp
32207 @item @var{type}
32208 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32209 @item @var{parameters}
32210 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32211 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32212 @end table
32213
32214 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32215 which the target program is, in the following form:
32216
32217 @smallexample
32218 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32219 args=[@var{arg list}]
32220 @end smallexample
32221
32222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32223
32224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32225
32226 @subsubheading Example
32227
32228 @smallexample
32229 (gdb)
32230 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32231 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32232 (gdb)
32233 @end smallexample
32234
32235 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32236 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32237 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32238
32239
32240 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32241 @findex -target-file-put
32242
32243 @subsubheading Synopsis
32244
32245 @smallexample
32246 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32247 @end smallexample
32248
32249 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32250 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32251
32252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32253
32254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32255
32256 @subsubheading Example
32257
32258 @smallexample
32259 (gdb)
32260 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32261 ^done
32262 (gdb)
32263 @end smallexample
32264
32265
32266 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32267 @findex -target-file-get
32268
32269 @subsubheading Synopsis
32270
32271 @smallexample
32272 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32273 @end smallexample
32274
32275 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32276 on the host system.
32277
32278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32279
32280 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32281
32282 @subsubheading Example
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 (gdb)
32286 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32287 ^done
32288 (gdb)
32289 @end smallexample
32290
32291
32292 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32293 @findex -target-file-delete
32294
32295 @subsubheading Synopsis
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32299 @end smallexample
32300
32301 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32302
32303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32304
32305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32306
32307 @subsubheading Example
32308
32309 @smallexample
32310 (gdb)
32311 -target-file-delete remotefile
32312 ^done
32313 (gdb)
32314 @end smallexample
32315
32316
32317 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32318 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32319 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32320
32321 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32322 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32323
32324 @subsubheading Synopsis
32325
32326 @smallexample
32327 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32328 @end smallexample
32329
32330 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32331 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32332 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32333
32334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32335
32336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32337
32338 @subsubheading Result
32339
32340 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32341 defined for each exception:
32342
32343 @table @samp
32344 @item name
32345 The name of the exception.
32346
32347 @item address
32348 The address of the exception.
32349
32350 @end table
32351
32352 @subsubheading Example
32353
32354 @smallexample
32355 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32356 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32357 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32358 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32359 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32360 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32361 @end smallexample
32362
32363 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32364
32365 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32366 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32367 Catchpoint Commands}.
32368
32369
32370 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32371 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32372 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32373
32374 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32375 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32376 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32377 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32378
32379 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32380 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32381 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32382
32383 @subsubheading Synopsis
32384
32385 @smallexample
32386 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32387 @end smallexample
32388
32389 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32390
32391 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32392 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32393 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32394 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32395 dash.
32396
32397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32398
32399 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32400
32401 @subsubheading Result
32402
32403 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32404
32405 @table @samp
32406 @item exists
32407 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32408 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32409
32410 @end table
32411
32412 @subsubheading Example
32413
32414 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32415
32416 @smallexample
32417 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32418 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32419 @end smallexample
32420
32421 @noindent
32422 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32423 to the debugger:
32424
32425 @smallexample
32426 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32427 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32428 @end smallexample
32429
32430 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32431 @findex -list-features
32432 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32433
32434 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32435 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32436 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32437 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32438 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32439 startup.
32440
32441 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32442 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32443 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32444 is given below.
32445
32446 Example output:
32447
32448 @smallexample
32449 (gdb) -list-features
32450 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32451 @end smallexample
32452
32453 The current list of features is:
32454
32455 @ftable @samp
32456 @item frozen-varobjs
32457 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32458 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32459 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32460 @item pending-breakpoints
32461 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32462 command.
32463 @item python
32464 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32465 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32466 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32467 @item thread-info
32468 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32469 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32470 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32471 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32472 @item breakpoint-notifications
32473 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32474 CLI will be announced via async records.
32475 @item ada-task-info
32476 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32477 @item language-option
32478 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32479 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32480 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32481 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32482 @item undefined-command-error-code
32483 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32484 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32485 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32486 @item exec-run-start-option
32487 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32488 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32489 @end ftable
32490
32491 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32492 @findex -list-target-features
32493
32494 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32495 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32496 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32497 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32498 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32499 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32500 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32501 Example output:
32502
32503 @smallexample
32504 (gdb) -list-target-features
32505 ^done,result=["async"]
32506 @end smallexample
32507
32508 The current list of features is:
32509
32510 @table @samp
32511 @item async
32512 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32513 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32514 while the target is running.
32515
32516 @item reverse
32517 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32518 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32519
32520 @end table
32521
32522 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32523 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32524 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32525
32526 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32527
32528 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32529 @findex -gdb-exit
32530
32531 @subsubheading Synopsis
32532
32533 @smallexample
32534 -gdb-exit
32535 @end smallexample
32536
32537 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32538
32539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32540
32541 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32542
32543 @subsubheading Example
32544
32545 @smallexample
32546 (gdb)
32547 -gdb-exit
32548 ^exit
32549 @end smallexample
32550
32551
32552 @ignore
32553 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32554 @findex -exec-abort
32555
32556 @subsubheading Synopsis
32557
32558 @smallexample
32559 -exec-abort
32560 @end smallexample
32561
32562 Kill the inferior running program.
32563
32564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32565
32566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32567
32568 @subsubheading Example
32569 N.A.
32570 @end ignore
32571
32572
32573 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32574 @findex -gdb-set
32575
32576 @subsubheading Synopsis
32577
32578 @smallexample
32579 -gdb-set
32580 @end smallexample
32581
32582 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32583 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32584
32585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32586
32587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32588
32589 @subsubheading Example
32590
32591 @smallexample
32592 (gdb)
32593 -gdb-set $foo=3
32594 ^done
32595 (gdb)
32596 @end smallexample
32597
32598
32599 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32600 @findex -gdb-show
32601
32602 @subsubheading Synopsis
32603
32604 @smallexample
32605 -gdb-show
32606 @end smallexample
32607
32608 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32609
32610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32611
32612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32613
32614 @subsubheading Example
32615
32616 @smallexample
32617 (gdb)
32618 -gdb-show annotate
32619 ^done,value="0"
32620 (gdb)
32621 @end smallexample
32622
32623 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32624
32625
32626 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32627 @findex -gdb-version
32628
32629 @subsubheading Synopsis
32630
32631 @smallexample
32632 -gdb-version
32633 @end smallexample
32634
32635 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32636
32637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32638
32639 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32640 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32641
32642 @subsubheading Example
32643
32644 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32645 @c box in TeX.
32646 @smallexample
32647 (gdb)
32648 -gdb-version
32649 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32650 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32651 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32652 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32653 ~ certain conditions.
32654 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32655 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32656 ~ details.
32657 ~This GDB was configured as
32658 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32659 ^done
32660 (gdb)
32661 @end smallexample
32662
32663 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32664 @findex -list-thread-groups
32665
32666 @subheading Synopsis
32667
32668 @smallexample
32669 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32670 @end smallexample
32671
32672 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32673 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32674 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32675 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32676 top-level thread groups.
32677
32678 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32679 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32680 available on the target.
32681
32682 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32683 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32684 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32685 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32686 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32687 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32688 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32689 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32690
32691 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32692 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32693 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32694 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32695 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32696 @samp{threads} field.
32697
32698 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32699 the following caveats:
32700
32701 @itemize @bullet
32702 @item
32703 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32704 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32705 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32706
32707 @item
32708 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32709 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32710 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32711 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32712 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32713 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32714
32715 @end itemize
32716
32717 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32718 have the following fields:
32719
32720 @table @code
32721 @item id
32722 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32723 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32724 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32725
32726 @item type
32727 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32728 valid type.
32729
32730 @item pid
32731 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32732 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32733
32734 @item exit-code
32735 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32736 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32737 only if the process is not running.
32738
32739 @item num_children
32740 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32741 absent for an available thread group.
32742
32743 @item threads
32744 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32745 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32746 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32747
32748 @item cores
32749 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32750 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32751 such information is not available.
32752
32753 @item executable
32754 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32755 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32756 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32757
32758 @end table
32759
32760 @subheading Example
32761
32762 @smallexample
32763 @value{GDBP}
32764 -list-thread-groups
32765 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32766 -list-thread-groups 17
32767 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32768 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32769 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32770 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32771 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32772 -list-thread-groups --available
32773 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32774 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32775 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32776 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32777 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32778 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32779 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32780 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32781 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32782 @end smallexample
32783
32784 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32785 @findex -info-os
32786
32787 @subsubheading Synopsis
32788
32789 @smallexample
32790 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32791 @end smallexample
32792
32793 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32794 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32795 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32796 of data of that type.
32797
32798 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32799 system.
32800
32801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32802
32803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32804
32805 @subsubheading Example
32806
32807 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32808 like this:
32809
32810 @smallexample
32811 @value{GDBP}
32812 -info-os
32813 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32814 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32815 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32816 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32817 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32818 col2="CPUs"@},
32819 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32820 col2="File descriptors"@},
32821 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32822 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32823 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32824 col2="Message queues"@},
32825 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32826 col2="Processes"@},
32827 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32828 col2="Process groups"@},
32829 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32830 col2="Semaphores"@},
32831 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32832 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32833 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32834 col2="Sockets"@},
32835 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32836 col2="Threads"@}]
32837 @value{GDBP}
32838 -info-os processes
32839 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32840 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32841 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32842 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32843 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32844 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32845 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32846 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32847 ...
32848 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32849 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32850 (gdb)
32851 @end smallexample
32852
32853 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32854 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32855 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32856 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32857 @code{info os} omits it.)
32858
32859 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32860 @findex -add-inferior
32861
32862 @subheading Synopsis
32863
32864 @smallexample
32865 -add-inferior
32866 @end smallexample
32867
32868 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32869 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32870 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32871 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32872 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32873 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32874
32875 @subheading Example
32876
32877 @smallexample
32878 @value{GDBP}
32879 -add-inferior
32880 ^done,inferior="i3"
32881 @end smallexample
32882
32883 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32884 @findex -interpreter-exec
32885
32886 @subheading Synopsis
32887
32888 @smallexample
32889 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32890 @end smallexample
32891 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32892
32893 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32894
32895 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32896
32897 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32898
32899 @subheading Example
32900
32901 @smallexample
32902 (gdb)
32903 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32904 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32905 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32906 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32907 ^done
32908 (gdb)
32909 @end smallexample
32910
32911 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32912 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32913
32914 @subheading Synopsis
32915
32916 @smallexample
32917 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32918 @end smallexample
32919
32920 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32921
32922 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32923
32924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32925
32926 @subheading Example
32927
32928 @smallexample
32929 (gdb)
32930 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32931 ^done
32932 (gdb)
32933 @end smallexample
32934
32935 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32936 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32937
32938 @subheading Synopsis
32939
32940 @smallexample
32941 -inferior-tty-show
32942 @end smallexample
32943
32944 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32945
32946 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32947
32948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32949
32950 @subheading Example
32951
32952 @smallexample
32953 (gdb)
32954 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32955 ^done
32956 (gdb)
32957 -inferior-tty-show
32958 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32959 (gdb)
32960 @end smallexample
32961
32962 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32963 @findex -enable-timings
32964
32965 @subheading Synopsis
32966
32967 @smallexample
32968 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32969 @end smallexample
32970
32971 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32972 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32973 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32974 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32975
32976 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32977
32978 No equivalent.
32979
32980 @subheading Example
32981
32982 @smallexample
32983 (gdb)
32984 -enable-timings
32985 ^done
32986 (gdb)
32987 -break-insert main
32988 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32989 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32990 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32991 times="0"@},
32992 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32993 (gdb)
32994 -enable-timings no
32995 ^done
32996 (gdb)
32997 -exec-run
32998 ^running
32999 (gdb)
33000 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33001 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33002 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33003 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33004 (gdb)
33005 @end smallexample
33006
33007 @node Annotations
33008 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33009
33010 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33011 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33012 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33013 relatively high level.
33014
33015 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33016 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33017
33018 @ignore
33019 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33020 @end ignore
33021
33022 @menu
33023 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33024 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33025 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33026 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33027 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33028 * Annotations for Running::
33029 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33030 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33031 @end menu
33032
33033 @node Annotations Overview
33034 @section What is an Annotation?
33035 @cindex annotations
33036
33037 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33038 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33039 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33040 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33041 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33042 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33043 cannot contain newline characters.
33044
33045 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33046 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33047 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33048 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33049 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33050 means those three characters as output.
33051
33052 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33053 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33054 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33055 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33056 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33057 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33058 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33059 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33060 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33061
33062 @table @code
33063 @kindex set annotate
33064 @item set annotate @var{level}
33065 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33066 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33067
33068 @item show annotate
33069 @kindex show annotate
33070 Show the current annotation level.
33071 @end table
33072
33073 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33074
33075 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33076
33077 @smallexample
33078 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33079 GNU gdb 6.0
33080 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33081 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33082 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33083 under certain conditions.
33084 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33085 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33086 for details.
33087 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33088
33089 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33090 (@value{GDBP})
33091 ^Z^Zprompt
33092 @kbd{quit}
33093
33094 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33095 $
33096 @end smallexample
33097
33098 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33099 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33100 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33101 output from @value{GDBN}.
33102
33103 @node Server Prefix
33104 @section The Server Prefix
33105 @cindex server prefix
33106
33107 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33108 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33109 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33110 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33111 a transparent manner.
33112
33113 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33114 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33115 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33116 @code{print} command.
33117
33118 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33119 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33120
33121 @node Prompting
33122 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33123
33124 @cindex annotations for prompts
33125 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33126 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33127 over, etc.
33128
33129 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33130 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33131 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33132 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33133 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33134 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33135 features the following annotations:
33136
33137 @smallexample
33138 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33139 ^Z^Zprompt
33140 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33141 @end smallexample
33142
33143 The input types are
33144
33145 @table @code
33146 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33147 @findex prompt annotation
33148 @findex post-prompt annotation
33149 @item prompt
33150 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33151
33152 @findex pre-commands annotation
33153 @findex commands annotation
33154 @findex post-commands annotation
33155 @item commands
33156 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33157 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33158
33159 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33160 @findex overload-choice annotation
33161 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33162 @item overload-choice
33163 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33164
33165 @findex pre-query annotation
33166 @findex query annotation
33167 @findex post-query annotation
33168 @item query
33169 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33170
33171 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33172 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33173 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33174 @item prompt-for-continue
33175 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33176 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33177 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33178 presence of annotations.
33179 @end table
33180
33181 @node Errors
33182 @section Errors
33183 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33184
33185 @findex quit annotation
33186 @smallexample
33187 ^Z^Zquit
33188 @end smallexample
33189
33190 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33191
33192 @findex error annotation
33193 @smallexample
33194 ^Z^Zerror
33195 @end smallexample
33196
33197 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33198
33199 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33200 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33201 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33202 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33203 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33204 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33205 to the top level.
33206
33207 @findex error-begin annotation
33208 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33209
33210 @smallexample
33211 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33212 @end smallexample
33213
33214 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33215 message.
33216
33217 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33218 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33219 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33220
33221 @node Invalidation
33222 @section Invalidation Notices
33223
33224 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33225 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33226 changed.
33227
33228 @table @code
33229 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33230 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33231
33232 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33233 have changed.
33234
33235 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33236 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33237
33238 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33239 deleted a breakpoint.
33240 @end table
33241
33242 @node Annotations for Running
33243 @section Running the Program
33244 @cindex annotations for running programs
33245
33246 @findex starting annotation
33247 @findex stopping annotation
33248 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33249 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33250
33251 @smallexample
33252 ^Z^Zstarting
33253 @end smallexample
33254
33255 is output. When the program stops,
33256
33257 @smallexample
33258 ^Z^Zstopped
33259 @end smallexample
33260
33261 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33262 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33263
33264 @table @code
33265 @findex exited annotation
33266 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33267 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33268 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33269
33270 @findex signalled annotation
33271 @findex signal-name annotation
33272 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33273 @findex signal-string annotation
33274 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33275 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33276 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33277 annotation continues:
33278
33279 @smallexample
33280 @var{intro-text}
33281 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33282 @var{name}
33283 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33284 @var{middle-text}
33285 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33286 @var{string}
33287 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33288 @var{end-text}
33289 @end smallexample
33290
33291 @noindent
33292 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33293 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33294 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33295 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33296 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33297
33298 @findex signal annotation
33299 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33300 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33301 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33302 terminated with it.
33303
33304 @findex breakpoint annotation
33305 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33306 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33307
33308 @findex watchpoint annotation
33309 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33310 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33311 @end table
33312
33313 @node Source Annotations
33314 @section Displaying Source
33315 @cindex annotations for source display
33316
33317 @findex source annotation
33318 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33319
33320 @smallexample
33321 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33322 @end smallexample
33323
33324 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33325 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33326 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33327 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33328 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33329 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33330 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33331 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33332 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33333 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33334 depend on the language).
33335
33336 @node JIT Interface
33337 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33338 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33339 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33340
33341 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33342 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33343 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33344 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33345
33346 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33347 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33348 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33349 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33350 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33351 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33352
33353 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33354 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33355 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33356 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33357 LLVM JIT.
33358
33359 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33360 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33361 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33362 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33363 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33364 out about additional code.
33365
33366 @menu
33367 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33368 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33369 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33370 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33371 @end menu
33372
33373 @node Declarations
33374 @section JIT Declarations
33375
33376 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33377 implement the interface:
33378
33379 @smallexample
33380 typedef enum
33381 @{
33382 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33383 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33384 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33385 @} jit_actions_t;
33386
33387 struct jit_code_entry
33388 @{
33389 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33390 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33391 const char *symfile_addr;
33392 uint64_t symfile_size;
33393 @};
33394
33395 struct jit_descriptor
33396 @{
33397 uint32_t version;
33398 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33399 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33400 uint32_t action_flag;
33401 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33402 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33403 @};
33404
33405 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33406 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33407
33408 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33409 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33410 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33411 @end smallexample
33412
33413 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33414 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33415 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33416
33417 @node Registering Code
33418 @section Registering Code
33419
33420 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33421
33422 @itemize @bullet
33423 @item
33424 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33425 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33426
33427 @item
33428 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33429 file.
33430
33431 @item
33432 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33433
33434 @item
33435 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33436
33437 @item
33438 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33439 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33440 @end itemize
33441
33442 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33443 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33444 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33445 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33446
33447 @node Unregistering Code
33448 @section Unregistering Code
33449
33450 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33451
33452 @itemize @bullet
33453 @item
33454 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33455
33456 @item
33457 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33458
33459 @item
33460 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33461 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33462 @end itemize
33463
33464 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33465 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33466
33467 @node Custom Debug Info
33468 @section Custom Debug Info
33469 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33470 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33471
33472 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33473 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33474 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33475 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33476 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33477 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33478 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33479 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33480 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33481
33482 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33483 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33484 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33485 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33486 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33487 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33488 compiler.
33489
33490 @menu
33491 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33492 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33493 @end menu
33494
33495 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33496 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33497 @kindex jit-reader-load
33498 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33499
33500 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33501 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33502
33503 @table @code
33504 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33505 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33506 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33507 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33508 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33509 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33510 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33511
33512 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33513 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33514 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33515 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33516 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33517
33518 @item jit-reader-unload
33519 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33520
33521 @end table
33522
33523 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33524 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33525 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33526
33527 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33528 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33529
33530 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33531 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33532 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33533 the system include directory.
33534
33535 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33536 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33537 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33538
33539 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33540 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33541
33542 @findex gdb_init_reader
33543 @smallexample
33544 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33545 @end smallexample
33546
33547 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33548
33549 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33550 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33551 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33552 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33553 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33554 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33555
33556 @smallexample
33557 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33558 @{
33559 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33560 int reader_version;
33561
33562 /* For use by the reader. */
33563 void *priv_data;
33564
33565 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33566 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33567 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33568 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33569 @};
33570 @end smallexample
33571
33572 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33573 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33574
33575 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33576 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33577 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33578 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33579 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33580 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33581 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33582 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33583 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33584 target's address space.
33585
33586 @node In-Process Agent
33587 @chapter In-Process Agent
33588 @cindex debugging agent
33589 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33590 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33591 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33592 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33593 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33594 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33595 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33596 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33597 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33598 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33599 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33600 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33601 behavior without interrupting it.
33602
33603 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33604 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33605 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33606 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33607 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33608 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33609 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33610 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33611 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33612
33613 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33614 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33615 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33616 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33617
33618 @anchor{Control Agent}
33619 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33620 debugging with the following commands:
33621
33622 @table @code
33623 @kindex set agent on
33624 @item set agent on
33625 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33626 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33627 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33628 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33629 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33630 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33631
33632 @kindex set agent off
33633 @item set agent off
33634 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33635 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33636
33637 @kindex show agent
33638 @item show agent
33639 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33640 the in-process agent.
33641 @end table
33642
33643 @menu
33644 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33645 @end menu
33646
33647 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33648 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33649 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33650
33651 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33652 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33653 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33654 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33655 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33656 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33657 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33658 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33659 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33660
33661 @menu
33662 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33663 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33664 @end menu
33665
33666 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33667 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33668 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33669
33670 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33671 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33672
33673 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33674 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33675 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33676 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33677
33678 @enumerate
33679 @item
33680 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33681 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33682 @item
33683 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33684 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33685 the other one.
33686 @end enumerate
33687
33688 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33689
33690 @enumerate
33691 @item
33692 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33693 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33694 @anchor{agent expression object}
33695 @item
33696 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33697 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33698 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33699 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33700 @item
33701 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33702 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33703
33704 @end enumerate
33705
33706 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33707 object:
33708
33709 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33710 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33711 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33712 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33713 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33714 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33715 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33716 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33717 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33718 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33719 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33720 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33721 memory address for collecting.
33722 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33723 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33724 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33725 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33726 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33727 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33728 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33729 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33730 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33731 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33732 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33733 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33734 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33735 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33736 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33737 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33738 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33739 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33740 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33741 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33742 @ref{agent expression object}
33743 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33744 @ref{agent expression object}
33745 @item actions @tab variable
33746 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33747 @end multitable
33748
33749 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33750 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33751 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33752
33753 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33754 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33755
33756 @table @samp
33757
33758 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33759 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33760 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33761 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33762 in IPA finally.
33763
33764 Replies:
33765 @table @samp
33766 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33767 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33768 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33769 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33770 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33771 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33772 @item E @var{NN}
33773 for an error
33774
33775 @end table
33776
33777 @item close
33778 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33779 is about to kill inferiors.
33780
33781 @item qTfSTM
33782 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33783 @item qTsSTM
33784 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33785 @item qTSTMat
33786 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33787 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33788 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33789
33790 Replies:
33791 @table @samp
33792 @item E @var{NN}
33793 for an error
33794 @end table
33795 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33796 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33797 @end table
33798
33799 @node GDB Bugs
33800 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33801 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33802 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33803
33804 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33805
33806 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33807 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33808 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33809 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33810
33811 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33812 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33813
33814 @menu
33815 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33816 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33817 @end menu
33818
33819 @node Bug Criteria
33820 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33821 @cindex bug criteria
33822
33823 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33824
33825 @itemize @bullet
33826 @cindex fatal signal
33827 @cindex debugger crash
33828 @cindex crash of debugger
33829 @item
33830 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33831 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33832
33833 @cindex error on valid input
33834 @item
33835 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33836 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33837 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33838
33839 @cindex invalid input
33840 @item
33841 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33842 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33843 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33844 for traditional practice''.
33845
33846 @item
33847 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33848 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33849 @end itemize
33850
33851 @node Bug Reporting
33852 @section How to Report Bugs
33853 @cindex bug reports
33854 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33855
33856 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33857 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33858 contact that organization first.
33859
33860 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33861 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33862 distribution.
33863 @c should add a web page ref...
33864
33865 @ifset BUGURL
33866 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33867 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33868 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33869 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33870 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33871 be used.
33872
33873 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33874 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33875 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33876 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33877
33878 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33879 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33880 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33881 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33882 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33883 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33884 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33885 bug reports to the mailing list.
33886 @end ifset
33887 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33888 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33889 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33890 @end ifclear
33891 @end ifset
33892
33893 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33894 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33895 fact or leave it out, state it!
33896
33897 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33898 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33899 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33900 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33901 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33902 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33903 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33904 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33905 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33906
33907 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33908 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33909 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33910 self-contained.
33911
33912 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33913 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33914 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33915 bugs properly.
33916
33917 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33918
33919 @itemize @bullet
33920 @item
33921 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33922 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33923 version}.
33924
33925 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33926 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33927
33928 @item
33929 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33930 version number.
33931
33932 @item
33933 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33934 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33935 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33936 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33937
33938 @item
33939 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33940 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33941
33942 @item
33943 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33944 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33945 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33946 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33947 those compilers.
33948
33949 @item
33950 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33951 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33952 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33953 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33954
33955 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33956 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33957
33958 @item
33959 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33960 reproduce the bug.
33961
33962 @item
33963 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33964 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33965
33966 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33967 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33968 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33969 a chance to make a mistake.
33970
33971 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33972 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33973 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33974 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33975 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33976 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33977 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33978 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33979
33980 @pindex script
33981 @cindex recording a session script
33982 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33983 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33984 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33985 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33986
33987 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33988 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33989
33990 @item
33991 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33992 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33993 it by context, not by line number.
33994
33995 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33996 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33997
33998 @end itemize
33999
34000 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34001
34002 @itemize @bullet
34003 @item
34004 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34005
34006 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34007 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34008 changes will not affect it.
34009
34010 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34011 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34012 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34013 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34014
34015 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34016 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34017 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34018 less time, and so on.
34019
34020 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34021 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34022
34023 @item
34024 A patch for the bug.
34025
34026 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34027 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34028 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34029 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34030
34031 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34032 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34033 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34034 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34035
34036 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34037 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34038 help us to understand.
34039
34040 @item
34041 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34042
34043 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34044 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34045 @end itemize
34046
34047 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34048 @c and consists of the two following files:
34049 @c rluser.texi
34050 @c hsuser.texi
34051 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34052 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34053 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34054 @include rluser.texi
34055 @include hsuser.texi
34056 @end ifclear
34057
34058 @node In Memoriam
34059 @appendix In Memoriam
34060
34061 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34062 contributors:
34063
34064 @table @code
34065 @item Fred Fish
34066 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34067 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34068 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34069
34070 @item Michael Snyder
34071 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34072 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34073 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34074 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34075 @end table
34076
34077 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34078 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34079
34080 @node Formatting Documentation
34081 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34082
34083 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34084 @cindex reference card
34085 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34086 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34087 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34088 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34089 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34090 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34091
34092 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34093 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34094
34095 @smallexample
34096 make refcard.dvi
34097 @end smallexample
34098
34099 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34100 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34101 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34102 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34103 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34104
34105 @cindex documentation
34106
34107 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34108 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34109 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34110 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34111 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34112 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34113
34114 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34115 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34116 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34117 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34118 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34119 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34120 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34121 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34122
34123 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34124 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34125 @code{makeinfo}.
34126
34127 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34128 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34129 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34130
34131 @smallexample
34132 cd gdb
34133 make gdb.info
34134 @end smallexample
34135
34136 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34137 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34138 Texinfo definitions file.
34139
34140 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34141 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34142 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34143 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34144 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34145 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34146 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34147
34148 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34149 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34150 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34151 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34152 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34153 directory.
34154
34155 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34156 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34157 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34158 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34159
34160 @smallexample
34161 make gdb.dvi
34162 @end smallexample
34163
34164 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34165
34166 @node Installing GDB
34167 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34168 @cindex installation
34169
34170 @menu
34171 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34172 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34173 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34174 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34175 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34176 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34177 @end menu
34178
34179 @node Requirements
34180 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34181 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34182
34183 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34184 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34185
34186 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34187 @table @asis
34188 @item ISO C90 compiler
34189 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34190 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34191
34192 @end table
34193
34194 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34195 @table @asis
34196 @item Expat
34197 @anchor{Expat}
34198 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34199 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34200 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34201 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34202 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34203 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34204
34205 Expat is used for:
34206
34207 @itemize @bullet
34208 @item
34209 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34210 @item
34211 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34212 @item
34213 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34214 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34215 @item
34216 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34217 @item
34218 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34219 @item
34220 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34221 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34222 @end itemize
34223
34224 @item zlib
34225 @cindex compressed debug sections
34226 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34227 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34228 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34229 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34230 information in such binaries.
34231
34232 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34233 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34234 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34235
34236 @item iconv
34237 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34238 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34239 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34240 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34241
34242 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34243 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34244 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34245 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34246
34247 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34248 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34249 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34250
34251 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34252 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34253 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34254 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34255 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34256 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34257 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34258 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34259 @end table
34260
34261 @node Running Configure
34262 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34263 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34264 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34265 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34266 build the @code{gdb} program.
34267 @iftex
34268 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34269 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34270 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34271 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34272 @end iftex
34273
34274 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34275 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34276 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34277
34278 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34279 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34280
34281 @table @code
34282 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34283 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34284
34285 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34286 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34287
34288 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34289 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34290
34291 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34292 @sc{gnu} include files
34293
34294 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34295 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34296
34297 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34298 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34299
34300 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34301 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34302
34303 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34304 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34305
34306 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34307 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34308 @end table
34309
34310 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34311 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34312 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34313
34314 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34315 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34316 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34317 argument.
34318
34319 For example:
34320
34321 @smallexample
34322 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34323 ./configure @var{host}
34324 make
34325 @end smallexample
34326
34327 @noindent
34328 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34329 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34330 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34331 correct value by examining your system.)
34332
34333 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34334 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34335 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34336 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34337
34338 @need 750
34339 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34340 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34341 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34342
34343 @smallexample
34344 sh configure @var{host}
34345 @end smallexample
34346
34347 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34348 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34349 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34350 @file{configure}
34351 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34352 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34353
34354 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34355 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34356 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34357 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34358 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34359 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34360 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34361 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34362 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34363
34364 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34365 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34366 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34367 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34368 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34369
34370 @node Separate Objdir
34371 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34372
34373 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34374 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34375 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34376 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34377 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34378 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34379 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34380 program specified there.
34381
34382 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34383 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34384 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34385 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34386 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34387 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34388
34389 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34390 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34391
34392 @smallexample
34393 @group
34394 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34395 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34396 cd ../gdb-sun4
34397 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34398 make
34399 @end group
34400 @end smallexample
34401
34402 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34403 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34404 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34405 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34406 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34407 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34408
34409 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34410 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34411 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34412 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34413 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34414
34415 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34416 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34417 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34418 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34419 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34420 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34421
34422 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34423 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34424 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34425
34426 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34427 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34428 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34429 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34430 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34431
34432 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34433 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34434 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34435 with each other.
34436
34437 @node Config Names
34438 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34439
34440 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34441 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34442 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34443 of information in the following pattern:
34444
34445 @smallexample
34446 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34447 @end smallexample
34448
34449 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34450 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34451 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34452
34453 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34454 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34455 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34456 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34457 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34458 abbreviations---for example:
34459
34460 @smallexample
34461 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34462 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34463 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34464 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34465 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34466 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34467 % sh config.sub sun4
34468 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34469 % sh config.sub sun3
34470 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34471 % sh config.sub i986v
34472 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34473 @end smallexample
34474
34475 @noindent
34476 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34477 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34478
34479 @node Configure Options
34480 @section @file{configure} Options
34481
34482 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34483 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34484 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34485 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34486
34487 @smallexample
34488 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34489 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34490 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34491 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34492 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34493 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34494 @var{host}
34495 @end smallexample
34496
34497 @noindent
34498 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34499 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34500 @samp{--}.
34501
34502 @table @code
34503 @item --help
34504 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34505
34506 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34507 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34508 @file{@var{dir}}.
34509
34510 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34511 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34512 @file{@var{dir}}.
34513
34514 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34515 @need 2000
34516 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34517 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34518 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34519 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34520 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34521 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34522 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34523 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34524 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34525 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34526 @var{dirname}.
34527
34528 @item --norecursion
34529 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34530 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34531
34532 @item --target=@var{target}
34533 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34534 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34535 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34536
34537 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34538
34539 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34540 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34541
34542 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34543 @end table
34544
34545 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34546 needed for special purposes only.
34547
34548 @node System-wide configuration
34549 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34550 @cindex system-wide init file
34551
34552 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34553 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34554 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34555
34556 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34557
34558 @table @code
34559 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34560 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34561 @var{file}.
34562 @end table
34563
34564 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34565 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34566
34567 @itemize @bullet
34568 @item
34569 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34570 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34571 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34572 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34573 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34574 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34575
34576 @item
34577 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34578 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34579 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34580 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34581 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34582 @end itemize
34583
34584 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34585 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34586 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34587 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34588 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34589 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34590 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34591 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34592 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34593 reread.
34594
34595 @menu
34596 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34597 @end menu
34598
34599 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34600 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34601 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34602
34603 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34604 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34605 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34606 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34607 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34608 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34609
34610 The following scripts are currently available:
34611 @itemize @bullet
34612
34613 @item @file{elinos.py}
34614 @pindex elinos.py
34615 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34616 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34617 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34618 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34619 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34620 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34621
34622 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34623 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34624 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34625 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34626 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34627 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34628
34629 @end itemize
34630
34631 @node Maintenance Commands
34632 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34633 @cindex maintenance commands
34634 @cindex internal commands
34635
34636 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34637 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34638 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34639 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34640 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34641
34642 @table @code
34643 @kindex maint agent
34644 @kindex maint agent-eval
34645 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34646 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34647 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34648 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34649 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34650 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34651 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34652 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34653 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34654 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34655 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34656 addition and return the sum.
34657 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34658 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34659
34660 @kindex maint agent-printf
34661 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34662 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34663 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34664 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34665 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34666
34667 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34668 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34669 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34670 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34671 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34672 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34673 is shown:
34674
34675 @table @code
34676 @item breakpoint
34677 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34678
34679 @item watchpoint
34680 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34681
34682 @item longjmp
34683 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34684 @code{longjmp} calls.
34685
34686 @item longjmp resume
34687 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34688
34689 @item until
34690 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34691
34692 @item finish
34693 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34694
34695 @item shlib events
34696 Shared library events.
34697
34698 @end table
34699
34700 @kindex maint info btrace
34701 @item maint info btrace
34702 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34703
34704 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34705 @item maint btrace packet-history
34706 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34707 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34708 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34709 recording format.
34710
34711 @table @code
34712 @item bts
34713 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34714 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34715
34716 @table @asis
34717 @item Block number
34718 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34719 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34720 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34721 @end table
34722
34723 @item pt
34724 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34725 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34726 information is printed:
34727
34728 @table @asis
34729 @item Packet number
34730 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34731 @item Trace offset
34732 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34733 @item Packet opcode and payload
34734 @end table
34735 @end table
34736
34737 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34738 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34739 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34740 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34741 needed.
34742
34743 @kindex maint btrace clear
34744 @item maint btrace clear
34745 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34746 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34747
34748 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34749 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34750 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34751 buffer.
34752
34753 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34754 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34755 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34756 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34757 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34758 packet history.
34759
34760 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34761 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34762 @cindex displaced stepping support
34763 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34764 @item set displaced-stepping
34765 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34766 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34767 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34768 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34769 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34770 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34771
34772 @table @code
34773 @item set displaced-stepping on
34774 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34775 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34776
34777 @item set displaced-stepping off
34778 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34779 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34780
34781 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34782 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34783 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34784 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34785 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34786 @end table
34787
34788 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34789 @item maint check-psymtabs
34790 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34791 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34792
34793 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34794 @item maint check-symtabs
34795 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34796
34797 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34798 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34799 Expand symbol tables.
34800 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34801 names matching @var{regexp}.
34802
34803 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34804 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34805 @cindex demangler crashes
34806 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34807 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34808 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34809 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34810 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34811 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34812 option to terminate the current session.
34813
34814 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34815 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34816 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34817
34818 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34819 @item maint cplus namespace
34820 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34821
34822 @kindex maint deprecate
34823 @kindex maint undeprecate
34824 @cindex deprecated commands
34825 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34826 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34827 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34828 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34829 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34830 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34831 the replacement as part of the warning.
34832
34833 @kindex maint dump-me
34834 @item maint dump-me
34835 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34836 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34837 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34838 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34839
34840 @kindex maint internal-error
34841 @kindex maint internal-warning
34842 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34843 @cindex demangler crashes
34844 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34845 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34846 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34847
34848 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34849 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34850 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34851 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34852 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34853 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34854 @value{GDBN} session.
34855
34856 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34857 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34858
34859 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34860
34861 @smallexample
34862 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34863 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34864 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34865 debugging may prove unreliable.
34866 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34867 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34868 (@value{GDBP})
34869 @end smallexample
34870
34871 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34872 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34873 @cindex demangler crashes
34874
34875 @kindex maint set internal-error
34876 @kindex maint show internal-error
34877 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34878 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34879 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34880 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34881 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34882 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34883 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34884 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34885 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34886 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34887 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34888 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34889 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34890 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34891 described in the table below.
34892
34893 @table @samp
34894 @item quit
34895 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34896 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34897
34898 @item corefile
34899 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34900 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34901 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34902 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34903 disabled.
34904 @end table
34905
34906 @kindex maint packet
34907 @item maint packet @var{text}
34908 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34909 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34910 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34911 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34912 checksum.
34913
34914 @kindex maint print architecture
34915 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34916 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34917 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34918
34919 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34920 @item maint print c-tdesc
34921 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34922 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
34923 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
34924 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
34925 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
34926 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
34927 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
34928 modify XML target descriptions.
34929
34930 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
34931 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
34932 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
34933 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
34934
34935 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34936 @item maint print dummy-frames
34937 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34938
34939 @smallexample
34940 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34941 @dots{}
34942 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34943 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34944 58 return (a + b);
34945 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34946 @dots{}
34947 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34948 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34949 (@value{GDBP})
34950 @end smallexample
34951
34952 Takes an optional file parameter.
34953
34954 @kindex maint print registers
34955 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34956 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34957 @kindex maint print register-groups
34958 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34959 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34960 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34961 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34962 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34963 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34964 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34965
34966 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34967 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34968 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34969 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34970 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34971 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34972 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34973 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34974
34975 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34976 write the information.
34977
34978 @kindex maint print reggroups
34979 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34980 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34981 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34982 information.
34983
34984 The register groups info looks like this:
34985
34986 @smallexample
34987 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34988 Group Type
34989 general user
34990 float user
34991 all user
34992 vector user
34993 system user
34994 save internal
34995 restore internal
34996 @end smallexample
34997
34998 @kindex flushregs
34999 @item flushregs
35000 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35001
35002 @kindex maint print objfiles
35003 @cindex info for known object files
35004 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35005 Print a dump of all known object files.
35006 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35007 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35008 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35009
35010 @kindex maint print user-registers
35011 @cindex user registers
35012 @item maint print user-registers
35013 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35014 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35015 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35016 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35017 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35018 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35019 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35020
35021 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35022 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35023 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35024 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35025 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35026 matching @var{regexp}.
35027 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35028 and the full path if known.
35029 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35030
35031 @kindex maint print statistics
35032 @cindex bcache statistics
35033 @item maint print statistics
35034 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35035 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35036 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35037 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35038 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35039 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35040 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35041 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35042 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35043 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35044 lengths.
35045
35046 @kindex maint print target-stack
35047 @cindex target stack description
35048 @item maint print target-stack
35049 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35050 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35051 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35052 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35053 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35054 address.
35055
35056 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35057 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35058
35059 @kindex maint print type
35060 @cindex type chain of a data type
35061 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35062 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35063 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35064 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35065 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35066 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35067
35068 @kindex maint selftest
35069 @cindex self tests
35070 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35071 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35072 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35073 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35074 name will by ran.
35075
35076 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35077 @cindex self tests
35078 @item maint info selftests
35079 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35080
35081 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35082 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35083 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35084 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35085 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35086 information.
35087
35088 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35089 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35090 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35091 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35092 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35093 always see the disassembly form.
35094
35095 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35096
35097 @smallexample
35098 (gdb) info addr argc
35099 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35100 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35101 @end smallexample
35102
35103 For more information on these expressions, see
35104 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35105
35106 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35107 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35108 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35109 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35110 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35111
35112 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35113 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35114 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35115 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35116 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35117 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35118 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35119 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35120 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35121
35122 @kindex maint set profile
35123 @kindex maint show profile
35124 @cindex profiling GDB
35125 @item maint set profile
35126 @itemx maint show profile
35127 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35128
35129 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35130 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35131 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35132 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35133 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35134 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35135 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35136
35137 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35138 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35139
35140 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35141 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35142 @cindex hardware debug registers
35143 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35144 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35145 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35146 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35147 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35148 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35149 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35150
35151 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35152 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35153 @item maint set show-all-tib
35154 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35155 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35156 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35157 command.
35158
35159 @kindex maint set target-async
35160 @kindex maint show target-async
35161 @item maint set target-async
35162 @itemx maint show target-async
35163 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35164 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35165 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35166 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35167
35168 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35169 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35170 @item maint set target-non-stop
35171 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35172
35173 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35174 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35175 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35176 if supported by the target.
35177
35178 @table @code
35179 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35180 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35181 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35182
35183 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35184 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35185 does not indicate support.
35186
35187 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35188 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35189 target supports it.
35190 @end table
35191
35192 @kindex maint set per-command
35193 @kindex maint show per-command
35194 @item maint set per-command
35195 @itemx maint show per-command
35196 @cindex resources used by commands
35197
35198 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35199 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35200
35201 @table @code
35202 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35203 @itemx maint show per-command space
35204 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35205 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35206 took, following the command's own output.
35207 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35208 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35209
35210 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35211 @itemx maint show per-command time
35212 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35213 for each command.
35214 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35215 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35216 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35217 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35218 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35219 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35220 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35221 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35222 spent by the program been debugged.
35223 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35224 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35225
35226 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35227 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35228 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35229 for each command.
35230 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35231
35232 @enumerate a
35233 @item
35234 number of symbol tables
35235 @item
35236 number of primary symbol tables
35237 @item
35238 number of blocks in the blockvector
35239 @end enumerate
35240 @end table
35241
35242 @kindex maint space
35243 @cindex memory used by commands
35244 @item maint space @var{value}
35245 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35246 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35247
35248 @kindex maint time
35249 @cindex time of command execution
35250 @item maint time @var{value}
35251 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35252 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35253
35254 @kindex maint translate-address
35255 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35256 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35257 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35258 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35259 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35260 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35261 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35262
35263 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35264 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35265 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35266
35267 @end table
35268
35269 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35270 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35271
35272 @table @code
35273 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35274 @kindex set watchdog
35275 @cindex watchdog timer
35276 @cindex timeout for commands
35277 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35278 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35279 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35280
35281 @item show watchdog
35282 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35283 @end table
35284
35285 @node Remote Protocol
35286 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35287
35288 @menu
35289 * Overview::
35290 * Packets::
35291 * Stop Reply Packets::
35292 * General Query Packets::
35293 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35294 * Tracepoint Packets::
35295 * Host I/O Packets::
35296 * Interrupts::
35297 * Notification Packets::
35298 * Remote Non-Stop::
35299 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35300 * Examples::
35301 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35302 * Library List Format::
35303 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35304 * Memory Map Format::
35305 * Thread List Format::
35306 * Traceframe Info Format::
35307 * Branch Trace Format::
35308 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35309 @end menu
35310
35311 @node Overview
35312 @section Overview
35313
35314 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35315 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35316 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35317 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35318
35319 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35320 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35321
35322 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35323 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35324 @cindex remote serial protocol
35325 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35326 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35327 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35328 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35329 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35330
35331 @smallexample
35332 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35333 @end smallexample
35334 @noindent
35335
35336 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35337 @noindent
35338 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35339 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35340 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35341
35342 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35343 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35344
35345 @smallexample
35346 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35347 @end smallexample
35348
35349 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35350 @noindent
35351 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35352 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35353 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35354
35355 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35356 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35357 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35358 retransmission):
35359
35360 @smallexample
35361 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35362 <- @code{+}
35363 @end smallexample
35364 @noindent
35365
35366 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35367 once a connection is established.
35368 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35369
35370 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35371 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35372 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35373 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35374 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35375 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35376 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35377
35378 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35379 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35380 exceptions).
35381
35382 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35383 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35384 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35385 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35386
35387 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35388 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35389 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35390
35391 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35392 @anchor{Binary Data}
35393 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35394 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35395 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35396 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35397 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35398 binary data.
35399
35400 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35401 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35402 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35403 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35404 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35405 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35406 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35407 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35408 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35409 (described next).
35410
35411 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35412 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35413 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35414 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35415 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35416 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35417 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35418 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35419 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35420 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35421 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35422 3}} more times.
35423
35424 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35425 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35426 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35427 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35428 @samp{0*"00}.
35429
35430 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35431 error number. That number is not well defined.
35432
35433 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35434 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35435 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35436 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35437 on that response.
35438
35439 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35440 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35441 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35442 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35443 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35444 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35445
35446 @node Packets
35447 @section Packets
35448
35449 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35450 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35451 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35452 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35453
35454 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35455 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35456 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35457 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35458 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35459 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35460 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35461 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35462 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35463 @var{baz}.
35464
35465 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35466 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35467 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35468 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35469 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35470 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35471 pick any thread.
35472
35473 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35474 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35475 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35476 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35477 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35478 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35479 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35480 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35481 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35482 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35483 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35484 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35485 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35486
35487 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35488 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35489 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35490 more information.
35491
35492 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35493 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35494
35495 Here are the packet descriptions.
35496
35497 @table @samp
35498
35499 @item !
35500 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35501 @anchor{extended mode}
35502 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35503 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35504 debugged.
35505
35506 Reply:
35507 @table @samp
35508 @item OK
35509 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35510 @end table
35511
35512 @item ?
35513 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35514 @anchor{? packet}
35515 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35516 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35517 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35518
35519 Reply:
35520 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35521
35522 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35523 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35524 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35525 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35526 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35527
35528 Reply:
35529 @table @samp
35530 @item OK
35531 The arguments were set.
35532 @item E @var{NN}
35533 An error occurred.
35534 @end table
35535
35536 @item b @var{baud}
35537 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35538 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35539 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35540
35541 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35542 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35543 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35544
35545 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35546 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35547 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35548 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35549 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35550
35551 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35552 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35553 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35554 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35555
35556 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35557 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35558
35559 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35560 @anchor{bc}
35561 @item bc
35562 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35563 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35564
35565 Reply:
35566 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35567
35568 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35569 @anchor{bs}
35570 @item bs
35571 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35572 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35573
35574 Reply:
35575 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35576
35577 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35578 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35579 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35580 is omitted, resume at current address.
35581
35582 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35583 packet}.
35584
35585 Reply:
35586 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35587
35588 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35589 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35590 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35591 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35592
35593 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35594 packet}.
35595
35596 Reply:
35597 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35598
35599 @item d
35600 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35601 Toggle debug flag.
35602
35603 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35604 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35605
35606 @item D
35607 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35608 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35609 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35610 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35611 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35612
35613 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35614 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35615 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35616 big-endian hex string.
35617
35618 Reply:
35619 @table @samp
35620 @item OK
35621 for success
35622 @item E @var{NN}
35623 for an error
35624 @end table
35625
35626 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35627 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35628 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35629 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35630 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35631
35632 @item g
35633 @anchor{read registers packet}
35634 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35635 Read general registers.
35636
35637 Reply:
35638 @table @samp
35639 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35640 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35641 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35642 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35643 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35644 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35645
35646 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35647 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35648 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35649 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35650 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35651 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35652 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35653 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35654
35655 @smallexample
35656 -> @code{g}
35657 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35658 @end smallexample
35659
35660 @item E @var{NN}
35661 for an error.
35662 @end table
35663
35664 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35665 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35666 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35667 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35668
35669 Reply:
35670 @table @samp
35671 @item OK
35672 for success
35673 @item E @var{NN}
35674 for an error
35675 @end table
35676
35677 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35678 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35679 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35680 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35681 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35682 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35683 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35684 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35685 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35686
35687 Reply:
35688 @table @samp
35689 @item OK
35690 for success
35691 @item E @var{NN}
35692 for an error
35693 @end table
35694
35695 @c FIXME: JTC:
35696 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35697 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35698 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35699 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35700 @c described. For example:
35701 @c
35702 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35703 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35704 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35705 @c
35706 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35707 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35708 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35709
35710 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35711 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35712 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35713 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35714 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35715 step starting at that address.
35716
35717 @item I
35718 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35719 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35720 step packet}.
35721
35722 @item k
35723 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35724 Kill request.
35725
35726 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35727
35728 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35729 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35730
35731 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35732
35733 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35734 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35735 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35736
35737 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35738 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35739 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35740
35741 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35742 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35743 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35744 (@pxref{? packet}).
35745
35746 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35747 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35748 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35749 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35750 any particular boundary.
35751
35752 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35753 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35754 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35755 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35756 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35757 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35758 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35759 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35760
35761 Reply:
35762 @table @samp
35763 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35764 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35765 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35766 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35767 @item E @var{NN}
35768 @var{NN} is errno
35769 @end table
35770
35771 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35772 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35773 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35774 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35775 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35776
35777 Reply:
35778 @table @samp
35779 @item OK
35780 for success
35781 @item E @var{NN}
35782 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35783 written).
35784 @end table
35785
35786 @item p @var{n}
35787 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35788 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35789 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35790 register value is encoded.
35791
35792 Reply:
35793 @table @samp
35794 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35795 the register's value
35796 @item E @var{NN}
35797 for an error
35798 @item @w{}
35799 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35800 @end table
35801
35802 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35803 @anchor{write register packet}
35804 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35805 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35806 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35807 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35808
35809 Reply:
35810 @table @samp
35811 @item OK
35812 for success
35813 @item E @var{NN}
35814 for an error
35815 @end table
35816
35817 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35818 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35819 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35820 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35821 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35822 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35823
35824 @item r
35825 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35826 Reset the entire system.
35827
35828 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35829
35830 @item R @var{XX}
35831 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35832 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35833 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35834
35835 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35836
35837 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35838 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35839 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35840 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35841
35842 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35843 packet}.
35844
35845 Reply:
35846 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35847
35848 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35849 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35850 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35851 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35852 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35853
35854 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35855 packet}.
35856
35857 Reply:
35858 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35859
35860 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35861 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35862 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35863 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35864 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35865
35866 @item T @var{thread-id}
35867 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35868 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35869
35870 Reply:
35871 @table @samp
35872 @item OK
35873 thread is still alive
35874 @item E @var{NN}
35875 thread is dead
35876 @end table
35877
35878 @item v
35879 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35880 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35881
35882 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35883 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35884 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35885 The process ID is a
35886 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35887 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35888 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35889
35890 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35891 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35892 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35893 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35894 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35895 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35896 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35897 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35898
35899 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35900
35901 Reply:
35902 @table @samp
35903 @item E @var{nn}
35904 for an error
35905 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35906 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35907 @item OK
35908 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35909 @end table
35910
35911 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35912 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35913 @anchor{vCont packet}
35914 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35915
35916 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35917 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35918 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35919 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35920 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35921 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35922 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35923 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35924 error.
35925
35926 Currently supported actions are:
35927
35928 @table @samp
35929 @item c
35930 Continue.
35931 @item C @var{sig}
35932 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35933 @item s
35934 Step.
35935 @item S @var{sig}
35936 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35937 @item t
35938 Stop.
35939 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35940 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35941 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35942 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35943 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35944 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35945
35946 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35947 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35948 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35949 jumps to @var{start}).
35950
35951 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35952 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35953 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35954
35955 @end table
35956
35957 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35958 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35959 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35960
35961 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35962 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35963 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35964 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35965 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35966 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35967 as an implementation detail.
35968
35969 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35970 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35971 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35972 stopped.
35973
35974 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35975 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35976 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35977
35978 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35979 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35980
35981 Reply:
35982 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35983
35984 @item vCont?
35985 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35986 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35987
35988 Reply:
35989 @table @samp
35990 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35991 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35992 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35993 @item @w{}
35994 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35995 @end table
35996
35997 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35998 @item vCtrlC
35999 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36000 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36001 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36002 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36003 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36004 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36005 variant.
36006
36007 Reply:
36008 @table @samp
36009 @item E @var{nn}
36010 for an error
36011 @item OK
36012 for success
36013 @end table
36014
36015 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36016 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36017 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36018 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36019
36020 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36021 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36022 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36023 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36024 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36025 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36026 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36027 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36028 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36029 packet is received.
36030
36031 Reply:
36032 @table @samp
36033 @item OK
36034 for success
36035 @item E @var{NN}
36036 for an error
36037 @end table
36038
36039 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36040 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36041 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36042 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36043 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36044 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36045 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36046 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36047 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36048 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36049 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36050 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36051
36052
36053 Reply:
36054 @table @samp
36055 @item OK
36056 for success
36057 @item E.memtype
36058 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36059 @item E @var{NN}
36060 for an error
36061 @end table
36062
36063 @item vFlashDone
36064 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36065 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36066 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36067 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36068 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36069 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36070 request is completed.
36071
36072 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36073 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36074 @anchor{vKill packet}
36075 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36076 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36077 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36078 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36079
36080 Reply:
36081 @table @samp
36082 @item E @var{nn}
36083 for an error
36084 @item OK
36085 for success
36086 @end table
36087
36088 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36089 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36090 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36091 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36092 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36093
36094 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36095 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36096 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36097 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36098 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36099 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36100
36101 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36102 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36103 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36104 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36105 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36106 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36107 state.
36108
36109 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36110
36111 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36112
36113 Reply:
36114 @table @samp
36115 @item E @var{nn}
36116 for an error
36117 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36118 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36119 @end table
36120
36121 @item vStopped
36122 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36123 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36124
36125 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36126 @anchor{X packet}
36127 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36128 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36129 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36130 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36131 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36132
36133 Reply:
36134 @table @samp
36135 @item OK
36136 for success
36137 @item E @var{NN}
36138 for an error
36139 @end table
36140
36141 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36142 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36143 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36144 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36145 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36146 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36147 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36148
36149 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36150 separately.
36151
36152 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36153 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36154 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36155 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36156 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36157 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36158
36159 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36160 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36161 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36162 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36163 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36164 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36165
36166 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36167 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36168 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36169 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36170 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36171 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36172 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36173 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36174 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36175 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36176 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36177 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36178 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36179
36180 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36181 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36182
36183 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36184 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36185
36186 @table @samp
36187
36188 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36189 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36190 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36191
36192 @end table
36193
36194 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36195 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36196 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36197 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36198 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36199 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36200 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36201
36202 @table @samp
36203
36204 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36205 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36206 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36207
36208 @end table
36209
36210 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36211 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36212 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36213 target, is not defined.}
36214
36215 Reply:
36216 @table @samp
36217 @item OK
36218 success
36219 @item @w{}
36220 not supported
36221 @item E @var{NN}
36222 for an error
36223 @end table
36224
36225 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36226 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36227 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36228 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36229 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36230 address @var{addr}.
36231
36232 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36233 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36234 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36235 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36236
36237 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36238 movement.}
36239
36240 Reply:
36241 @table @samp
36242 @item OK
36243 success
36244 @item @w{}
36245 not supported
36246 @item E @var{NN}
36247 for an error
36248 @end table
36249
36250 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36251 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36252 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36253 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36254 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36255 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36256
36257 Reply:
36258 @table @samp
36259 @item OK
36260 success
36261 @item @w{}
36262 not supported
36263 @item E @var{NN}
36264 for an error
36265 @end table
36266
36267 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36268 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36269 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36270 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36271 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36272 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36273
36274 Reply:
36275 @table @samp
36276 @item OK
36277 success
36278 @item @w{}
36279 not supported
36280 @item E @var{NN}
36281 for an error
36282 @end table
36283
36284 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36285 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36286 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36287 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36288 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36289 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36290
36291 Reply:
36292 @table @samp
36293 @item OK
36294 success
36295 @item @w{}
36296 not supported
36297 @item E @var{NN}
36298 for an error
36299 @end table
36300
36301 @end table
36302
36303 @node Stop Reply Packets
36304 @section Stop Reply Packets
36305 @cindex stop reply packets
36306
36307 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36308 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36309 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36310 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36311 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36312 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36313 @value{GDBN} source code.
36314
36315 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36316 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36317 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36318
36319 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36320 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36321 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36322 components.
36323
36324 @table @samp
36325
36326 @item S @var{AA}
36327 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36328 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36329 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36330
36331 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36332 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36333 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36334 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36335 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36336 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36337 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36338 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36339
36340 @itemize @bullet
36341 @item
36342 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36343 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36344 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36345 two-digit hex number.
36346
36347 @item
36348 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36349 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36350
36351 @item
36352 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36353 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36354
36355 @item
36356 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36357 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36358 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36359 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36360
36361 @item
36362 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36363 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36364 future.
36365 @end itemize
36366
36367 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36368
36369 @table @samp
36370 @item watch
36371 @itemx rwatch
36372 @itemx awatch
36373 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36374 hex.
36375
36376 @item syscall_entry
36377 @itemx syscall_return
36378 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36379 syscall number, in hex.
36380
36381 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36382 @item library
36383 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36384 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36385 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36386
36387 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36388 @item replaylog
36389 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36390 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36391 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36392 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36393 for more information.
36394
36395 @item swbreak
36396 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36397 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36398 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36399 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36400 part must be left empty.
36401
36402 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36403 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36404 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36405 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36406 address.
36407
36408 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36409 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36410 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36411 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36412 indicating support.
36413
36414 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36415
36416 @item hwbreak
36417 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36418 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36419
36420 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36421 apply.
36422
36423 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36424 @item fork
36425 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36426 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36427 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36428 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36429 fork events.
36430
36431 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36432 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36433 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36434 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36435 indicating support.
36436
36437 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36438 @item vfork
36439 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36440 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36441 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36442 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36443 vfork events.
36444
36445 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36446 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36447 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36448 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36449 indicating support.
36450
36451 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36452 @item vforkdone
36453 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36454 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36455 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36456 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36457 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36458
36459 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36460 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36461 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36462 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36463 indicating support.
36464
36465 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36466 @item exec
36467 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36468 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36469 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36470
36471 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36472 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36473 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36474 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36475 indicating support.
36476
36477 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36478 @anchor{thread create event}
36479 @item create
36480 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36481 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36482 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36483 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36484 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36485 @var{r} part is ignored.
36486
36487 @end table
36488
36489 @item W @var{AA}
36490 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36491 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36492 applicable to certain targets.
36493
36494 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36495 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36496 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36497 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36498 hex strings.
36499
36500 @item X @var{AA}
36501 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36502 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36503
36504 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36505 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36506 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36507 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36508 hex strings.
36509
36510 @anchor{thread exit event}
36511 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36512 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36513
36514 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36515 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36516 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36517 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36518
36519 @item N
36520 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36521 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36522 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36523 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36524 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36525 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36526 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36527 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36528 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36529 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36530 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36531 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36532 support.
36533
36534 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36535 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36536 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36537 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36538 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36539
36540 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36541 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36542 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36543 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36544 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36545 system calls.
36546
36547 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36548 this very system call.
36549
36550 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36551 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36552 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36553 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36554 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36555 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36556
36557 @end table
36558
36559 @node General Query Packets
36560 @section General Query Packets
36561 @cindex remote query requests
36562
36563 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36564 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36565 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36566 sending information to and from the stub.
36567
36568 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36569 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36570 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36571 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36572 conventions:
36573
36574 @itemize @bullet
36575 @item
36576 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36577 @item
36578 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36579 letter.
36580 @item
36581 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36582 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36583 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36584 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36585 @end itemize
36586
36587 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36588 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36589 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36590 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36591 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36592 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36593 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36594 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36595 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36596 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36597 packet.}.
36598
36599 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36600 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36601 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36602 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36603 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36604
36605 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36606
36607 @table @samp
36608
36609 @item QAgent:1
36610 @itemx QAgent:0
36611 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36612 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36613
36614 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36615 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36616 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36617 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36618 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36619 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36620 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36621 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36622 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36623 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36624 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36625
36626 @item qC
36627 @cindex current thread, remote request
36628 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36629 Return the current thread ID.
36630
36631 Reply:
36632 @table @samp
36633 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36634 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36635 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36636 @item @r{(anything else)}
36637 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36638 @end table
36639
36640 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36641 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36642 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36643 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36644 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36645 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36646 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36647 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36648
36649 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36650 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36651 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36652 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36653 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36654 detect trailing zeros.
36655
36656 Reply:
36657 @table @samp
36658 @item E @var{NN}
36659 An error (such as memory fault)
36660 @item C @var{crc32}
36661 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36662 @end table
36663
36664 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36665 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36666 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36667 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36668 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36669 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36670 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36671 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36672 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36673 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36674 randomization.
36675
36676 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36677
36678 Reply:
36679 @table @samp
36680 @item OK
36681 The request succeeded.
36682
36683 @item E @var{nn}
36684 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36685
36686 @item @w{}
36687 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36688 by the stub.
36689 @end table
36690
36691 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36692 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36693 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36694 address space randomization.
36695
36696 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36697 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36698 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36699 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36700 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36701 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36702 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36703 inferior using a shell or not.
36704
36705 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36706 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36707 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36708 values are considered an error.
36709
36710 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36711 mode}).
36712
36713 Reply:
36714 @table @samp
36715 @item OK
36716 The request succeeded.
36717
36718 @item E @var{nn}
36719 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36720 @end table
36721
36722 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36723 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36724 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36725 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36726
36727 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36728 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36729
36730 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36731 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36732 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
36733 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36734 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36735 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36736 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36737 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36738 environment}).
36739
36740 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36741 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36742 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36743 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36744 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36745 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36746 not be present.
36747
36748 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36749 mode}).
36750
36751 Reply:
36752 @table @samp
36753 @item OK
36754 The request succeeded.
36755 @end table
36756
36757 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36758 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36759 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36760 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36761 inferior.
36762
36763 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36764 @pxref{set environment}.
36765
36766 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36767 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36768 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36769 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36770 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36771 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36772 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36773 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36774
36775 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36776 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36777
36778 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36779 mode}).
36780
36781 Reply:
36782 @table @samp
36783 @item OK
36784 The request succeeded.
36785 @end table
36786
36787 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36788 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36789 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36790 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36791 inferior.
36792
36793 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36794 @pxref{unset environment}.
36795
36796 @item QEnvironmentReset
36797 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
36798 @cindex reset environment, remote request
36799 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
36800 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
36801 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
36802 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
36803 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
36804 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
36805 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36806 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
36807 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
36808
36809 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36810 mode}).
36811
36812 Reply:
36813 @table @samp
36814 @item OK
36815 The request succeeded.
36816 @end table
36817
36818 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36819 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36820 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36821 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36822 inferior.
36823
36824 @item qfThreadInfo
36825 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36826 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36827 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36828 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36829 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36830 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36831 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36832 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36833 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36834 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36835
36836 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36837
36838 Reply:
36839 @table @samp
36840 @item m @var{thread-id}
36841 A single thread ID
36842 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36843 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36844 @item l
36845 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36846 @end table
36847
36848 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36849 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36850 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36851 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36852 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36853 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36854 fields.
36855
36856 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36857 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36858 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36859 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36860 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36861
36862 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36863 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36864 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36865 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36866 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36867
36868 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36869 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36870
36871 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36872 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36873 information associated with the variable.)
36874
36875 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36876 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36877 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36878 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36879 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36880 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36881
36882 Reply:
36883 @table @samp
36884 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36885 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36886 local storage requested.
36887
36888 @item E @var{nn}
36889 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36890
36891 @item @w{}
36892 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36893 @end table
36894
36895 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36896 @cindex get thread information block address
36897 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36898 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36899
36900 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36901
36902 Reply:
36903 @table @samp
36904 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36905 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36906 thread information block.
36907
36908 @item E @var{nn}
36909 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36910 address could not be retrieved.
36911
36912 @item @w{}
36913 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36914 @end table
36915
36916 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36917 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36918 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36919 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36920 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36921 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36922 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36923
36924 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36925
36926 Reply:
36927 @table @samp
36928 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36929 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36930 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36931 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36932 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36933 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36934 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36935 @end table
36936
36937 @item qOffsets
36938 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36939 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36940 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36941 image.
36942
36943 Reply:
36944 @table @samp
36945 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36946 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36947 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36948 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36949 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36950 segments by the supplied offsets.
36951
36952 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36953 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36954 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36955
36956 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36957 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36958 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36959 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36960 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36961 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36962 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36963 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36964 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36965 @end table
36966
36967 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36968 @cindex thread information, remote request
36969 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36970 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36971 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36972 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36973
36974 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36975 (see below).
36976
36977 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36978
36979 @item QNonStop:1
36980 @itemx QNonStop:0
36981 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36982 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36983 @anchor{QNonStop}
36984 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36985 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36986
36987 Reply:
36988 @table @samp
36989 @item OK
36990 The request succeeded.
36991
36992 @item E @var{nn}
36993 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36994
36995 @item @w{}
36996 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36997 the stub.
36998 @end table
36999
37000 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37001 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37002 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37003 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37004
37005 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37006 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37007 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37008 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37009 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37010 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37011 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37012
37013 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37014 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37015 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37016
37017 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37018 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37019 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37020 report the requested syscalls.
37021
37022 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37023 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37024
37025 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37026 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37027 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37028 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37029
37030 Reply:
37031 @table @samp
37032 @item OK
37033 The request succeeded.
37034
37035 @item E @var{nn}
37036 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37037
37038 @item @w{}
37039 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37040 the stub.
37041 @end table
37042
37043 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37044 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37045 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37046 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37047
37048 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37049 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37050 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37051 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37052 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37053 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37054 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37055 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37056 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37057 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37058 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37059 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37060 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37061
37062 Reply:
37063 @table @samp
37064 @item OK
37065 The request succeeded.
37066
37067 @item E @var{nn}
37068 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37069
37070 @item @w{}
37071 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37072 the stub.
37073 @end table
37074
37075 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37076 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37077 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37078 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37079
37080 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37081 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37082 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37083 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37084 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37085 Others should be silently discarded.
37086
37087 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37088 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37089 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37090 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37091 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37092 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37093 signals.
37094
37095 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37096 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37097
37098 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37099 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37100 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37101 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37102 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37103
37104 Reply:
37105 @table @samp
37106 @item OK
37107 The request succeeded.
37108
37109 @item E @var{nn}
37110 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37111
37112 @item @w{}
37113 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37114 by the stub.
37115 @end table
37116
37117 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37118 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37119 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37120 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37121
37122 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37123 @item QThreadEvents:1
37124 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37125 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37126 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37127
37128 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37129 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37130 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37131 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37132 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37133 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37134 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37135 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37136 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37137 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37138
37139 Reply:
37140 @table @samp
37141 @item OK
37142 The request succeeded.
37143
37144 @item E @var{nn}
37145 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37146
37147 @item @w{}
37148 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37149 the stub.
37150 @end table
37151
37152 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37153 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37154
37155 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37156 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37157 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37158 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37159 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37160 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37161 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37162 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37163 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37164
37165 Reply:
37166 @table @samp
37167 @item OK
37168 A command response with no output.
37169 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37170 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37171 @item E @var{NN}
37172 Indicate a badly formed request.
37173 @item @w{}
37174 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37175 @end table
37176
37177 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37178 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37179 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37180 packets.)
37181
37182 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37183 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37184 @ifnotinfo
37185 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37186 @end ifnotinfo
37187 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37188 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37189 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37190 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37191 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37192
37193 Reply:
37194 @table @samp
37195 @item 0
37196 The pattern was not found.
37197 @item 1,address
37198 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37199 @item E @var{NN}
37200 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37201 @item @w{}
37202 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37203 @end table
37204
37205 @item QStartNoAckMode
37206 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37207 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37208 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37209 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37210
37211 Reply:
37212 @table @samp
37213 @item OK
37214 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37215 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37216 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37217 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37218 @item @w{}
37219 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37220 @end table
37221
37222 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37223 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37224 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37225 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37226 @anchor{qSupported}
37227 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37228 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37229 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37230 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37231 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37232 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37233 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37234 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37235 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37236 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37237 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37238 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37239 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37240 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37241
37242 Reply:
37243 @table @samp
37244 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37245 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37246 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37247 possible forms).
37248 @item @w{}
37249 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37250 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37251 @end table
37252
37253 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37254 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37255 are:
37256
37257 @table @samp
37258 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37259 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37260 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37261 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37262 @item @var{name}+
37263 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37264 need an associated value.
37265 @item @var{name}-
37266 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37267 @item @var{name}?
37268 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37269 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37270 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37271 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37272 @end table
37273
37274 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37275 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37276 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37277 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37278 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37279
37280 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37281 are defined:
37282
37283 @table @samp
37284 @item multiprocess
37285 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37286 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37287 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37288 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37289 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37290
37291 @item xmlRegisters
37292 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37293 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37294 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37295 description.
37296
37297 @item qRelocInsn
37298 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37299 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37300 instruction reply packet}).
37301
37302 @item swbreak
37303 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37304 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37305
37306 @item hwbreak
37307 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37308 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37309
37310 @item fork-events
37311 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37312 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37313 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37314 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37315
37316 @item vfork-events
37317 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37318 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37319 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37320 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37321
37322 @item exec-events
37323 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37324 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37325 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37326 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37327
37328 @item vContSupported
37329 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37330 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37331 @end table
37332
37333 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37334 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37335 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37336 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37337 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37338 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37339 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37340 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37341 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37342 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37343 all the features it supports.
37344
37345 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37346 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37347
37348 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37349 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37350 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37351 form response.
37352
37353 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37354 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37355 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37356 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37357
37358 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37359 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37360 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37361 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37362 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37363
37364 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37365
37366 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37367 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37368 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37369 @item Feature Name
37370 @tab Value Required
37371 @tab Default
37372 @tab Probe Allowed
37373
37374 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37375 @tab Yes
37376 @tab @samp{-}
37377 @tab No
37378
37379 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37380 @tab No
37381 @tab @samp{-}
37382 @tab Yes
37383
37384 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37385 @tab No
37386 @tab @samp{-}
37387 @tab Yes
37388
37389 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37390 @tab No
37391 @tab @samp{-}
37392 @tab Yes
37393
37394 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37395 @tab No
37396 @tab @samp{-}
37397 @tab Yes
37398
37399 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37400 @tab No
37401 @tab @samp{-}
37402 @tab Yes
37403
37404 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37405 @tab No
37406 @tab @samp{-}
37407 @tab Yes
37408
37409 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37410 @tab No
37411 @tab @samp{-}
37412 @tab Yes
37413
37414 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37415 @tab No
37416 @tab @samp{-}
37417 @tab No
37418
37419 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37420 @tab No
37421 @tab @samp{-}
37422 @tab Yes
37423
37424 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37425 @tab No
37426 @tab @samp{-}
37427 @tab Yes
37428
37429 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37430 @tab No
37431 @tab @samp{-}
37432 @tab Yes
37433
37434 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37435 @tab No
37436 @tab @samp{-}
37437 @tab Yes
37438
37439 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37440 @tab No
37441 @tab @samp{-}
37442 @tab Yes
37443
37444 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37445 @tab No
37446 @tab @samp{-}
37447 @tab Yes
37448
37449 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37450 @tab No
37451 @tab @samp{-}
37452 @tab Yes
37453
37454 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37455 @tab No
37456 @tab @samp{-}
37457 @tab Yes
37458
37459 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37460 @tab No
37461 @tab @samp{-}
37462 @tab Yes
37463
37464 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37465 @tab No
37466 @tab @samp{-}
37467 @tab Yes
37468
37469 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37470 @tab Yes
37471 @tab @samp{-}
37472 @tab Yes
37473
37474 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37475 @tab Yes
37476 @tab @samp{-}
37477 @tab Yes
37478
37479 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37480 @tab Yes
37481 @tab @samp{-}
37482 @tab Yes
37483
37484 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37485 @tab Yes
37486 @tab @samp{-}
37487 @tab Yes
37488
37489 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37490 @tab Yes
37491 @tab @samp{-}
37492 @tab Yes
37493
37494 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37495 @tab No
37496 @tab @samp{-}
37497 @tab Yes
37498
37499 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37500 @tab No
37501 @tab @samp{-}
37502 @tab Yes
37503
37504 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37505 @tab No
37506 @tab @samp{-}
37507 @tab Yes
37508
37509 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37510 @tab No
37511 @tab @samp{-}
37512 @tab Yes
37513
37514 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37515 @tab No
37516 @tab @samp{-}
37517 @tab No
37518
37519 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37520 @tab No
37521 @tab @samp{-}
37522 @tab No
37523
37524 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37525 @tab No
37526 @tab @samp{-}
37527 @tab No
37528
37529 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37530 @tab No
37531 @tab @samp{-}
37532 @tab No
37533
37534 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37535 @tab No
37536 @tab @samp{-}
37537 @tab No
37538
37539 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37540 @tab No
37541 @tab @samp{-}
37542 @tab No
37543
37544 @item @samp{QAgent}
37545 @tab No
37546 @tab @samp{-}
37547 @tab No
37548
37549 @item @samp{QAllow}
37550 @tab No
37551 @tab @samp{-}
37552 @tab No
37553
37554 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37555 @tab No
37556 @tab @samp{-}
37557 @tab No
37558
37559 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37560 @tab No
37561 @tab @samp{-}
37562 @tab No
37563
37564 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37565 @tab No
37566 @tab @samp{-}
37567 @tab No
37568
37569 @item @samp{tracenz}
37570 @tab No
37571 @tab @samp{-}
37572 @tab No
37573
37574 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37575 @tab No
37576 @tab @samp{-}
37577 @tab No
37578
37579 @item @samp{swbreak}
37580 @tab No
37581 @tab @samp{-}
37582 @tab No
37583
37584 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37585 @tab No
37586 @tab @samp{-}
37587 @tab No
37588
37589 @item @samp{fork-events}
37590 @tab No
37591 @tab @samp{-}
37592 @tab No
37593
37594 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37595 @tab No
37596 @tab @samp{-}
37597 @tab No
37598
37599 @item @samp{exec-events}
37600 @tab No
37601 @tab @samp{-}
37602 @tab No
37603
37604 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37605 @tab No
37606 @tab @samp{-}
37607 @tab No
37608
37609 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37610 @tab No
37611 @tab @samp{-}
37612 @tab No
37613
37614 @end multitable
37615
37616 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37617
37618 @table @samp
37619 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37620 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37621 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37622 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37623 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37624 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37625 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37626 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37627 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37628 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37629
37630 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37631 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37632 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37633
37634 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37635 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37636 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37637
37638 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37639 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37640 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37641
37642 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37643 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37644 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37645
37646 @item qXfer:features:read
37647 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37648 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37649
37650 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37651 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37652 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37653
37654 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37655 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37656 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37657
37658 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37659 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37660 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37661 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37662
37663 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37664 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37665 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37666
37667 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37668 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37669 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37670
37671 @item qXfer:spu:read
37672 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37673 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37674
37675 @item qXfer:spu:write
37676 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37677 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37678
37679 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37680 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37681 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37682
37683 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37684 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37685 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37686
37687 @item qXfer:threads:read
37688 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37689 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37690
37691 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37692 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37693 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37694
37695 @item qXfer:uib:read
37696 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37697 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37698
37699 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37700 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37701 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37702
37703 @item QNonStop
37704 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37705 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37706
37707 @item QCatchSyscalls
37708 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37709 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37710
37711 @item QPassSignals
37712 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37713 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37714
37715 @item QStartNoAckMode
37716 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37717 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37718
37719 @item multiprocess
37720 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37721 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37722 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37723 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37724 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37725 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37726 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37727 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37728 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37729 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37730 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37731
37732 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37733 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37734 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37735
37736 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37737 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37738 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37739 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37740
37741 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37742 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37743 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37744
37745 @item ReverseContinue
37746 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37747 (@pxref{bc}).
37748
37749 @item ReverseStep
37750 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37751 (@pxref{bs}).
37752
37753 @item TracepointSource
37754 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37755 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37756
37757 @item QAgent
37758 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37759
37760 @item QAllow
37761 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37762
37763 @item QDisableRandomization
37764 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37765
37766 @item StaticTracepoint
37767 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37768 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37769
37770 @item InstallInTrace
37771 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37772 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37773
37774 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37775 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37776 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37777 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37778
37779 @item QTBuffer:size
37780 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37781 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37782
37783 @item tracenz
37784 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37785 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37786 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37787
37788 @item BreakpointCommands
37789 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37790 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37791 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37792
37793 @item Qbtrace:off
37794 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37795
37796 @item Qbtrace:bts
37797 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37798
37799 @item Qbtrace:pt
37800 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37801
37802 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37803 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37804
37805 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37806 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37807
37808 @item swbreak
37809 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37810 breakpoints.
37811
37812 @item hwbreak
37813 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37814 breakpoints.
37815
37816 @item fork-events
37817 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37818
37819 @item vfork-events
37820 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37821 and vforkdone events.
37822
37823 @item exec-events
37824 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37825
37826 @item vContSupported
37827 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37828 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37829
37830 @item QThreadEvents
37831 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37832
37833 @item no-resumed
37834 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37835
37836 @end table
37837
37838 @item qSymbol::
37839 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37840 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37841 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37842 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37843
37844 Reply:
37845 @table @samp
37846 @item OK
37847 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37848 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37849 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37850 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37851 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37852 below.
37853 @end table
37854
37855 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37856 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37857
37858 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37859 target has previously requested.
37860
37861 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37862 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37863 will be empty.
37864
37865 Reply:
37866 @table @samp
37867 @item OK
37868 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37869 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37870 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37871 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37872 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37873 @end table
37874
37875 @item qTBuffer
37876 @itemx QTBuffer
37877 @itemx QTDisconnected
37878 @itemx QTDP
37879 @itemx QTDPsrc
37880 @itemx QTDV
37881 @itemx qTfP
37882 @itemx qTfV
37883 @itemx QTFrame
37884 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37885
37886 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37887
37888 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37889 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37890 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37891 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37892 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37893 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37894 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37895 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37896 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37897 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37898 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37899
37900 Reply:
37901 @table @samp
37902 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37903 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37904 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37905 the thread's attributes.
37906 @end table
37907
37908 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37909 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37910 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37911 packets.)
37912
37913 @item QTNotes
37914 @itemx qTP
37915 @itemx QTSave
37916 @itemx qTsP
37917 @itemx qTsV
37918 @itemx QTStart
37919 @itemx QTStop
37920 @itemx QTEnable
37921 @itemx QTDisable
37922 @itemx QTinit
37923 @itemx QTro
37924 @itemx qTStatus
37925 @itemx qTV
37926 @itemx qTfSTM
37927 @itemx qTsSTM
37928 @itemx qTSTMat
37929 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37930
37931 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37932 @cindex read special object, remote request
37933 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37934 @anchor{qXfer read}
37935 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37936 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37937 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37938 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37939 additional details about what data to access.
37940
37941 Reply:
37942 @table @samp
37943 @item m @var{data}
37944 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37945 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37946 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37947 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37948 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37949 request.
37950
37951 @item l @var{data}
37952 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37953 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37954 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37955
37956 @item l
37957 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37958 There is no more data to be read.
37959
37960 @item E00
37961 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37962
37963 @item E @var{nn}
37964 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37965 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37966
37967 @item @w{}
37968 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37969 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37970 @end table
37971
37972 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37973 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37974 formats, listed above.
37975
37976 @table @samp
37977 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37978 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37979 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37980 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37981
37982 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37983 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37984
37985 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37986 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37987
37988 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37989 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37990 packet may have one of the following values:
37991
37992 @table @code
37993 @item all
37994 Returns all available branch trace.
37995
37996 @item new
37997 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37998 the last read request.
37999
38000 @item delta
38001 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38002 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38003 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38004 used to stitch traces together.
38005
38006 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38007 @end table
38008
38009 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38010 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38011
38012 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38013 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38014
38015 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38016 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38017
38018 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38019 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38020
38021 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38022 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38023 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38024 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38025 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38026 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38027 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38028
38029 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38030 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38031
38032 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38033 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38034 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38035 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38036 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38037
38038 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38039 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38040
38041 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38042 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38043 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38044 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38045 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38046
38047 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38048 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38049 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38050
38051 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38052 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38053
38054 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38055 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38056 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38057 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38058 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38059 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38060 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38061 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38062
38063 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38064 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38065
38066 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38067 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38068
38069 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38070 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38071 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38072 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38073
38074 @table @code
38075 @item start=@var{address}
38076 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38077 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38078 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38079 chosen as the starting point.
38080
38081 @item prev=@var{address}
38082 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38083 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38084 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38085 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38086 exists prior to the starting point.
38087
38088 @end table
38089
38090 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38091 ignored.
38092
38093 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38094 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38095 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38096 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38097 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38098
38099 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38100 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38101
38102 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38103 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38104
38105 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38106 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38107 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38108 Action Lists}.
38109
38110 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38111 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38112 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38113
38114 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38115 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38116 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38117 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38118 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38119
38120 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38121 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38122 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38123
38124 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38125 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38126 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38127 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38128 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38129 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38130 in that context to be accessed.
38131
38132 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38133 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38134 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38135
38136 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38137 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38138 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38139 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38140 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38141
38142 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38143 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38144
38145 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38146 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38147
38148 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38149 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38150 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38151
38152 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38153 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38154
38155 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38156 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38157
38158 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38159 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38160
38161 This packet is not probed by default.
38162
38163 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38164 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38165 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38166 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38167 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38168
38169 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38170 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38171
38172 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38173 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38174 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38175 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38176
38177 @end table
38178
38179 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38180 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38181 @anchor{qXfer write}
38182 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38183 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38184 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38185 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38186 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38187 to access.
38188
38189 Reply:
38190 @table @samp
38191 @item @var{nn}
38192 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38193 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38194
38195 @item E00
38196 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38197
38198 @item E @var{nn}
38199 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38200 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38201
38202 @item @w{}
38203 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38204 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38205 @end table
38206
38207 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38208 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38209 formats, listed above.
38210
38211 @table @samp
38212 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38213 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38214 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38215 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38216 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38217
38218 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38219 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38220 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38221
38222 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38223 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38224 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38225 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38226 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38227 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38228 in that context to be accessed.
38229
38230 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38231 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38232 @end table
38233
38234 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38235 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38236 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38237 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38238 must respond with an empty packet.
38239
38240 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38241 @cindex query attached, remote request
38242 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38243 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38244 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38245 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38246 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38247 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38248 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38249
38250 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38251 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38252 the @code{quit} command.
38253
38254 Reply:
38255 @table @samp
38256 @item 1
38257 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38258 @item 0
38259 The remote server created a new process.
38260 @item E @var{NN}
38261 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38262 @end table
38263
38264 @item Qbtrace:bts
38265 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38266
38267 Reply:
38268 @table @samp
38269 @item OK
38270 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38271 @item E.errtext
38272 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38273 @end table
38274
38275 @item Qbtrace:pt
38276 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38277
38278 Reply:
38279 @table @samp
38280 @item OK
38281 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38282 @item E.errtext
38283 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38284 @end table
38285
38286 @item Qbtrace:off
38287 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38288
38289 Reply:
38290 @table @samp
38291 @item OK
38292 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38293 @item E.errtext
38294 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38295 @end table
38296
38297 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38298 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38299 btrace recording method in bts format.
38300
38301 Reply:
38302 @table @samp
38303 @item OK
38304 The ring buffer size has been set.
38305 @item E.errtext
38306 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38307 @end table
38308
38309 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38310 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38311 btrace recording method in pt format.
38312
38313 Reply:
38314 @table @samp
38315 @item OK
38316 The ring buffer size has been set.
38317 @item E.errtext
38318 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38319 @end table
38320
38321 @end table
38322
38323 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38324 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38325
38326 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38327 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38328 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38329
38330 @menu
38331 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38332 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38333 @end menu
38334
38335 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38336 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38337
38338 @menu
38339 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38340 @end menu
38341
38342 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38343 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38344 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38345
38346 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38347
38348 @table @r
38349
38350 @item 2
38351 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38352
38353 @item 3
38354 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38355
38356 @item 4
38357 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38358
38359 @end table
38360
38361 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38362 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38363
38364 @menu
38365 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38366 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38367 @end menu
38368
38369 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38370 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38371 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38372
38373 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38374 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38375 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38376 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38377 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38378 most-significant -- least-significant.
38379
38380 @table @r
38381
38382 @item MIPS32
38383 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38384 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38385 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38386
38387 @item MIPS64
38388 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38389 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38390 as @code{MIPS32}.
38391
38392 @end table
38393
38394 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38395 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38396 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38397
38398 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38399
38400 @table @r
38401
38402 @item 2
38403 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38404
38405 @item 3
38406 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38407
38408 @item 4
38409 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38410
38411 @item 5
38412 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38413
38414 @end table
38415
38416 @node Tracepoint Packets
38417 @section Tracepoint Packets
38418 @cindex tracepoint packets
38419 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38420
38421 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38422 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38423
38424 @table @samp
38425
38426 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38427 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38428 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38429 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38430 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38431 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38432 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38433 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38434 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38435 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38436 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38437 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38438 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38439 actions.
38440
38441 Replies:
38442 @table @samp
38443 @item OK
38444 The packet was understood and carried out.
38445 @item qRelocInsn
38446 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38447 @item @w{}
38448 The packet was not recognized.
38449 @end table
38450
38451 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38452 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38453 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38454 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38455 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38456 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38457 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38458
38459 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38460 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38461 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38462 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38463 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38464 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38465 tracepoint actions.
38466
38467 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38468 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38469 following forms:
38470
38471 @table @samp
38472
38473 @item R @var{mask}
38474 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38475 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38476 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38477 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38478 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38479
38480 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38481 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38482 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38483 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38484 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38485 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38486 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38487
38488 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38489 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38490 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38491 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38492 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38493 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38494 packet).
38495
38496 @end table
38497
38498 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38499 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38500 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38501 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38502 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38503 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38504 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38505 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38506
38507 Replies:
38508 @table @samp
38509 @item OK
38510 The packet was understood and carried out.
38511 @item qRelocInsn
38512 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38513 @item @w{}
38514 The packet was not recognized.
38515 @end table
38516
38517 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38518 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38519 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38520 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38521 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38522 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38523 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38524 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38525
38526 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38527 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38528 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38529 fit in a single packet.
38530 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38531 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38532
38533 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38534 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38535 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38536 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38537
38538 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38539 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38540 query packets.
38541
38542 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38543 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38544 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38545 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38546 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38547 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38548 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38549 be found.
38550
38551 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38552 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38553 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38554 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38555 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38556 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38557 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38558 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38559 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38560 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38561 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38562 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38563 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38564 variable.
38565
38566 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38567 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38568 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38569 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38570 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38571
38572 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38573 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38574 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38575 one of the following forms:
38576
38577 @table @samp
38578 @item F @var{f}
38579 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38580 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38581 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38582
38583 @item T @var{t}
38584 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38585 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38586
38587 @end table
38588
38589 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38590 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38591 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38592 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38593
38594 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38595 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38596 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38597 is a hexadecimal number.
38598
38599 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38600 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38601 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38602 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38603 numbers.
38604
38605 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38606 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38607 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38608
38609 @item qTMinFTPILen
38610 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38611 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38612 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38613 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38614 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38615 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38616 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38617 arrange for that.
38618
38619 Replies:
38620
38621 @table @samp
38622 @item 0
38623 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38624 @item @var{length}
38625 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38626 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38627 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38628 regardless of size.
38629 @item E
38630 An error has occurred.
38631 @item @w{}
38632 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38633 @end table
38634
38635 @item QTStart
38636 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38637 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38638 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38639 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38640 instruction reply packet}).
38641
38642 @item QTStop
38643 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38644 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38645
38646 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38647 @anchor{QTEnable}
38648 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38649 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38650 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38651 of data from it will resume.
38652
38653 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38654 @anchor{QTDisable}
38655 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38656 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38657 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38658 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38659
38660 @item QTinit
38661 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38662 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38663
38664 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38665 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38666 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38667 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38668 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38669
38670 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38671 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38672 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38673 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38674
38675 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38676 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38677 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38678 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38679 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38680 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38681
38682 @item qTStatus
38683 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38684 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38685
38686 The reply has the form:
38687
38688 @table @samp
38689
38690 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38691 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38692 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38693 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38694
38695 @end table
38696
38697 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38698 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38699
38700 @table @samp
38701
38702 @item tnotrun:0
38703 No trace has been run yet.
38704
38705 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38706 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38707 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38708 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38709 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38710
38711 @item tfull:0
38712 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38713
38714 @item tdisconnected:0
38715 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38716
38717 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38718 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38719
38720 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38721 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38722 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38723 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38724 is hex encoded.
38725
38726 @item tunknown:0
38727 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38728
38729 @end table
38730
38731 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38732 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38733 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38734 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38735 trace.
38736
38737 @table @samp
38738
38739 @item tframes:@var{n}
38740 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38741
38742 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38743 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38744 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38745
38746 @item tsize:@var{n}
38747 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38748
38749 @item tfree:@var{n}
38750 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38751
38752 @item circular:@var{n}
38753 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38754 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38755 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38756 and may fill up.
38757
38758 @item disconn:@var{n}
38759 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38760 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38761 that the trace run will stop.
38762
38763 @end table
38764
38765 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38766 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38767 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38768 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38769 address @var{addr}.
38770
38771 Replies:
38772 @table @samp
38773 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38774 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38775 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38776 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38777 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38778
38779 @end table
38780
38781 @item qTV:@var{var}
38782 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38783 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38784 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38785
38786 Replies:
38787 @table @samp
38788 @item V@var{value}
38789 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38790 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38791 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38792 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38793 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38794 program is running.
38795
38796 @item U
38797 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38798 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38799 was not collected.
38800 @end table
38801
38802 @item qTfP
38803 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38804 @itemx qTsP
38805 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38806 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38807 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38808 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38809 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38810 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38811
38812 @item qTfV
38813 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38814 @itemx qTsV
38815 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38816 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38817 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38818 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38819 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38820 trace state variables.
38821
38822 @item qTfSTM
38823 @itemx qTsSTM
38824 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38825 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38826 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38827 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38828 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38829 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38830 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38831 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38832
38833 Reply:
38834 @table @samp
38835 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38836 A single marker
38837 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38838 a comma-separated list of markers
38839 @item l
38840 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38841 @item E @var{nn}
38842 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38843 @item @w{}
38844 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38845 stub.
38846 @end table
38847
38848 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38849 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38850
38851 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38852 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38853 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38854 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38855 @dfn{last}).
38856
38857 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38858 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38859 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38860 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38861 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38862 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38863 tracepoint markers.
38864
38865 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38866 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38867 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38868 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38869 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38870 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38871
38872 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38873 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38874 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38875 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38876 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38877 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38878 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38879 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38880 available.
38881
38882 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38883 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38884 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38885
38886 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38887 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38888 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38889 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38890 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38891 use whatever size it prefers.
38892
38893 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38894 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38895 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38896 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38897 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38898
38899 @end table
38900
38901 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38902 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38903 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38904 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38905 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38906 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38907 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38908 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38909 it had executed in the original location.
38910
38911 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38912 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38913 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38914 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38915 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38916 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38917 format of the request is:
38918
38919 @table @samp
38920 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38921
38922 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38923 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38924 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38925 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38926 memory starting at @var{to}.
38927 @end table
38928
38929 Replies:
38930 @table @samp
38931 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38932 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38933 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38934 @item E @var{NN}
38935 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38936 relocating the instruction.
38937 @end table
38938
38939 @node Host I/O Packets
38940 @section Host I/O Packets
38941 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38942 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38943
38944 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38945 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38946 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38947 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38948 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38949 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38950 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38951 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38952 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38953 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38954
38955 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38956 its arguments. They have this format:
38957
38958 @table @samp
38959
38960 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38961 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38962 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38963 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38964 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38965 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38966 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38967 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38968 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38969
38970 @end table
38971
38972 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38973
38974 @table @samp
38975
38976 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38977 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38978 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38979 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38980 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38981 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38982 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38983 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38984 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38985 @var{attachment}.
38986
38987 @item @w{}
38988 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38989
38990 @end table
38991
38992 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38993
38994 @table @samp
38995 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38996 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38997 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38998 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38999 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39000 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39001 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39002
39003 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39004 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39005 -1 if an error occurs.
39006
39007 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39008 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39009 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39010 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39011 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39012 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39013 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39014 @var{count} was zero.
39015
39016 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39017 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39018 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39019 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39020 some characters were escaped.
39021
39022 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39023 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39024 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39025 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39026 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39027 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39028 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39029 error occurred.
39030
39031 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39032 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39033 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39034 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39035 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39036 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39037
39038 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39039 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39040 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39041
39042 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39043 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39044 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39045
39046 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39047 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39048 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39049 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39050 some characters were escaped.
39051
39052 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39053 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39054 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39055 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39056 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39057 inferior(s).
39058
39059 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39060 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39061 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39062 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39063 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39064 operation.
39065
39066 @end table
39067
39068 @node Interrupts
39069 @section Interrupts
39070 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39071 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39072
39073 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39074 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39075 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39076 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39077
39078 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39079 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39080 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39081 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39082 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39083
39084 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39085 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39086 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39087 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39088 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39089 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39090 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39091 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39092
39093 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39094 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39095 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39096
39097 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39098 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39099 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39100 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39101 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39102 @code{0x03}.
39103
39104 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39105 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39106 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39107 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39108 currently-executing threads and processes.
39109 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39110 running program, it should send one of the stop
39111 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39112 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39113 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39114 Interrupts received while the
39115 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39116 it is resumed next time.
39117
39118 @node Notification Packets
39119 @section Notification Packets
39120 @cindex notification packets
39121 @cindex packets, notification
39122
39123 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39124 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39125 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39126 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39127 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39128 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39129 is not a problem.
39130
39131 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39132 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39133 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39134 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39135 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39136 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39137 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39138
39139 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39140 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39141
39142 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39143 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39144 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39145 not they understand it.
39146
39147 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39148 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39149 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39150 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39151 recipients.
39152
39153 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39154 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39155 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39156 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39157 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39158
39159 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39160 @table @samp
39161 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39162 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39163 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39164 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39165 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39166 @item @var{ack}
39167 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39168 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39169 @end table
39170
39171 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39172 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39173
39174 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39175 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39176 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39177 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39178 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39179 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39180 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39181 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39182 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39183 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39184
39185 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39186 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39187 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39188 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39189 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39190 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39191
39192 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39193 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39194 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39195 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39196 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39197
39198 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39199 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39200 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39201 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39202 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39203 normally.
39204
39205 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39206 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39207 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39208 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39209 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39210 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39211 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39212 the process shall be repeated.
39213
39214 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39215 following example:
39216 @smallexample
39217 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39218 @code{...}
39219 -> @code{vStopped}
39220 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39221 -> @code{vStopped}
39222 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39223 -> @code{vStopped}
39224 <- @code{OK}
39225 @end smallexample
39226
39227 The following notifications are defined:
39228 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39229
39230 @item Notification
39231 @tab Ack
39232 @tab Event
39233 @tab Description
39234
39235 @item Stop
39236 @tab vStopped
39237 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39238 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39239 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39240 @value{GDBN}.
39241 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39242
39243 @end multitable
39244
39245 @node Remote Non-Stop
39246 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39247
39248 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39249 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39250 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39251 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39252
39253 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39254 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39255 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39256 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39257 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39258 probe the target state after a mode change.
39259
39260 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39261 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39262 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39263 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39264 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39265 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39266 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39267 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39268 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39269 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39270 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39271
39272 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39273 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39274 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39275 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39276 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39277 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39278 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39279 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39280 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39281 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39282 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39283 @samp{OK}.
39284
39285 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39286 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39287 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39288 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39289 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39290 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39291 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39292 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39293 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39294 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39295 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39296 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39297 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39298
39299 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39300 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39301
39302 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39303 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39304 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39305 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39306 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39307 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39308 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39309
39310 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39311 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39312 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39313 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39314 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39315
39316 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39317 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39318 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39319 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39320
39321 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39322 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39323 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39324 @pxref{qSupported}.
39325 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39326 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39327 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39328 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39329 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39330 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39331 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39332
39333 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39334 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39335 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39336 connection.
39337 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39338 new connection is established,
39339 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39340 for the current connection, once disabled.
39341
39342 @node Examples
39343 @section Examples
39344
39345 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39346 does not get any direct output:
39347
39348 @smallexample
39349 -> @code{R00}
39350 <- @code{+}
39351 @emph{target restarts}
39352 -> @code{?}
39353 <- @code{+}
39354 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39355 -> @code{+}
39356 @end smallexample
39357
39358 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39359
39360 @smallexample
39361 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39362 <- @code{+}
39363 -> @code{s}
39364 <- @code{+}
39365 @emph{time passes}
39366 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39367 -> @code{+}
39368 -> @code{g}
39369 <- @code{+}
39370 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39371 -> @code{+}
39372 @end smallexample
39373
39374 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39375 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39376 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39377
39378 @menu
39379 * File-I/O Overview::
39380 * Protocol Basics::
39381 * The F Request Packet::
39382 * The F Reply Packet::
39383 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39384 * Console I/O::
39385 * List of Supported Calls::
39386 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39387 * Constants::
39388 * File-I/O Examples::
39389 @end menu
39390
39391 @node File-I/O Overview
39392 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39393 @cindex file-i/o overview
39394
39395 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39396 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39397 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39398 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39399 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39400 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39401
39402 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39403 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39404 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39405 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39406 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39407
39408 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39409 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39410 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39411 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39412 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39413 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39414 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39415
39416 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39417 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39418 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39419 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39420 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39421
39422 @smallexample
39423 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39424 <- target requests 'system call X'
39425 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39426 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39427 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39428 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39429 @end smallexample
39430
39431 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39432 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39433 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39434 system are not supported by this protocol.
39435
39436 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39437
39438 @node Protocol Basics
39439 @subsection Protocol Basics
39440 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39441
39442 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39443 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39444 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39445 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39446 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39447 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39448 to call the appropriate host system call:
39449
39450 @itemize @bullet
39451 @item
39452 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39453
39454 @item
39455 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39456 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39457 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39458 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39459
39460 @end itemize
39461
39462 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39463
39464 @itemize @bullet
39465 @item
39466 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39467 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39468 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39469 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39470 packet.
39471
39472 @item
39473 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39474 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39475
39476 @item
39477 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39478
39479 @item
39480 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39481
39482 @item
39483 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39484 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39485 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39486 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39487 packet.
39488
39489 @end itemize
39490
39491 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39492 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39493
39494 @itemize @bullet
39495 @item
39496 Return value.
39497
39498 @item
39499 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39500
39501 @item
39502 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39503
39504 @end itemize
39505
39506 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39507 the latest continue or step action.
39508
39509 @node The F Request Packet
39510 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39511 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39512 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39513
39514 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39515
39516 @table @samp
39517 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39518
39519 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39520 This is just the name of the function.
39521
39522 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39523 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39524 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39525 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39526 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39527 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39528 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39529
39530 @end table
39531
39532
39533
39534 @node The F Reply Packet
39535 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39536 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39537 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39538
39539 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39540
39541 @table @samp
39542
39543 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39544
39545 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39546
39547 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39548 representation.
39549 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39550
39551 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39552 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39553 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39554
39555 @smallexample
39556 F0,0,C
39557 @end smallexample
39558
39559 @noindent
39560 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39561
39562 @smallexample
39563 F-1,4,C
39564 @end smallexample
39565
39566 @noindent
39567 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39568
39569 @end table
39570
39571
39572 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39573 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39574 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39575
39576 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39577 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39578 the target should behave as if it had
39579 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39580 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39581 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39582 packet.
39583
39584 It's important for the target to know in which
39585 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39586
39587 @itemize @bullet
39588 @item
39589 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39590
39591 @item
39592 The system call on the host has been finished.
39593
39594 @end itemize
39595
39596 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39597 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39598 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39599 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39600 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39601 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39602
39603 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39604 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39605 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39606 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39607 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39608 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39609 or the full action has been completed.
39610
39611 @node Console I/O
39612 @subsection Console I/O
39613 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39614
39615 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39616 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39617 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39618 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39619 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39620 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39621 conditions is met:
39622
39623 @itemize @bullet
39624 @item
39625 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39626 @code{read}
39627 system call is treated as finished.
39628
39629 @item
39630 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39631 newline.
39632
39633 @item
39634 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39635 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39636
39637 @end itemize
39638
39639 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39640 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39641 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39642 is stopped at the user's request.
39643
39644
39645 @node List of Supported Calls
39646 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39647 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39648
39649 @menu
39650 * open::
39651 * close::
39652 * read::
39653 * write::
39654 * lseek::
39655 * rename::
39656 * unlink::
39657 * stat/fstat::
39658 * gettimeofday::
39659 * isatty::
39660 * system::
39661 @end menu
39662
39663 @node open
39664 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39665 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39666
39667 @table @asis
39668 @item Synopsis:
39669 @smallexample
39670 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39671 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39672 @end smallexample
39673
39674 @item Request:
39675 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39676
39677 @noindent
39678 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39679
39680 @table @code
39681 @item O_CREAT
39682 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39683 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39684 are concerned.
39685
39686 @item O_EXCL
39687 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39688 an error and open() fails.
39689
39690 @item O_TRUNC
39691 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39692 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39693 truncated to zero length.
39694
39695 @item O_APPEND
39696 The file is opened in append mode.
39697
39698 @item O_RDONLY
39699 The file is opened for reading only.
39700
39701 @item O_WRONLY
39702 The file is opened for writing only.
39703
39704 @item O_RDWR
39705 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39706 @end table
39707
39708 @noindent
39709 Other bits are silently ignored.
39710
39711
39712 @noindent
39713 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39714
39715 @table @code
39716 @item S_IRUSR
39717 User has read permission.
39718
39719 @item S_IWUSR
39720 User has write permission.
39721
39722 @item S_IRGRP
39723 Group has read permission.
39724
39725 @item S_IWGRP
39726 Group has write permission.
39727
39728 @item S_IROTH
39729 Others have read permission.
39730
39731 @item S_IWOTH
39732 Others have write permission.
39733 @end table
39734
39735 @noindent
39736 Other bits are silently ignored.
39737
39738
39739 @item Return value:
39740 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39741 occurred.
39742
39743 @item Errors:
39744
39745 @table @code
39746 @item EEXIST
39747 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39748
39749 @item EISDIR
39750 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39751
39752 @item EACCES
39753 The requested access is not allowed.
39754
39755 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39756 @var{pathname} was too long.
39757
39758 @item ENOENT
39759 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39760
39761 @item ENODEV
39762 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39763
39764 @item EROFS
39765 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39766 write access was requested.
39767
39768 @item EFAULT
39769 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39770
39771 @item ENOSPC
39772 No space on device to create the file.
39773
39774 @item EMFILE
39775 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39776
39777 @item ENFILE
39778 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39779 has been reached.
39780
39781 @item EINTR
39782 The call was interrupted by the user.
39783 @end table
39784
39785 @end table
39786
39787 @node close
39788 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39789 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39790
39791 @table @asis
39792 @item Synopsis:
39793 @smallexample
39794 int close(int fd);
39795 @end smallexample
39796
39797 @item Request:
39798 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39799
39800 @item Return value:
39801 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39802
39803 @item Errors:
39804
39805 @table @code
39806 @item EBADF
39807 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39808
39809 @item EINTR
39810 The call was interrupted by the user.
39811 @end table
39812
39813 @end table
39814
39815 @node read
39816 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39817 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39818
39819 @table @asis
39820 @item Synopsis:
39821 @smallexample
39822 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39823 @end smallexample
39824
39825 @item Request:
39826 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39827
39828 @item Return value:
39829 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39830 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39831 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39832
39833 @item Errors:
39834
39835 @table @code
39836 @item EBADF
39837 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39838 reading.
39839
39840 @item EFAULT
39841 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39842
39843 @item EINTR
39844 The call was interrupted by the user.
39845 @end table
39846
39847 @end table
39848
39849 @node write
39850 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39851 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39852
39853 @table @asis
39854 @item Synopsis:
39855 @smallexample
39856 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39857 @end smallexample
39858
39859 @item Request:
39860 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39861
39862 @item Return value:
39863 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39864 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39865 is returned.
39866
39867 @item Errors:
39868
39869 @table @code
39870 @item EBADF
39871 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39872 writing.
39873
39874 @item EFAULT
39875 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39876
39877 @item EFBIG
39878 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39879 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39880
39881 @item ENOSPC
39882 No space on device to write the data.
39883
39884 @item EINTR
39885 The call was interrupted by the user.
39886 @end table
39887
39888 @end table
39889
39890 @node lseek
39891 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39892 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39893
39894 @table @asis
39895 @item Synopsis:
39896 @smallexample
39897 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39898 @end smallexample
39899
39900 @item Request:
39901 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39902
39903 @var{flag} is one of:
39904
39905 @table @code
39906 @item SEEK_SET
39907 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39908
39909 @item SEEK_CUR
39910 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39911 bytes.
39912
39913 @item SEEK_END
39914 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39915 bytes.
39916 @end table
39917
39918 @item Return value:
39919 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39920 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39921 value of -1 is returned.
39922
39923 @item Errors:
39924
39925 @table @code
39926 @item EBADF
39927 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39928
39929 @item ESPIPE
39930 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39931
39932 @item EINVAL
39933 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39934
39935 @item EINTR
39936 The call was interrupted by the user.
39937 @end table
39938
39939 @end table
39940
39941 @node rename
39942 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39943 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39944
39945 @table @asis
39946 @item Synopsis:
39947 @smallexample
39948 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39949 @end smallexample
39950
39951 @item Request:
39952 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39953
39954 @item Return value:
39955 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39956
39957 @item Errors:
39958
39959 @table @code
39960 @item EISDIR
39961 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39962 directory.
39963
39964 @item EEXIST
39965 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39966
39967 @item EBUSY
39968 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39969 process.
39970
39971 @item EINVAL
39972 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39973 of itself.
39974
39975 @item ENOTDIR
39976 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39977 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39978 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39979
39980 @item EFAULT
39981 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39982
39983 @item EACCES
39984 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39985
39986 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39987
39988 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39989
39990 @item ENOENT
39991 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39992
39993 @item EROFS
39994 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39995
39996 @item ENOSPC
39997 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39998 directory entry.
39999
40000 @item EINTR
40001 The call was interrupted by the user.
40002 @end table
40003
40004 @end table
40005
40006 @node unlink
40007 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40008 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40009
40010 @table @asis
40011 @item Synopsis:
40012 @smallexample
40013 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40014 @end smallexample
40015
40016 @item Request:
40017 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40018
40019 @item Return value:
40020 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40021
40022 @item Errors:
40023
40024 @table @code
40025 @item EACCES
40026 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40027
40028 @item EPERM
40029 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40030
40031 @item EBUSY
40032 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40033 being used by another process.
40034
40035 @item EFAULT
40036 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40037
40038 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40039 @var{pathname} was too long.
40040
40041 @item ENOENT
40042 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40043
40044 @item ENOTDIR
40045 A component of the path is not a directory.
40046
40047 @item EROFS
40048 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40049
40050 @item EINTR
40051 The call was interrupted by the user.
40052 @end table
40053
40054 @end table
40055
40056 @node stat/fstat
40057 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40058 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40059 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40060
40061 @table @asis
40062 @item Synopsis:
40063 @smallexample
40064 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40065 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40066 @end smallexample
40067
40068 @item Request:
40069 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40070 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40071
40072 @item Return value:
40073 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40074
40075 @item Errors:
40076
40077 @table @code
40078 @item EBADF
40079 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40080
40081 @item ENOENT
40082 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40083 path is an empty string.
40084
40085 @item ENOTDIR
40086 A component of the path is not a directory.
40087
40088 @item EFAULT
40089 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40090
40091 @item EACCES
40092 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40093
40094 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40095 @var{pathname} was too long.
40096
40097 @item EINTR
40098 The call was interrupted by the user.
40099 @end table
40100
40101 @end table
40102
40103 @node gettimeofday
40104 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40105 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40106
40107 @table @asis
40108 @item Synopsis:
40109 @smallexample
40110 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40111 @end smallexample
40112
40113 @item Request:
40114 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40115
40116 @item Return value:
40117 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40118
40119 @item Errors:
40120
40121 @table @code
40122 @item EINVAL
40123 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40124
40125 @item EFAULT
40126 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40127 @end table
40128
40129 @end table
40130
40131 @node isatty
40132 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40133 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40134
40135 @table @asis
40136 @item Synopsis:
40137 @smallexample
40138 int isatty(int fd);
40139 @end smallexample
40140
40141 @item Request:
40142 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40143
40144 @item Return value:
40145 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40146
40147 @item Errors:
40148
40149 @table @code
40150 @item EINTR
40151 The call was interrupted by the user.
40152 @end table
40153
40154 @end table
40155
40156 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40157 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40158 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40159 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40160 needed.
40161
40162
40163 @node system
40164 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40165 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40166
40167 @table @asis
40168 @item Synopsis:
40169 @smallexample
40170 int system(const char *command);
40171 @end smallexample
40172
40173 @item Request:
40174 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40175
40176 @item Return value:
40177 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40178 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40179 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40180 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40181 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40182 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40183 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40184
40185 @item Errors:
40186
40187 @table @code
40188 @item EINTR
40189 The call was interrupted by the user.
40190 @end table
40191
40192 @end table
40193
40194 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40195 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40196 the host is simplified before it's returned
40197 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40198 is discarded, and the return value consists
40199 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40200
40201 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40202 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40203 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40204
40205 @table @code
40206 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40207 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40208 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40209 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40210
40211 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40212 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40213 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40214 protocol.
40215 @end table
40216
40217 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40218 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40219 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40220
40221 @menu
40222 * Integral Datatypes::
40223 * Pointer Values::
40224 * Memory Transfer::
40225 * struct stat::
40226 * struct timeval::
40227 @end menu
40228
40229 @node Integral Datatypes
40230 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40231 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40232
40233 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40234 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40235 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40236
40237 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40238 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40239
40240 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40241
40242 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40243 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40244
40245 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40246
40247 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40248 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40249 byte order.
40250
40251 @node Pointer Values
40252 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40253 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40254
40255 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40256 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40257 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40258 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40259
40260 @smallexample
40261 @code{1aaf/12}
40262 @end smallexample
40263
40264 @noindent
40265 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40266 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40267 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40268 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40269
40270 @smallexample
40271 @code{123456/d}
40272 @end smallexample
40273
40274 @node Memory Transfer
40275 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40276 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40277
40278 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40279 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40280 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40281 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40282 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40283 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40284 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40285
40286
40287 @node struct stat
40288 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40289 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40290
40291 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40292 is defined as follows:
40293
40294 @smallexample
40295 struct stat @{
40296 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40297 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40298 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40299 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40300 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40301 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40302 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40303 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40304 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40305 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40306 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40307 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40308 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40309 @};
40310 @end smallexample
40311
40312 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40313 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40314 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40315
40316 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40317 range of values.
40318
40319 @table @code
40320
40321 @item st_dev
40322 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40323
40324 @item st_ino
40325 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40326
40327 @item st_mode
40328 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40329 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40330
40331 @item st_uid
40332 @itemx st_gid
40333 @itemx st_rdev
40334 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40335
40336 @item st_atime
40337 @itemx st_mtime
40338 @itemx st_ctime
40339 These values have a host and file system dependent
40340 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40341 support exact timing values.
40342 @end table
40343
40344 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40345 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40346 continuing.
40347
40348 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40349 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40350 get truncated on the target.
40351
40352 @node struct timeval
40353 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40354 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40355
40356 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40357 is defined as follows:
40358
40359 @smallexample
40360 struct timeval @{
40361 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40362 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40363 @};
40364 @end smallexample
40365
40366 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40367 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40368 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40369
40370 @node Constants
40371 @subsection Constants
40372 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40373
40374 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40375 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40376 values before and after the call as needed.
40377
40378 @menu
40379 * Open Flags::
40380 * mode_t Values::
40381 * Errno Values::
40382 * Lseek Flags::
40383 * Limits::
40384 @end menu
40385
40386 @node Open Flags
40387 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40388 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40389
40390 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40391
40392 @smallexample
40393 O_RDONLY 0x0
40394 O_WRONLY 0x1
40395 O_RDWR 0x2
40396 O_APPEND 0x8
40397 O_CREAT 0x200
40398 O_TRUNC 0x400
40399 O_EXCL 0x800
40400 @end smallexample
40401
40402 @node mode_t Values
40403 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40404 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40405
40406 All values are given in octal representation.
40407
40408 @smallexample
40409 S_IFREG 0100000
40410 S_IFDIR 040000
40411 S_IRUSR 0400
40412 S_IWUSR 0200
40413 S_IXUSR 0100
40414 S_IRGRP 040
40415 S_IWGRP 020
40416 S_IXGRP 010
40417 S_IROTH 04
40418 S_IWOTH 02
40419 S_IXOTH 01
40420 @end smallexample
40421
40422 @node Errno Values
40423 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40424 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40425
40426 All values are given in decimal representation.
40427
40428 @smallexample
40429 EPERM 1
40430 ENOENT 2
40431 EINTR 4
40432 EBADF 9
40433 EACCES 13
40434 EFAULT 14
40435 EBUSY 16
40436 EEXIST 17
40437 ENODEV 19
40438 ENOTDIR 20
40439 EISDIR 21
40440 EINVAL 22
40441 ENFILE 23
40442 EMFILE 24
40443 EFBIG 27
40444 ENOSPC 28
40445 ESPIPE 29
40446 EROFS 30
40447 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40448 EUNKNOWN 9999
40449 @end smallexample
40450
40451 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40452 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40453
40454 @node Lseek Flags
40455 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40456 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40457
40458 @smallexample
40459 SEEK_SET 0
40460 SEEK_CUR 1
40461 SEEK_END 2
40462 @end smallexample
40463
40464 @node Limits
40465 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40466 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40467
40468 All values are given in decimal representation.
40469
40470 @smallexample
40471 INT_MIN -2147483648
40472 INT_MAX 2147483647
40473 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40474 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40475 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40476 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40477 @end smallexample
40478
40479 @node File-I/O Examples
40480 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40481 @cindex file-i/o examples
40482
40483 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40484 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40485
40486 @smallexample
40487 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40488 @emph{request memory read from target}
40489 -> @code{m1234,6}
40490 <- XXXXXX
40491 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40492 -> @code{F6}
40493 @end smallexample
40494
40495 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40496 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40497
40498 @smallexample
40499 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40500 @emph{request memory write to target}
40501 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40502 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40503 -> @code{F6}
40504 @end smallexample
40505
40506 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40507 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40508
40509 @smallexample
40510 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40511 -> @code{F-1,9}
40512 @end smallexample
40513
40514 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40515 host is called:
40516
40517 @smallexample
40518 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40519 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40520 <- @code{T02}
40521 @end smallexample
40522
40523 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40524 host is called:
40525
40526 @smallexample
40527 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40528 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40529 <- @code{T02}
40530 @end smallexample
40531
40532 @node Library List Format
40533 @section Library List Format
40534 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40535
40536 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40537 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40538 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40539 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40540 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40541 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40542 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40543 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40544 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40545 are loaded.
40546
40547 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40548 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40549 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40550 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40551
40552 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40553 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40554 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40555 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40556 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40557 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40558
40559 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40560 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40561
40562 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40563 offset, looks like this:
40564
40565 @smallexample
40566 <library-list>
40567 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40568 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40569 </library>
40570 </library-list>
40571 @end smallexample
40572
40573 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40574 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40575
40576 @smallexample
40577 <library-list>
40578 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40579 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40580 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40581 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40582 </library>
40583 </library-list>
40584 @end smallexample
40585
40586 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40587
40588 @smallexample
40589 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40590 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40591 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40592 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40593 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40594 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40595 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40596 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40597 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40598 @end smallexample
40599
40600 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40601 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40602 section for each library.
40603
40604 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40605 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40606 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40607
40608 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40609 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40610 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40611 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40612
40613 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40614 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40615 target, the following parameters are reported:
40616
40617 @itemize @minus
40618 @item
40619 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40620 @code{struct link_map}.
40621 @item
40622 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40623 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40624 @item
40625 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40626 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40627 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40628 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40629 @item
40630 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40631 @end itemize
40632
40633 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40634 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40635 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40636
40637 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40638 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40639
40640 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40641 looks like this:
40642
40643 @smallexample
40644 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40645 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40646 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40647 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40648 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40649 </library-list-svr>
40650 @end smallexample
40651
40652 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40653
40654 @smallexample
40655 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40656 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40657 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40658 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40659 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40660 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40661 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40662 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40663 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40664 @end smallexample
40665
40666 @node Memory Map Format
40667 @section Memory Map Format
40668 @cindex memory map format
40669
40670 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40671 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40672 memory map.
40673
40674 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40675 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40676 lists memory regions.
40677
40678 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40679 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40680
40681 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40682
40683 @smallexample
40684 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40685 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40686 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40687 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40688 <memory-map>
40689 region...
40690 </memory-map>
40691 @end smallexample
40692
40693 Each region can be either:
40694
40695 @itemize
40696
40697 @item
40698 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40699 bytes from there:
40700
40701 @smallexample
40702 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40703 @end smallexample
40704
40705
40706 @item
40707 A region of read-only memory:
40708
40709 @smallexample
40710 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40711 @end smallexample
40712
40713
40714 @item
40715 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40716 bytes in length:
40717
40718 @smallexample
40719 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40720 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40721 </memory>
40722 @end smallexample
40723
40724 @end itemize
40725
40726 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40727 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40728 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40729
40730 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40731
40732 @smallexample
40733 <!-- ................................................... -->
40734 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40735 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40736 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40737 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40738 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40739 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40740 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40741 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40742 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40743 and its type, or device. -->
40744 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40745 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40746 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40747 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40748 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40749 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40750 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40751 @end smallexample
40752
40753 @node Thread List Format
40754 @section Thread List Format
40755 @cindex thread list format
40756
40757 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40758 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40759 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40760 the following structure:
40761
40762 @smallexample
40763 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40764 <threads>
40765 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40766 ... description ...
40767 </thread>
40768 </threads>
40769 @end smallexample
40770
40771 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40772 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40773 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40774 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40775 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40776 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40777 auxiliary information.
40778
40779 @node Traceframe Info Format
40780 @section Traceframe Info Format
40781 @cindex traceframe info format
40782
40783 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40784 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40785 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40786 collected in a traceframe.
40787
40788 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40789 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40790
40791 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40792 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40793
40794 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40795
40796 @smallexample
40797 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40798 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40799 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40800 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40801 <traceframe-info>
40802 block...
40803 </traceframe-info>
40804 @end smallexample
40805
40806 Each traceframe block can be either:
40807
40808 @itemize
40809
40810 @item
40811 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40812 @var{length} bytes from there:
40813
40814 @smallexample
40815 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40816 @end smallexample
40817
40818 @item
40819 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40820 collected:
40821
40822 @smallexample
40823 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40824 @end smallexample
40825
40826 @end itemize
40827
40828 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40829
40830 @smallexample
40831 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40832 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40833
40834 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40835 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40836 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40837 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40838 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40839 @end smallexample
40840
40841 @node Branch Trace Format
40842 @section Branch Trace Format
40843 @cindex branch trace format
40844
40845 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40846 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40847 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40848 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40849
40850 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40851 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40852
40853 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40854 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40855
40856 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40857
40858 @smallexample
40859 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40860 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40861 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40862 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40863 <btrace>
40864 block...
40865 </btrace>
40866 @end smallexample
40867
40868 @itemize
40869
40870 @item
40871 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40872 and ending at @var{end}:
40873
40874 @smallexample
40875 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40876 @end smallexample
40877
40878 @end itemize
40879
40880 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40881
40882 @smallexample
40883 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40884 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40885
40886 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40887 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40888 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40889
40890 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40891
40892 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40893
40894 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40895 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40896 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40897 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40898 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40899
40900 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40901 @end smallexample
40902
40903 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40904 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40905 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40906
40907 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40908 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40909 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40910
40911 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40912 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40913
40914 @table @code
40915 @item bts
40916 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40917 @table @code
40918 @item size
40919 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40920 @end table
40921 @item pt
40922 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40923 PT}) format.
40924 @table @code
40925 @item size
40926 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40927 @end table
40928 @end table
40929
40930 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40931 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40932
40933 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40934
40935 @smallexample
40936 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40937 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40938
40939 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40940 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40941
40942 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40943 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40944 @end smallexample
40945
40946 @include agentexpr.texi
40947
40948 @node Target Descriptions
40949 @appendix Target Descriptions
40950 @cindex target descriptions
40951
40952 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40953 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40954 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40955 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40956 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40957 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40958 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40959
40960 @itemize @bullet
40961 @item
40962 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40963 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40964 @item
40965 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40966 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40967 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40968 @item
40969 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40970 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40971 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40972 @end itemize
40973
40974 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40975 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40976 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40977 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40978 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40979
40980 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40981 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40982
40983 @menu
40984 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40985 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40986 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40987 descriptions.
40988 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40989 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40990 @end menu
40991
40992 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40993 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40994
40995 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40996 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40997 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40998 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40999 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41000 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41001 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41002 Format}.
41003
41004 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41005 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41006 specify a file are:
41007
41008 @table @code
41009 @cindex set tdesc filename
41010 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41011 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41012
41013 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41014 @item unset tdesc filename
41015 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41016 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41017
41018 @cindex show tdesc filename
41019 @item show tdesc filename
41020 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41021 @end table
41022
41023
41024 @node Target Description Format
41025 @section Target Description Format
41026 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41027
41028 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41029 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41030 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41031 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41032 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41033 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41034 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41035
41036 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41037 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41038 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41039 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41040 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41041
41042 Here is a simple target description:
41043
41044 @smallexample
41045 <target version="1.0">
41046 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41047 </target>
41048 @end smallexample
41049
41050 @noindent
41051 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41052 the x86-64 architecture.
41053
41054 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41055 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41056 are explained further below.
41057
41058 @smallexample
41059 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41060 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41061 <target version="1.0">
41062 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41063 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41064 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41065 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41066 </target>
41067 @end smallexample
41068
41069 @noindent
41070 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41071 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41072 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41073 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41074 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41075 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41076 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41077 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41078 the version mismatch.
41079
41080 @subsection Inclusion
41081 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41082 @cindex XInclude
41083 @ifnotinfo
41084 @cindex <xi:include>
41085 @end ifnotinfo
41086
41087 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41088 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41089 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41090 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41091 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41092
41093 @smallexample
41094 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41095 @end smallexample
41096
41097 @noindent
41098 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41099 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41100 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41101 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41102 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41103 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41104 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41105 original description.
41106
41107 @subsection Architecture
41108 @cindex <architecture>
41109
41110 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41111
41112 @smallexample
41113 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41114 @end smallexample
41115
41116 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41117 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41118
41119 @subsection OS ABI
41120 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41121
41122 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41123 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41124
41125 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41126
41127 @smallexample
41128 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41129 @end smallexample
41130
41131 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41132 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41133
41134 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41135 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41136
41137 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41138 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41139
41140 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41141
41142 @smallexample
41143 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41144 @end smallexample
41145
41146 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41147 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41148
41149 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41150 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41151 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41152 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41153 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41154 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41155 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41156
41157 @smallexample
41158 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41159 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41160 @end smallexample
41161
41162 @subsection Features
41163 @cindex <feature>
41164
41165 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41166 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41167 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41168 has this form:
41169
41170 @smallexample
41171 <feature name="@var{name}">
41172 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41173 @var{reg}@dots{}
41174 </feature>
41175 @end smallexample
41176
41177 @noindent
41178 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41179 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41180 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41181 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41182
41183 @subsection Types
41184
41185 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41186 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41187 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41188 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41189 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41190 and enum types.
41191
41192 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41193 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41194 Types must be defined before they are used.
41195
41196 @cindex <vector>
41197 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41198 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41199 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41200 @var{count}:
41201
41202 @smallexample
41203 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41204 @end smallexample
41205
41206 @cindex <union>
41207 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41208 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41209 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41210 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41211
41212 @smallexample
41213 <union id="@var{id}">
41214 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41215 @dots{}
41216 </union>
41217 @end smallexample
41218
41219 @cindex <struct>
41220 @cindex <flags>
41221 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41222 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41223 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41224 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41225 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41226 specified.
41227
41228 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41229
41230 @smallexample
41231 <struct id="@var{id}">
41232 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41233 @dots{}
41234 </struct>
41235 @end smallexample
41236
41237 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41238 No implicit padding is added.
41239
41240 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41241
41242 @smallexample
41243 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41244 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41245 @dots{}
41246 </struct>
41247 @end smallexample
41248
41249 @smallexample
41250 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41251 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41252 @dots{}
41253 </flags>
41254 @end smallexample
41255
41256 The @var{name} value is required.
41257 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41258 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41259 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41260
41261 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41262 is optional.
41263 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41264 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41265
41266 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41267 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41268
41269 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41270
41271 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41272 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41273
41274 @itemize @bullet
41275 @item
41276 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41277 @item
41278 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41279 @end itemize
41280
41281 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41282 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41283
41284 @itemize @bullet
41285 @item
41286 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41287
41288 @smallexample
41289 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41290 $1 = 42
41291 @end smallexample
41292
41293 @end itemize
41294
41295 @subsection Registers
41296 @cindex <reg>
41297
41298 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41299
41300 @smallexample
41301 <reg name="@var{name}"
41302 bitsize="@var{size}"
41303 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41304 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41305 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41306 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41307 @end smallexample
41308
41309 @noindent
41310 The components are as follows:
41311
41312 @table @var
41313
41314 @item name
41315 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41316
41317 @item bitsize
41318 The register's size, in bits.
41319
41320 @item regnum
41321 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41322 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41323 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41324 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41325 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41326 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41327 in order of increasing register number.
41328
41329 @item save-restore
41330 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41331 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41332 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41333 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41334 ABI.
41335
41336 @item type
41337 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41338 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41339 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41340 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41341 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41342 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41343
41344 @item group
41345 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41346 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41347 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41348 in @code{info registers}.
41349
41350 @end table
41351
41352 @node Predefined Target Types
41353 @section Predefined Target Types
41354 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41355
41356 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41357 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41358 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41359 types. The currently supported types are:
41360
41361 @table @code
41362
41363 @item bool
41364 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41365
41366 @item int8
41367 @itemx int16
41368 @itemx int32
41369 @itemx int64
41370 @itemx int128
41371 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41372
41373 @item uint8
41374 @itemx uint16
41375 @itemx uint32
41376 @itemx uint64
41377 @itemx uint128
41378 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41379
41380 @item code_ptr
41381 @itemx data_ptr
41382 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41383 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41384 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41385 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41386 may be marked as data pointers.
41387
41388 @item ieee_single
41389 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41390
41391 @item ieee_double
41392 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41393
41394 @item arm_fpa_ext
41395 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41396
41397 @item i387_ext
41398 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41399
41400 @item i386_eflags
41401 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41402
41403 @item i386_mxcsr
41404 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41405
41406 @end table
41407
41408 @node Enum Target Types
41409 @section Enum Target Types
41410 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41411
41412 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41413 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41414
41415 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41416
41417 @smallexample
41418 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41419 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41420 @dots{}
41421 </enum>
41422 @end smallexample
41423
41424 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41425
41426 @smallexample
41427 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41428 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41429 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41430 </enum>
41431 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41432 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41433 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41434 </flags>
41435 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41436 @end smallexample
41437
41438 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41439 would be printed as:
41440
41441 @smallexample
41442 (gdb) info register flags
41443 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41444 @end smallexample
41445
41446 @node Standard Target Features
41447 @section Standard Target Features
41448 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41449
41450 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41451 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41452 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41453 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41454 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41455 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41456 can recognize them.
41457
41458 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41459 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41460 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41461 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41462 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41463 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41464 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41465 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41466
41467 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41468 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41469 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41470
41471 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41472 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41473 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41474 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41475
41476 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41477 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41478 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41479
41480 @menu
41481 * AArch64 Features::
41482 * ARC Features::
41483 * ARM Features::
41484 * i386 Features::
41485 * MicroBlaze Features::
41486 * MIPS Features::
41487 * M68K Features::
41488 * NDS32 Features::
41489 * Nios II Features::
41490 * PowerPC Features::
41491 * S/390 and System z Features::
41492 * Sparc Features::
41493 * TIC6x Features::
41494 @end menu
41495
41496
41497 @node AArch64 Features
41498 @subsection AArch64 Features
41499 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41500
41501 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41502 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41503 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41504
41505 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41506 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41507 and @samp{fpcr}.
41508
41509 @node ARC Features
41510 @subsection ARC Features
41511 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41512
41513 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41514 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41515 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41516 that one of the core registers features is present.
41517 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41518
41519 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41520 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41521 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41522 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41523 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41524 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41525 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41526
41527 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41528 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41529 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41530 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41531 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41532 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41533
41534 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41535 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41536 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41537 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41538 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41539 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41540 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41541 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41542 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41543 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41544
41545 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41546 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41547
41548 @node ARM Features
41549 @subsection ARM Features
41550 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41551
41552 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41553 ARM targets.
41554 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41555 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41556
41557 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41558 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41559 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41560 and @samp{xpsr}.
41561
41562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41563 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41564
41565 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41566 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41567 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41568 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41569
41570 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41571 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41572 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41573 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41574 halves of the double-precision registers.
41575
41576 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41577 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41578 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41579 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41580 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41581 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41582
41583 @node i386 Features
41584 @subsection i386 Features
41585 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41586
41587 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41588 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41589
41590 @itemize @minus
41591 @item
41592 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41593 @item
41594 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41595 @item
41596 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41597 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41598 @item
41599 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41600 @item
41601 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41602 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41603 @end itemize
41604
41605 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41606
41607 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41608 describe registers:
41609
41610 @itemize @minus
41611 @item
41612 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41613 @item
41614 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41615 @item
41616 @samp{mxcsr}
41617 @end itemize
41618
41619 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41620 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41621 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41622
41623 @itemize @minus
41624 @item
41625 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41626 @item
41627 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41628 @end itemize
41629
41630 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41631 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41632
41633 @itemize @minus
41634 @item
41635 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41636 @item
41637 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41638 @end itemize
41639
41640 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41641 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41642
41643 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41644 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41645
41646 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41647 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41648 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41649
41650 @itemize @minus
41651 @item
41652 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41653 @end itemize
41654
41655 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41656
41657 @itemize @minus
41658 @item
41659 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41660 @end itemize
41661
41662 It should
41663 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41664
41665 @itemize @minus
41666 @item
41667 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41668 @item
41669 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41670 @end itemize
41671
41672 It should
41673 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41674
41675 @itemize @minus
41676 @item
41677 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41678 @end itemize
41679
41680 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41681 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41682 valid for i386 and amd64.
41683
41684 @node MicroBlaze Features
41685 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41686 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41687
41688 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41689 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41690 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41691 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41692 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41693
41694 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41695 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41696
41697 @node MIPS Features
41698 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41699 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41700
41701 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41702 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41703 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41704 on the target.
41705
41706 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41707 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41708 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41709
41710 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41711 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41712 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41713 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41714
41715 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41716 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41717 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41718 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41719
41720 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41721 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41722 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41723
41724 @node M68K Features
41725 @subsection M68K Features
41726 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41727
41728 @table @code
41729 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41730 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41731 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41732 One of those features must be always present.
41733 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41734 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41735 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41736 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41737
41738 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41739 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41740 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41741 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41742 @end table
41743
41744 @node NDS32 Features
41745 @subsection NDS32 Features
41746 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41747
41748 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41749 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41750 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41751 and @samp{pc}.
41752
41753 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41754 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41755 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41756 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41757
41758 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41759 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41760 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41761 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41762 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41763 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41764 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41765
41766 @node Nios II Features
41767 @subsection Nios II Features
41768 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41769
41770 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41771 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41772 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41773 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41774 @samp{mpuacc}).
41775
41776 @node PowerPC Features
41777 @subsection PowerPC Features
41778 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41779
41780 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41781 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41782 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41783 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41784
41785 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41786 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41787
41788 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41789 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41790 and @samp{vrsave}.
41791
41792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41793 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41794 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41795 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41796 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41797 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41798
41799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41800 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41801 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41802 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41803 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41804 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41805 user.
41806
41807 @node S/390 and System z Features
41808 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41809 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41810 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41811
41812 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41813 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41814 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41815 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41816 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41817 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41818 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41819 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41820 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41821
41822 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41823 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41824 @samp{fpc}.
41825
41826 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41827 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41828
41829 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41830 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41831 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41832 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41833 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41834 32-bit wide.
41835
41836 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41837 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41838 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41839
41840 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41841 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41842 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41843 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41844 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41845 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41846 @samp{v31}.
41847
41848 @node Sparc Features
41849 @subsection Sparc Features
41850 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41851 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41852 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41853 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41854
41855 @itemize @minus
41856 @item
41857 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41858 @item
41859 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41860 @item
41861 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41862 @item
41863 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41864 @end itemize
41865
41866 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41867
41868 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41869 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41870
41871 @itemize @minus
41872 @item
41873 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41874 @item
41875 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41876 @end itemize
41877
41878 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41879 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41880
41881 @itemize @minus
41882 @item
41883 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41884 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41885 @item
41886 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41887 for sparc64
41888 @end itemize
41889
41890 @node TIC6x Features
41891 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41892 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41893 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41894 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41895 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41896 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41897
41898 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41899 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41900 through @samp{B31}.
41901
41902 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41903 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41904
41905 @node Operating System Information
41906 @appendix Operating System Information
41907 @cindex operating system information
41908
41909 @menu
41910 * Process list::
41911 @end menu
41912
41913 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41914 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41915 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41916 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41917 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41918 on a different aspect of target.
41919
41920 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41921 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41922 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41923 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41924
41925 @node Process list
41926 @appendixsection Process list
41927 @cindex operating system information, process list
41928
41929 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41930 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41931 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41932 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41933
41934 An example document is:
41935
41936 @smallexample
41937 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41938 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41939 <osdata type="processes">
41940 <item>
41941 <column name="pid">1</column>
41942 <column name="user">root</column>
41943 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41944 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41945 </item>
41946 </osdata>
41947 @end smallexample
41948
41949 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41950 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41951 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41952 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41953 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41954 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41955 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41956
41957 @node Trace File Format
41958 @appendix Trace File Format
41959 @cindex trace file format
41960
41961 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41962 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41963
41964 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41965 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41966 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41967 in the future.
41968
41969 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41970 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41971 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41972 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41973 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41974 of this section.
41975
41976 @table @code
41977 @item R @var{size}
41978 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41979 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41980 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41981 a single trace file.
41982
41983 @item status @var{status}
41984 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41985 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41986 file.
41987
41988 @item tp @var{payload}
41989 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41990 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41991 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41992 reply packets.
41993
41994 @item tsv @var{payload}
41995 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41996 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41997 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41998 reply packets.
41999
42000 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42001 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42002 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42003 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42004 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42005 file. Includes are not allowed.
42006
42007 @end table
42008
42009 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42010 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42011 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42012 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42013 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42014 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42015 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42016 endianness.
42017
42018 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42019
42020 @table @code
42021 @item R @var{bytes}
42022 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42023 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42024 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42025
42026 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42027 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42028 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42029 @var{length} bytes.
42030
42031 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42032 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42033 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42034
42035 @end table
42036
42037 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42038 of blocks.
42039
42040 @node Index Section Format
42041 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42042 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42043 @cindex index section format
42044
42045 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42046 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42047 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42048 description.
42049
42050 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42051 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42052 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42053 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42054 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42055 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42056
42057 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42058
42059 @enumerate
42060 @item
42061 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42062 unless otherwise noted:
42063
42064 @enumerate
42065 @item
42066 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42067 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42068 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42069 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42070 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42071 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42072 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42073
42074 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42075 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42076 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42077 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42078
42079 @item
42080 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42081
42082 @item
42083 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42084 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42085 to the next offset.
42086
42087 @item
42088 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42089
42090 @item
42091 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42092
42093 @item
42094 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42095 @end enumerate
42096
42097 @item
42098 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42099 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42100 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42101 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42102 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42103 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42104 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42105 CU indices.
42106
42107 @item
42108 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42109 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42110 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42111 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42112
42113 @item
42114 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42115 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42116
42117 @enumerate
42118 @item
42119 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42120
42121 @item
42122 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42123 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42124
42125 @item
42126 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42127 @end enumerate
42128
42129 @item
42130 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42131 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42132
42133 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42134 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42135 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42136 constant pool.
42137
42138 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42139 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42140 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42141
42142 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42143 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42144 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42145 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42146 index version:
42147
42148 @table @asis
42149 @item Version 4
42150 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42151
42152 @item Versions 5 to 7
42153 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42154 @end table
42155
42156 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42157
42158 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42159 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42160 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42161 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42162 collision.
42163
42164 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42165 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42166 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42167 the code.
42168
42169 @item
42170 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42171 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42172 strings.
42173
42174 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42175 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42176 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42177 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42178 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42179 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42180
42181 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42182 @end enumerate
42183
42184 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42185 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42186 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42187
42188 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42189 (bit 0 = LSB):
42190
42191 @table @asis
42192
42193 @item Bits 0-23
42194 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42195 @item Bits 24-27
42196 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42197 @item Bits 28-30
42198 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42199
42200 @table @asis
42201 @item 0
42202 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42203 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42204 with previous versions of the index.
42205 @item 1
42206 The symbol is a type.
42207 @item 2
42208 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42209 @item 3
42210 The symbol is a function.
42211 @item 4
42212 Any other kind of symbol.
42213 @item 5,6,7
42214 These values are reserved.
42215 @end table
42216
42217 @item Bit 31
42218 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42219
42220 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42221 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42222 @value{GDBN} sources.
42223
42224 @end table
42225
42226 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42227 global/static attributes in the index.
42228
42229 @smallexample
42230 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42231 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42232 switch (die->tag)
42233 @{
42234 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42235 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42236 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42237 kind = TYPE;
42238 is_static = 1;
42239 break;
42240 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42241 kind = VARIABLE;
42242 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42243 break;
42244 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42245 kind = FUNCTION;
42246 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42247 break;
42248 case DW_TAG_constant:
42249 kind = VARIABLE;
42250 is_static = ! is_external;
42251 break;
42252 case DW_TAG_variable:
42253 kind = VARIABLE;
42254 is_static = ! is_external;
42255 break;
42256 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42257 kind = TYPE;
42258 is_static = 0;
42259 break;
42260 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42261 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42262 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42263 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42264 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42265 kind = TYPE;
42266 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42267 break;
42268 default:
42269 assert (0);
42270 @}
42271 @end smallexample
42272
42273 @node Man Pages
42274 @appendix Manual pages
42275 @cindex Man pages
42276
42277 @menu
42278 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42279 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42280 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42281 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42282 @end menu
42283
42284 @node gdb man
42285 @heading gdb man
42286
42287 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42288
42289 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42290 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42291 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42292 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42293 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42294 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42295 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42296 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42297 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42298 @c man end
42299
42300 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42301 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42302 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42303 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42304
42305 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42306 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42307
42308 @itemize @bullet
42309 @item
42310 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42311
42312 @item
42313 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42314
42315 @item
42316 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42317
42318 @item
42319 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42320 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42321 @end itemize
42322
42323 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42324 Modula-2.
42325
42326 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42327 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42328 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42329 by using the command @code{help}.
42330
42331 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42332 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42333 executable program as the argument:
42334
42335 @smallexample
42336 gdb program
42337 @end smallexample
42338
42339 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42340
42341 @smallexample
42342 gdb program core
42343 @end smallexample
42344
42345 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42346 to debug a running process:
42347
42348 @smallexample
42349 gdb program 1234
42350 gdb -p 1234
42351 @end smallexample
42352
42353 @noindent
42354 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42355 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42356 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42357
42358 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42359
42360 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42361 @table @env
42362 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42363 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42364
42365 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42366 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42367
42368 @item bt
42369 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42370
42371 @item print @var{expr}
42372 Display the value of an expression.
42373
42374 @item c
42375 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42376
42377 @item next
42378 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42379 function calls in the line.
42380
42381 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42382 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42383
42384 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42385 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42386
42387 @item step
42388 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42389 function calls in the line.
42390
42391 @item help [@var{name}]
42392 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42393 about using @value{GDBN}.
42394
42395 @item quit
42396 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42397 @end table
42398
42399 @ifset man
42400 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42401 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42402 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42403 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42404 @end ifset
42405 @c man end
42406
42407 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42408 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42409 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42410 encountered with no
42411 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42412 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42413 Many options have
42414 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42415 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42416 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42417 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42418 more usual convention.)
42419
42420 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42421 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42422 option is used.
42423
42424 @table @env
42425 @item -help
42426 @itemx -h
42427 List all options, with brief explanations.
42428
42429 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42430 @itemx -s @var{file}
42431 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42432
42433 @item -write
42434 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42435
42436 @item -exec=@var{file}
42437 @itemx -e @var{file}
42438 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42439 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42440 dump.
42441
42442 @item -se=@var{file}
42443 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42444 file.
42445
42446 @item -core=@var{file}
42447 @itemx -c @var{file}
42448 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42449
42450 @item -command=@var{file}
42451 @itemx -x @var{file}
42452 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42453
42454 @item -ex @var{command}
42455 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42456
42457 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42458 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42459 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42460
42461 @item -nh
42462 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42463
42464 @item -nx
42465 @itemx -n
42466 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42467
42468 @item -quiet
42469 @itemx -q
42470 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42471 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42472
42473 @item -batch
42474 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42475 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42476 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42477 commands in the command files.
42478
42479 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42480 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42481 more useful, the message
42482
42483 @smallexample
42484 Program exited normally.
42485 @end smallexample
42486
42487 @noindent
42488 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42489 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42490
42491 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42492 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42493 instead of the current directory.
42494
42495 @item -fullname
42496 @itemx -f
42497 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42498 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42499 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42500 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42501 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42502 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42503 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42504 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42505
42506 @item -b @var{bps}
42507 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42508 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42509
42510 @item -tty=@var{device}
42511 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42512 @end table
42513 @c man end
42514
42515 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42516 @ifset man
42517 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42518 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42519 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42520
42521 @smallexample
42522 info gdb
42523 @end smallexample
42524
42525 @noindent
42526 should give you access to the complete manual.
42527
42528 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42529 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42530 @end ifset
42531 @c man end
42532
42533 @node gdbserver man
42534 @heading gdbserver man
42535
42536 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42537 @format
42538 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42539 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42540
42541 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42542
42543 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42544 @c man end
42545 @end format
42546
42547 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42548 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42549 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42550
42551 @ifclear man
42552 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42553 @end ifclear
42554 @ifset man
42555 Usage (server (target) side):
42556 @end ifset
42557
42558 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42559 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42560 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42561 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42562
42563 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42564 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42565 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42566
42567 @smallexample
42568 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42569 @end smallexample
42570
42571 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42572
42573 @smallexample
42574 @ifset man
42575 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42576 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42577 @end ifset
42578 @ifclear man
42579 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42580 @end ifclear
42581 @end smallexample
42582
42583 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42584 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42585 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42586
42587 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42588
42589 @smallexample
42590 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42591 @end smallexample
42592
42593 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42594 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42595 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42596 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42597 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42598 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42599 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42600 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42601 print an error message and exit.
42602
42603 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42604 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42605
42606 @smallexample
42607 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42608 @end smallexample
42609
42610 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42611 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42612
42613 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42614 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42615 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42616 the program you want to debug.
42617
42618 @smallexample
42619 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42620 @end smallexample
42621
42622 @ifclear man
42623 @subheading Usage (host side)
42624 @end ifclear
42625 @ifset man
42626 Usage (host side):
42627 @end ifset
42628
42629 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42630 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42631 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42632 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42633 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42634 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42635 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42636 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42637 descriptor. For example:
42638
42639 @smallexample
42640 @ifset man
42641 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42642 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42643 @end ifset
42644 @ifclear man
42645 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42646 @end ifclear
42647 @end smallexample
42648
42649 @noindent
42650 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42651
42652 @smallexample
42653 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42654 @end smallexample
42655
42656 @noindent
42657 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42658 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42659 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42660 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42661 `Connection refused'.
42662
42663 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42664 described in
42665 @ifset man
42666 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42667 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42668 @end ifset
42669 @ifclear man
42670 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42671 @end ifclear
42672 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42673
42674 @smallexample
42675 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42676 @end smallexample
42677
42678 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42679 case.
42680 @c man end
42681
42682 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42683 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42684
42685 @itemize @bullet
42686
42687 @item
42688 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42689
42690 @smallexample
42691 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42692 @end smallexample
42693
42694 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42695 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42696 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42697 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42698 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42699 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42700 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42701
42702 @item
42703 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42704 program:
42705
42706 @smallexample
42707 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42708 @end smallexample
42709
42710 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42711 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42712 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42713 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42714
42715 @item
42716 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42717
42718 @smallexample
42719 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42720 @end smallexample
42721
42722 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42723 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42724 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42725 debug several processes in the same session.
42726 @end itemize
42727
42728 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42729
42730 @table @env
42731
42732 @item --help
42733 List all options, with brief explanations.
42734
42735 @item --version
42736 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42737
42738 @item --attach
42739 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42740
42741 @smallexample
42742 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42743 @end smallexample
42744
42745 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42746 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42747
42748 @item --multi
42749 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42750 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42751 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42752 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42753
42754 @smallexample
42755 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42756 @end smallexample
42757
42758 @item --debug
42759 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42760 process.
42761 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42762 the developers.
42763
42764 @item --remote-debug
42765 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42766 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42767 the developers.
42768
42769 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42770 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42771 of debugging output.
42772 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42773
42774 @item --wrapper
42775 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42776 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42777 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42778 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42779
42780 @item --once
42781 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42782 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42783 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42784 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42785
42786 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42787
42788 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42789 @c QDisableRandomization.
42790
42791 @end table
42792 @c man end
42793
42794 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42795 @ifset man
42796 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42797 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42798 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42799
42800 @smallexample
42801 info gdb
42802 @end smallexample
42803
42804 should give you access to the complete manual.
42805
42806 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42807 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42808 @end ifset
42809 @c man end
42810
42811 @node gcore man
42812 @heading gcore
42813
42814 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42815
42816 @format
42817 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42818 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42819 @c man end
42820 @end format
42821
42822 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42823 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42824 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42825 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42826 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42827 running without any change.
42828 @c man end
42829
42830 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42831 @table @env
42832 @item -o @var{filename}
42833 The optional argument
42834 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42835 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42836 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42837 @end table
42838 @c man end
42839
42840 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42841 @ifset man
42842 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42843 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42844 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42845
42846 @smallexample
42847 info gdb
42848 @end smallexample
42849
42850 @noindent
42851 should give you access to the complete manual.
42852
42853 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42854 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42855 @end ifset
42856 @c man end
42857
42858 @node gdbinit man
42859 @heading gdbinit
42860
42861 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42862
42863 @format
42864 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42865 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42866 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42867 @end ifset
42868
42869 ~/.gdbinit
42870
42871 ./.gdbinit
42872 @c man end
42873 @end format
42874
42875 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42876 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42877 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42878 described in
42879 @ifset man
42880 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42881 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42882 @end ifset
42883 @ifclear man
42884 @ref{Sequences}.
42885 @end ifclear
42886
42887 Please read more in
42888 @ifset man
42889 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42890 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42891 @end ifset
42892 @ifclear man
42893 @ref{Startup}.
42894 @end ifclear
42895
42896 @table @env
42897 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42898 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42899 @end ifset
42900 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42901 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42902 @end ifclear
42903 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42904 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42905 See more in
42906 @ifset man
42907 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42908 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42909 @end ifset
42910 @ifclear man
42911 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42912 @end ifclear
42913
42914 @item ~/.gdbinit
42915 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42916 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42917
42918 @item ./.gdbinit
42919 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42920 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42921 See more in
42922 @ifset man
42923 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42924 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42925 @end ifset
42926 @ifclear man
42927 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42928 @end ifclear
42929 @end table
42930 @c man end
42931
42932 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42933 @ifset man
42934 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42935
42936 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42937 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42938 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42939
42940 @smallexample
42941 info gdb
42942 @end smallexample
42943
42944 should give you access to the complete manual.
42945
42946 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42947 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42948 @end ifset
42949 @c man end
42950
42951 @include gpl.texi
42952
42953 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42954 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42955 @include fdl.texi
42956
42957 @node Concept Index
42958 @unnumbered Concept Index
42959
42960 @printindex cp
42961
42962 @node Command and Variable Index
42963 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42964
42965 @printindex fn
42966
42967 @tex
42968 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42969 % meantime:
42970 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42971 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42972 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42973 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42974 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42975 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42976 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42977 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42978 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42979 \page\colophon
42980 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42981 @end tex
42982
42983 @bye
This page took 1.046556 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.